An Introduction to Modern Philosophy: Examining the Human Condition [6 ed.] 0023200928, 9780023200922

This popular introduction to modern philosophy features question-based chapters with a stimulating debate-style format,

410 74 69MB

English Pages 774 Year 1993

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD FILE

Polecaj historie

An Introduction to Modern Philosophy: Examining the Human Condition [6 ed.]
 0023200928, 9780023200922

Citation preview

1d by

ic or 1 in writ-

Alfred A. Knopf. ALBERT CAMUS, The Plague, Stuart Gilbert, trans., 1972. Copyright © 1948 by Stuart Gilbert. Reprinted by permission of Alfred A. Knopf, Inc. American Society for Aesthetics. MORRIS WEITZ, "The Role of Theory in Aesthetics," in The Journal of Aesthetics and Art Criticism XV, No. 1 (September 1956). Reprinted by permission. Atheneum. HENRY CLARKE WARREN, trans., "Introduction to the ]akata (i.58.81) and the Mahavagga (i.21.1)," in Buddhism in Translation, 1987. Bantam Doubleday Dell Publishing Group, Inc. RAYMOND A. MOODY, JR., The Light Beyond, copyright© 1988 by Raymond A. Moody, Jr. Used by permis­ sion of Bantam Doubleday Dell Publishing Group, Inc. Beacon Press. VIKTOR E. FRANKL, from Man's Search for Meaning: An Intrc1duction to Logotherapy, copyright© 1959, 1962, 1984, 1992 by Viktor E. Frankl, Reprinted by permission of Beacon Press. Benziger Publishing Company. SAINT THOMAS AQUINAS, Summa Theologiuz, Laurence Shapcote, trans., 1911. Excerpts reprinted by permission. Brown University. BRAND BLANSHARD, "The New Subjectivism in Ethics," in Philosophy and Phenomenological Research 9, No. 3 (March 1949). Reprinted by permission. Cambridge University Press. NED BLOCK, "What Intuitions About Homunculi Don't Show," in Behavioral and Brain Sciences, Vol. 3 (1980). Reprinted with the permission of Cambridge University Press. Cambridge University Press. BRUCE BRIDGEMAN, "Brains + Progress = Minds," in Behavioral and Brain Sciences, Vol. 3 (1980). Reprinted with the permission of Cambridge University Press. Cambridge University Press. JOHN SEARLE, "Minds, Brains and Programs," in Behavioral and Brain Sciences, Vol. 3 (1980). Reprinted with the permission of Cambridge University Press. Dover Publications, Inc. A. J. AYER, Language, Truth and Logic, 2nd ed., 1946. Reprinted by permission. Frederick Ungar Publishing Co. CORLISS LAMONT, The Illusion of Immortality, rev. ed., 1965. Reprinted by permission of the author.

iii

ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

HarperCollins, Publishers, Inc. ANTONY FLEW, The Presumption of Atheism, 1976. Reprinted by permission of HarperCollins, Publisher, Inc. HarperCollins, Publishers1 Inc. GILBERT RYLE, The Concept of Mind, approximately 20 pages. Copyright© 1949 by Gilbert Ryle. Reprinted by permission of HarperCollins, Publishers, Inc. HarperCollins, Publishers, Inc. WALTER STACE, Religion and the Modern Mind, selected excerpt. Copyright© 1952 by W. T. Stace. Reprinted by permission of HarperCollins, Publishers, Inc. Harvard University Press. ALVIN I. GOLDMAN, Epistemology and Cognition, 1986. Reprinted by permission of the publishers, Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press, copyright© 1986 by the President and Fellows of Harvard College. Johns Hopkins University Press. HERBERT FEIGL, The Scientific Outlook: Naturalism and Humanism," in American Quarterly l (1949). Reprinted by permission. Macmillan Publishing Company. H. GENE BLOCKER, Philosophy of Art, 1979. Reprinted with the permission of Charles Scribner's Sons, an imprint of Macmillan Publishing Company. Copyright© 1979 Gene Blocker. The New York Times Company. JOI-IN MARKOFF, Can Machines Think? Humans Match Wits/' The New York Times, November 9, 1991. Copyright© 1991 by the New York Times Company. Oxford University Press. From The New English Bible. Copyright © the Delegates of the Oxford University Press and the Syndics of the Cambridge University Press, 1961, 1970, 1989. Reprinted by permission. Oxford University Press. A. J. AYER, Demonstration of the Impossibility of Metaphysics," in Mind XLIII (1934). Oxford University Press. RICHARD M. HARE, The Language of Morals, 1952. Reprinted by permission of Oxford University Press. Oxford University Press. A. M. TURING, 'Computing Machinery and Intelligence," in Mind 59, (1950). Reprinted by permission of Oxford University Press. Philosophical Library. JEAN-PAUL SARTRE, Existentialism Is a Humanism, copyright © 1946. Reprinted by permission. Prentice Hall. NORMAN MALCOLM, Knowledge and Certainty, copyright© 1963 by Norman Malcolm. Princeton University Press. S. RADHAKRISHNAN AND CHARLES A. MOORE, eds., "Samyutta Nikayo, 5.420," cited in A Source Book in Indian Philosophy, 1957. Reprinted by permission. Princeton University Press. RICHARD RORTY, Philosophy and the Mirror of Nature, 1979. Reprinted by permission. Routledge, Chapman and Hall, Inc. PAUL FEYERABEND, "Introduction !l from his Against Method, rev. ed., 1988, by permission of the publisher, Routledge, Chapman and Halt Inc. Routledge, Chapman and Hall, Inc. ALISON JAGGAR, "Love and Knowledge: Emotion in Feminist Epistemology." Reprinted from Women, Knowledge and 11

11

11

1

ACKNOWLEDGMENTS

V

Reality, Ann Garry and Marilyn Pearsall, eds., 1989, by permission of the pub­ lisher, Routledge, Chapman and Hall, Inc. Routledge & Kegan Paul Ltd. PETER GEACH, "Immortality," in God and the Soul, 1969. Rowman & Littlefield Publishers. ROBERT ALMEDER, Death and Personal Survival: The Evidence for Life After Death, copyright© 1992 by Rowman & Littlefield Publishers. Reprinted by permission. St. Martin's Press, Inc. DOROTHY EMMET, from The Moral Prism, 1979. Reprinted with permission of St. Martin's Press, Incorporated. SCM Press Ltd. ANTONY FLEW, "Theology and Falsification," in New Essays in Philosophical Theology, Antony Flew and Alasdair MacIntyre, eds., 1955, pp. 90-96. Reprinted by permission. Scientific American, Inc. JERRY FODOR, The Mind-Body Problem (January 1981). Reprinted with permission. Copyright© 1981 by Scientific American, Inc. All rights reserved. Springer-Verlag. JOHN ECCLES, The Self and Its Brain, copyright© 1976. Reprinted by permission. Springer-Verlag. KARL POPPER, The Self and Its Brain, copyright© 1976. Reprinted by permission. Theology Today. JOHN HICK, "Theology and Verification," in Theology Today 17 (1960). Reprinted by permission. University of California Press. C. J. DUCASSE, Is Life After Death Possible?, Foerster Lecture Series 2, copyright© 1948 by the Regents of the University of California. University of California Press. LARRY LAUDEN, Science and Values: An Essay on the Aims of Science and Their Role in Scientific Debate, excerpts from Chapter 4, copyright© 1984 The Regents of the University of California. University of Chicago Press. THOMAS KUHN, "The Structure of Scientific Revolutions," originally published in International Encyclopedia of UniJied Science, Vol. 2, No. 2, 1962. University Press of America. ALBERT SCHEVEN, comp., Swahili Proverbs, 1985. Reprinted by permission. Westview Press. KEITH LEHRER, Theory of Knowledge, 1990. Reprinted by permis­ sion of Westview Press, Boulder,Colorado. Writers House, Inc. MARTIN LUTHER KING, JR., "Letter from Birmingham Jail, April 16, 1963," from Why We Can't Wait. Reprinted by arrangement with The Heirs to the Estate of Martin Luther King, Jr., c/o Joan Daves Agency as agent for the proprietor. Copyright© 1963 by Martin Luther King, Jr., copyright renewed 1991 by Coretta Scott King. Yale University Press. WILLIAM KELLY SIMPSON, ed., "Wisdom of Ptahhotpe," in The Literature of Ancient Egypt, 1972. Excerpts reprinted by permission. Yale University Press. C. L. STEVENSON, Ethics and Language, 1944. Excerpts reprinted by permission.

This text continues to be aimed at introducing students to the wonder and rigor of philosophical analysis. We have tried for a balance between making things plain to the novice and being true to the rigorous demands of philosophy. This is the justifi­ cation for our editorial comments breaking up the original sources and for occa­ sional contemporary renderings of older works. Sometimes the material is just too difficult or too long for beginning students, who often need to be reassured that they have actually understood a passage before they are ready to go on. Each chapter reflects answers to the enduring questions of philosophy. Two new sections have been added to this edition: Chapter 11, What Is Science: Positivism to Postmodernism, and an epilogue, Making Sense Out of Life. To make room for these and other additions, the chapter on the philosophy of history has been omitted from this edition. The following chapters have been considerably expanded by adding more points of view as represented by contemporary readings: Chapter 21 Am I a Body and a Mind?; Chapter 3, Am I Free or Determined?; Chapter 4, Can l Survive Death?; Chapter 6, On What Principles Do I Judge Things Right or Wrong?; and Chapter 10, When Can I Say "I Know"? The text now covers identity theory as well as the cognitive science approach to the mind-body problem, including articles by Jerry Fodor, A. M. Turing, John Searle, and two replies to Searle; also included is Norman Malcolm on other minds and an attempt at a neurophysiological defense of dualism by Sir John Eccles. On the free-will issue, John Bender offers a strong contemporary defense of compatibilism; Karl Popper gives a spirited critique of scientifically based determinism. In the section on immortality, new data on the existence of an after­ life is presented, along with an analysis by Peter Geach of what immortality ought to mean. Bernard Gert and Dorothy Emmet on ethics; Alvin Goldman and Keith Lehrer on epistemology; and Thomas Kuhn, Larry Laudan, Allison Jaggar, Paul Feyerabend, and Richard Rorty on science and the relativism of knowledge round out the additions. The epilogue shows how a philosophical mind would try to make sense of the question "What is the meaning of life?" We take up non-Western answers in this section so that students can see a broad approach to answers. Given that

vii

A NOTE ON THE SIXTH EDITION

philosophical questions asked in the Socratic tradition aim at an answer to "What is the good life-a life with meaning?" we see this epilogue as an appropriate end to the book. We are convinced that these additions and especially the epilogue would be pleasing to Alburey Castell, who edited the first edition in 1943 and continued to be senior editor until his death in 1987. We would like to thank the Macmillan editor of Philosophy and Religion, Maggie Barbieri, for her enthusiastic support of this revised edition. Our thanks also go to Sharon Lee, the production editor for this book at Macmillan. We were also helped with the permissions by Gina McCormack and Ami Johnston and with copy editing by Peg Gluntz. Chris Delasandry assisted with the compiling of the index. And as always, Alice Donohoe, the Philosophy Department secretary, made everything work. Naturally, our wives, Mary Ellen and Laurie, have to be thanked, for if any­ one suffered through the pains of producing this book, they did.

Donald M. Borchert Arthur Zucker Ohio University Athens, Ohio August 1993

CHAPTER 1

What Is Philosophy? 1.1

1 Socrates: THE EXAMINED LIFE

2

CHAPTER 2

Am I a Body and a Mind? 2.1 2.2 2.3

2.4

2.5 2.6 2.7 2.8

2.9

21

The Question Posed 21 Rene Descartes: I AM A MIND (RES COG/TANS) AND A BODY (RES EXTENSA) 23 Gilbert Ryle: DESCARTES WAS CONFUSED 32 J. J. C. Smart: THE IDENTITY THEORY 46 Jerry Fodor: FUNCTIONALISM AS A CRITIQUE 50 OF IDENTITY THEORY AND LOGICAL BEHAVIORISM A. M. Turing: MACHINES CAN THINK 65 John Searle: COMPUTERS CANNOT THINK 72 Bruce Bridgeman and Ned Block: SEARLE IS MISTAKEN Norman Malcolm: THE ARGUMENT FROM ANALOGY FOR OTHER MINDS IS BASED ON A MISCONCEPTION 81 John Eccles: CONTEMPORARY DUALISM 86

76

CHAPTER 3

Am ; Free or Determined?

3.1 3.2 3.3

3.4

91 The Question Posed 91 92 Baron D'Holbach: I AM DETERMINED Jean-Paul Sartre: I AM FREE 99 Walter T. Stace: I AM DETERMINED AND FREE 110 William James: THE DILEMMA OF DETERMINISM 119 ix

CONTENTS

3.5

Karl Popper: AN ARGUMENT FOR INDETERMINISM

3.6 John W Bender: COMPATIBlUSM IS NO QUAGMIRE

131 134

CHAPTER 4

Can I Survive Death? 153 The Question Posed 153 4.1 Corliss Lamont: DEATH IS THE END 155 4.2 Curt John Ducasse: THE QUESTION IS STILL OPEN 167 175 4.3 Robert Almeder: DEATH IS NOT THE END 4.4 Peter Geach: DUALISM REJECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED 4.5 Antony Flew: DEATH IS THE END 209

200

CHAPTER 5

What Grounds Do I Have for Belief in God? 221 The Question Posed 221 5.1 Thomas Aquinas: BELIEF SUPPORTED BY PROOFS 224 5.2 Blaise Pascal: BELIEF WITHOUT PROOFS 231 240 5.3 David Hume: DOUBTS ABOUT NATURAL THEOLOGY 5.4 John Stuart Mill: A FINITE GOD 249 259 5.5 TH. Huxley: AGNOSTICISM--THE ONLY LEGITIMATE RESPONSE 265 5.6 William James: LEGITIMATE BELIEF IN SPITE OF AGNOSTICISM 274 5.7 Antony Flew and John Hick: FALSIFICATION AND VERIFICATION CHAPTER 6

289 On What Principle Do I Judge Things Right or Wrong? The Question Posed 289 292 6.1 William Paley: THE WILL OF GOD 299 6.2 Immanuel Kant: THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE 311 6.3 John Stuart Mill: THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS 322 6.4 Friedrich Nietzsche: THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY 6.5 A. J. Ayer: EMOTIVISM AFFIRMED 340 6.6 Brand Blanshard: EMOTIVISM CRITIQUED 348 6.7 C. L. Stevenson: EMOTIVISM REFINED 357 374 6.8 R. M. Hare: PRESCRIPTIVISM-REFINEMENTS ON STEVENSON 6. 9 Bernard Gert: MORALITY 389 397 6.10 Dorothy Emmet: THE MORAL PRISM

xi

CONTENTS

CHAPTER

7

When Should I Conform to the Law?

403

The Question Posed 403 Thomas Hobbes: THE CASE FOR THE LEGISLATIVE LIFE 404 412 7.2 Jean Jacques Rousseau: THE CASE FOR THE COMMON GOOD 422 7.3 Edmund Burke: THE CASE FOR CONSERVATISM 432 7.4 Karl Marx: THE CASE FOR REVOLUTION 447 7.5 John Stuart Mill: THE CASE FOR LIBERTY AND LAW 466 7.6 Martin Luther King: THE CASE FOR CIVIL DISOBEDIENCE 7.1

CHAPTER

8

What Things Shall I Call Art?

8.1 8.2 8.3 8.4 8.5 8.6

479

The Question Posed 479 H. Gene Blocker: ART AS REPRESENTATION OF REALITY 480 Eugene Veron: ART AS EXPRESSION OF EMOTION 493 Leo Tolstoy: ART AS COMMUNICATION OF EMOTION 501 R. G. Collingwood: ART AS EXPRESSION OF EMOTION 508 John Hospers: CRITIQUE OF EXPRESSIONISM 514 Morris Weitz: IS AESTHETICS FOUNDED ON A MISTAKE? 526

CHAPTER 9

What Shall I Say About Ultimate Reality? 9.1 9.2 9.3

9.4

CHAPTER

557

10

When Can I Say "I Know"?

10.l 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6

537

The Question Posed 537 Thomas Hobbes: THE CLAIMS OF MATERIALISM 539 George Berkeley: THE CLAIMS OF IDEALISM 546 Arthur Schopenhauer: THE CLAIMS OF VOLUNTARISM Auguste Comte: THE CLAIMS OF POSITIVISM 571

581

The Question Posed 581 David Hume: AN APPEAL TO EXPERIENCE 582 590 Immanuel Kant: A CRITIQUE OF REASON IN EXPERIENCE A. J. Ayer: A CRITIQUE FROM LOGICAL POSITIVISM 601 612 R. G. Collingwood: THE PRESUPPOSITIONS OF KNOWLEDGE Alvin Goldman: THE ELEMENTS OF EPISTEMOLOGY 618 Keith Lehrer: THE ANALYSIS OF KNOWLEDGE 625

CONTENTS CHAPTER 11

What Is Science?-Positivism to Postmodernism The Question Posed 631 11.1 Herbert Feigl: THE POSITIVIST VIEW OF SCIENCE 11.2 Thomas Kuhn: PROBLEMS WITH THE POSITIVISTIC INTERPRETATIONS OF SCIENCE 640 11.3 Paul Feyerabend: RELATIVISM, EVEN IN SCIENCE,

11.4 11.5 11.6 11.7

631 631

IS THE ONLY CONCLUSION 649 Larry Laudan: KUHN HAS MISREAD SCIENCE AND ITS HISTORY 653 Alison Jaggar: SCIENCE IS NEITHER OBJECTIVE NOR UNEMOTIONAL 663 Richard Rorty: RELATIVISM MEANS THE END OF PHILOSOPHY 672 H Gene Blocker: AN EXPLANATION OF POSTMODERNISM 674

EPILOGUE

Making Sense Out of Life 683 The Question Posed 683 1. Viktor E. Frankl: THE WILL TO MEANING 686 2. The Biblical Tradition: THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS 3. The Buddhist Tradition: THE STORY OF

4. 5.

TRANSCENDING SUFFERING 710 THE STORY OF PURSUING THE MORAL IDEAL 718 Albert Camus: THE STORY OF COMBATTING SUFFERING

699

The African Tradition:

Glossary 739 Index 757

731

his book is an introduction to philosophy. It is written with the beginning stu­ dent of philosophy in mind. We must, therefore, try to get clear from the outset what "philosophy" is. People use the word "philosophy" in a number of contexts. Perhaps you have heard breweries advertise their philosophy of beer making, and innkeepers proclaim their philosophy of innkeeping, and coaches debate their philosophies of football or basketball. When people speak of "philosophy" in these settings " or " or "a personal they usually take the word to mean "a point of something." And while these people use "a personal way or technique for unhesitatingly, most of them would probably be the term "philosophy" somewhat reluctant to call themselves philosophers. Indeed, would we find it rather strange if we heard one of them say, As a philosopher, I think a hotel should be managed to ensure that every unit turns a profit"? This hesitancy of people to call themselves "philosophers" at the same time that they find themselves expounding on their "philosophies" of this or that sug­ gests that they sense that the philosophy of the philosopher is something other than a personal point of view or a certain technique for doing something. What, then, does philosophy mean for the philosopher? The term "philosophy" is derived from two Greek words: philein meaning "to " love" and sophia meaning "wisdom." Philosophy, then, is "the love of and a philosopher is a "lover of wisdom." According to an ancient tradition, the first person to call himself a "philosopher" was the sixth century B.C. Greek thinker, Pythagoras. But what does it mean to call oneself a lover of wisdom? And what is this "wisdom" that the philosopher loves, seeks, and pursues? Clearly, what we are looking for is a definition of philosophy. An engaging and instructive way to for­ mulate one is to observe a philosopher action and then single out those char­ acteristics of the philosopher which seem to make that person a philosopher. Let 11

1

THE EXAMINED LIFE

us try such an approach, and let us consider as our model philosopher Socrates whose status as a philosopher is eminent and secure. The material we have selected to represent Socrates is basically the account of his trial recorded b y one of his most celebrated students, Plato. As you read Plato's account of Socrates defending himself before a citizen jury in Athens almost 2,500 years ago, try to fig­ ure out what it is about Socrates that has led people to regard him as a notable philosopher.

1

SOCRATES

THE EXAMINED UFE

Socrates was born about 470 B.c.-shortly after the Persian invasions of Greece had been repulsed and just before a golden age of Athenian culture flourished under the leadership of Pericles. From 460 B.C. until his death in 430 B.C., Pericles was the political leader of an increasingly democratic and culturally creative Athens. The flowering of Athenian culture at this time was magnificently symbol­ ized by Pericles' reconstruction of the Acropolis with its new majestic Parthenon­ a temple dedicated to the goddess Athena whose colossal statue, carved in gold and ivory by Phidias and set within the Parthenon, reminded the Athenians that their success over the Persians and the glories of their expanding empire were gifts of the gods. As democracy developed in Athens a key factor in a politician's success became the ability to influence the citizenry through eloquent speeches. Accordingly, when various itinerant scholars called the Sophists-who tried to popularize knowledge and who offered lessons in rhetoric-appeared in Athens during the fifth century B.C., they were sought out by young Athenians with political ambitions. These Sophists concentrated on the techniques of persuasion and refutation. They taught their clientele how to defend and oppose various conflicting opinions with the consequence that serious questions were raised whether or not there was any abiding truth to which all humans could assent. In such an intellectual climate it is not surprising that belief in the traditional gods came to be questioned. Nor is it surprising that the conservative and traditional sectors of Athenian society viewed the teachings of the Sophists with great alarm. Indeed when one of Pericles' friends among the Sophists was prosecuted for his alleged pernicious religious ideas, not even the intervention of Pericles himself could save the Sophist from condemnation. As Athens entered its protracted struggle with Sparta, the Athenian democ­ racy became the victim of incompetent leadership, treachery, and fickle public opinion, all of which contributed to the humiliating defeat of Athens in 404 B.C. No clearer evidence of the weakness of Athenian democracy can be found than the situation that prevailed in the courts. Citizen juries, which had been intro­ duced by Solon in the sixth century as a court of appeal, were enlarged until they comprised some six thousand jurors. These jurors were subdivided into smaller

l

SOCRATES

3

juries, each of which contained five hundred and one jurors. To enable even the poorest of citizens to leave their work to participate in juries, the Athenians legis­ lated payment for jury service. This truly noble idea, however, was corrupted when the state treasury became exhausted and juries found it convenient to lay heavy fines on accused citizens, irrespective of their guilt or innocence, in order to insure that the funds would be available for their salaries. In this environment, the additional decadent practice developed whereby wealthy citizens would be accused of fictitious crimes to entice them to settle out of court with their accusers rather than face the greed of a citizen jury. It was before such a jury that Socrates was hauled in 399 B.C. to respond to charges that he was corrupting the youth of Athens with his teachings. And it is to Socrates' defense on that occasion that we wish to direct our attention to view a philosopher in action. Bear in mind that Athenian society was far from stable. In the aftermath of Sparta's victory over Athens, the nobles were struggling with the democratic masses for control of the state; and the ideas of the Sophists were vying with the traditional beliefs for the intellectual commitment of the citizenry. It was not an enviable time to stand before a citizen's jury in Athens. Yet the seventy-year-old Socrates presents a courageous and noble defense. Socrates begins with a plea that he be allowed to speak in his accustomed manner, the power of which resides not in the force of eloquence but in the force of truth. How you, 0 Athenians, have been affected by my accusers, I cannot tell; but I know that they almost made me forget who I was-so persuasively did they speak; and yet they have hardly uttered a word of truth. But of the many falsehoods told by them, there was one which quite amazed me-I mean when they said that you should be upon your guard and not allow yourselves to be deceived by the force of my elo­ quence. To say this, when they were certain to be detected as soon as I npened my lips and proved myself to be anything but a great speaker, did indeed appear to me most shameless-unless by the force of eloquence they mean the force of truth; for if such is their meaning, I admit that I am eloquent. But in how different a way from theirs! Well, as I was saying, they have scarcely spoken the truth at all; but from me you shall hear the whole truth; not, however, delivered after their manner in a set oration duly ornamented with words and phrases. No, by heaven! but I shall use the words and arguments which occur to me at the moment; for I am confident in the justice of my cause; at my time of life I ought not to be appearing before you, 0 men of Athens, in the character of a juvenile orator-let no one expect it of me. And I must beg of you to grant me a favor-if I defend myself in my accustomed manner and you hear me using the words which I have been in the habit of using in the agora, at the tables of the money-changers, or anywhere else, I would ask you not to be sur­ prised, and not to interrupt me on this account. For I am more than seventy years of age, and appearing now for the first time in a court of law, I am quite a stranger to the language of the place; and therefore I would have you regard me as if I were really a stranger, whom you would excuse if he spoke in his native tongue and after the fash­ ion of his country-Am I making an unfair request of you? Never mind the manner, which may or may not be good; but think only of the truth of my words, and give heed to that; let the speaker speak truly and the judge decide justly.

THE EXAMINED LIFE

Socrates proceeds to identify the charges leveled against him. It is alleged that he is a student of the physical world, with the implication that such studies are incompatible with traditional religious belief. After all, if you demythologize heavenly bodies by saying the sun is rock and the moon is earth, have you not discarded the notion that the sun and the moon are divine beings? Furthermore, it is alleged that Socrates has traditional values all mixed up when he debates with people. That is to say, what most people would regard as"good," he consid­ ered to be"evil," and vice versa. And furthermore, he accepts money from people to teach them these problematic doctrines. These accusations had been associated with Socrates for many years and were reinforced publicly in the play, Clouds, by Aristophanes, who made Socrates appear as a shiftless, ridiculous wizard with words. Well, then, I must make my defence, and endeavor to clear away in a short time, a slander which has lasted a long time.May I succeed, if to succeed be for my good and yours, or likely to avail me in my cause! The task is not an easy one; I quite under­ stand the nature of it. And so leaving the event with God, in obedience to the law, I will now make my defence. I will begin at the beginning, and ask what is the accusation which has given rise to the slander of me, and in fact has encouraged Meletus to prefer this charge against me. Welt wh1at do the slanderers say? They shall be my prosecutors, and I will sum up their wmtls in an affidavit: "Socrates is an evil-doer, and a curious person, who searches into things under the earth and in heaven, and he makes the worse appear the better cause; and he teaches the aforesaid doctrines to others." Such is the nature of the accusation; it is just what you have yourselves seen in the comedy of Aristophanes, who has introduced a man whom he calls Socrates, going about and saying that he walks in air, and talking a deal of nonsense concerning matters of which I do not pretend to know either much or little-not that I mean to speak dis­ paragingly of any one who is a student of natural philosophy. I should be very sorry if Meletus could bring so grave a charge against me. But the simple truth is, 0 Athenians, that I have nothing to do with physical speculations. Very many of those here present are witnesses to the truth of this, and to them I appeal. Speak then, you who have heard me, and tell your neighbors whether any of you have ever known me hold forth in few words or in many upon such matters....You hear the answer. And from what they say of this part of the charge you will be able to judge of the truth of the rest. As little foundation is there for the report that I am a teacher, and take money; this accusation has no more truth in it than the other. Although, if a man were really able to instruct mankind, to receive money for giving instruction would, in my opin­ ion, be an honor to him. There is Gorgias of Leontium, and Prodicus of Ceos, and Hippias of Elis, who go the round of the cities, and are able to persuade the young men to leave their own citizens by whom they might be taught for nothing, and come to them whom they not only pay, but are thankful if they may be allowed to pay them. I dare say, Athenians, that some one among you will reply, 'Yes, Socrates, but what is the origin of these accusations which are brought against you; there must have been something strange which you have been doing? All these rumors and this talk about you would never have arisen if you had been like other men; tell us, then,

what is the cause of them, for we should be sorry of you.' Now regard this as a fair challenge, and will endeavor to explain to you the reason am called wise and have such an evil fame. Please to attend then. And although some of you may think that am joking, declare that I will tell you the entire truth. Men of Athens, this reputation of mine has come of a certain sort of wisdom which possess. If you ask me what kind of wisdom, reply, wisdom such as may perhaps be attained by man, for that extent am inclined to believe that I am wise; whereas the persons of whom I was speaking have a superhuman wisdom, which I may fail to describe, because have it not myself; and he who says that I have, speaks falsely, and is taking away my character. And here, 0 men of Athens, I must beg you not to interrupt me, even, if I seem to say something extravagant. For the word which I will speak is not mine. will refer you to a witness who is worthy of credit; that witness shall be the God of Delphi-he will tell you about my wisdom, if I have any, and of what sort it is. You must have known Chaerephon; he was early a friend of mine, and also a friend of yours, for he shared in the recent exile of the people, and returned with you. Well, Chaerephon, as you know, was very impetuous in all his doings, and he went to Delphi and boldly asked the oracle to tell him whether-as I was saying, I must beg you not to interrupt-he asked the oracle to tell him whether any one was wiser than I was, and the Pythian prophetess answered, that there was no man wiser. Chaerephon is dead himself; but his brother, who is in court, will confirm the truth of what I am saying. Why do I mention this? Because I am going to explain to you why I have such an evil name. When I heard the answer, I said to myself, What can the god mean? and what is the interpretation of his riddle? for I know that I have no wisdom, small or great. What then can he mean when he says that I am the wisest of men? And yet he is a god, and cannot lie; that would be against his nature. After long consideration, I thought of a method of trying the question. I reflect that if I could only /-ind a man wiser than myself, then might go to the god with a refutation in my hand. I should say to him, 'Here is a man who is wiser than I am; but you said that I was the wisest.' Accordingly I went to one who had the reputation of wisdom, and observed him­ his name I need not mention; he was a politician whom I selected for examination­ and the result was as follows: When I began to talk with him, could not help think­ ing that he was not really wise, although he was thought wise by many, and still wiser by himself; and thereupon tried to explain to him that he thought himself wise, but was not really wise; and the consequence was that he hated me, and his enmity was shared by several who were present and heard me. So I left him, saying to myself, as I went away: Well, although I do not suppose that either of us knows anything really beautiful and good, I am better off than he is,-for he knows nothing, and thinks that he knows; I neither know nor think that know. In this latter particu­ lar, then, I seem to have slightly the advantage of him. Then I went to another who had still higher pretensions to wisdom, and my conclusion was exactly the same. Whereupon I made another enemy of him, and of many others besides him. Then I went to one man after another, being not unconscious of the enmity which I provoked, and I lamented and feared this: But necessity was laid upon me,­ the word of God, thought, ought to be considered first. And I said to myself, Go I must to all who appear to know, and find out the meaning of the oracle. And I swear to you, Athenians, by the dog I swear---for I must tell you the truth-the result of my mission was just this: I found that the men most in repute were all but the most fool­ ish; and that others less esteemed were really wiser and better.

many enemies of the worst most danhad led to This gerous kind, and has occasion also to many calumnies. And am called wise, for my hearers always that myself possess the wisdom which find in others; but the truth is, 0 men of Athens, that God only is wise; and his answer he intends to show that the wisdom of men is worth little or nothing; he is not ing of Socrates, he is only using my name by way of illustration, as if he said, He, 0 men, is the wisest, who, like Socrates, knows that his wisdom is in truth worth noth­ ing. And so go about the world, obedient to the god, and search and make enquiry into the wisdom of any one, whether citizen or stranger, who appears to be wise; and if he is not wise, then in vindication of the oracle I show him that he is not wise; and my occupation quite absorbs me, and I have no time to give either to any public mat­ ter of interest or to any concern of my own, but I am in utter poverty by reason of my devotion to the god. There is another thing-young men of the richer classes, who have not much to do, come about me of their own accord; they like to hear the pretenders examined, and they often imitate me, and proceed to examine others; there are plenty of per­ sons, as they quickly discover, who think that they know something but really know little or nothing; and then those who are examined by them instead of being angry with themselves are angry with me: This confounded Socrates, they say; this villain­ ous misleader of youth!-and if somebody asks them, Why, what evil does he prac­ tise or teach? they do not know, and cannot tell; but in order that they may not appear to be at a loss, they repeat the ready-made charges which are used against all philosophers about teaching things up in the clouds and under the earth, and having no gods, making the worse appear the better cause; for they do not like to confess that their pretence of knowledge has been detected-which is the truth; and as they are numerous and ambitious and energetic, and are drawn up in battle array and have persuasive tongues, they have filled your ears with their loud and inveterate calumnies. And this is the reason why my three accusers, Meletus and and Lycon, have set upon me; Meletus, who has a quarrel with me on behalf of the Anytus, on behalf of the craftsmen and politicians; behalf of the rhetori­ cians; and as said at the beginning, I cannot expect to get rid of such a mass of calumny all in a moment. And this, 0 men of Athens, is the truth and the whole truth; I have concealed nothing, I have dissembled nothing. And yet, know that my plainness of speech makes them hate me, and what is their hatred but a proof that am speaking the truth?-Hence has arisen the prejudice against me; and this is the reason of it, as you will find out either in this or in any future enquiry.

that the evil,-.,.,,.._,-,,,,....., about himself In Socrates many is the result of his effort to understand what an oracle had said. In the ancient of Delphi there was a shrine to which the Greeks would sometimes answers to their The human attendants at the had declared that no one was wiser than Socrates. To chalfor the of the that Socrates to find someone wiser than himself. With his -.-.onof-l"C> r\l"Df-£::.n,;o,n,nc to wisdom and and discovered

Socrates encountered was involved

SOCRATES

7

tion. After describing the charges that Meletus was bringing against him, Socrates asked Euthyphro to explain his suit. Much to Socrates' amazement, Euthyphro declared that he was prosecuting his own father for "murder" because of the way he let a slave die. Euthyphro firmly believed that, in prosecuting his father, he was exhibiting a high level of piety even though, according to the conventional wisdom of the time, disloyalty to one's father seemed to be an enormously impi­ ous act. Euthyphro describes the alleged murder: Now the man who is dead was a poor dependant of mine who worked for us as a field labourer on our farm in Naxos, and one day in a fit of drunken passion he got into a quarrel with one of our domestic servants and slew him. My father bound him hand and foot and threw him into a ditch, and then sent to Athens to ask of a diviner what he should do with him. Meanwhile he never attended to him and took no care about him, for he regarded him as a murderer; and thought that no great harm would be done even if he did die. Now this was just what happened. For such was the effect of cold and hunger and chains upon him, that before the messenger returned from the diviner, he was dead. And my father and family are angry with me for taking the part of the murderer and prosecuting my father. They say that he did not kill him, and that if he did, the dead man was a murderer, and I ought not to take any notice, for that a son is impious who prosecutes a father. Which shows, Socrates, how little they know what the gods think about piety and impiety.

Euthyphro goes on to claim that he, more than any other person, has exact knowledge about piety and impiety, and it is this knowledge that gives him the confidence that he is being most pious in prosecuting his father. Here, then, is one of those people who claims to have unusual wisdom, and from whom Socrates is prepared to learn. Alas, however, the incisive questions uf Socrates reveal that Euthyphro' s purported theological wisdom is confused and internally inconsistent. Here is part of the dialogue. Soc. And what is piety, and what is impiety? Euth. Piety is doing as I am doing; that is to say, prosecuting any one who is guilty of murder, sacrilege, or of any similar crime-whether he be your father or mother, or whoever he may be-that makes no difference; and not to prosecute them is impiety. And please to consider, Socrates, what a notable proof I will give you of the truth of my words, a proof which I have already given to others:-of the princi­ ple, I mean, that the impious, whoever he may be, ought not to go unpunished. For do not men regard Zeus as the best and most righteous of the gods?-and yet they admit that he bound his father (Cronos) because he wickedly devoured his sons, and that he too had punished his own father (Uranus) for a similar reason, in a nameless manner. And yet when I proceed against my father, they are angry with me. So inconsistent are they in their way of talking when the gods are concerned, and when I am concerned. Soc. And do you really believe that the gods fought with one another, and had_ dire quarrels, battles, and the like, as the poets say, and as you may see represented in the world of the great artists? Are all these tales of the gods true, Euthyphro? Euth. Yes, Socrates; and, as I was saying, I can tell you, if you would like to hear them, many other things about the gods which would quite amaze you.

THE EXAMINED LIFE

Soc. I dare say; and you shall tell me them at some other time when I have leisure. But just at present I would rather hear from you a more precise answer, which you have not as yet given, my friend, to the question, What is "piety"? When asked, you only replied, Doing as you do, charging your father with murder. Euth. And what I said was true, Socrates. Soc. No doubt, Euthyphro; but you would admit that there are many other pious acts?

Euth.

There are.

Soc. Remember that I did not ask you to give me two or three examples of piety, but to explain the general idea which makes all pious things to be pious.

Euth.

I remember.

Soc. Tell me what is the nature of this idea, and then I shall have a standard to which I may look, and by which I may measure actions, whether yours or those of any one else, and then I shall be able to say that such and such an action is pious, such another impious.

Euth. I will tell you, if you like. Soc.

I should very much like.

Euth. Piety, then, is that which is dear to the gods, and impiety is that which is not dear to them. Soc. Very good, Euthyphro; you have now given me the sort of answer which I wanted. But whether what you say is true or not I cannot as yet tell, although I make no doubt that you will prove the truth of your words.

Euth.

Of course.

Soc. Come, then, and let us examine what we are saying. That thing or person which is dear to the gods is pious, and that thing or person which is hateful to the gods is impious, these two being the extreme opposites of one another. Was not that said?

Euth. Soc.

Euth.

It was. And well said? Yes, Socrates, I thought so; it was certainly said.

Soc. And further, Euthyphro, the gods were admitted to have enmities and hatreds and differences?

Euth.

Yes, that was also said.

Soc. And what sort of difference creates enmity and anger? Suppose for exam­ ple that you and I, my good friend, differ about a number; do differences of this sort make us enemies and set us at variance with one another? Do we not go at once to arithmetic, and put an end to them by a sum?

Euth.

True.

Soc. Or suppose that we differ about magnitudes, do we not quickly mend the differences by measuring?

Euth.

Very true.

Soc. And we end a controversy about heavy and light by resorting to a weigh­ ing machine?

I l

SOCRATES

Euth.

9

To be sure.

Soc. But what differences are there which cannot be thus decided, and which therefore make us angry and set us at enmity with one another? I dare say the answer does not occur to you at the moment, and therefore I will suggest that these enmities arise when the matters of differences are just and unjust, good and evil, honorable and dishonorable. Are not these the points about which men differ, and about which when we are unable satisfactorily to decide our differences, you and I and all of us quarrel, when we do quarrel?

Euth. Yes, Socrates, the nature of the differences about which we quarrel is such as you describe. Soc. And the quarrels of the gods, noble Euthyphro, when they occur, are of a like nature.

Euth.

Certainly they are.

Soc. They have differences of opinion, as you say, about good and evil, just and unjust, honorable and dishonorable; there would have been no quarrels among them, if there had been no such differences-would there now?

Euth. You are quite right. Soc. Does not every man love that which he deems noble and just and good, and hate the opposite of them?

Euth.

Very true.

Soc. But, as you say, people regard the same things, some as just and others as unjust, about these they dispute; and so there arise wars and fightings among them.

Euth.

Very true.

Soc. Then the same things are hated by the gods and loved by the gods, and are both hateful and dear to them?

Euth.

True.

Soc. And upon this view the same things, Euthyphro, will be pious and also impious?

Euth.

So I should suppose.

Soc. Then, my friend, I remark with surprise that you have not answered the question which I asked. For I certainly did not ask you to tell me what action is both pious and impious; but now it would seem that what is loved by the gods is also hated by them. And therefore, Euthyphro, in thus chastising your father you may very likely be doing what is agreeable to Zeus but disagreeable to Cronos or Uranus, and what is acceptable to Hephaestus but unacceptable to Here, and there may be other gods who have similar differences of opinion.

The dialogue continues as Euthyphro adjusts and readjusts his definitions of piety and impiety in response to the pressing questions of Socrates. The discus­ sion closes with Euthyphro being driven to admit that either his claims at the beginning of the dialogue are false or his claims at the end of the dialogue are false. Both cannot be true. Soc. Then either we were wrong in our former assertion; or, if we were right then, we are wrong now.

Euth.

be true.

One of the two

and ask, What is an Soc. we which shall never be weary of v�iu,Au,,-... as far as your to the utmost, and tell me the truth.For, any man scorn me, but to knows, you are he; and therefore I must detain you, like Proteus, until you tell. you had not certainly known the nature of and I am confident that you your father with murder. You would never, on behalf of a serf, have would not have run such a risk of doing wrong the sight of the and you for the of men. am sure, therefore, that would have had too much you know the nature of piety and llTinH>t-u out then, my dear Hnnn,r.h and do not hide your knowledge. ,mr.1£:>hT

Euth.

Another time, Socrates, for I am in a hurry, and must go now.

Soc. Alas! my C!Jiil:,1='2. - 1l: 0Jr,, and will you leave me in despair? was hoping that you would instruct me in the nature of piety and impiety.... _11

as a friend or as a new foe? the wisdom of Did Socrates-a wisdom rooted in the ...,,.,,,.n-..--. of how little he knew-is set in such as t- h�rinh who pre­ sharp contrast to the wisdom of his !�'!",�':'. r;,-._ -:,.,.., tended to know so much but were unaware of their own ignorance. Made aware -ini,:,c:,c•or-1 to see the one of their ignorance, these "wise" persons were who had their ideas on trial now himself on trial for his life. Socrates to the allegation that he is an who does not believe in the of the state, evil-doer who but who believes in novel deities. With his Socrates exposes the these charges L..n-1-hn�

r

100

11

1

�u�/'-JiL�Lu

He says that I am a doer of evil, and corrupt the youth; but I say, 0 men of Athens that Meletus is a doer of evil, in that he pretends to be in earnest when he is in zeal and interest about jest, and is so eager to bring men to trial from a r-.-r,:,f-onrl matters in which he really never had the smallest interest.And the truth of this will endeavor to prove to you. Come hither, Meletus, and let me ask a question of you. You think a great deal about the improvement of youth? Yes, I do. Tell the judges, then, who is their improver; for you must know, as you have me before taken the pains to discover their corrupter, and are citing and them. Speak, then, and tell the judges who their improver is-Observe, Meletus, that you are silent, and have nothing to say. But is not this rather disgraceful, and a very considerable proof of what I was saying, that you have no interest in the matter? Speak up, friend, and tell us who their improver is. The laws. But that, my good sir, is not my meaning. want to know who the person is, knows the laws. who, in the first in court. The judges, Socrates, who are that they are able to instruct and improve What, do you mean to say, youth? they are.

SOCRATES

11

What, all of them, or some only and not others? All of them. By the goddess Here, that is good news! There are plenty of improvers, then. And what do you say of the audience,-do they improve them? Yes, they do. And the senators? Yes, the senators improve them. But perhaps the members of the assembly corrupt them?-or do they too improve them? They improve them. Then every Athenian improves and elevates them; all with the exception of myself; and I alone am their corrupter? Is that what you affirm? That is what I stoutly affirm. I am very unfortunate if you are right. But suppose I ask you a question: How about horses? Does one man do them harm and all the world good? Is not the exact opposite the truth? One man is able to do them good, or at least not many;-the trainer of horses, that is to say, does them good, and others who have to do with them rather injure them? ls not that true, Meletus, of horses, or of any other animals? Most assuredly it is; whether you and Anytus say yes or no. Happy indeed would be the condition of youth if they had one corrupter only, and all the rest of the world were their improvers. But you, Meletus, have sufficiently shown that you never had a thought about the young; your carelessness is seen in your not caring about the very things which you bring against me. And now, Meletus, I will ask you another question-by Zeus I will: Which is bet­ ter, to live among bad citizens, or among good ones? Answer, friend, I say; the ques­ tion is one which may be easily answered. Do not the good do their neighbors good, and the bad do them evil? Certainly. And is there any one who would rather be injured than benefited by those who live with him? Answer, my good friend, the law requires you to answer -does any one like to be injured? Certainly not. And when you accuse me of corrupting and deteriorating the youth, do you allege that I corrupt them intentionally or unintentionally? Intentionally, I say. But you have just admitted that the good do their neighbors good, and evil do them evil. Now, is that a truth which your superior wisdom has recognized thus early in life, and am I, at my age, in such darkness and ignorance as not to know that if a man with whom I have to live is corrupted by me, I am very likely to be harmed by him; and yet I corrupt him, and intentionally, too-so you say, although neither I nor any other human being is ever likely to be convinced by you. But either I do not cor­ rupt them, or I corrupt them unintentionally; and on either view of the case you lie. If my offence is unintentional, the law has no cognizance of unintentional offences; you ought to have taken me privately, and warned and admonished me; for if I had been better advised, I should have left off doing what I only did unintentionally-no doubt I should; but you would have nothing to say to me and refused to teach me. And now you bring me up in this court, which i�, a place not of instruction, but of punishment. It will be very clear to you, Athenians, as I was saying, that Meletus has no care at all, great or small, about the matter. But still I should like to know, Meletus, in what

THE EXAMINED LIFE

I am affirmed to corrupt the young. I suppose you mean, as I infer from your indict­ ment, that I teach them not to acknowledge the gods which the state acknowledges, but some other new divinities or spiritual agencies in their stead. These are the lessons by which I corrupt the youth, as you say. Yes, that I say emphatically. Then, by the gods, Meletus, of whom we are speaking, tell me and the court in somewhat plainer terms, what you mean! For I do not as yet understand whether you affirm that I teach other men to acknowledge some gods, and therefore that I do believe in gods, and am not an entire atheist-this you do not lay to my charge,-but only you say that they are not the same gods which the city recognizes-the charge is that they are different gods. Or, do you mean that I am an atheist simply, and a teacher of atheism? I mean the latter-that you are a complete atheist. What an extraordinary statement! Why do you think so, Meletus? Do you mean that I do not believe in the godhead of the sun or moon, like other men? I assure you, judges, that he does not; for he says that the sun is stone, and the moon earth. Friend Meletus, you think that you are accusing Anaxagoras; and you have but a bad opinion of the judges, if you fancy them illiterate to such a degree as not to know that these doctrines are found in the books of Anaxagoras the Clazomenian, which are full of them. And so, forsooth, the youth are said to be taught them by Socrates, when there are not unfrequently exhibitions of them at the theater (price of admis­ sion one drachma at the most); and they might pay their money, and laugh at Socrates if he pretends to father these extraordinary views. And so, Meletus, you really think that I do not believe in any god? I swear by Zeus that you believe absolutely in none at all. Nobody will believe you, Meletus, and I am pretty sure that you do not believe yourself. I cannot help thinking, men of Athens, that Meletus is reckless and impu­ dent, and that he has written this indictment in a spirit of mere wantonness and youthful bravado. Has he not compounded a riddle, thinking to try me? He said to himself:-! shall see whether the wise Socrates will discover my facetious contradic­ tion, or whether I shall be able to deceive him and the rest of them. For he certainly does appear to me to contradict himself in the indictment as much as if he said that Socrates is guilty of not believing in the gods, and yet of believing in them-but this is not like a person who is in earnest. I should like you, 0 men of Athens, to join me in examining what I conceive to be his inconsistency; and do you, Meletus, answer. And I must remind the audience of my request that they would not make a disturbance if I speak in my accustomed manner. Did ever man, Meletus, believe in the existence of human things, and not of human beings? ... I wish, men of Athens, that he would answer, and not be always trying to get up an interruption. Did ever any man believe in horsemanship, and not in horses? or in flute-playing, and not in flute-players? No, my friend; I will answer to you and to the court, as you refuse to answer for yourself.There is no man who ever did. But now please to answer the next question: Can a man believe in spiritual and divine agencies, and not in spirits or demigods? He cannot. How lucky I am to have extracted that answer, by the assistance of the court! But then you swear in the indictment that I teach and believe in divine or spiritual agen-

cies old, you say and swear in the andae1m1i�oc1s;--rnu:st assume that your silence consent. Now they not either or the sons of gods? they are. what call the facetious riddle invented you: the �,�u"''"'�-�u or its are gods, and you say first that do not believe in gods, and then again that believe in gods; that is, if believe in demigods. For if the demigods are the mate sons of gods, whether by the any other mothers, of whom or are said to be the sons-what human being will ever believe that there are no gods if they are the sons of gods? You might as well affirm the existence of mules, and deny that of horses and asses. Such nonsense, Meletus, could only have been tended you to make trial of me. You have this into the indictment because you had noth­ ing real of which to accuse me. But no one who has a particle of understanding will ever be convinced by you that the same men can believe in divine and superhuman things, and yet not believe there are gods and demigods and heroes. have said enough to answer to the charge of Meletus; any elaborate defence is know only too well how many are the enmities which I have unnecessary; incurred; and this is what will be my destruction if am destroyed;-not Meletus, nor yet Anytus, but the envy and detraction of the world, which has been the death of many good men, and will -.--.,s,--,,-,,,"''" be the death of many more; there is no danger of my being the last of them.

Can one believe Meletus that every Athenian of the Can one believe Meletus when Socrates was aware such do harm to backfire on himself? Can one believe Meletus that Socrates is an atheist when c,-l--,,,r• .--.,---.--1- h Such of fact he ho.i,,o�r.c:,c �u��-•�·-

sions rather than on reasoned assessment is what one would of five hundred and one members. -.--..-,..,::,n,:,-,.o,r1 to his over Socrates' head. Is The death to exposof the ��hu:.,__, ::_,_��-.-,.�-.-.n Is he r,-,.,ot-,::,n c,o of wisdom among his fellow Athenians to save his life? Is he in order to avoid death? His response is to give up rr

Men of Athens, I honor and love you; but shall obey God rather than you, and while I have life and strength shall never cease from the practice and teaching of philoso­ phy, exhorting any one whom I meet and saying to him after my manner: You, my friend-a citizen of the great and mighty and wise city of Athens,-are you not ashamed of heaping up the greatest amount of money and honor and reputation, and caring so little about wisdom and truth and the greatest improvement of the sout which you never regard or heed at all? And if the person with whom I am argu­ ing, says: Yes, but do care; then do not leave him or let him go at once; pro-

THE EXAIV1INED LIFE

ceed to interrogate and examine and cross-examine him, and if I think that he has no virtue in him, but only says that he has, I reproach him with undervaluing the greater, and overvaluing the less. And I shall repeat the same words to every one whom I meet, young and old, citizen and alien, but especially to the citizens, inas­ much as they are my brethren. For know that this is the command of God; and I believe that no greater good has ever happened in the state than my service to the God. For I do nothing but go about persuading you all, old and young alike, not to take thought for your persons or your properties, but first and chiefly to care about the greatest improvement of the soul. I tell you that virtue is not given by money, but that from virtue comes money and every other good of man, public as well as private. This is my teaching, and if this is the doctrine which corrupts the youth, I am a mis­ chievous person. But if any one says that this is not my teaching, he is speaking an untruth. Wherefore, 0 men of Athens, I say to you, do as Anytus bids or not as Anytus bids, and either acquit me or not; but whichever you do, understand that I shall never alter my ways, not even if I have to die many times.

The vote is taken, and it is close. Socrates is found guilty, but thirty addi­ tional votes (out of 501) being cast in his favor would have resulted in his acquit­ tal. His accusers call for the death penalty, and Socrates is offered the opportunity to argue for a lesser penalty. Instead, with a touch of irony, Socrates suggests that he should be rewarded in a fashion similar to the treatment accorded to victori­ ous Olympian athletes because of the benefit that his philosophizing has brought to Athens. Unwilling to admit that he has wronged anyone, Socrates refuses to acknowledge that he deserves any punishment whatsoever. We rejoin the dia­ logue at the point where Socrates is examining the suggestion that he propose "exile" as the court's penalty. Some one will say: Yes, Socrates, but cannot you hold your tongue, and then you may go into a foreign city, and no one will interfere with you ? Now I have great diffi­ culty in making you understand my answer to this. For if I tell you that to do as you say would be a disobedience to the God, and therefore that I cannot hold my tongue, you will not believe that I am serious; and if I say again that daily to discourse about virtue, and of those other things about which you hear me examining myself and oth­ ers, is the greatest good of man, and that the unexamined life is not worth living, you are still less likely to believe me. Yet I say what is true, although a thing of which it is hard for me to persuade you. Also, I have never been accustomed to think that I deserve to suffer any harm. Had I money I might have estimated the offence at what I was able to pay, and not have been much the worse. But I have none, and therefore I must ask you to proportion the fine to my means. Well, perhaps I could afford a mina, and therefore I propose that penalty: Plato, Crito, Critobulus, and Apollodorus, my friends here, bid me say thirty minae, and they will be the sureties. Let thirty minae be the penalty; for which sum they will be ample security to you.

Another vote is taken. Socrates is condemned to death. In his concluding statement, he addresses his accusers and charges that they are guilty of unright­ eousness. You think that I was convicted because I had no words of the sort which would have procured my acquittal-I mean, if I had thought fit to leave nothing undone or

my conviction was not of words-ceror inclination to address as urc,or,1nrr and wailing and ·�'"..�'·""'"h' and saying and you would have liked me to many things which you have been accustomed to hear from others, and as I maintain, are unworthy of me. thought at the time that ought not to do any­ thing common or mean when in danger; nor do now repent of the style of my after my manner, than in your man­ defence; would rather die having ner and live. For neither in war nor yet at law ought or any man to use every way of escaping death. Often in battle there can be no doubt that if a man will throw away his arms, and fall on his knees before his pursuers, he may escape death; and in other dangers there are other ways of escaping death, if a man is willing to say and do any­ thing. The difficulty, my friends, is not to avoid death, but to avoid unrighteousness; for that runs faster than death. am old and move slowly, and the slower runner has overtaken me, and my accusers are keen and quick, and the faster runner, who is unrighteousness1 has overtaken them.And now I depart hence condemned by you to suffer the penalty of death1-they too go their ways condemned by the truth to suffer the penalty of villainy and wrong; and I must abide by my award-let them abide by theirs. suppose that these things may be regarded as fated1-and I think that they are well.

Socrates also has some .,,,.,..,,,..,_,..,., words for his friends among the who evil outcome of the trial. To encourage them1 the and to or going on a that death is either Socrates neither of those 1--1vocau..u.•u'--·"' would occasion any evil for him. n-

Friends1 who would have acquitted me, would also like to talk with you about the thing which has come to pass1 while the magistrates are busy1 and before go to the place at which must die. Stay then a little1 for we may as well talk with one another while there is time.... Let us reflect ...and we shall see that there is great reason to hope death is a good; for one of two things-either death is state of nothingness and unconsciousness, or1 as men say1 there is a change and migration of the soul from this world to another. Now if you suppose that there is no consciousness1 but a sleep like the sleep of him who is undisturbed even by dreams1 death will be an unspeakable gain. For if a person were to select the night in which his was undisturbed even dreams1 and were to compare with this the other days and nights of his life, and then were to tell us how many days and nights he had passed in the course of his life bet­ ter and more pleasantly than this one, think that any man, I will not say a private man, but even the great king will not find many such or nights1 when compared with the others. Now if death be of such a nature1 say that to die is gain; for eternity is then only a single night. But if death is the journey to another place, and there, as men say, all the dead abide1 what good, 0 my friends and judges1 can be greater than this? If indeed when the pilgrim arrives in the world below1 he is delivered from the professors of justice in this world, and finds the true judges who are said to give judgment there1 Minos and Rhadamanthus and Aeacus and Triptolemus, and other sons of God who were righteous in their own life, that pilgrimage will be worth mak­ ing. What would not a man give if he might converse with Orpheus and Musaeus and Hesiod and Homer? Nay1 if this be true, let me die again and again.I myself, too1 shall have a wonderful interest in there meeting and conversing with Palamedes, and

THE EXAMINED LIFE

Ajax the son of Telamon, and any other ancient hero who has suffered death through an unjust judgment; and there will be no small pleasure, as I think, in comparing my own sufferings with theirs. Above all, I shall then be able to continue my search into true and false knowledge; as in this world, so also in the next; and I shall find out who is wise, and who pretends to be wise, and is not. What would not a man give, 0 judges, to be able to examine the leader of the great Trojan expedition; or Odysseus or Sisyphus, or numberless others, men and women too! What infinite delight would there be in conversing with them and asking them questions! In another world they do not put a man to death for asking questions; assuredly not.For besides being hap­ pier than we are, they will be immortal, if what is said is true. Wherefore, 0 judges, be of good cheer about death, and know of a certainty, that no evil can happen to a good man, either in life or after death.He and his are not neglected by the gods ... I have a favor to ask . . When my sons are grown up, I would ask you, 0 my friends, to punish them; And I would have you trouble them, as I have troubled you, if they seem to care about riches, or anything, more than about virtue; or if they pre­ tend to be something when they are really nothing,-then reprove them, as I have reproved you, for not caring about that for which they ought to care, and thinking that they are something when they are really nothing. And if you do this, both I and my sons will have received justice at your hands. The hour of departure has arrived, and we go our ways-I to die, and you to live. Which is better God only knows.

Having viewed Socrates the philosopher in action, are you now able to say what philosophy is? If you are having some difficulty, take heart because contem­ porary professional philosophers are by no means in agreement about how phi­ losophy should be defined. Indeed, one could view the current philosophical scene as a debate between two different views of philosophy. On the one hand, there is the modern analytic tradition which has roots in eighteenth century British empiricism, modern science, and twentieth century logical positivism. It emphasizes the analysis of language in order to achieve both clarity and also the resolution of verbal disputes. Would not the modern analytic philosopher who focuses on the clarification of the meaning of words be following the example of Socrates as he challenged Euthyphro to clarify his concept of "piety"? On the other hand, there is the more speculative tradition of philosophy (as exemplified by metaphysicians such as Descartes, Spinoza, Leibniz, and Hegel) which tries to formulate answers to such questions as the nature of human existence, the pur­ pose of human life, the prospect of life after death, the existence of God, the nature of ultimate reality, the features necessary for the good life, and so forth. Could not such philosophers also claim to be following the example of Socrates when he summoned his contemporaries to pursue virtue and as he speculated about whether death was going to sleep on going on a journey? If both of these traditions can legitimately appeal to Socrates in support of their views, does it not seem likely that philosophy in the Socratic tradition involves both views, that it embraces concern for clarifying the words of human discourse and also formulating responses to perennial human questions? The

WHAT IS PHILOSOPHY?

17

presence of these two emphases in the Socratic tradition can be seen if we con­ sider the Socratic goal and method of philosophizing. The Socratic Goal. What did Socrates want to accomplish? Some might say that Socrates wished primarily to make himself appear wise by making others look foolish. If so, Socrates was a clever and arrogant man. Others might say that his major goal was to promote social change by teaching young people how to ques­ tion and discredit the authorities of society. If so, Socrates was something of a rev­ olutionary. Still others might say that Socrates wished to nourish the examined life. Let us consider this latter alternative in more detail. You will recall that Socrates declared that "the unexamined life is not worth living." Why is it not worth living? The unexamined life does not ponder ques­ tions like this: Who am I? What ought I to do? What may I hope? The unexam­ ined life does not evaluate alternative futures. It lives with the flow. The unexam­ ined life hears no evil and sees no evil. It is devoid of critical self-assessment. It stifles the breath of reason. It violates a distinctive human capacity. In contrast, the examined life allows human reason to breathe, live, and grow strong. The examined life seeks not simply to satisfy curiosity, but rather strives for human virtue. Remember how concerned Socrates was about virtue. Recall that he asked his friends to punish his sons when they are grown if they cared about anything more than virtue. The examined life and the pursuit of virtue were dear to Socrates and they were linked together in the philosophical task. Through the examined life, one could pursue answers to fundamental human questions, dis­ cover what it means to be a human being, and learn what human virtue is. Does not the philosophic quest in the Socratic tradition, then, seem to include the pur­ suit of the examined life in order to make virtue abound?

How did Socrates pursue this goal? At least two katures of Socrates' method stand out. First, he sought conceptual clarification. Even as he challenged Euthyphro over the meaning of piety, no doubt he would require us to be clear about the meaning of virtue. He might ask us, for example, if virtue stands for the personal qualities that a particular culture at a specific time finds attractive. If so, would not the meaning of virtue vary according to time and place? Or is virtue transcultural? If so, would not human beings who pursued virtue have a common goal? If so, what would be the human characteristics that these people from diverse cultures would consider to be at the heart of virtue? Notice how the philosophic goal inspires one question after another. Second, the Socratic method involved a critical examination of received opin­ ions and accepted beliefs. In the wake of the declaration of the Oracle of Apollo at Delphi, Socrates went about testing the knowledge claims of his contemporaries. Suppose you said "I believe that there is a God who cares for humankind." Socrates would probably ask you, "On what basis do you hold that belief?" Clearly, Socrates would be asking you to justify your belief. What do you think Socrates would accept as justification for your belief? Would quoting from sacred scriptures do the job? Would citing a personal, private religious experience count The Socratic Method.

AN INTRODUCTION TO MODERN PHILOSOPHY

as evidence to justify your belief? How about summoning the testimony of the leaders of society who also believe in God? Would their testimony satisfy Socrates? What about the so-called proofs for the existence of God offered by Aristotle, Thomas Aquinas, Rene Descartes, William Paley, and others? Finding evidence to justify one1 s belief in God is not easy, as we will discover in the chap­ ter on God's existence. Indeed, finding evidence to justify a good number of our beliefs is no easy matter. If we are able to produce evidence that justifies our belief that God exists, then we could say that we have knowledge that God exists. But in whose eyes does the evidence for our belief have to be convincing? Do all rational persons have to agree that our evidence is sufficient before we can claim that our belief is justi­ fied? Or would the concurrence of the majority of rational persons be sufficient? Or should we be willing to settle for something less than a majority? And would it be permissible to speak of degrees of justification depending upon the quantity and quality of the evidence we are able to cite in support of our belief? What if we are unable to produce evidence that justifies our belief that God exists? Must we then abandon that belief? Indeed, is it ever permissible to hold a belief that is unjustified? Furthermore, what really counts as evidence? These are the kinds of questions that give rise to a theory of knowledge, and to that subject we will be devoting a full chapter later in this book. Philosophers, in the Socratic tradition, pursue the examined life in order to generate virtue; and the virtue that Socrates and his disciples had in mind is mul­ tifaceted. It involves the fulfillment of all the distinctively1 human potentialities, the harmonious blending of human appetites, emotions, and thinking. In other words, to pursue virtue is to seek human flourishing. The method philosophers use in this pursuit involves both conceptual clarification and 1the critical examina­ tion of accepted beliefs. Unrelentingly, philosophers ask us, "What do you mean by that?" and "What evidence do you have to support that beli�f?" If we agree with Socrates that the unexamined life is nob worth living, and decide to pursue the examined life, then we must subject the beliefs of humankind to rigorous scrutiny. But where should we begin? Let us return to the life of Socrates for a suggestion. The ancient oracle of Apollo at Delphi, where the divine declaration had been made that no one was wiser than Socrates, has some advice for us. At the entrance to that shrine these words were carved in stone: "Know Thyself." Those words suggest an intriguing point of departure for us. Perhaps the examined life should begin with an attempt to understand who or what we are. The pursuit of such self-knowledge would, in due course, prompt us to raise additional questions, which would cease only when we have examined the whole human condition. In this book we have adopted the oracle's advice. The questions we have explored include the following: Arn I a body and a mind? Arn I determined or free? Arn I mortal or immortal? Arn I a creature of God?

WHAT IS PHILOSOPHY?

19

On what basis shall I judge things morally? On what basis shall I judge things artistically? On what basis shall I judge the law? On what basis shall I claim to have knowledge? What shall I say about ultimate reality? Does my life have any meaning? What does science tell me about the world? All of these are perennial questions, which generation after generation of Socrates' disciples have encountered as they have pursued the examined life. We have selected passages from the writings of modern philosophers who will often propose conflicting answers to these questions. The debate between these philosophers will at times be heated, and, we hope, at all times engaging. As we ourselves try to fashion responses to these questions ( and respond to them we must), occasionally we will achieve some strongly warranted answers to our questions. Frequently, however, our questioning will result in uncertainties. Indeed, we will find ourselves in what Bertrand Russell referred to as the "no man1 s land" between the knowledge of science and the dogma of theology. Yet those uncertainties can be celebrated as the high cost of being human, of being rational, of being open to the future, of being able to ask questions that we are perhaps unable to answer completely. Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted from Plato, "Euthyphro" and "Apology," trans. B. Jowett in The Dialogues of Plato, 4th ed. (Oxford, England: Oxford University Press, 1953).

I

am free; I am I am a creature of God. Each of these is an answer to "What am I?" We shall discuss these answers in the ,, this chapter, we focus on three different kinds of answers: I am a am a body, I am some mix of the two. These answers show the influence of the Rene Descartes. He can I discusstage for western His answer set and how ·it can affect the sion of the and whether or not we can know if there are minds other than our own. often called the rise of the new science. the The new science uu.::,iLu.u a view which held that matter is the primary feature of and relegates mind or either to a status or to no status at all. Promulgated by sixth- and like ,__,----..;:---.__:;�.::;�.::;··� and _.__,,,.__i.,_.,Lf..__.L materialism was over­ B.C. Greek shadowed for centuries by the doctrines of ...... and Christian theolowho accorded mind (or a more prominent and in the landscape of reality. Materialism, however, garnered a formidable in modern science. how one Medieval scientists had busied themselves with the task of class of being is logically related to another class of beings. Modern science was born when scientists '--"''___,._,._.,.UL..__ their concerns beyond the issue of group relat­ edness to include both the for based on data (note the work of Francis Bacon use of mathematical reasoning. Now the method of mathematical reasoning involves the quantification of the observed the ov,"-,,.c,cc,,nn of those 11,

00

,_,,....,

'--. L . L U ....... L..__.H,.,_.LL,

-�����v,

L . L . U.'-L-'-----'-''�.LL . .LH.L,,

1--''---'-''"'"'----"L

.LL,.'--''"''--•

.L.LL,A......� ..... .L•SA•-.L

o,VYH£C>..,.,,nrr

-A•-~�•AA�,=

AN INTRODUCTION TO MODERN PHILOSOPHY

ties in formulae, the synthesis of those formulae into explanatory systems, the prediction of the behavior of phenomena through those systems, and the test­ ing of those predictions against empirical data. It was particularly in astronomy that this new mathematical method developed, especially through the work of Copernicus (1473-1543), Kepler (1571-1630), Brahe (1546-1601); and Galileo (1564-1642). The view of reality that emerged from this new science seemed to support materialism. According to the new science, physical reality was depicted as mat­ ter in motion. Matter objectively possessed position, shape, size, mass, and velocity. All these characteristics were definable, so their relations to one another could be reasoned out, as in geometry. In contrast smells, sounds, colors, and tastes could be identified only by putting a person in a situation where the per­ son will have the experience we have in mind and saying, "There, that is what I mean." These latter characteristics that do not lend themselves to deductions and reasoning were considered to be not objectively real. They were rather "appearances" that arise in us when our sense organs are stimulated by objec­ tively real matter with its geometrical characteristics. Objective reality, accord­ ingly, came to be viewed as basically a world of material objects moving in a mechanistic fashion. That view of reality left precious little room, if any, for an immaterial mind, for human freedom, for immortality, and for a spiritual being called God-all of which had been prominent in medieval thought. Materialism, then, seemed to have gained an ally in the new science; and that new science's impressive explanatory power and its capacity to aid humans in the manipula­ tion of their environment made it a formidable ally indeed! Writing during this time, but not entirely from within the tradition, Descartes developed an impressive philosophical system in which the human was interpreted as being both a mind (res cogitans) and a body (res extensa). The twentieth-century philosopher Gilbert Ryle, our second author, con­ tends that Descartes made a serious mistake in logic, called the category-mis­ take. Next, we read excerpts from J. J.C. Smart and Jerry Fodor, who agree with Ryle that Descartes has made serious errors but are not convinced that Ryle's answer to the mind-body problem is acceptable. Smart and Fodor appeal to contemporary advances in science to support their view. Smart appeals to neu­ rophysiology, whereas Fodor uses advances in computer science. Our fifth author, Allen Turing, takes computer technology just about as far as it will go when he claims that we will probably be forced to admit that very advanced computers can be said to think. John Searle, the next author in this section, thinks that those who appeal to computer science to bolster the view that think­ ing is nothing more than what computers do have made a serious mistake-one just as serious as the category-mistake apparently made by Descartes. Finally, after a digression into the question, "Are there other minds?" we return to a modern statement ofCartesian dualism from Nobel prize-winning neurophysi­ ologist, John Eccles.

RENE DESCARTES

1

23

RENE DESCARTES

AM A MIND {RES COGITANS) AND A BODY (RES EXTENSA)

Philosophical interest in the nature of the human being begins for many persons with the writings by Rene Descartes in the middle of the seventeenth century. As a French Catholic, Descartes was raised to believe that a person, a referent of per­ sonal pronouns, is a created spiritual substance, obscurely related to a body and the world of matter, rationat active, free, and immortal. Such a conception of man is far removed from the claim that he is simply a part of nature. Descartes' reasoning takes off from his realization that an increasing number and range of his beliefs were either doubtful or false. This triggered the question whether any of his beliefs were neither doubtful nor false. To settle this he asked whether any of his beliefs were indubitable, not doubtable. Not doubtable is a stronger term than not doubtful. If a claim is not doubtable, then there are no pos­ sible circumstances that could make it doubtful. Welt i( like Descartes, you are harassed by doubts and denials, and if doubt­ ing and denying are modes of thinking, then there is no doubt that, there is no doubting that it is not doubtable that, you do think. There is, under the condi­ tions of such harassment no such question as, "Do you perform the activity that is normally called thinking?" You cannot cast reasonable doubt on the claim that you think that you are, as Descartes says of himself, a res cogitans, a thinking thing. And further, if to think, you must exist then the indubitable character of "I think" carries over to "I am." As he says, "I think, therefore I am; cogito, ergo sum." Granted that he is, indubitably, a res cogitans, and therefore an existing i hing, are there any other claims he can make about himself? He is a res cogitans. Is he any­ thing else? That is one line along which he worked. A second and related line took off from the question, "What is it to think?" "What is the nature, the defining character, of the activity which a thinker, a rational animat typically performs?" Hence such titles as Rules for the Direction of the Understanding, and Discourse on the Method of Rightly Conducting One's Reason and Seeking Truth in the Sciences. A third line took off from the contrast between an activity and passivity. This concern centers on the contrast between what I do and what happens to me. What sort of event happens to me because I am a rational animat a res cogitans, which does not happen to a stone or a plant? Descartes' treatise on these matters, published in 1649, the year before he died, is called The Passions of the Sout meaning the modes of passivity to which the souls, the psy­ ches, of rational animals are liable. It dealt with sensations and emotions and related modes of passivity. In respect to modern interest in the nature of the human being, Descartes is something of a Caput Nili, a source of the Nile. When he is working at the ques­ tion of the nature of the I in I think, the outcome is a contribution to metaphysics. When he is working at the question of the nature of the thinking activity per-

I AM A MIND (RES COG/TANS) AND A BODY (RES EXTENSA)

formed by the I, the outcome is a contribution to logic and epistemology. When he is working at the question of the nature of the conscious (or, later, subcon­ scious) processes that occur in or to the psyches of rational animals, the outcome is a contribution to philosophical psychology. Like Plato among the ancients, Descartes among the moderns is an excellent introduction to the philosophical study of the nature of man. BIOGRAPHICAL NOTE. Descartes was born in France in 1596 and died in Sweden in 1650 at the age of fifty-four. His formal education from eight to sixteen was received at the Jesuit college of La Fleche. Here he acquired the essentials of a "gentleman's education," which he subsequently devoted much time to erasing. Before he had turned seventeen he put aside his books and after a few lessons in fencing and horsemanship went to "the great world of Paris." Here he remained for about five years, living at first the usual life of gaiety and gambling, but retiring after a while to the quiet and seclusion of an obscure lodging house. His thought­ ful temper reasserted itself. Habits of reflection acquired at La Fleche, and roused once more by a Catholic friend, Father Mersenne, took possession of him again. In 1618 Descartes left Paris, determined to see the world. He became a sol­ dier, serving in three different European armies, in the Netherlands, in Bavaria, and in Hungary. It was a life that gave him much time for thought during months of idleness in winter quarters. He stuck to soldiering for three or four years, then resolved "no longer to carry a musket." Army days over, he continued his travels for five or six years more, visiting Switzerland and Italy, until in 1628, he decided that he had read enough in the "great book of the world." In 1629, his mind crowded with ideas demanding to be written down, he set­ tled in Holland. He was seeking quiet and seclusion once more. His European retirement, as he called it, lasted twenty years. These were years of fruitful produc­ tion. Book followed book. His reputation spread. He had the intellectuals of his generation for his readers, and its rulers for his patrons and friends. In rapid suc­ cession he wrote Quest for Truth, Rules for the Direction of the Mind, Discourse on Method, Meditations on First Philosophy, Principles of Philosophy, Treatise on the Passions, and many other volumes that soon became stock-in-trade for the philo­ sophically minded of his day. In 1649 he was invited by Queen Christina of Sweden to visit her at Stockholm and expound the principles of the "new philoso­ phy." After much hesitation, and against the advice of his friends, he agreed to go. It cost him his life, for he caught a cold in his lungs that brought about his death. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Most of the following passages are quoted, abridged, or paraphrased from Descartes' Meditations on First Philosophy. The thought in this small book might be paraphrased as follows: I was given the usual gentlemen's education in my youth. Presently I became skeptical of most of what had been taught me. Accordingly, I determined to abandon all my learning and begin again with a clean slate upon which no one but myself should write, and upon which nothing should be written that was not clear and distinct. I needed, as a starting point, something that could stand against skepticism, something not

RENE DESCARTES

25

doubtable. To that end I set about the cultivation of my doubt. My doubts were brought to an end by the fact of my own existence. The fact that I was doubting entailed necessarily my own existence as a doubter. From this indubitandum my reconstruction must proceed. Could I use the undoubtability of my own existence to prove the existence of anything else? Two great steps were in order: to demonstrate the existence of God and the existence of the material world. The steps by which I moved from doubts about things taught me at school, to the demonstrated existence of myself, God, and the external world, constitute the theme of these Meditations. The first passages supply some autobiographical facts: I had been nourished on letters since my childhood, and since I was given to believe that by their means a clear and certain knowledge could be obtained of all that is use­ ful in life, I had an extreme desire to acquire instruction. But as soon as I had achieved the entire course of study at the close of which one is usually received into the ranks of the learned, I entirely changed my opinion. I found myself embarrassed with so many doubts and errors that it seemed to me that the effort to instruct myself had no effect other than the increasing discovery of my own ignorance. And yet I was studying at one of the most celebrated schools in Europe, where I thought there must be men of learning if such were to be found any­ where in the world. I learned there all that others had learned. Moreover, not being satisfied with the sciences that we were taught, I even read through all books which fell into my hands, treating of what is considered most curious and rare. Along with this, I knew the judgments which others had formed of me, and I did not feel that I was esteemed inferior to my fellow students. And finally, our century seemed to me as flourishing, and as fertile in great minds, as any which had preceded it. These reflections combined to make me take the liberty of judging all others by myself, and of coming to the conclusion that there was no learning in the world such as I had formerly believed it to be. That is why, as soon as age permitted me to emerge from the control of my tutors, I entirely quitted the study of letters. I resolved to seek no other knowledge than that which could be found in myself, or at least in the great book of the world. I employed the rest of my youth in travel; in seeing courts and armies, in intercourse with men of diverse temperaments and conditions, in collecting varied experiences, in testing myself in the various predicaments in which I was placed by fortune. In all circumstances I sought to bring my mind to bear on the things that came before it so that I might derive some profit from my experience. For nine years I did nothing but roam hither and thither, trying to be a spectator rather than an actor in all the comedies which the world displays. Especially did I ask myself, in each matter that came before me, whether anything could make it subject to suspicion or doubt. I considered the manners and customs of other men, and found nothing to give me settled convictions. I remarked in them almost as much diversity as I had formerly seen in the opinions of philosophers. So much was this so, that I learned to believe nothing too certainly of which I had been convinced only by example and custom. I thus concluded that it is much more custom and example that persuade us than any certain knowledge. And this despite the fact that the voice of the majority affords no proof of any value in matters a little difficult to discover. Such truths are like to have been discovered by one man, more than by a nation. But I could not,

I AM A MIND (RES COG/TANS) AND A BODY (RES EXTENSA)

however, put my finger on a single person whose opinions seemed preferable to those of others. I found I was constrained, so to speak, to undertake the direction of my own inquiries. As regards all the opinions which, up to that time, I had embraced, I thought I could not do better than try once for all to sweep them completely away. Later on they might be replaced, either by others which were better, or by the same when I had made them conform to the uniformity of a rational scheme. I firmly believed that by this means I should succeed much better than if I had built on foundations and principles of which I had allowed myself to be persuaded in youth without having inquired into their truth. My design has never extended beyond trying to reform my own opinions and to build on a foundation which is entirely my own. I was not seeking to imitate the skeptics, who only doubt for the sake of doubt­ ing and pretend always to be uncertain. On the contrary, my design was only to pro­ vide myself with good ground for assurance1 to reject the quicksand and the mud in order to find the rock or clay.

These remarks give us the terms of this self-imposed task; on the one hand, to work himself free from the opinions he had accepted as part of a normal edu­ cation, on the other, to avoid mere skepticism. The execution of this design called for a definite procedure. This Descartes outlines: Like one who walks alone and in the twilight, I resolved to go slowly, to use so much circumspection that even if my advance was very small at least I guarded myself from falling. I did not wish to reject any opinion finally until I had planned out the task I had undertaken, and until I had sought out the true method of arriving at a knowl­ edge of the things of which my mind was capable. In my younger days I had studied logic and geometry and algebra-three sci­ ences which, it seemed, ought to contribute something to the design I had in view. But, in examining them, I observed in respect to logic, that syllogisms and the rest served better to explain those things which one already knows than to learn something new. As to geometry and algebra, they embrace only the most abstract matters, such as appear to have no actual use. This made me feel that some other method must be found exempt from their fault. So, in place of the many precepts of which logic is composed, and the many rules and formulae of which mathematics is composed1 I settled on four rules for the direction of the understanding. My first rule was to accept nothing as true which I did not clearly recognize to be so; to accept nothing more than what was presented to my mind so clearly and distinctly that I could have no occasion to doubt it. The second rule was to divide each problem or difficulty into as many parts as possible. The third rule was to com­ mence my reflections with objects which were the simplest and easiest to understand, and rise thence, little by little, to knowledge of the most complex. The fourth rule was to make enumerations so complete, and reviews so general, that I should be certain to have omitted nothing. Those long chains of reasoning which geometricians make had caused me to imagine that all parts of human knowledge might be mutually related in the same fashion; and that, provided we abstain from receiving anything as true which is not so, and always deduce one conclusion from some other1 there can be nothing so remote that we cannot reach it, nor so recondite that we cannot discover it.

RENE DESCARTES

27

But what pleased me most, in this method which I was determined to follow, was that I was certain by its means to exercise my reason in all things; if not perfectly, at least as well as was in my power. I felt that, in making use of it, my mind would gradually accustom itself to think about its objects more accurately and distinctly.

The first of the above rules is perhaps the important one: to accept nothing as true that he did not clearly recognize to be so. It is one thing to lay this rule down. It is another to abide by it. The difficulty is in knowing where to start searching for one indubitable fact. But the search is under way. . . . it is necessary for me to reject as false everything as to which I can imagine the least ground of doubt, in order to see if anything remains that is entirely certain. So I set myself seriously and freely to the general upheaval of all my former opinions. To that end it is not requisite that I examine each opinion in particular. That would be an endless undertaking. Owing, however, to the fact that the destruction of the foundations brings with it the downfall of the rest of the edifice, I shall only attack those principles upon which all my former opinions rested. All that up to the present time I have accepted as most true and certain I have learned either from the senses or through the senses. But it is sometimes proved to me that these senses are deceptive. And it is wiser not to trust entirely to anything by which we have once been deceived. But it may be objected that, although the senses sometimes deceive us concern­ ing things which are hardly perceptible or are very far away, there are yet many things as to which we cannot reasonably have any doubt although we recognize them by their means. For example, there is the fact that I am here, seated by the fire, attired in a dressing gown, having this paper in my hand. And how could I deny that these hands and this body are mine? At the same time I must remember that I am in the habit of sleeping, a,1d in my dreams representing to myself the same things. How often has it happened that I dreamt I was in this particular place, dressed and seated near the fire, while in reality I was lying undressed in bed. On many occasions I have in sleep been decc·ived by similar illusions. In thinking carefully about this fact, I see that there are manifestly no certain indications by which we may clearly distinguish wakefulness from sleep. Suppose we assume, then 1 that we are asleep; that all these particulars, e.g., opening our eyes, shaking our head, extending our hand, are but false delusions; that possibly neither our hands nor our body are such as they appear to us to be. There is a point, however, which we must not overlook. We must admit that the things which are represented to us in sleep are like painted representations which can only have been formed as the counterparts of something real and true, i.e., not illusory. It would follow from this admission that those general things at least, i.e., eyes, head, hands, body, are not imaginary things but things really existent. We are bound, at the same time, to confess that there are some objects yet more simple and universal than eyes, a head, a body, etc., namely, colors, shapes, size, number, etc., which are real and true. For, whether I am awake or asleep, red is not blue, two and three make five, squares have only four sides, and so on. It does not seem possible that truths so clear can be suspected of any falsity. Nevertheless, I have long had fixed in my mind the belief that an all-powerful God existed by whom I have been created such as I am. But how do I know that He has not brought it to pass that there is no earth, no heaven, no extended body, no

I AM A MIND (RES COG/TANS) AND A BODY (RES EXTENSA)

magnitude, no place; and that, nonetheless, I possess perceptions of all these things which seem to me to exist just exactly as I now see them? It might be urged against this suggestion that God has not desired that I should be thus deceived. For is He not said to be supremely good? However, if it is contrary to His goodness to have made me such that I am constantly deceived, it would also seem to be contrary to His goodness to permit me to be sometimes deceived; and yet it cannot be denied that He does permit this. There may indeed be those who, rather than believe that all other things are uncertain, would prefer to deny the existence of a God so powerful. Let us not oppose them. Let us suppose, then, not that God (who is supremely good and the fountain of truth) but some evil genius not less powerful than deceitful, has employed his whole energies in deceiving me. I shall suppose, then, that some evil genius not less powerful than deceitful is employing His whole energies to deceive me. I shall consider that the heavens, the earth, colors, shapes, sounds, and all other external things, are nothing but illusions and dreams by which this evil genius has laid traps for my credulity. I shall consider myself as having no hands, no eyes, no flesh, no blood, nor any senses; yet falsely believing myself to possess all these things. I shall remain obstinately attached to this idea. If, by this means, it is not in my power to arrive at the knowledge of any truth, I may at least do what is in my power, namely, suspend judgment, and thus avoid belief in anything false and avoid being imposed upon by this arch deceiver, however powerful and deceptive he may be.

Determined to "doubt everything," until doubt becomes impossible of being pushed further, Descartes has had recourse to heroic measures. The senses have been discredited, and with them the credibility of the external world revealed by the senses. This, one might have thought, would have sufficed. But assurance must be made doubly sure. Hence the hypothesis of a malignant genius who deceives him. At this point the eagerly sought indubitandum begins to appear: I suppose, then, that all the things that I see are false. I persuade myself that nothing has ever existed of all that my fallacious memory represents to me. I consider that I possess no senses. I imagine that body, figure, extension, motion, and place are but the fictions of my mind. What, then, can be esteemed as true? Perhaps nothing at all, unless that there is nothing in the world that is certain. But immediately I notice that while I wish to think all things false, it is nonethe­ less absolutely essential that I, who wish to think this, should truly exist. There is a powerful and cunning deceiver who employs his ingenuity in misleading me? Let it be granted. It follows the more that I exist, if he deceives me. If I did not exist, he could not deceive me. This truth, "I think, therefore I am; cogito, ergo sum," is so cer­ tain, so assured, that all the most extravagant skepticism is incapable of shaking it. This truth, "I am. I exist," I can receive without scruple as the first principle of the phi­ losophy for which I am seeking.

Descartes has used doubt to defeat doubt. He has found his indubitandum. He has discovered that which is undoubtable. Clearly and distinctly he has recog­ nized that his thinking presupposes the "I" doing the thinking, and that his being deceived by the malignant genius (if such be the case) presupposes the "I" in order for this deception to occur. That this "I" exists he can be completely certain.

RENE DESCARTES

29

He then proceeds to ponder what the nature of this "I/' this res cogitans, this thinking thing is. I think, therefore, I am. But what am I? I do not yet know; and hence I must be care­ ful less I imprudently take some other object in place of myself and thus go astray in respect of this knowledge which I hold to be the most certain of all that I formerly believed. What then did I formerly believe myself to be? I considered myself as having a face, hands, arms, and all that system of members which I designate by the name of body. In addition to this, I considered that I was nourished, that I walked, that I felt, and that I thought. But what am I, now that I assume that there is an evil and malicious genius who employs all his powers to deceive me? Can I affirm, with as much certainty as I can affirm my existence, that I possess any of the least of all those things which I have just now ascribed to myself? I pause to consider. I resolve all these things in my mind. I find none of the bodily attributes which I can ascribe to myself. What of thinking? I find that thought alone is an attribute which cannot be sepa­ rated from me. I am, I exist; that is certain. But this certainty reposes on the "I think" which preceded. I am trying here not to admit anything which is not necessarily true. To speak thus strictly, I am nothing more than a thing which thinks, that is, to say, a mind, an understanding. I am a real thing. I really exist. But what am I? I have answered: a thing which thinks. I am a thing which thinks. And what more? What is a thing which thinks? It is a thing which doubts, understands, conceives, affirms, denies, wills, refuses, imagines, feels. Certainly it is no small matter if all these things pertain to my nature. But why should they not so pertain? Am I not that being who now doubts nearly everything, who nevertheless understands certain things, who ;itiirms that only one thing is true, who denies all other things, who desires to know more, who is averse from being deceived, who imagines many things, who perceives many things? Is there, in all this, anything which is less certain than that I exist? Indeed, il is so evi­ dent that it is I who doubt, who understand, vvho desire, and so on, that there is no reason here to add anything to explain it. From this time I begin to know what I am with a little more clearness and distinctness than before.

Doubt has been explored and exploited. The existence of the "I" has been shown to be undoubtable. Because the existence of that which thinks (res cogitans) can be proven without having proven the existence of the body (res extensa), the mind must be logically distinct from the body. Can the certainty of the existence of the mind be used as a stepping-stone to other certainties? For example, the exis­ tence of the body? But what about the malignant genius? Can Descartes be certain of anything else at all as long as that evil deceiver lurks in the background? To dis­ pose of the evil deceiver, then, must be the next item on Descartes' agenda. I shall now close my eyes; I shall stop my ears. I shall call away all my senses. I shall efface from my thoughts all images of material things-or, since that is hardly possi­ ble-I shall esteem them as vain and false. Thus holding converse only with my self, and considering my own nature, I shall try to reach a better knowledge of what I am. I am a thing which thinks; that is to say, that doubts, affirms, denies, knows, is ignorant, wills, desires, imagines, perceives. For, as I remarked before, although the

I AM A MIND (RES COG/TANS) AND A BODY (RES EXTENSA)

things which I perceive and imagine are perhaps nothing apart from me, yet the per­ ceptions and imaginings certainly reside in me. And in the little that I have just said, I think I have summed up all that I really know or was hitherto aware that I knew. To extend my knowledge further, I shall look around more carefully and see whether I cannot still discover in myself some other things which I have not hitherto perceived. I am certain that I am a thing which thinks. But if I am indeed certain of this I must know what is requisite to render me certain of anything. I must possess a stan­ dard of certainty. In this first knowledge which I have gained, what is there that assures me of its truth? Nothing except the clear and distinct perception of what I state. This, indeed, would not suffice to assure me that what I state is true if it could ever happen that I should clearly and distinctly perceive to be true something which was in fact false. Accordingly, I can establish as a general rule that all things which I perceive very clearly and very distinctly are true. All things which I perceive very clearly and very distinctly, are true. If I have heretofore judged that such matters could be doubted, it was because it came into my mind that perhaps a God might have endowed me with such a nature that I might have been deceived even concerning things which seemed to me most manifest. I see no reason to believe that there is a God who is a deceiver; however, as yet I have not satisfied myself that there is a God at all. I must inquire whether there is a God. And, if I find that there is a God, I must also inquire whether He may be a deceiver. For, without a knowledge of these two truths, I do not see that I can ever be certain of anything. Now, it is obvious that there must be at least as much reality in any cause as in its effect. For whence could the effect derive its reality, if not from its cause? From this it follows that something cannot proceed from nothing; and that the more or the greater cannot proceed from the less. The longer and more carefully I investigate these matters, the more clearly and distinctly do I perceive their truth. But what may I conclude from it alt finally? It is this: If I have any idea which I myself cannot be the cause ot it follows of necessity that I am not alone in the world, that there is some other being which exists as the cause of this idea. Have I any such idea? There is the idea of God. Is this idea something that could have originated in, been caused by, me? By the name God I understand a being that is infinite, eternal, immutable, independent all-knowing, all-powerfut by which I myself and every­ thing else (if anything else does exist) have been created. Now, all these qualities are such that the more diligently I attend to them, the less do they appear capable of originating in me alone. Hence, from what was premised above, we must conclude that God necessarily exists as the origin of this idea I have of Him. For, to consider but one point, the idea of a being or a substance is within me owing to the fact that I am myself a being or substance; nevertheless, I would not have the idea of an infinite being, since I am myself finite, unless it had proceeded from some being who was infinite. I see nothing in all that I have just said which, the light of nature, is not manifest to anyone who desires to think attentively on the subject. It only remains to examine into the manner in which I have acquired this idea from God. I have not received it through the senses; nor is it a fiction of my mind, for it is not in my power to take from or add to it. The only alternative is that it is innate in me, just as the idea of myself is innate in me.

RENE DESCARTES

31

It is not strange that God, in creating me, placed this idea within me to be like the mark of the workman imprinted on his work. For, from the fact that God created me it is most probable that He has placed His image and similitude upon me. The whole strength of the argument which I have here used to prove the existence of God consists in this: it is not possible that my nature should be what it is, and that I should have in myself the idea of a God, if God did not exist. God, whose idea is in me, pos­ sesses all those supreme perfections of which our mind may have some idea but without understanding them all; is liable to no errors or defects, and has none of those marks which denote imperfection. From this it is manifest that He cannot be a deceiver, since fraud and deception proceed from some defect. Before I pass on to the consideration of other truths which may be derived from this one, it seems to me right to pause for a while to contemplate God Himself, to ponder at leisure His marvelous attributes, to consider and to admire and to adore the beauty of His light. Faith teaches us that supreme felicity of the life to come con­ sists in this contemplation of the Divine Majesty. Even so we continue to learn by experience that a similar meditation, though less perfect, causes us to enjoy the great­ est satisfaction of which we are capable in this life.

Disillusionment. Systematic doubt. Existence of self as a thinking thing. Existence of God, no longer the deceiving genius of the early part of the argu­ ment. There remains only the external world, revealed by the senses. Can this be reinstated? Can its existence be shown to be part of the network, inextricably bound up with his own and Deity's nature and existence? And so I see that the certainty and truth of all knowledge depends alone upon the knowledge of the true God. Before I knew Him, I could not have a perfect knowledge of any other thing. Now that I know Him I have the means of acquirin::; a perfect knowledge of any infinitude of things. Nothing further now remains but to inquire whether rnaterial things exist. And first of all I shall recall those matters which I hitherto held to be true, as hrlving per­ ceived them through the senses; in the next place I shall examine the reasons which have since obliged me to place them in doubt; and in the last place I shall consider which of them I must now believe. First of all, I perceived that I had a head, hands, feet, and all other members of which this body is composed. Further, I was sensible that this body was placed amid many others. In them, in addition to extension, figure, and motion, I remarked hard­ ness, heat, light, color, scents, sounds, and so forth. Considering the ideas of all these qualities which presented themselves to my mind, it was not without reason that I believed my self to perceive objects quite dif­ ferent from my thought, to wit, bodies from which those ideas proceeded. For I found by experience that these ideas of all these qualities presented themselves to me with­ out my consent being needed. Thus, I could not perceive any object unless it were present to the organs of sense; nor could I help but perceive it, when it was present. Furthermore, because these ideas which I received through my senses were clearer, more lively, more distinct, than any ideas I could myself frame in meditation or find in memory, it appeared as though they could not have proceeded from my mind. So, therefore, I concluded that they must have been produced in me by some other things. And, since I had no knowledge of these objects except the knowledge

which ideas themselves gave was more to occur to my mind themselves were similar to the ideas which were caused. than that the little, all the faith which But afterwards many ex1pie1�1,eit1ic:��s ci-rn,, r1 little observed that towers, which from had rested my senses. For appeared to me to be round, seemed square when more closely nhco,•uc,,r1 that colos­ sal statues seemed quite tiny when viewed from a distance; that persons whose legs or arms had been cut off seemed to feel in the part which had been amputated; that my dreams, which could not be caused outside objects, closely resembled my waking moments; and so on. Now, however, that I begin to know myself better am a thing which thinks") and to discover more clearly the author of my being, I do not think I should rashly admit all the things which the senses seem to teach me, nor do think that I should doubt them all universally. This much is certain, i.e., clear and distinct: There is in me the capacity to receive and recognize the ideas of sensible things. The active cause of these ideas which I passively receive cannot be in me, since those ideas are often produced in me without my contributing in any way to the same, often even against my will. It follows that the power which produces these ideas resides in some substance different from me. This substance is either a material object of God or some other creature. But, I have argued already, God is no deceiver. He has given me a very great inclination to believe that my ideas of sensible objects are sent or conveyed to me by external material objects. I do not see how He could be defended from the accusation of deceit if these ideas were produced in me by any cause other than material objects. Hence we must allow that material objects exist. 0

0

We have examined a brief summary of Descartes' In response to our "Am I a and a mind?" Descartes would say, "I am both." Notice that that claim the way. He has established the existence ,-,o,rt-c:1·,n-i-�, of his own ·-•,�H Then from the cerhe has demonstrated the existence of from the ,�o.... of God's tion he has shown that external bodies (res such as his own, do in fact exist. T�,,�

f-r,H,hT

NOTE ON SOURCES. The material in this section is or parafrom Rene Descartes, The Philosophical Works of Descartes, translated E. York: Dover Haldane and G. R. T. Ross I. The auto­ biographical account and the statement of the rules is from the Discourse on Methods, Parts I, III. The rest is from Meditations I, and VI. ��u�•Au,;A

GILBERT RYLE DESCAR

ES WA

CONFUSED

FROM DESCARTES TO RYLE. The involves three be made? If so, are there issues: Can a valid distinction between mind and that ,-,n,rrocr,nnrl to those two terms? that is so, what is the any 1�,,�...-,h,� .... as far back as Plato relation between �/H.VUA•,-..

0

33

GILBERT RYLE

dealt with some of these issues, Descartes was really the first to develop a system­ atic theory about the natures and interrelationships of mind and body. For him, body was a thing extended in space and unthinking, whereas mind was a think­ ing thing unextended in space. For him both body and mind were substances of different sorts so intimately united in the human being that mental events can affect physical events, and vice versa. Descartes1 position has been called dualism because of its affirmation of two substances. A good number of philosophers have followed Descartes in adopting dualism1 although they may differ with him on how mind and body interact. Other philosophers1 aware of the perplexing problems associated with dualism1 have rejected dualism in favor of monism, which affirms one substance-either mind or body, but not both. Ryle mounts an attack on dualism in general and on Descartes in particular; an attack which every dualist committed to the examined life must take seriously. BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Gilbert Ryle was born in 1900. His academic education was received at Oxford where he taught until his retirement. He succeeded R. G. Collingwood as Waynfleet professor of metaphysical philosophy at the University of Oxford at the end of World War II. He succeeded G. E. Moore as editor of the distinguished philosophical journal Mind in 1947. He published his most impor­ tant and influential book, The Concept of Mind, in 1949. For the years 1945-1960, he was one of the most widely read and influential philosophers in the Anglo­ American academic world. The reasons for this are to be found in the volumes of Mind1 in his Concept of Mind (1949), his Dilemmas (1954), his Plato 1s Progress (1966) 1 and his two volumes of Collected Papers (1971). He died in 1976. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. The following selection is Chapter One of Gilbert Ryle1 s Concept of Mind. In this chapter, titled Descartes 1 Myth, Ryle sets the problem for his book: How should we conceive of the nature of a mind and its relation to a body? The answer that most persons in the Western world, espe­ cially since Descartes1 lifetime, have given to that question, Ryle calls the official doctrine1 and believes that it bristles with theoretical difficulties. The chapter is divided into three sections and a brief terminal historical note. Section One, The Official Doctrine, is a vivid and deflationary account of how many, indeed most, people conceive of a person in terms of a mind-body dualism. Every person, the doctrine declares, has a mind and a body, or is a combination, a union of a mind and a body. Bodies are located in space and are subject to mechani­ cal laws. In contrast, minds are not located in space, have no spatial dimensions, no spatial size or shape, and are not subject to mechanical laws. Frequently, the terms external and interna( outer and inner, used in a metaphorical sense, are applied to bodies and minds, respectively. Bodies have surfaces, can meet and collide and jolt; 11 minds have no surfaces, cannot meet head on. How these spatial bodies are related to nonspatial minds is obscure. How they can influence each other, inter­ act,'1 is a difficult theoretical question. Events in one body can directly cause events in another body. But do events in one mind cause events in another mind? And do 11

'

11

11

DESCARTES WAS CONFUSED

events in a mind cause events in the body which that mind presumably "inhabits"? Hnot, minds are shut out from their bodies and shut off from each other. Additional difficulties with the "official doctrine" arise. Bodily processes can be observed by second-party observers: I can observe that your body is blanching and sweating and trembling. But I cannot thus observe workings in your mind. They are not witnessable by me. They are "private" to you. I can observe your body wince. I cannot feel your pain. Each of us has direct and unchallengeable knowledge of at least some events in our own minds, but no such knowledge of events in each other's minds. I can observe what happens to or goes on in your body. I may infer from that to what happens or goes on in your mind, but I have no way of confirming that inference by any observation. The question then arises: Does any person have any good reason for believing in the existence of other minds? Other bodies, yes; other minds, how so? The "official doctrine," then, leads us to the notion that each person has two "histories": a history of one's bod­ ily events and a history of one's mental events. But, says Ryle, the relation between these two "histories" is not at all clear. (1) THE OFFICIAL DOCTRINE

There is a doctrine about the nature and place of minds which is so prevalent among theorists and even among laymen that it deserves to be described as the official the­ ory. Most philosophers, psychologists and religious teachers subscribe, with minor reservations, to its main articles and, although they admit certain theoretical difficul­ ties in it, they tend to assume that these can be overcome without serious modifica­ tions being made to the architecture of the theory. It will be argued here that the cen­ tral principles of the doctrine are unsound and conflict with the whole body of what we know about minds when we are not speculating about them. The official doctrine, which hails chiefly from Descartes, is something like this. With the doubtful exceptions of idiots and infants in arms every human being has both a body and a mind. Some would prefer to say that every human being is both a body and a mind. His body and his mind are ordinarily harnessed together, but after the death of the body his mind may continue to exist and function. Human bodies are in space and are subject to the mechanical laws which govern all other bodies in space. Bodily processes and states can be inspected by external observers. So a man's bodily life is as much a public affair as are the lives of animals and reptiles and even as the careers of trees, crystals and planets. But minds are not in space, nor are their operations subject to mechanical laws. The workings of one mind are not witnessable by other observers; its career is private. Only I can take direct cognisance of the states and processes of my own mind. A per­ son therefore lives through two collateral histories, one consisting of what happens in and to his body, the other consisting of what happens in and to his mind. The first is public, the second private. The events in the first history are events in the physical world, those in the second are events in the mental world. It has been disputed whether a person does or can directly monitor all or only some of the episodes of his own private history; but, according to the official doctrine, of at least some of these episodes he has direct and unchallengeable cognisance. In consciousness, self-consciousness and introspection he is directly and authentically apprised of the present states and operations of his mind. He may have great or small

GILBERT RYLE

35

uncertainties about concurrent and adjacent episodes in the physical world, but he can have none about at least part of what is momentarily occupying his mind. It is customary to express this bifurcation of his two lives and of his two worlds by saying that the things and events which belong to the physical world, including his own body, are externat while the workings of his own mind are internal. This antithesis of outer and inner is of course meant to be construed as a metaphor, since minds, not being in space, could not be described as being spatially inside anything else, or as having things going on spatially inside themselves. But relapses from this good intention are common and theorists are found speculating how stimuli, the physical sources of which are yards or miles outside a person's skin, can generate mental responses inside his skull, or how decisions framed inside his cranium can set going movements of his extremities. Even when "inner" and "outer" are construed as metaphors, the problem how a person's mind and body influence one another is notoriously charged with theoreti­ cal difficulties. What the mind wills, the legs, arms, and tongue execute; what affects the ear and the eye has something to do with what the mind perceives; grimaces and smiles betray the mind's moods and bodily castigations lead, it is hoped, to moral improvement. But the actual transactions between the episodes of the private history and those of the public history remain mysterious, since by definition they can belong to neither series. They could not be reported among the happenings described in a person's autobiography of his inner life, nor could they be reported among those described in someone else's biography of that person's overt career. They can be inspected neither by introspection nor by laboratory experiment. They are theoretical shuttlecocks which are forever being bandied from the physiologist back to the psy­ chologist and from the psychologist back to the physiologist. Underlying this partly metaphorical representation of the bifurcation of a per­ son's two lives there is a seemingly more profound and philosophical assuinption. It is assumed that there are two different kinds of existence or status. What exists or happens may have the status of physical existence, or it may have the status of men­ tal existence. Somewhat as the faces of coins are either heads of tails, or somewhat as living creatures are either male or female, so, it is supposed, some existing physical existing, other existing is mental existing. It is a necessary feature of what has physical existence that it is in space and time; it is a necessary feature of what has mental exis­ tence that it is in time but not in space. What has physical existence is composed of matter, or else is a function of matter; what has mental existence consists of con­ sciousness, or else is a function of consciousness. There is thus a polar opposition between mind and matter, an opposition which is often brought out as follows. Material objects are situated in a common field, known as "space," and what happens to one body in one part of space is mechani­ cally connected with what happens to other bodies in other parts of space. But men­ tal happenings occur in insulated fields, known as minds," and there is, apart maybe from telepathy, no direct causal connection between what happens in one mind and what happens in another. Only through the medium of the public physical world can the mind of one person make a difference to the mind of another. The mind is its own place and in his inner life each of us lives the life of a ghostly Robinson Crusoe. People can see, hear and jolt one another's bodies, but they are irremediably blind 1 and deaf to the workings of one another s minds and inoperative upon them. What sort of knowledge can be secured of the workings of a mind? On the one side, according to the official theory, a person has direct knowledge of the best imag11

DESCARTES WAS CONFUSED

inable kind of the workings of his own mind. Mental states and processes are (or are normally) conscious states and processes, and the consciousness which irradiates them can engender no illusions and leaves the door open for no doubts. A person's present thinkings, feelings and willings, his perceivings, rememberings and imagin­ ings are intrinsically "phosphorescent"; their existence and their nature are inevitably betrayed to the owner. The inner life is a stream of consciousness of such a sort that it would be absurd to suggest that the mind whose life is that stream might be unaware of what is passing down it. True, the evidence adduced recently by Freud seemed to show that there exist channels tributary to this stream, which run hidden from their owner. People are actu­ ated by impulses the existence of which they vigorously disavow; some of their thoughts differ from the thoughts which they acknowledge; and some of the actions which they think they will to perform they do not really will. They are thoroughly gulled by some of their own hypocrisies and they successfully ignore facts about their mental lives which on the official theory ought to be patent to them. Holders of the official theory tend, however, to maintain that anyhow in normal circumstances a person must be directly and authentically seized of the present state and workings of his own mind. Besides being currently supplied with these alleged immediate data of con­ sciousness, a person is also generally supposed to be able to exercise from time to time a special kind of perception, namely inn.er perception, or introspection. He can take a (non-optical) "look'' at what is passing in his mind. Not only can he view and scrutinize a flower through his sense of sight and listen to and discriminate the notes of a bell through his sense of hearing; he can also reflectively or introspectively watch, without any bodily organ of sense, the current episodes of his inner life. This self-observation is also commonly supposed to be immune from illusion, confusion, or doubt. A mind's reports of its own affairs have a certainty superior to the best that is possessed by its reports of matters in the physical world. Sense-perceptions can, but consciousness and introspection cannot, be mistaken or confused. On the other side, one person has no direct access of any sort to the events of the inner life of another. He cannot do better than make problematic inferences from the observed behavior of the other person's body to the states of mind, which by analogy from his own conduct, he supposes to be signalized by that behavior. Direct access to the workings of a mind is the privilege of that mind itself; in default of such privileged access, the workings of one mind are inevitably occult to everyone else. For the sup­ posed arguments from bodily movements similar to their own to mental workings simi­ lar to their own would lack any possibility of observational corroboration. Not unnatu­ rally, therefore, an adherent of the official theory finds it difficult to resist this consequence of his premises, that he has no good reason to believe that there do exist minds other than his own. Even if he prefers to believe that to other human bodies there are harnessed minds not unlike his own, he cannot claim to be able to discover their individual characteristics, or the particular things that they undergo and do. Absolute solitude is on this showing the ineluctable destiny of the soul. Only our bodies can meet. As a necessary corollary of this general scheme there is implicitly prescribed a special way of construing our ordinary concepts of mental powers and operations. The verbs, nouns, and adjectives, with which in ordinary life we describe the wits, characteristics, and higher grade performances of the people with whom we have to do, are required to be construed as signifying special episodes in their secret histories, or else as signifying tendencies for such episodes to occur. When someone is described as knowing, believing, or guessing something, as hoping, dreading, intend-

as verbs are to denote the occurrence or occult stream of consciousness. Only his direct awareness and 1r1t-r,'xc;i.,�c0c·1,t ",__;•-n, could The onlooker, be he teacher, critic/ conduct verbs are correctly or ,n..r� r->YY'2C:tl1 or friend, can never assure himself that his comments have any vestige of truth. Yet it was because we do in fact know how to make such comments, make them with general correctness and correct them when they turn out to be confused mistaken, that philosophers found it necessary to construct their theories of the nature and of minds. Finding mental-conduct concepts being regularly and effectively used, they properly sought to fix their logical geography. But the logical geography officially recommended would entail that there could be no regular or effective use of these mental-conduct concepts in our descriptions of, and prescrip­ tions for, other people's minds. "

is a claim, then, is that the official" doctrine is that a -.--,..,-��.� related to his machine" intimately but dualism as the mates" his body machine. He refers to this traditional doctrine of the "ghost in the machine," and claims that those who hold it are thereby involved in a number of theoretical absurdities1 all of which express in one way or another a gross and flagrant"category-mistake." He gives exclmPlE�s of cate­ gory-mistakes, none of which is the particular category-mistake present in the untenable notion of a person as a ghost in a machine." A person who, having seen now, is the univer­ asked, the colleges that make up Oxford of a category-mistake, imagining that the university itself sity?" would be existed in the same way that the colleges did. with witnessed the marching of the battalions that make up a to see the ignoring the fact that a division does not exist in the way that its battalions do. His other c:)(�1Irtp1c?s are to the same effect. A more .-..,�..-.. -� .. nonsensi­ cal example of category-mistake would be made a person who should say,"She came in a taxi and left in a rage," and then go on to ask about the rage that nn2s-Lmt)m,ea that it had same order of existence as the taxi; for "How fast did it travel?" "What fuel did it use?" and so on. To such a person we do not arise1 a rage belongs a radically different catewould say,"Your gory from a taxi." In this second section of Chapter is more concerned to illustrate the notion of a G:1t:e,go,�rv--m1Lst,1Ke and how it could rise to cmno1etie1v and misleading questions, than to spell out the -r,,..,-......,r,,, category-mistake that rise to the "impossible1 "ghost-in-the-machine" notion of a person as a body united with a mind. It takes the rest of the book to spell out that category­ mistake and to suggest some other way of conceiving of the ,,..,,.,........,'--- ......,H,,n relation. 11

11

11

i-.-.,•0"'''�,_..·TT

,TT

'--ILIC'---'--''-H..,,

'

(2) THE ABSURDITY OF THE OFFICIAL DOCTRINE

Such in outline is the official theory. shall often of it, with deliberate abusive­ ness, as "the dogma of the Ghost the Machine." hope to prove that it is entirely false, and false not in detail but in pnn,ci,p,lP�. is not merely an assemblage of particu­ lar mistakes. It is one big mistake and a mistake of a special kind. It is namely, a cate­ gory-mistake. It represents the facts of mental life as if they belonged to one logical

DESCARTES WAS CONFUSED

type or category (or range of types or categories), when they actually belong to another. The dogma is, therefore, a philosopher's myth. In attempting to explode the myth I shall probably be taken to be denying well-known facts about the mental life of human beings, and my plea that I aim at doing nothing more than rectify the logic of mental-conduct concepts will probably be disallowed as mere subterfuge. I must first indicate what is meant by the phrase ' category-mistake." This I do in a series of illustrations. A foreigner visiting Oxford or Cambridge for the first time is shown a number of colleges, libraries, playing fields, museums, scientific departments, and administrative officers. He then asks, 'But where is the University? I have seen where the members of the College live, where the Registrar works, where the scientists experiment and the rest. But I have not yet seen the University in which reside and work the mem­ bers of your University." It has then to be explained to him that the University is not another collateral institution, some ulterior counterpart to the colleges, laboratories and offices which he has seen. The University is just the way in which all that he has already seen is organized. When they are seen and when their coordination is under­ stood, the University has been seen. His mistake lay in his innocent assumption that it was correct to speak of Christ Church, the Bodleian Library, the Ashmolean Museum, and the University, to speak, that is, as if the University" stood for an extra member of the class of which these other units are members. He was mistakenly allo­ cating the University to the same category as that to which the other institutions belong. The same mistake would be made by a child witnessing the march-past of a divi­ sion, who, having pointed out to him such and such battalions, batteries, squadrons, etc., asked when the division was going to appear. He would be supposing that a division was a counterpart to the units already seen, partly similar to them and partly unlike them. He would be shown his mistake by being told that in watching the bat­ talions, batteries, and squadrons marching past he had been watching the division marching past. The march-past was not a parade of battalions, batteries, squadrons, and a division; it was a parade of battalions, batteries, and squadrons of a division. One more illustration. A foreigner watching his first game of cricket learns what are the functions of the bowlers, the batsmen, the fielders, the umpires, and the scor­ ers. He then says, But there is no one left on the field to contribute the famous ele­ ment of team-spirit. I see who does the bowling, the batting, and the wicketkeeping; but I do not see whose role it is to exercise esprit de corps." Once more, it would have to be explained that he was looking for the wrong type of thing. Team-spirit is not another cricketing-operation supplementary to all of the other special tasks. It is roughly, the keenness with which each of the special tasks is performed, and per­ forming a task keenly is not performing two tasks. Certainly exhibiting team-spirit is not the same thing as bowling or catching, but nor is it a third thing such that we can say that the bowler first bowls and then exhibits team-spirit or that a fielder is at a given moment either catching or displaying esprit de corps. These illustrations of category-mistakes have a common feature which must be noted. The mistakes were made by people who did not know how to wield the con­ cepts University, division and team-spirit. Their puzzles arose from inability to use cer­ tain items in the English vocabulary. The theoretically interesting category-mistakes are those made by people who are perfectly competent to apply concepts, at least in the situations with which they are familiar, but are still liable in their abstract thinking to allocate those concepts to logical 1

1

11

11

An instance of a of this sort would be differences between the has learned British, the French and the American Constitutions, and has learned also the differParliament, the various Ministries, the ences and connections between the ,.,,1,�-·'"·" and th e Church of Hncrlc,nr1 But he still becomes embarrassed when asked questions about the connections between the Church of England, the Home Office, and the British Constitution. For while the Church and the Home Office are institu­ tions, the British Constitution is not another institution in the same sense of that noun. So inter-institutional relations which can be asserted or denied to hold between the Church and the Horne Office cannot be asserted or denied to hold between either of them and the British Constitution. "The British Constitution" is not a term of the same logical type as "the Home Office" and "the Church of England." In a partially similar way, John Doe may be a relative, a friend, an enemy or a stranger to Richard Roe; but he cannot be any of these things to the Average Taxpayer. He knows how to talk sense in certain sorts of discussions about the Average Taxpayer, but he is baffled to say could not come across him in the street as he can come across Richard Roe. It is pertinent to our main subject to notice that, so long as the student of politics continues to think of the British Constitution as a counterpart to the other institu­ tions, he will tend to describe it as a mysteriously occult institution; and so long as John Doe continues to think of the Average Taxpayer as a fellow-citizen, he will tend to think of him as an elusive insubstantial man, a ghost who is everywhere yet nowhere. destructive purpose is to show that a family of radical category-mistakes is the source of the double-life theory. The representation of a person as a ghost myste­ riously ensconced in a machine derives from this argument. Because, as is true, a per­ son's thinking, feeling and purposive doing cannot be described solely in the idioms chemistry and physiology, therefore they must be described counter­ of part idioms. As the human is a c::nr.cl::::x organized unit, so the human mind must be another complex organized unit, though one made of a different sort of stuff and a different sort of structure. Or, again, as the human like any oiher parcel of matter, is a field of causes and effects, so the mind must be another field of causes and effects, though not (Heaven be praised) mechanical causes and effects. UUuLU"�'-

0



third section asks how this In the take ever came to be made anyway. To use his own words to frame this question, we could "What was the intellectual of what I have to prove to be the Cartesian ,--,,--,-1-orr,, ....u His answer is along this line: Finding that the mechanistic model of modern science made good sense of processes that go on in Descartes saw that if that model were applied to the human the physical being as a complete and sufficient of human activity, then dire conse­ quences would result in the religious and ethical domains. For example, if the physical machine, what becomes of the human is a .... therefore, to reduce humans to immortality, and moral��,,,..,.,,� l,TAT,..,..... l.ro Descartes and his ,,..,.�,-,....-. ....,,,� followers the status of mere that whereas such sciences as another scisense of the mechanical processes that go on made would 1n1veim�2:at:e the nonmechanical processes that go on the "existence" of bodies and v

.l ,..::�,.���U�L·.:_�L ....

AAU���u-�

1

WORLD 2

STATES OF CONSCIOUSNESS Subjective knowledge Experience of perception thinking emotions dispositional intentions memories dreams creative imagination

2.2 Tabular representation of the three worlds that comprise all existents and all experience as defined by Popper. Source: John Eccles and Karl Popper. The Self and Its Brain. (London: Springer-Verlag, 1976).

KNOWLEDGE

OBJECTIVE SENSE

Cultural heritage coded on material substrates philosophical theological scientific historical literary artistic technological Theoretical systems scientific problems critical arguments

89

JOHN ECCLES

5. A key component of the hypothesis is that the unity of conscious experience is provided by the self-conscious mind and not by the neural machinery of the liaison areas of the cerebral hemisphere. Hitherto it has been impossible to develop any neurophysiological the­ ory that explains how a diversity of brain events comes to be synthesized so that there is a unified conscious experience of a global or gestalt character. The brain events remain disparate, being essentially the individual actions of countless neurones that are built into complex circuits and so participate in the spatiotempo­ ral patterns of activity. This is the case even for the most specialized neurones so far detected, the feature detection neurones of the inferotemporal lobe of primates. Our present hypothesis regards the neuronal machinery as a multiplex of radiat­ ing and receiving structures: the experienced unity comes, not from a neurophysiological synthesis, but from the proposed integrating character of the self-conscious mind. We con­ jecture that in the first place the self-conscious mind is developed in order to give this unity of the self in all of its conscious experiences and actions.... The self-conscious mind is scanning the modular activities in the liaison areas of the cerebral cortex, as may be appreciated from the very inadequate diagram in Figure 2.3.From moment to moment it is selecting modules according to its interest, the phe­ nomenon of attention, and is itself integrating from all this diversity to give the uni­ fied conscious experience.Available for this read-out, if we may call it so, is the whole range of performance of those areas of the dominant hemisphere which have linguis­ tic and ideational performance. Collectively we will call them liaison areas . .. . The self-conscious mind plays through the whole liaison brain in a selective and unifying manner. An analogy is provided by a searchlight in the manner that has

Figure 2.3. Information flow diagram for brain-mind interac­ tion. The three components of World 2: outer sense, inner sense and the ego or self are dia­ grammed with their connectivi­ ties. Also shown are the lines of communication across the inter­ face between World 1 and World 2, that is from the liaison brain to and from these World 2 com­ ponents. The liaison brain has the columnar arrangement indi­ cated. It must be imagined that the area of the liaison brain is enormous, with open modules numbering a hundred thousand or more, not just the two score here depicted. Source: John Eccles and Karl Popper. The Self and Its Brain (London:

Springer-Verlag, 1976).

BRAIN --.ll(r------l► P- MIND INTERACTION OUTER SENSE

World 2

INNER SENSE

Light Color Sound Smell Taste

Thoughts Feelings Memories Dreams Im aginings Intentions

LIAISON BRAIN

World 1 I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

I

J

CONTEMPORARY DUALISM

been suggested by Jung [1954] and by Popper [1945]. Perhaps a better analogy would be some multiple scanning and probing device that reads out from and selects from the immense and diverse patterns of activity in the cerebral cortex and integrates these selected components, so organizing them into the unity of conscious experience.... The essential feature of the hypothesis is the active role of the self-conscious mind in its influence on the neural machinery of the liaison brain.

Eccles has clearly done a fine job of redescribing the Cartesian sort of mind in contemporary neurophysiological terminology. But has he really explained the mechanism of interaction? Or has he merely reasserted that there is an experi­ enced distinction between the mental and the physical and that there is, at the same time, an experienced relation between the mental and the physical? Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is from John Eccles and Karl Popper, The Self and Its Brain (London: Springer-Verlag, 1976), pp. 358-365.

for self-understanding we have been the n our claim that the human is a part of nature. That which is rather received substantial �,,·����-- from the emergence of modern science. Those who make the claim intend ..-n,o.,,.c,nn to deny at least four things about the say that humans do not have human that humans are not that hnrv-. ,.,,...c, do not survive the death and that humans are not creatures of God. We explored the first of those denials the the chapter. chapter we will consider the second denial as we examine the u.'--·" cn.n ,, "Am free or determined?" you have an examination tomorrow and a friend asks you to at a party. Your friend does not urge or threaten and or coerce you. You consider the and after a moment's thought decide to up for that and go to the We would ordinarsay that you are r,,-,,..,,,,..-,....,-,, for your decision. We think of such cases as actions in which you are free to decide one way or the other. Contrast this to a sit­ on your bed uation in which a headache leads you to lie down and fall ,_,� ... �,� to In this case it would not make sense to say that instead of you are free to decide one way or the other about between The advocates of free will and advocates of determinism is basically a whether incidents like the two so which feel so rht+c»•or, are different when viewed nh,,o,.-,l�nr,::,l�r Whereas the advocate of free will would these two sorts of acts as the determinist would not. The determinist argue that reasonable for you believe that your decision to stay home although it is for the exam was an to of free nevertheless closer �,.,�iiui,.u

c

..-.,,,.,n�"""

�,_,,,...,T,.,�

I AM DETERMINED

scrutiny would reveal that your behavior was not really free after all. What you thought was a free choice was really a choice dictated by your desires, which in turn spring from your character, which in its turn is fashioned by the forces of heredity and environment, which are clearly beyond your control. The central affirmation of determinism is that every event has a cause. By an analysis of the causes of any one of your actions, the determinist would cause your so-called freedom to vanish in a chain of causes that stretches back into the remote recesses of your heredity and environment. Nature and nurture, genes and society-those are the facts that made you what you are and cause you to act the way you do. The notion that you are free is really a misapprehension, an illusion. The battle between libertarians (advocates of free will) and determinists has been joined for centuries. The first of the combatants we have selected for study is the eighteenth-century advocate of determinism, Baron d'Holbach. In a clear and uncompromising fashion he presents the position of determinism. To cross swords with him we have called up Jean-Paul Sartre who depicts the human being as a free­ dom (pour soi) in the midst of a world of determined things (en soi). To treat the pour soi as an en soi as the determinist does, says Sartre, is to destroy the distinctively human. Walter Stace, our third writer, tries to mediate the conflict by blending determinism and freedom in a coherent way. William James argues that the deter­ minist is face to face with a very unpleasant alternative: the determinist must adopt either subjectivism or pessimism-neither of which, we will see, is very attractive. Karl Popper uses science to undercut determinists who claim that science shows that free will is a mere hope, with no basis in fact. Finally, a contemporary look at compatibilism from John Bender has us going through a thought experiment meant to support the compatibilist position that freedom and determinism can coexist. In due course, when the dust has settled from the conflict of these great war­ riors, you will have to formulate your own response to the question, Am I free or determined?" Your response can never be trivial because in it the meaningfulne:=;s and seriousness of much of civilization is at stake for you. 11

BARON D'HOLBACH I AM DETERMINED

You will recall that Descartes, the so-called father of modern philosophy, exploited the method of doubt in order to defeat doubt. The seventeenth century in which Descartes lived was a time when traditional ideas and institutions were chal­ lenged. The intellectual fires of the Renaissance and the Reformation had not died out. The skeptic Michel De Montaigne (1533-1592) had cast a cloud of doubt over the reliability of all human knowledge, and Descartes tried to dissipate that cloud. Descartes probably thought he was in step with the new science in that he had discovered by careful scrutiny an indubitable truth rooted in the concrete, empiri­ cal data of the thinking self, and in that he had used geometrical-style reasoning to

BARON

and was accordthe basis of observed data. rro-.-,ol"�TO of '--''�,l:,tf2f:r�tn-rc,-n French fictions. That is nr,Pr,colu intellectuals of the Enlightenment leveled at the Cartesians. These intellectuals learned about the new science the u,.,.,,.,., ...,'"'"'" of Locke Isaac Newton data, ...,.,,.,2(.:!.1.Ct,l,'J for whom were essential. So 1mpr1ess,ect with the empirical bent of the new science were these French thinkers that they abandoned the dualistic -..orcr,or-i-,u of Cartesian materialistic world view. Perhaps the most rad­ thought and went over to a ical of this group of French intellectuals was Baron '-',...,. ...._ __,"' who affirmed that one's fate is fixed external causes. _._ ''----HV-'-.H•� .... ,.... ,

O�H,TOn-"\O

U.L\,UL'L'UIP'2'"LrL2�t1 �, have previously described in outline limbo of unneeded and unwanted n" -n°• form the extraordinary complexity of the human body, its gradual evolution through hundreds of millions of years, and the infinite intricacy of the structure underlying the view of these facts it is surely intellectual and emotional activities of human beings. not rash to claim that no supernatural soul is required to explain the great and varied achievements, powers and potentialities of man illustrated in every age and clime throughout the vast panorama of history. For the personality, which usually receives the credit for these things, is in truth hardly more remarkable than the body which is its base. CHl"Ylll-.rc,n,'O

,.:: ..

1 1 "'"

000

Lamont concludes, All in all, therefore, the findings of science, coupled with my earlier analysis of vari­ ous immortality ideas, establish a very powerful case in support of our thesis that immortality is an illusion.

In summary, Lamont claims that scientific evidence supports a monistic psy­ chology according to which human personality is simply a quality or characteris­ To introduce a ...,._,,,_.L,.,U.,_.__. soul or mind in Cartesian fashion that tics of the could survive death is to postulate a totally unnecessary concept that violates the highly re�:;o12ctea law of parsimony. In Lamont's discussion, then, dualism is at death is affirmed. and annihilation of 1"DlDrl-orl

CURT

DUCASSE

THE QUESTION IS STILL

PEN

FROM LAMONT TO DUCASSE. Immanuel Kant one of the most impressive of all modern philosophers, used to say that metaphysics, to the extent that it was colorful and humanly important, shook down to a reflective and immortality. concern with three questions: God, freedom (meaning free Can the existence of God be demonstrated and His nature defined? Does any 2 For a twentieth-century example of such a hypothesis, let us consider the claim that flowers grow healthily because fairies secretly minister to them during the hours of darkness. This thesis is supported by Sir Arthur Conan Doyle, who became a Spiritualist in his later years. In his book The Coming of the Fairies (Hodder, Toronto, 1922), there are submitted alleged photographs of the fairy folk at work. I am of course an admirer of Sir Arthur's stories of Sherlock Holmes, and I believe that his account of the fairies also belongs purely in the realm of the imagination.

THE QUESTION IS STILL OPEN

human behavior express genuine free will-self-originating, spontaneous auton­ omy? Does a human being survive the death of his body? Our present author, the late C. J. Ducasse, thought and wrote on all three of Kant's questions. In the pre­ sent section we examine his widely read lecture "Is Life After Death Possible?" As Ducasse sees it, the position taken and defended by philosophers such as Lamont has been adopted by most people. For them the question of personal immortality has been settled; the answer is in; the question is closed. No person survives the death of the body. For Ducasse, however, the evidence offered by Lamont does not justify the conclusion that belief in immortality is an illusion. For Ducasse, the question of personal immortality is still open; the matter is still debatable. In his lecture Ducasse attempts to convince Lamont and likeminded persons that discussion of the question is worth reopening. BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Curt John Ducasse was born in France in 1881. He came to the United States in 1900 and became an American citizen ten years later. He received his A.B. degree from the University of Washington and his Ph.D. from Harvard. He spent almost his entire professional philosophical career at Brown University where he chaired the Department of Philosophy for over twenty years. He had a number of prestigious offices in professional societies and filled several distinguished visiting professorships. His many books include Causation and the Types of Necessity (1924), The Philosophy of Art (1930), Philosophy as a Science (1941), Nature, Mind, and Death (1951), A Philosophical Scrutiny of Religion (1953), A Critical Examination of the Belief in Life After Death (1961), and Knowledge, Truth and Causation (1969). He died at the age of 88 in 1969. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. In the following material selected from his lec­ ture, Ducasse proposes to do four things: 1. To explore why people desire, and believe in, some sort of life after death. 2. To state the arguments commonly advanced to prove that such a life after death is impossible. 3. To show that these arguments fail to prove their point. 4. To expose the tacit but arbitrary assumption that makes these arguments against survival appear more convincing than the evidence allows. Why, then, do people desire and believe in a life after death? The craving for continued existence is very widespread. Even persons who believe that death means complete extinction of the individual's consciousness often find comfort in various substitute conceptions of survival. They may, for instance, dwell on the continuity of the individual's germ plasm in his descendants. Or they find solace in the thought that, the past being indestructible, their individual life remains eternally an intrinsic part of the history of the world. Also-and more satisfying to one's craving for personal importance-there is the fact that since the acts of one's life have effects, and these in turn further effects, and so on, therefore what one has done goes on for­ ever influencing remotely, and sometimes greatly, the course of future events. Gratifying to one's vanity, too, is the prospect that, if the achievements of one's life have been great or even only conspicuous, or one's benefactions or evil deeds have been

and relatives for a one's name may not only be remembered by little while, but may live on in recorded history. But cnnr1o-n..-,,u survival in any of these senses is but a consolation prize-but a thin substitute for the continuation of conscious individual life, which may not be a fact, but which most men crave nonetheless. The roots of this craving are certain desires which death appears to frustrate. For some, the chief of these is for reunion with persons dearly loved. For others, whose lives have been wretched, it is the desire for another chance at the happiness they have missed. For others yet, it is desire for further opportunity to grow in ability, knowledge or character. Often, there is also the desire, already mentioned, to go on counting for something in the affairs of men. And again, a future life for oneself and others is often desired in order that the redressing of the many injustices of this life shall be possible. But it goes without saying that, although desires such as these are often sufficient to cause belief in a future life, they constitute no evidence at all that it is a fact. In this connection, it may be well to point out that, although both the belief in survival and the belief in the existence of a god or gods are found in most religions, nevertheless there is no necessary connection between the two beliefs. No contradic­ tion would be involved in supposing either that there is a God but no life after death or that there is a life after death but no God. The belief that there is a life after death may be tied to a religion, but it is no more intrinsically religious than would be a belief that there is life on the planet Mars. The after-death world, if it exists, is just another region or dimension of the universe. But although belief in survival of death is natural and easy and has always been held in one form or another by a large majority of mankind, critical reflection quickly brings forth a number of apparently strong reasons to regard that belief as quite illusory. HL'LUL/H... ,

A belief in survival comes to many ..,,'---'"'..,,n.... It That has been Ducasse' s first true thinkers like Lamont have come up with as an exercise in wishful such belief as reasons, the most to review those problem. The first reason he examines is the claim consciousness depends on the central nervous Ducasse 1---''VUU.4'---L'U'

�L.�i ..,� .., �, .. ,.: .. �·�i

�·�"

There are, first of all, a number of facts which definitely suggest that both the exis­ tence and the nature of consciousness wholly depend on the presence of a function­ ing nervous system. It is pointed out, for example, that wherever consciousness is observed, it is found associated with a living and functioning body. Further, when the body dies, or the head is struck a heavy blow, or some anesthetic is administered, the familiar outward evidences of consciousness terminate, permanently or tem­ porarily. Again, we know well that drugs of various kinds-alcohol, caffeine, opium, heroin, and many others-cause specific changes at the time in the nature of a per­ son's mental states. Also, by stimulating in appropriate ways the body's sense organs, corresponding states of consciousness-namely, the various kinds of sensations-can be caused at will. On the other hand, cutting a sensory nerve immediately eliminates a whole range of sensations. Again, the contents of consciousness, the mental powers, or even the personal­ ity, are modified in characteristic ways when certain regions of the brain are destroyed by disease or injury or are disconnected from the rest by such an operation as prefrontal lobotomy. And that the nervous system is the indispensable basis of the

THE QUESTION IS STILL OPEN

mind is further suggested by the fact that in the evolutionary scale, the degree of intelligence of various species of animals keeps pace closely with the degree of devel­ opment of their brain.

The implication of this close dependence of consciousness on the central ner­ vous system is that when the nervous system dies, consciousness loses its hold on existence. When your bodily nervous system dies, you go out like a light. The second argument against postdeath survival Ducasse scrutinizes is the claim that consciousness does not merely depend on the nervous system but is identical with minute physical or chemical events that take place in the brain. Identity is a much closer relationship than dependence. That continued existence of mind after death is impossible has been argued also on the basis ... that what we call states of consciousness-or more particularly, ideas, sensations, volitions, feelings, and the like-are really nothing but the minute physi­ cal or chemical events which take place in the tissues of the brain. For, it is urged, it would be absurd to suppose that an idea or volition, if it is not itself a material thing or process, could cause material effects such as contractions of muscles .... Still another difficulty confronting the hypothesis of survival becomes evident when one imagines in some detail what survival would have to include in order to satisfy the desires which cause man to crave it. It would, of course, have to include persistence not alone of consciousness, but also of personality; that is, of the individ­ ual's character, acquired knowledge, cultural skills and interests, memories, and awareness of personal identity. But even this would not be enough, for what man desires is not bare survival, but to go on living in some objective way.And this means to go on meeting new situations and, by exerting himself to deal with them, to broaden and deepen his experience and develop his latent capacities. But it is hard to imagine this possible without a body and an environment for it, upon which to act and from which to receive impressions. And, if a body and an environment were supposed, but not material and corruptible ones, then it is para­ doxical to think that, under such radically different conditions, a given personality could persist. To take a crude but telling analogy, it is past belief that, if the body of any one of us were suddenly changed into that of a shark or an octopus, and placed in the ocean, his personality could, for more than a very short time, if at all, survive intact so radical a change of environment and a bodily form.

Thus far Professor Ducasse has asked why so many people find some form of personal survival to be both desirable and credible, and why, nevertheless, other people, more tough-minded perhaps, consider such belief to be lacking sufficient objective evidence. Now he turns to criticism of the position of those tough­ minded skeptics: first, their argument from identity; next, their argument from dependence. Such, in brief, are the chief reasons commonly advanced for holding that survival is impossible. Scrutiny of them, however, will, I think, reveal that they are not as strong as they first seem and far from strong enough to show that there can be no life after death. Let us consider first the assertion that thought," or consciousness," is another name for subvocal speech, or for some other form of behavior, or for molecular 11

11

that assertion, because to make the words thought," different from those which these words are on, denote -Y"" 1""· r1 to denote. To say that those words are but other names for certain chemical or behavioral events is as grossly arbitrary as it would be to say that wood" is but another name for or but another name for cabbage. What desire, sensation, and other mental states are each of us can observe directly by introspection; and what introspection reveals is that they do not in the least resemble muscular contraction, or glandular secretion, or any other known events. No tampering with language can alter the observable fact that thinking is one thing and muttering quite another; that the feeling called anger has no resemblance to the bod­ ily behavior which usually goes with it; or that an act of will is not in the least like anything we find when we open the skull and examine the brain. Certain mental events are doubtless connected in some way with certain bodily events, but they are not those bodily events themselves. The connection is not identity. This being clear, let us next consider the arguments offered to show that mental processes, although not identical with bodily processes, nevertheless depend on them. We are told, for instance, that some head injuries, or anesthetics, totally extin­ guish consciousness for the time being. As already pointed out, however, the strict fact is only that the usual bodily signs of consciousness are then absent. But they are also absent when a person is asleep; and yet, at the same time, dreams, which are states of consciousness, may be occurring. It is true that when the person concerned awakens, he often remembers his dreams, whereas the person that has been anesthetized or injured has usually no mem­ ories relating to the period of apparent blankness. But this could mean that his con­ sciousness was, for the first time, dissociated from its ordinary channels of inanifesta­ tion, as was reported of the coconscious personalities of some of the patients of Dr. Morton Prince. Moreover, it sometimes occurs that a person has been in an acci­ dent reports lack of memories not only for the during which his body \vas unre­ sponsive but also for a period of several hours before the accident, during which he had given to his associates all the ordinary external signs of being conscious as usual. But, more generally, if absence of memories relating to a given period proved unconsciousness for that period, this would force us to conclude that we were uncon­ scious during the first few years of our lives, and indeed have been so most of the time since; for the fact is that we have no memories whatever of most of our days. That we were alive and conscious on any long past specific date is, with only a few exceptions, not something we actually remember, but only something which we infer must be true. 11

01

0

11

Ducasse launches into an exposition and defense of psychical At this research because he believes such research ,.._.,,.,n,�T,,,,::,,., evidence which must be taken seriously as one addresses the issue of postdeath survival. In c:xzur.n--- •..--. normal phenomena such as apparitions and the Research (of which Ducasse was a committed member for many sented evidence that seems to call into the ,...,,,.r,.nrv-,r.-�¼-" and dependence, to survival.

THE QUESTION IS STILL OPEN

To assert that [all manifestations of the mind invariably cease at death] is to ignore altogether the considerable amount of evidence to the contrary, gathered over many years and carefully checked by the Society for Psychical Research. This evidence, which is of a variety of kinds, has been reviewed by Professor Gardner Murphy in an article published in the Journal of the Society. He mentions first the numerous well­ authenticated cases of apparition of a dead person to others as yet unaware that he had died or even been ill or in danger. The more strongly evidential cases of appari­ tion are those in which the apparition conveys to the person who sees it specific facts until then secret. An example would be that of the apparition of a girl to her brother nine years after her death, with a conspicuous scratch on her cheek. Their mother then revealed to him that she herself had made that scratch accidentally while preparing her daughter's body for burial, but that she had then at once covered it with powder and never mentioned it to anyone.... Other striking instances are those of an apparition seen simultaneously by sev­ eral persons. It is on record that an apparition of a child was perceived first by a dog, that the animal's rushing at it, loudly barking, interrupted the conversation of the seven persons present in the room, thus drawing their attention to the apparition, and that the latter then moved through the room for some fifteen seconds, followed by the barking dog. Another type of empirical evidence of survival consists of communications, pur­ porting to come from the dead, made through the persons commonly called sensi­ tives, mediums, or automatists. Some of the most remarkable of these communica­ tions were given by the celebrated American medium, Mrs. Piper, who for many years was studied by the Society for Psychical Research, London, with the most elab­ orate precautions against all possibility of fraud. Twice, particularly, the evidences of identity supplied by the dead persons who purportedly were thus communicating with the living were of the very kinds, and of the same precision and detail which would ordinarily satisfy a living person of the identity of another living person with whom he was not able to communicate directly, but only through an intermediary, or by letter or telephone. Again, sometimes the same mark of identity of a dead person, or the same mes­ sage from him, or complementary parts of one message, are obtained independently from two mediums in different parts of the world. Of course, when facts of these kinds are recounted, as I have just done, only in abstract summary, they make little if any impression upon us. And the very word "medium" at once brings to our minds the innumerable instances of demonstrated fraud perpetuated by charlatans to extract money from the credulous bereaved. But the modes of trickery and sources of error, which immediately suggest themselves to us as easy, natural explanations of the seemingly extraordinary facts, suggest them­ selves just as quickly to the members of the research committees of the Society for Psychical Research.Usually, these men have had a good deal more experience than the rest of us with the tricks of conjurers and fraudulent mediums, and take against them precautions far more strict and ingenious than would occur to the average sceptic. But when, instead of stopping at summaries, one takes the trouble to study the detailed, original reports, it then becomes evident that they cannot all be just laughed off; for to accept the hypothesis of fraud or mal-observation would often require more credulity than to accept the facts reported. To explain those facts, however, is quite another thing. Only two hypotheses at all adequate to do so have yet been advanced. One is that the communications really

to do, from persons who have died and have VDOthes1s of rn ,,/_ _ rn is, the enough, that the rr,f:c11,urr is able to gather information others, and that this is the true source of the 0�=•�-,,_,�-� communicated. account this hypothesis has to be stretched very far, for some for all the facts, them require us to suppose that the rr,c'.d'l.tl' lT, can the minds even of persons far away and quite unknown to him, and can even the subconscious of their minds. Diverse highly ingenious attempts have been made to devise conditions that would rule out telepathy as a nncc,hle> of the communications received; but some of the most critical and best-documented investigators still hold that it has not yet been absolutely excluded. Hence, although some of the facts recorded by psy­ chical research constitute, prima facie, strong empirical evidence of survival, they can­ not be said to establish it beyond question. But they do show that we need to revise rather radically in some respects our ordinary ideas of what is and is not ooss1lble in nature. �n,-,,icu,,.cic;i

give fair consideration to the of psychical research, and If they scrutinize the arguments Ducasse agree with him that those ��,,,���·~ .. against survival are not nearly so find these as critics like Lamont lead us to believe. But why do so convincing? That is a good question to ask. If you have examined a person's rrn,mor, on a certain matter, and you find them it is a weak and .. ���·�· thing to ask ev12rtne1ess, that person Ducasse offers the ..n,,nr,n answer: finds them n

�H.AA�•AAAU

It is, believe, because these persons approach the quesr1on of survival a certain unconscious metaphysical bias. It derives from a particular initial as�;urnonon which they tacitly make. It is that to be real is to be material. And to be material, of course, is to be some process or part of the perceptually public world, that is, of the we all perceive by means of our so-called five senses. Now the assumption that to be real is to be material is a useful and appropriate one for the purpose of investigating the material world and operating upon it; and this purpose is a legitimate and frequent one. But those persons, and most of us, do relative to that specific pur­ not realize that the validity of that assumption is pose. Hence they, and most of us, continue u,,uu.. ,_, the assumption, and it continues to rule judgment, even when, as now, the purpose in view is a different one, for which the assumption is no longer useful or even congruous. The point is all-important here and therefore worth stressing. Its essence is that the conception of the nature of reality that proposes to define the real as the material is not the expression of an observable fact to which everyone would have to bow, but is the expression only of a certain direction of interest on the part of the persons who so define reality-of interest, namely, which they have chosen to center wholly in the material, perceptually public world. This specialized interest is of course as legitimate as any other; but it automatically ignores all the facts, commonly called facts of mind, which only introspection reveals. And that specialized interest is what alone compels persons in its grip to employ the word "mind" to denote, instead of what it com­ monly does denote, something else altogether, namely, the public behavior of bodies that have minds.

THE QUESTION IS STILL OPEN

Only so long as one's judgement is swayed unawares by that special interest do the logically weak arguments against the possibility of survival which we have exam­ ined seem strong. It is possible, however, and just as legitimate, as well as more conducive to a fair view of our question, to center one's interest at the start on the facts of mind as intro­ spectively observable, ranking them as most real in the sense that they are the facts the intrinsic nature of which we most directly experience, the facts which we most certainly know to exist; and moreover, that they are the facts without the experienc­ ing of which we should not know any other facts whatever-such, for instance, as . those of the material world. The sort of perspective one gets from this point of view is what I propose now to sketch briefly. For one thing, the material world is then seen to be but one among other objects of our consciousness. Moreover, one becomes aware of the crucially important fact that it is an object postulated rather than strictly given. What this means may be made clearer by an example. Suppose that, perhaps in a restaurant we visit for the first time, an entire wall is occupied by a large mirror and we look into it without realizing that it is a mirror. We then perceive, in the part of space beyond it, various material objects, notwithstanding that in fact they have no existence there at all. A certain set of the vivid color images which we call visual sensations was all that was strictly given to us, and these we construed, automatically and instantaneously, but nonetheless erroneously, as signs or appearances of the existence of certain mate­ rial objects at a certain place. Again, and similarly, we perceive in our dreams various objects which at the time we take as physical but which eventually we come to believe were not so. And this eventual conclusion, let it be noted, is forced upon us not because we then detect that something, called "physical substance," was lacking in those objects, but only because we notice, as we did not at the time, that their behavior was erratic-incohf1 ent with their ordinary one. That is, their appearance was a mere appearance, decep­ tive in the sense that it did not then predict truly, as ordinarily it does, their later appearances. This, it is important to notice, is the only way in which we ever discowr that an object we perceive was not really physical, or was not the particular sort 01 physical object we judged it to be. These two examples illustrate the fact that our perception of physical objects is sometimes erroneous. But the essential point is that, even when it is veridical instead of erroneous, all that is literally and directly given to our minds is still only some set of sensations. These, on a given occasion, may be only color sensations; but they often include also tactual sensations, sounds, odors, and so on. It is especially interesting, however, to remark here in passing that, with respect to almost all the many thou­ sands of persons and other "physical" objects we have perceived in a life time, vivid color images were the only data our perceiving strictly had to go by; that, if the truth should happen to have been that those objects, like ghosts or images in a mirror, were actually intangible-that is, were only color images-we should never had discovered that this was the fact. For all we directly know, it may have been the fact! To perceive a physical object, then, instead of merely experiencing passively certain sensations (something which perhaps hardly ever occurs), is always to interpret, that is to construe, given sensations as signs of, and appearances to us of, a postulated something other than themselves, which we believe is causing them in us and is capable of causing in us others of specific kinds. We believe this because we believe that our sensations too must have some cause, and we find none of them among our other mental states.

a that we observe purpose to be clear than is constituted for �,,,,��-� the of two factorsone, a set of sensations to us, and the other an act of interpretation of these, oe.rt·or· ,'Tl,E'ct by us-is something which escapes notice and has even been denied. This, however, is because the interpretive act is almost automatic, instantaneous, and correct-like, for instance, that of thinking of the meaning of any familiar word we hear. But that an interpretive act does occur is forced on our attention when, in a particular case, we discover that we misconstrued the meaning of the sensa­ tions. Or again, the interpretive act is noticeable when, because the sensations are too scant and therefore ambiguous, we catch ourselves hesitating between two or more possible interpretations of them and say that we are not sure what object it is we see.

We should recall Ducasse's intentions as ovn .... ,:,ccor1 in the title that he chose for his lecture. The title was, "Is Life After Death Possible?" His stated intentions do not go beyond that. He is not trying to prove that a person does indeed sur­ vive the death of his or her body. Instead, in this lecture he has offered a defensive skirmish directed against those persons who insist that survival is not and that therefore any belief in it is an ,m-nn,ecc, belief. Ducasse's defensive strategy is to insist that their are not and that their obliviousness to this may well stem from an ''".,...,,..,.,..,,.,..,.,.., or unacknowlbias that be real is be material. Our next Robert on the basis of a comprehensive survey of human ences, moves somewhat beyond Ducasse to argue that not is belief in death survival p·os::;1Dlf'_, is indeed rationally warranted. NOTE ON SOU RCES. in this section is from Curt u'-''-"'"'''-, "Is Life After Death ,-,,."'"'''n,,__, " published the Forester Lecture l-.....,,un,•c,,+-.;r of California

ROBERT ALMEDER E TH IS NOT THE EN

FROM DUCASSE TO ALMEDER. For Lamont the death is the end. For vival is an open: death may not in fact be the end. Ducasse challenged Lamont's tion of the empirical data and invited -no.ny,. like Lamont to consider some addi­ tional data: the data harbored the paranormal of humankind. Robert Almeder has _,,,,,,,ur,ro multitude of accounts that and has winnowed out of these a considerable cluster of 110

1-"'-"L� .... ,L, .... ,_...,

DEATH IS NOT THE END

accounts that he believes are beyond fraud and hoax. Such '' authentic" accounts require an explanation, and the explanation Almeder has reached involves per­ sonal postdeath survival. Indeed, Almeder finds the data so convincing that he almost echoes Lamont in saying that the question is closed (but closed in a differ­ ent fashion): death is not the end; persons do survive the death of their bodies. The following case presented by Almeder is taken from his recent book, Death and Personal Survival: The Evidence for Life After Death, published in 1992. BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Robert F. Almeder is Professor of Philosophy at Georgia State University. Almeder received his doctorate in philosophy from the University of Pennsylvania in 1969 and specializes in epistemology, American philosophy and ethics. Among his recent works are Blind Realism: An Essay on Human Knowledge and Natural Science; Beyond Death: Evidence for Life After Death (1987); and Death and Personal Survival: The Evidence for Life After Death (1992), from which the readings in this section have been taken. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Almeder cites five kinds of human experi­ ences which, he argues, are best explained by the hypothesis of postdeath sur­ vival. Given the variety of these experiences and the number of their occurrences, Almeder claims that they provide sufficient evidence for belief in postdeath sur­ vival. From the many cases discussed by Almeder we have selected only one or two to illustrate each of the five types. The first type of experience involves a person remembering that he or she lived an earlier life as a different person. These memories have frequently been so vivid and detailed that people have taken them to be evidence of reincarnation. Consider the following case of Mrs. Smith reported by the British psychiatrist, Dr. Arthur Guirdham. In his book The Cathars and Reincarnation, a British psychiatrist named Dr. Arthur Guirdham describes in detail a particular case that compelled him to accept the belief in reincarnation.I The woman in the case, Mrs. Smith, was his patient; and he met her in 1961 when he was chief psychiatrist at Bath Hospital in England. Mrs. Smith's problem was that she had persistent nightmares during which she shrieked so loud that she and her husband feared it would wake the whole neighborhood. Dr. Guirdham examined her closely for neuroses but found she had none. After a few months, Mrs. Smith told Guirdham that, when she was a girl, she had written her dreams down. She had also written things that came spontaneously to her mind as rec­ ollections-things she could not understand that had to do with people, and specific names she had never heard. She gave the papers to the doctor, and he examined them.2 Dr. Guirdham was surprised to find that what she had written as a school girl were verses of songs in medieval French and in langue d' oc, the language spoken in southern France in the twelfth and thirteenth centuries. The doctor ascertained that she had never studied these languages in school and that there was no source avail1 Arthur Guirdham, The Cathars and Reincarnation (London: Neville Spearman, 1970). 2 Ibid., p. 108.

ROBERT ALMEDER

177

able for her learning them. He sent a report of her story to Professor Rene Nelli of Toulouse University, and asked for the professor's opinion on the matter. Nelli responded that her writings gave an accurate account of the Cathars in Toulouse in the thirteenth century. The Cathars were a group of Christian dissidents of the extreme dualist persuasion, whose religious beliefs were close to the Albigensians and centered on the belief in reincarnation. They were persecuted and destroyed during the Inquisition. Only gradually did Mrs. Smith admit having had an intensive uprush of mem­ ory in her early teens3-memories of a past life with a Cathar priest named Roger de Grisolles, whom she loved very much, and who taught her Cathar rituals and reli­ gious principles.4 Guirdham states that, apart from her dreams, Mrs. Smith had expe­ rienced a number of these spontaneous recollections, and she told him in horrid detail her recollection of the massacre of the Cathars.5 She also told him that in her dreams and recollections of a previous life she had been kept prisoner in a certain church crypt. Guirdham notes that, at first, experts said this church crypt had never been used for that purpose, but later research showed that so many religious prison­ ers were taken on one occasion that there was no room for all of them in regular pris­ ons. Some had been kept in that very crypt. Guirdham visited the south of France in 1967 to investigate the case. He read thirteenth-century manuscripts (available to only a limited number of scholarst and these manuscripts showed that Mrs. Smith's account was accurate. She had given Guirdham names and descriptions of people, places, and events, all of which turned out to be accurate to the last detail. Guirdham claims that there was no normal way in which Mrs. Smith could have known about these things. He even found in the manu­ scripts four of the songs she wrote as a child. They were correct, word for word.6 Guirdham notes that, although his subject claimed never to have read any books on the subject of thirteenth-century life, she made correct drawings of uld French coins, jewelry worn at the time, and the layout of buildings--to say nothing of the intricate details of Cathar ritual. Guirdham attests that Mrs. Smith was able to name and place accurate! yin their family and social relationships people who do not appear in the textbooks, but who were ultimately traced by going back to the dog-Latin records of the Inquisition. These minor characters are still traceable owing to the antlike industry of the Inquisitors and their clerks. Mrs. Smith remembered members of the Fanjeaux and Mazzarolles families, in particular giving their first names and the roles they played. She recollected treating her friend Roger de Grisolles with sugarloaf as a tonic. However, the experts called this into question: the existence of sugar at this time in Europe was doubted. Further investigation disclosed that sugar in loaf form was derived from Arab medicine and did indeed exist at this period in France? Even more remarkable was Guirdham's patient's description of her death when she was burned at the stake. This she both dreamed and subsequently claimed to remember. The description, conveyed by Guirdham as part of his case, reads as follows:

3 4 s 6 7

Ibid., p. 10. Ibid., pp. 73-84. Ibid., pp. 107ff. Ibid., pp. 125ff. Ibid., pp. 94-95.

B

DEATH IS NOT THE END

The pain was maddening.You should pray to God when you're dying,if you can pray when you're in agony.In my dream I didn't pray to God....I didn't know when you were burnt to death you'd bleed.I thought the blood would all dry up in the terrible heat.But I was bleeding heavily. The blood was dripping and hissing in the flames.I wished I had enough blood to put the flames out. The worst part was my eyes. I hate the thought of going blind. ....In this dream I was going blind.I tried to close my eyelids but I couldn't. They must have been burnt off, and now those flames were going to pluck my eyes out with their evil fingers.... The flames weren't so cruel after all. They began to feel cold.Icy cold.It occurred to me that I wasn't burning to death but freezing to death.I was numb with the cold and suddenly I started to laugh. I had fooled those people who thought they could burn me.I am a witch. I had magicked the fire and turned it to ice.s Finally, in a lecture entitled "Reincarnation and the Practice of Medicine," Dr. Guirdham reflected on certain crucial details of the case, many of which were also discussed in his book. Twenty-five years ago, as a student, a school girl at the age of 13,she was insist­ ing that Cathar priests did not always wear black. You will find the statement that they did in any book on the subject written in any language until 1965.Yet she said that her friend in the thirteenth century wore dark blue. It now tran­ spires that at one sitting of the Inquisition (the Inquisition of Jacques Fournier, who was Bishop at Palmiers), it came out ten times in one session that Cathar priests sometimes wore dark blue or dark green. But that fact had been lying in the archives in Latin for long enough,and was only accessible to the public in 1965 when Duvernoy edited the record of the said Inquisitors that was pub­ lished in Toulouse in 1966.But this woman knew this in 1944 as a school girL Again she could describe rituals in a house, a kind of convent. ... Professor Nelli, the greatest living authority on the Troubadors-who definitely are connected with the Cathars-wrote to me and said,"This is almost exactly Cathar ritual,making allowance for local deviation." He also added later that he would tell me where the place was,the Convent of Montreal.By way of future advice,he added that,in case of doubt,one should"go by the patient." Professor Nelli is the most meticulous and skeptical assessor of evidence. When I first wrote to another specialist,Professor Duvernoy of Toulouse,he said,"Get in touch with me about everything you want.I am astonished at your detailed knowledge of Catharism." I couldn't say,'Tve got this by copying down the dreams of a woman of thirty-six or seven which she had when she was a grammar school girl of thirteen." He's found out since,but he's all the more keen to supply me with the evidence.... If the professors at Toulouse are amazed at the accuracy with which an English girl can produce details of Catharism known to few,that is good enough for me.... [A]ll I have done in this matter is to listen to the story,act as an ama-

s

Ibid., p. 89.

179

ROBERT ALMEDER

teur historian, and try to verify from many sources the details she had noted. I believe this to be a unique and entirely valid experience.9

Alrneder observes,

At this point, then, the argument for reincarnation is very simple. It is this. What would be a better or more plausible explanation for these cases than to assume that human personality (whatever it admits of reincarnation? Opponents of reincarna­ tion must provide an equally plausible or better alterative explanation for the data if they are to undermine effectively the claim that the best available explanation for these sorts of cases is reincarnation.

The second type of experience includes apparitions of the dead. For many of us, the thought of ghosts engenders ideas of the trickery associated with Halloween and horror movies. Yet there are people who claim that they have in fact encoun­ tered apparitions of deceased persons that are neither fraudulent nor hallucinatory, apparitions which have been taken as evidence of postmortem survival. As you assess the following case involving Mrs. Butler, note the measures taken by the Reverend Abraham Cummings to verify the happenings. Consider the case noted by C. J. Ducasse in A Critical Examination of the Belief in Life after Death-a case that Ducasse thinks provides striking evidence for life after death.JO The original account was written in 1826 by the Reverend Abraham Cummings, a graduate of Brown University and a Baptist minister in Maine, in a pamphlet entitled Immortality Proved by Testimony of Sense.11 The apparitions were of the deceased Mrs. George Butler and occurred in a vil­ lage near Machiasport, Maine. The "specter" of Mrs. Butler appeared a number of times over a period of several months. She was seen on different occasions by groups of p1,ople numbering as many as 40 persons, and appeared both indoors and outdoon,.12 She presented extended discourses and moved freely among the gathered people. She also accurately predicted both births and deaths, and conveyed intimah· and allegedly very private details of the lives of those in the group.13 For example, she accurately predicted that the new Mrs. Butler would have one child and shortly thereafter die. She also provided one man with the information-unknown to him and everybody else in the group at the time-that his father in a distant town had 9 Arthur Guirdham,"Reincarnation and the Practice of Medicine," lecture delivered at the College of Psychic Science, London, March 1969, unpublished. See also Guirdham, Cathars, pp. 92ff. 10 C. J. Ducasse, A Critical Examination of the Belief in Life after Death (Springfield, Ill.: Charles C. Thomas, 1961), pp. 21-22. 11 The Reverend AbrahamCummings's Immortality Proved by Testimony of Sense was originally published by J.C. Torrey, in Bath, Maine, in 1826. A copy is available in the New York Public Library as well as in the Library of the Division of Personality Studies in the Department of Behavioral Medicine at the University of Virginia School of Medicine in Charlottesville, Virginia. The case has been closely examined by Muriel Roll in her article"A Nineteenth-century Matchmaking Apparition: Comments on Abraham Cummings' 'Immortality Proved by Testimony of the Senses, Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research 63, no. 4 (October 1969), pp. 396---409. 12 Cummings, Immortality Proved, pp. 29ff. 13 Ibid., pp. 32-34. 111

DEATH IS NOT THE END

recently died.14 Given the time factor involved, Cummings argues that nobody in town could have had normal knowledge of that death. Moreover, Reverend Cummings was astute enough to obtain at the time more than 30 sworn affidavits from some of the 100 or more persons who had heard and/or seen the specter under different circumstances in the company of others.IS These affidavits are reproduced in the pamphlet.16 He also examined the testimony very closely and rejected the pos­ sibility of fraud or hoax.17 Furthermore, on one occasion Captain Butler (Mrs. Butler's living husband) placed his hand "upon" the apparition, and his hand passed through as if its body were made of light. Six or seven persons witnessed this event and made it part of their sworn testimony.IS Assuming the absence of fraud or hoax, and assuming that other similar cases exist in which we can equally assume the absence of fraud or hoax (both assumptions we shall establish later), what can be said about this case? To begin with, the frequency of the apparition, the changing circumstances in which it appeared, and the large and varying numbers of persons involved in testify­ ing to each instance of the apparition suggest that the likelihood of a collective per­ ceptual error on each occasion is remarkably low. Certainly we cannot dismiss this case as readily as we would a report of an apparition by one person or a group of per­ sons on only one occasion. Here, any appeal to delusion or hallucination seems much more difficult to argue, and not very convincing. Certainly the probability of such a mistake on each occasion is remarkably lower than it is in the case of a group sighting on only one occasion. As a matter of fact, the probability of a large group of people being mistaken in their perceptual beliefs about what they have seen when they tes­ tify to seeing the same thing repeatedly under different circumstances (both indoors and outdoors) over an extended period of time (many months) in which the member­ ship of the group changes frequently is zero. I know of no case in which a collective mistaken belief of precisely this sort has ever been established. Also, inasmuch as the specter accurately predicted both births and deaths, and conveyed to the group information (some very private) that nobody in the group could plausibly have known at the time, we cannot easily dismiss as mistaken the information the group obtained in the apparitional experience. If the people in this case were seeing and hearing something other than the postmortem surviving per­ sonality of Mrs. Butler (but mistakenly believed that they were seeing as much), what indeed could they have been seeing that is not evidence of personal survival? It is fashionable to say that they must have been seeing things that were not really there, or seeing things that were really there but not the things they thought they saw. Such a response is predicated on the assumption that they did not see what they say they saw-and what exactly is the evidence that they could not have seen what they say they saw?

You may be inclined to discount the report about Mrs. Butler because it was recorded more than 150 years ago. If so, consider the following case which 14 Ibid., p. 33. 1s Ibid., pp. 70ff. 16 Ibid., pp. 22ff. 17 Ibid., p. 34. 18 Ibid., p. 30.

ROBERT ALMEDER

181

occurred just a few years ago, the case of The Ghost of Flight 401." Like the apparition of Mrs. Butler, the Ghost of Flight 401 made specific predictions that accurately foretold future events. 11

In the dead of night on December 28, 1972, Eastern Airlines Flight 401 plunged into the Florida Everglades, killing 101 passengers and crew. Two months later the alleged ghosts of its pilot and its second officer began to appear on sister ships carrying or using parts salvaged from the original crash. The pilot's name was Captain Robert Loft; the second officer's was Don Repo. According to John F uller (the principal investigator of the caset testimony regarding the apparition of the two ghosts grew to alarming proportions. Most of the sightings occurred in the galley of Eastern plane 318, which-like a few other L-lOlls-was using some of the salvaged parts of the L1011 that crashed in the Everglades.19 One incident occurred on plane 318 as it prepared to depart Newark, New Jersey, for Miami, Florida. The second officer had completed his preflight walk­ around check. The captain and the first officer were in the cockpit. The food for in­ flight meals had been delivered to the plane, and everything was set for takeoff. In the first-class section, the senior stewardess was making the usual head count, and her count was off by one passenger too many. An Eastern captain in uniform was in one of the seats. She inferred that he was "deadheading" (going back) to Miami, where the flight originated; he was not on her list thus accounting for the extra pas­ senger. It was necessary, however, to confirm the count, and she advised the captain that he was not on her list. She asked if he would be riding in the jump seat back to Miami. The captain did not respond, looking straight ahead. She asked him again whether he was a first-class traveler in the jump seat. Still he did not answer and looked straight ahead. Perplexed, she brought the flight supervisor over to ask the same question, and she too received no response. The captain seemed normal in every respect except that he seemed to be in some sort of daze. His unresponsiveness worried the two attendants, and one of them went into the cockpit to tell the flight captain what was transpiring. The flight captain, too, was perplexed. He left the cock­ pit and went to the first-class compartment. In reporting this incident, John Fuller notes that half-a-dozen regular first-class passengers were in the immediate vicinity of the silent deadheading captain, and all of them were curious about what was going on.20 As the flight captain approached the seat, he was puzzled that there was no record of another Eastern captain's being listed as jump-seat occupant, and that this one apparently had no pass for the flight. With the flight's two stewardesses and their supervisor beside him, the captain leaned down to address the other captain and, just as he did, he froze. "My God, it's Bob Loft," he said. The cabin was totally silent and then, as it is reported, the captain in the seat disappeared before the eyes of all. The flight captain returned to the operations officer in the cockpit. After a bit of delay, the plane was totally searched. The missing captain could not be found. Plane 318 finally did take off for Miami, its passengers and crew still stunned. When the three attendants on the flight later sought to examine the flight log (in which, by F AA regulation, every unusual incident had to be recorded), they found the page for that flight missing, even though the entire crew reported the incident. 19 See John Fuller, The Ghost of Flight 401 (New York: Berkeley Publishing, 1978). 20 Ibid., p. 138.

12

DEATH IS NOT THE END

All the pages up to and including the incident had been removed, contrary to gene practice. The captain's and the crew's comments were completely miss i ng. Thereafter, the plane 318 log book was removed after every flight-a practice not f lowed in any other planes at Eastern. Captain Loft was later sighted again on the same plane, in the galley, simultan ously by two stewardesses and the captain. After this incident, however, the flig was cancelled.22 Don Repo, Captain Loft's second officer, was seen even more frequently 0 plane 318. Indeed, whereas Loft's appearances stopped after a short while (seernin restricted to the one flight that was cancelled), the specter of Don Repo continued be visible for at least two years after the crash. I shall recount here only a few of more interesting incidents in which Repo appeared to a number of people. Howe in no fewer than two dozen incidents by the end of 1973, various people repor seeing Repo. In general, he appeared in order to do little repairs for the stewardes or to advise the flight crew of potential mechanical problems. He was a friendly an helpful specter who was frequently reported to have had discussions with vario people on the plane. Then there was the incident involving a woman passenger in the first-class s tion of plane 318, scheduled for a New York to Miami flight. The plane was at t ramp, and the head count had not yet been taken by the flight attendant in the fir class section. The woman passenger was seated next to an Eastern flight officer, in th uniform of a flight engineer. Something about the officer worried the woman. He looked so ghastly pale a ill; and when she said something to him, he would not respond. She asked him if felt all right and if she should call the stewardess to help him. Still no response ca from the sickly looking flight officer. The woman called the stewardess, who agre that he seemed ill. The stewardess asked him if he needed any help. Other pas c;t gers also noticed him. Then, in front of the group-as before-the flight engineer d appeared. The woman became almost hysterical. Later she and the flight attenda picked out a picture of Repo as the officer who had been in the first-class seat. In 1974 an Eastern captain allegedly told John Fuller that he had once bee warned by a flight engineer riding in the jump seat of his L-1011 that there was goi to be an electrical failure.23 The captain ordered a recheck, which revealed a faulty d cuit. Later, after a second look, the cockpit crew identified the intruding second of cer sitting in the jump seat as Don Repo. Finally, there is the Mexico City incident. In February 1974, plane 318 was read ied for a flight to Mexico City. During the preparations, one of the flight attendants working in the galley below-looked at the window of one of the ovens and cle saw the face of Don Repo looking out at her. She ran to the elevator, went up a de and grabbed another flight attendant. Together they went down into the galley an approached the oven. The second flight attendant also saw the image. It was not reflection. They called the flight deck and gave the story to the flight enginee Immediately he came down. He also recognized Repo's face in the oven window; an as he gazed at Repo, Repo spoke audibly to the engineer and said, "Watch out for fir 21 Ibid., p. 141. 22 Ibid., p. 150. 23 Ibid., p. 159.

ROBERT ALMEDER

183

on this plane." Then he disappeared. Later that day the plane's third engine burst into flame on takeoff, and it returned to the ground on one engine. Eastern Airlines' official position on the Ghost of Flight 401 (which principally refers to the sightings of Repo) is that it is gossip, and that nobody ever reported see­ ing any such ghosts. But the log book of plane 318 has never been made available. Sightings of the ghosts finally did stop-after all the salvaged parts were removed from plane 318. Like the Butler case, this case involved various persons-sometimes in groups­ under various circumstances and over a long period of time, who simultaneously had the same apparitional experience. And nobody had anything to gain by reporting such stories.

Almeder offers his summary assessment of the evidence for postdeath survival provided by encounters with apparitions. In the end, we may not be able to say how a disembodied person can be causally effec­ tive in producing visual and auditory sensations that are plausibly taken as evidence for its existence. The crucial point, however, is not that we be able to explain how all this can happen, or even why it happens. We need only show good reasons for think­ ing that it happens. Here again, demonstrating that something happens is no substi­ tute for showing how or why it happens. But failure to show how or why is quite consis­ tent with showing that it happens. Is the Butler case unique? Well, if it were, this would be sufficient reason to sus­ pect that the case was fabricated-that it was a hoax of some sort, or the product of some sort of a mistake we may not be able now to detect. Fortunately, the fact that there are other cases very similar to the Butler case-such as the Ghost of Flight 401 and the other cases described above--is good reason to think that the Butler ,:ase is not a hoax of some sort or the product of some undetectable mistake. Even so, we must admit that there is a serious problem with the case of the Ghost of Flight 401. The problem is that, unlike in the Butler case, the testimony and evidence is not a matter of public record and carefully recorded testimony. Nur was the matter investigated by more than the one person cited (a journalist) and the data independently verified with careful methodology. This affords good grounds to ques­ tion the data and raise the question of hoax. And even if it is not a hoax or the prod­ uct of careless but honest methodology, we cannot at this moment regard it as a well­ established case investigated by careful inquirers. In this regard we can only hope that Eastern Airlines will release the log of flights of plane 318, that some of the prin­ cipals will come forward to be identified, and that the data will be reexamined. Similarly, there are those who will argue-plausibly-that a close examination of the Butler case as it is depicted in the pamphlet written by Reverend Cummings raises important questions that were not asked at the time. Moreover, the Butler case took place so long ago that the principals cannot be directly examined on the matter. Was Reverend Cummings the right person to investigate and report on the case? Might he have been altogether too careless and naive? For these reasons-while it seems fair to say that nobody has successfully disputed the Butler case, or even the case of the Ghost of Flight 401-the evidence for personal survival based on these cases is certainly not so strong as would be necessary for inducing anything like robustly confirmed belief rather than plausible or likely belief.

DEATH IS NOT THE END

The third type of experience examined by Almeder that purportedly pro­ vides evidence for postmortem survival is possession. "Possession," writes Almeder, "is usually defined as the alleged phenomenon in which a clearly established and well-recognized personality is totally replaced, often only temporarily, by another personality occupying the same physical body" (p. 135). Such a concept of posses­ sion presupposes a kind of dualism in which one's personality is distinct from and separable from one's physical body. Both of the following cases of possession involve the supplanting of a woman's personality by the personality of a woman who had recently died. The first case we will review is that of Lurancy Vennum/M:ary Roff, the so-called "Watseka Wonder," summarized by Almeder. Any reasonably adequate discussion of the evidence for life after death should include a consideration of the famous Watseka Wonder as a striking instance of pos­ session-an instance that allegedly supports the belief in postmortem personal sur­ vival. The case was originally presented and described by Dr. E. W. Stevens in 1887 in a paper entitled "The Watseka Wonder: A Narrative of Startling Phenomena Occurring in the Case of Mary Lurancy Vennum,"24 and C. J. Ducasse discusses it in detail in his 1961 Critical Examination of the Belief in Life after Death.25 The circumstances took place in Watseka, Illinois, and concern two girls. The first girl, Mary Roff, had died at 18 in 1865. She was said to have suffered from "fits" and was allegedly able to read closed books and the contents of sealed envelopes. The second girl was Lurancy Vennum, born in April 1864 and over a year old when Mary Roff died. Lurancy seemed quite normal until 1877 when, at age 13, she complained of feeling queer and had a fit, "including a cataleptic state lasting five hours."26 On later occasions, while in a trance state, she allegedly talked with "angels" or "spirits" of deceased persons. She also seemed to be possessed by various alien spirits, each of whom took turns possessing her. Her sanity was questioned. The most interesting (according to Ducasse) of Lurancy's "possessions" was that by the mind of Mary Roff. Lurancy claimed to be Mary Roff and gave evidence of being homesick and wanting to see her (Mary's) parents and brothers. After a few days, Lurancy was taken to and permitted to live with the Roff family. While living with the Roffs, she seemed quite happy and knew everybody that Mary Roff had known in her lifetime 12-25 years earlier. She readily identified by name the persons who had been friends and neighbors of the Roffs during Mary's lifetime. During her stay at the Roffs' residence, she recounted hundreds of incidents that had occurred in Mary's natural life and, unlike any reincarnation case, never had any awareness of her identity as Lurancy; she could not identify or recognize any of the Vennum family members or their friends and neighbors. Her identity as Mary while living with the Roffs lasted more than three and a half months, and she was fully accepted as Mary by the family. Later, her identity as Lurancy returned and she recognized nothing about the Roffs but had all the memories of Lurancy, including the usual recognitions attending 24 E.W. Stevens, "The Watseka Wonder: A Narrative of Startling Phenomena Occurring in the Case of Mary Lurancy Vennum," Philosophical Journal, Religio-philosophical Publishing House, Chicago (1887), pp. 286-316. 25 C. J. Ducasse, A Critical Examination of the Belief in Life after Death (Springfield, Ill.: Charles C. Thomas, 1961). 26 Ibid., p. 172.

ROBERT ALMEDER

185

her life with the Vennums. Occasionally later on, when she visited the Roffs, the Mary Roff personality would emerge for a short while, and again she would lose her identity as Lurancy. Responding to the charge that this is simply a manifestation of alternating per­ sonality, or multiple personality-a personality disorder readily characterized in psy­ chiatry-Ducasse notes that the personality that displaced Lurancy's was (by every test that could be applied) not a dissociated part of her own. Rather, it was the per­ sonality, including all the memories, of a particular 18-year old girl who had died when Lurancy was 14 months old.27 Moreover, Ducasse claims that in no way could Lurancy have obtained by nor­ mal means the extensive and detailed knowledge that Mary possessed and that Lurancy manifested. The Vennums were away from Watseka (the town in Illinois where both the Roffs and the Vennums lived) for the first seven years of Lurancy's life. When they returned to Watseka, their acquaintance with the Roffs consisted of only one brief call lasting a few minutes made by Mrs. Roff on Mrs. Vennum, and of a formal speaking acquaintance on the part of the two men, until the time when Mr. Roff brought Dr. Stevens (the principal investigator) to the Vennums because of Lurancy's insane behavior.28 Can we explain what transpired in this case without endorsing the explanation that the disembodied postmortem personality of Mary Roff "took possession" of Lurancy Vennum's body? If not, then we have good evidence that human personal­ ity in some important way and to some important degree survives biological death. Naturally, we have to assume that the case is not a hoax or a fraud. Perhaps we could justifiably discount it if there never was another case similar to it, or if we had no other documented cases like it. But we have many cases similar to it, some even better examined and more recent.29

One of those "better examined and more recent" cases involves thE experi­ ences of Sumitra Singh which took place in India in the 1980s. Almeder offers us a summary of the report prepared by a team of on site investigators. In a 1989 article in the Journal of Scientific Exploration, Ian Stevenson, Satwant Pasricha, and Nicholas McClean-Rice describe and discuss what they regard as a rare case of possession with evidence of paranormal knowledge.30 The case involves two com­ pletely unrelated and unacquainted persons whose families lived in widely separated towns and villages, and the relevant testimony justifies believing that they had no contact with each other before the case developed. The following are the main details of the case offered by Stevenson and his associates. The subject, Sumitra Singh, was a young married woman of about 17 years old when the case developed in 1985. She was living with her husband and their one 27 Ibid., p. 173. 2s Ibid. 29 For other cases similar to the Watseka Wonder, see E. Bourguignon, Possession (San Francisco: Chandler and Sharp, 1976); I. M. Lewis, Ecstatic Religion: An Anthropological Study of Spirit Possession and Shamanism (Harmondsworth, Middlesex, England: Penguin Books, 1971); and E. M. Pattison, J. Kahan, and G. S. Hurd, "Trance and Possession States," in Handbook of States of Consciousness, eds. B. B. Wolman and M. Ullman (New York: Van Nostrand Reinhold, 1986). 30 Ian Stevenson, Satwant Pasricha, and Nicholas McClean-Rice, "A Case of the Possession Type in India with Evidence of Paranormal Knowledge," Journal of Scientific Explanation 3, no. 1 (1989), pp. 89-101.

DEATH IS NOT THE END

child in the husband's family home in the village of Sharifpura, in the Farrukhabad district of the State of Uttar Pradesh, India. Early in 1985 Sumitra began to develop episodes of loss of consciousness along with eye-roll movements and clenching of teeth. Sometimes in these trances she would speak, and in July of that year she pre. dieted she would die three days later. Indeed, three days later-July 19-she seemed to die. All who were around her considered her dead; she had no pulse, was apneic, and her face was totally drained of blood like that of a dead person. They were griev. ing and preparing for her funeral when suddenly she revived in a confused state. Thereafter the woman began to behave very much like a different person. She no longer recognized the people around her, saying that her name was Shiva and that she had been murdered by her in-laws at a place called Dibiyapur. She rejected Sumi tr a's husband and child and asked to be taken to Shiva's two children. She stated many details that were subsequently found to correspond with the life of another young married woman, Shiva Diwedi, who had died violently-whether from murder or suicide is not known-at Dibiyapur on the night of May 18-19, 1985, two months before Sumitra' s apparent death and revival. Shiva's parental family were convinced that her in-laws had murdered her and then attempted to simulate suicide by laying her body on the railway tracks nearby. Shiva's father, Ram Siya Tripathi, had filed a complaint and so initiated a judicial inquiry. Sumitra's in-laws said they knew nothing of a Shiva who had died at a place called Dibiyapur. Initially, they thought that Sumitra had gone mad and only later that she had become possessed by a discarnate spirit. But, importantly enough, they made no attempt whatsoever to verify what she was saying. It was about a month before Ram Siya Tripathi learned about Sumitra1 s statements. This occurred acciden­ tally when he heard a rumor, while he was visiting Dibiyapur, that his deceased daughter had taken possession of a girl in a distant village. Nearly two more months elapsed before he was able to verify this information by having someone from a neighboring village visit Sumitra and her family. The information gathered in this way prompted Ram Siya, accompanied by a relative, to visit Sumitra. Sumitra recog­ nized him and said that she was his daughter. With Ram Siya, she visited Shiva's vil­ lage during the following days and recognized at least 13 members of Shiva1 s family and friends. Stevenson and his associates note that, in addition to Sumitra's statements about the life of Shiva and her recognitions of persons Shiva had known, she showed a marked change in behavior. Sumitra's family belonged to the Thakur caste and they were villagers with very little education; Sumitra herself had no formal education, although she could read and write a little. The Tripathis, on the other hand, were Brahmins and middle-class urbanites. Ram Siya was a lecturer in a college, and Shiva had been educated up to the level of earning a B.A. degree. After her revival, Sumitra's behavior changed from that of a simple village girl to that of a reasonably well educated woman of higher caste and more urbane manners, who could now read and write Hindi fluently.31 Shortly after the first exchanges of visits between the families concerned, the case caught the attention of Ian Stevenson and S. Pasricha who, with others, began to investigate the case promptly in mid-October 1985. The method of investigation con­ sisted basically of interviews with informants, particularly first-hand witnesses of the 11

31 Ibid., p. 83.

ALMEDER

in '--"'''F-.,UUHF-, team spent almost as much time revival."32 But members of Shiva's family. The interviews were conducted over a nATn_,,oc:, ous October Stevenson and Pasricha, who with everybody who in any way be relevant or material to the case. They interviewed 24 members of Shiva's and Sumitra's families, with the most important witnesses among them being interviewed two or more times. Extensive verbatim notes were taken; and during a few special inter­ views, tape recordings were made either solely or in addition to taking notes. Moreover, the investigators interviewed another 29 persons who were able to furnish background information, especially about communications between the communities involved in the case. In examining the case, the Stevenson team paid particular attention to the fol­ lowing aspects: the preceding illness, apparent death, and revival of Sumitra; the pos­ sibilities for normal communication of information about Shiva's life and death to Sumitra and her family; and the circumstances under which Sumitra after her revival identified Shiva's family in person and in photographs. Informants for Sumitra's side of the case claimed no previous acquaintance with Shiva's family, and members of Shiva's family claimed that they were completely ignorant of Sumitra's family before the case developed. As Stevenson also notes, apart from the long (for India) geo­ graphical distances between the families, they were also separated by significant dif­ ferences of caste, education, and economic condition.33 Naturally, from an evidential viewpoint, the informant's denial of prior acquain­ tance between the two families is important. According to the investigators, strong support for the informants' denial of prior acquaintance derives from the slow and indirect manner in which Shiva's family learned about the personality change in Sumitra. The investigators describe this process in the following way: �u,. , �,•• �,"�-��'"'

Sumitra's father and her in-laws made no attempt to verify her statements about Shiva.Word about them first reached the neighboring village of Murra, ·which is 2 km from Sharifpura.From there it traveled Dibiyapur apparently co1 by women of Murra who had married and were living there.Ram Siya Tripathi, on a visit to Dibiyapur, heard a rumor that his dead daughter had taken posses­ sion of a girl in a distant village called Sharifpura.However, he had never been to Sharifpura and did not even know where it was located.After another two weeks he learned about a man called Ram Prakash a native of Murra who was living in Etawah, but whom he had not previously known.He asked Ram Prakash Dube to inquire about the truth of the account he had heard in Dibiyapur.The monsoon rains led to further delays.When Ram Prakash Dube next visited Murra, he looked into the story and confirmed its main outlines to Ram Siya Tripathi, who, as we have mentioned, then went to Sharifpura and had his first meeting with Sumitra on Oct. 20, 1985.This was exactly three months after Sumitra's apparent death and revival.We believe that if the fami­ lies concerned had been previously acquainted or had had any lines of commu­ nication through mutual acquaintances, they would have exchanged informa­ tion about Sumitra's change of personality much sooner than they did.... 32 Ibid., p. 85. 33 Ibid.

DEATH IS NOT THE END 1

Members of Sumitra s family said that they had heard nothing about Shiva s death before Sumitra1 s death1 revival and personality change. However1 in view of the circulation of some newspapers in their area and of some trading between Sharifpura and Etawah1 it is best to assume that they might have 1 learned of Shiva s death and perhaps also learned about some of the allegations of suicide and homicide that figured in the newspaper reports. (There was no radio station in the area. Some television had been introduced at Etawah only [Sharifpura had no electricityL but it only relayed programs from Delhi and broadcast no local news.) The newspaper reports included some of the names of Shiva1 s parental family and in-laws. The important question remaining is1 there­ fore 1 whether Sumitra, after the change in her personality, demonstrated knowl­ edge and behavior corresponding to Shiva's life that went beyond the informa­ tion available in the newspapers reporting the death of Shiva and the related judicial inquiry.34 1

The published report of this case offers a detailed statement of the life, last ill­ ness, apparent death, and revival of Sumitra. It emphasizes that, prior to her apparent 1 death, she had experienced a number of 'possession-type' episodes for which her family sought the help of a healer. The investigators do not claim that Sumitra had in fact died before her revival. Also, the report examines the pertinent details of the life and death of Shiva. Here the investigators concur with the local authorities in saying that Shiva1 s death was not accidental; she either was murdered by her in-laws who made it look as though Shiva committed suicide 1 or else did commit suicide by throw­ ing herself before a railway train. Most importantly, the report shows a large number of detailed and verified claims made by Sumitra about the life and death of Shiva, and concludes that there is no way of explaining Sumitra1 s knowledge by appeal to the normal sources of knowl­ edge. Also, Sumitra's behavioral traits distinctly replicated the behavioral characteris­ tics of Shiva even though the two had definitely never met. Thus, impersonation can­ not be the explanation for the manifestation of those traits. Without seeking to repeat all the facts of the case, let us look a bit more closely at these two factors as described in detail in the case study. 1 Stevenson and his associates divide Sumitra s statements into three groups. The first group consists of names of persons and places that the newspaper accounts of Shiva1 s death and her father 1 s lawsuit had published. The investigators think it extremely unlikely that anyone communicated even the fact of Shiva1 s death-much 1 less the details-to Sumitra s family. Even so, as noted above, the investigators acknowledge that some newspapers were circulated in the general area of Sharifpura, and so it is possible that Sumitra's family might have learned about Shiva's death through normal channels of information. Therefore, none of the facts that Sumitra related were regarded as paranormally derived if they could be found in the various 1 newspaper accounts of Shiva s death and the circumstances attending it. The second 1 group of Sumitra s statements consists of unverified claims. Sumitra' s description of Shiva1 s death, for example, and the role of her in-laws in the death, remains unveri­ fied. The third group of statements includes nicknames and other private affairs not published in the newspapers. This group is the most important because it consists of statements that are verified and that there is no normal way for Sumitra to have acquired. On this point the report states1 1

34 Ibid. 1 pp. 85-86 and 87.

ROBERT ALMEDER

189

We learned of 19 items that we felt justified in placing in this, the important group. These showed that Sumitra had l.,,.r>1nn- NDEs. While no two NDEs are identical in content, researchers have been able to several themes that recur in 0

0 10 .,,·

0

0

39 Ibid., p. 97.

ROBERT ALMEDER

191

the accounts of people who have had NDEs. NDEers frequently report having experienced such things as travel through a tunnel toward a bright light, feelings of serenity and painlessness, encounter with other beings, and a life review. In addition, just over 25 percent of NDEers claim to have had out-of-body experi­ ences. Moody reviews several of these reports for us. There are a couple of things that present enormous difficulty to these researchers: How is it that the patients can give such elaborate and detailed accounts of resuscita­ tion, explaining in their entirety what the doctors were doing to bring them back to life? How can so many people explain what was going on in other rooms of a hospital while their bodies were in the operating room being resuscitated? To me, these are the most difficult points for the NDE researchers to answer. In fact, so far they have been impossible to explain except with one answer: they really occurred. Before presenting the wide variety of attempted explanations that exist about NDEs, let's look at some examples of these unexplainable events. A forty-nine-year-old man had a heart attack so severe that after thirty-five min­ utes of vigorous resuscitation efforts, the doctor gave up and began filling out the death certificate. Then someone noticed a flicker of life, so the doctor continued his work with the paddles and breathing equipment and was able to restart the man's heart. The next day, when he was more coherent, the patient was able to describe in great detail what went on in the emergency room. This surprised the doctor. But what astonished him even more was the patient's vivid description of the emergency room nurse who hurried into the room to assist the doctor. He described her perfectly right down to her wedge hairdo and her last name, Hawkes. He said that she rolled this cart down the hall with a machine that had what looked like two Ping-Pong paddles on it (an electroshocker that is basic resuscilation equipment). When the doctor asked him how he knew the nurse's name and what she had been doing during his heart attack, he said that he had left his body and- while walking down the hall to see his wife-passed right through nurse Hawkes. Ht: read the name tag as he went through her, and remembered it so he could thank her later. I talked to the doctor at great length about this case. He was quite rattled by it. Being there, he said, was the only way the man could have recounted this with such complete accuracy. On Long Island, a seventy-year-old woman who had been blind since the age of eighteen was able to describe in vivid detail what was happening around her as doc­ tors resuscitated her after a heart attack Not only could she describe what the instruments looked like, but she could even describe their colors. The most amazing thing about this to me was that most of these instruments weren't even thought of over fifty years ago when she could last see. On top of all this, she was even able to tell the doctor that he was wearing a blue suit when he began the resuscitation. Another amazing case that says NDEs are more than just tricks of the mind was relayed to me by a doctor in South Dakota. Driving into the hospital one morning, he had rear-ended a car. It had been very upsetting to him. He was very worried that the people he had hit would claim neck injury and sue him for a large sum of money.

92

DEATH IS NOT THE END

This accident left him distraught and was very much on his mind later that morning when he rushed to the emergency room to resuscitate a person who was having a cardiac arrest. The next day, the man he had rescued told him a remarkable story: "While you were working on me, I left my body and watched you work." The doctor began to ask questions about what the man had seen an d was amazed at the accuracy of his description. In precise detail, he told the doctor ho the instruments looked and even in what order they were used. He described the col ors of the equipment, shapes, and even settings of dials on the machines. But what finally convinced this young cardiologist that the man's experienc was genuine was when he said, "Doctor, I could tell that you were worried about th accident. But there isn't any reason to be worried about things like that. You give your time to other people. Nobody is going to hurt you." Not only had this patient picked up on the physical details of his surroundings, he had also read the doctor's mind. After a lecture to doctors at the U.S. Army base in Fort Dix, New Jersey, a man approached me and told about his remarkable NDE. I later confirmed it with his attending physicians. I was terribly ill and near death with heart problems at the same time that my sister was near death in another part of the same hospital with a diabetic coma. I left. my body and went into the corner of the room, where I watched them work on me down below. Suddenly, I found myself in conversation with my sister, who was up there with me. I was very attached to her, and we were having a great conversation about what was going on down there when she began to move away from me. I tried to go with her but she kept telling me to stay where I was. "It's not your time," she said. "You can't go with me because it's not your time." Then she just began to recede off into the distance through a tunnel while I was left there alone. When I awoke, I told the doctors that my sister had died. He denied it, but at my insistence, he had a nurse check on it. She had in fact died, just as I knew she did. These are only a few of the cases that prove to me that NDEs are more than just hallucinations or "bad dreams." There is no logical explanation for the experiences of these people. Although tunnel experiences and beings of light can easily be chalked off as mere "mind play," out-of-body experiences baffle even the most skeptical in the medical profession.

Having examined the findings of Moody and other researchers, Almeder concludes that out-of-body experiences (OBEs) seem to justify belief in (1) some kind of mind-body dualism and (2) some sort of postmortem survival. Yet, Almeder admits that until we have ideal cases of OBEs that are "well documented and repeated frequently under controlled conditions, we cannot claim to have conclusive evidence warranting the dualist's interpretation of the nonhallucina­ tory OBE." But, Almeder adds, "we can certainly claim that the dualist's interpre­ tation is more rationally warranted than any alternative interpretation presently available" (Death and Personal Survival, p. 198). The fifth type of experience embraces the claims of people who believe that dead persons have been able to communicate with living persons through inter-

ROBERT ALMEDER

193

mediaries called mediums. A medium is a person who usually enters a trance vol­ untarily, presumably receives information from dead persons, and then commu­ nicates that information to living persons who are sitting in the presence of the entranced medium. On some occasions, after a medium has entered a trance his or her personality is apparently supplanted by the personality of a deceased per­ son called the control." This control allegedly J/uses" the body of the medium to communicate to those present at the trance information about deceased persons. When the medium is taken over" in this fashion by a control, the medium speaks and acts in ways that are uncharacteristic of the medium's own personal­ ity but are characteristic of the deceased person who is functioning as the control. Consider the following case involving Laura Edmonds as a medium and the reactions of her father, Judge John Worth Edmonds of the Supreme Court of New York, as reported by Almeder. 11

11

In 1905 the Annales des Sciences Psychiques reported a case in which a medium under trance spoke a language of which, in her normal state, she was entirely ignorant.40 The medium was a Ms. Laura Edmonds, the daughter of the distinguished Judge John Worth Edmonds, president the New York State Senate and later judge of the Supreme Court of New York. Judge Edmonds was widely regarded as a person of unquestionable integrity and considerable intelligence. At one time the Judge had undertaken the study of psychical research to demon­ strate the worthlessness of the activity and the foolishness of those who took such phenomena seriously. We can image the depth of his concern when his daughter Laura, a fervent Catholic capable of speaking her mother tongue and French only, began to shine as a developing medium. Anyway, as the case is reported, one evening a Mr. Evangelides, a Greek visited the Edmondses. At a sitting (a seance) held later that evening, Laura-in trance-was controlled by a friend of Evangelides named Botzaris, who had died earlier in Greece. According to Judge Edmonds, this control (Botzaris) spoke in modern G t'eek to Evangelides and informed him that his son, whom Evangelides still supposed was well and alive in Greece, had recently died. Evangelides wept at this news and could scarcely believe it. But the fact of his son's death was subsequently confirmed. Judge Edmonds, who submitted an affidavit testifying to the above, made the following observations: To deny the fact is impossible, it was too well known; I could as well deny the light of the sun; nor could I think it an illusion, for it is in no way different from any other reality. It took place before ten educated and intelligent persons. We had never seen Mr. Evangelides before; he was introduced by a friend that same evening. How could Laura tell him of his son? How could she understand and speak Greek which she had never previously heard?41

Now ponder Almeder's description of the mediumship of Mrs. Willett who, though unsophisticated philosophically, became the intermediary for a highly sophisticated philosophical discussion between two deceased thinkers and a liv­ ing philosopher. 40 Annales des Sciences Psychiqes 15, no. 317 (1905). 41 Ibid.

4

DEATH IS NOT THE END

Unlike Mrs. Piper and other mediums, when the English medium Mrs. Willett went into deep trance she did not lose control of her body as if she were asleep or in a swoon. She would sit up and talk in a natural way and in the first-person singular. There was no appearance of her body's being used by the deceased personality that spoke through her. So, while clearly a trance medium, she was not the usual kind of possession medium. Back in 1885 Mrs. Willett had married a landed proprietor from Neath. Her hus. band's sister was the wife of F. W. H. Myers, one of the founders of the Society for Psychical Research and the author of Human Personality and Its Survival of Bodily Death.42 Mrs. Willett, a person of notable achievement, was well educated and took a prominent part in public affairs, particularly in South Wales. For example, she served as chairman of the arts and crafts section of the national Eisteddfod in 1918, and later in 1920 was made a justice of the peace for Glamorganshire, being the first woman to occupy that office there. In 1922 she was appointed by the British government as a delegate to the assembly of the League of Nations. In terms of the history of her mediumship, Mrs. Willett became a member of the Society for Psychical Research soon after F. W. H. Myers (whom, by the way, she had never met) died in 1901, and then-for lack of interest-resigned in 1905. However, in 1908 she suffered a death in the family and decided to take up automatic writing-an activity she had dabbled in as a young girl. In 1909 Mrs. Willett's mediumship bloomed, and continued for a number of years.43 She died in 1956. What is important about Mrs. Willett's mediumship is that the alleged post­ mortem persons of F. W. H. Myers and Edmund Gurney-both of them founders of the Society for Psychical Research-seemed to communicate through Mrs. Willett and requested that one of the sitters be their friend G. W. Balfour, a keen psychic researcher and president of the Society for Psychical Research from 1906 to 1907. When alive, Myers and Gurney were avid philosophers, widely read in philosophy, psychology, and theology. Balfour had engaged in numerous philosophical discus­ sions with both Myers and Gurney before they died. With Balfour and others present on June 4, 1911, Mrs. Willett went into a deep trance. There ensued the first of a series of sittings characterizable as lively philosoph­ ical discussions between Balfour, the sitter, and both Myers and Gurney, the communicators.44 Commenting on the content of these discussions, C. D. Broad noted that all the ostensible communications were "plainly the product of a highly intelligent and cultivated mind or minds, with a keen interest in psychology, psychical research and philosophy, and with a capacity for drawing subtle and significant distinc-

1903).

42 F. W. H. Myers, Human Personality and Its Survival of Bodily Death (London: Longmans Green,

43 The early phase of Mrs. Willett' s mediumship was the subject of a long and important paper authored by G. W. Balfour in the Proceedings of the Society for Psychical Research 43 (1935), pp. 43-318. 44 As C. D. Broad has noted about the Willett sittings with Balfour, the sittings covered three topics: (1) the conditions under which the communicators were working in communicating through Mrs. Willett; (2) the processes involved in such communication in general, and the special procedures involved in conducting a cross-correspondence (several mediums) experiment; (3) their views on cer­ tain philosophical questions about the nature of human personality, its survival of bodily death, and the relation of the human individual to the Absolute. C. D. Broad, Lectures on Psychical Research (London: Routledge and Kegan Paul, 1962), p. 296.

ROBERT ALMEDER

195

tions."45 Moreover, whatever the source of the utterances, the communicators showed a thorough acquaintance with the views and terminology of Myers's book Human Personality and Its Survival of Bodily Death. It is worth emphasizing that the seances produced a high level of sophisticated philosophizing between the sitter and communicators.46 Typically, for example, Balfour would examine leisurely the record of a sitting, and then at the next sitting make criticisms or suggestions and ask for explanations. The Gurney communicator would then speak to the issues raised and try to clear up the obscurities. Sometimes the Gurney communicator would accept, and sometimes vigorously reject, Balfour's suggestions and interpretations. Some of the sittings-those held on October 8, 1911, January 21, 1912, and March 5, 1912-were purely philosophical and sound like the transcript of an Ivy League graduate seminar on classical philosophy.47 Before determining the strength of these communications as evidence for per­ sonal survivat we must keep in mind two crucial considerations. First, Mrs. Willett knew little philosophy and had even less patience for all that kind of talk. When not in trance state, and when subsequently shown a transcript of the sittings, Mrs. Willett could not understand the content. For example, one typical sentence-uttered by the communicator on May 24, 1911-is this: "The Absolute labors to attain self-conscious­ ness through the myriad of self-created sentient beings."48 When shown this script some time later, Mrs. Willett did not know either the origin or the point of the script. Second, even though Balfour and others were convinced that the Myers and Gurney communicators acted and spoke in ways uniquely characteristic of Myers and Gurney when they were alive, Mrs. Willett had met neither one of them. As we shall see, these two considerations, when combined with the content of the communications, make it impossible to explain the sittings as an instance of the medium's subcon­ sciously impersonating people she had previously met and communicating informa­ tion obtained through ESP. At any rate, Balfour came to believe that he was indeed in communication with the departed spirits of both Gurney and Myers, and that no other hypothesis could explain the data so well.

Given collective evidence provided by these five types of experiences, A!meder claims that belief in postdeath survival is warranted. He concludes with a reply to three basic skeptical objections to this belief. First he summarizes the force of the evidence. If we had only the best available evidence from recent reincarnation studies, or only the best evidence on apparitions of the dead and cases of possession, or only the best evidence bearing on OBEs, or only the best evidence from mediumship, then we might well be inclined to ignore the belief in personal survival of death. After all, extraordinary claims require extraordinary evidence; and even though the evidence seems compelling in each of the above categories of research, we might not find the evidence in each category sufficiently compelling to warrant full-blooded conviction in personal survival.

45 46 47 48

Ibid., p. 297. Ibid. Much of the transcripts can be found in ibid., pp. 290ff. Ibid., p. 298.

DEATH IS NOT THE END

But the force of the case for personal survival rests on the whole body of evj. dence viewed collectively as a set of arguments. Each argument from each category of research discussed and examined in these past pages is like a thread that, of itself may well be incapable of carrying the full weight of the belief in some form of per� sonal survival. Bound together, however, they converge and make a strong cord that lifts the belief from the realm of superstition and thoughtless commitment in t absence of sound evidence. We have here support for a confirmed belief based pure on factual evidence. The multiplicity of the arguments provides the extraordinary evi� dence required for conviction. We have reached the point where a critical examina. tion of all the evidence available makes such a commitment a good deal easier than has ever been before. Certainly, we are considerably better off than was Plato in giv� ing his reasons for believing in personal survival and reincarnation.

Next he replies to the skeptics. There are three fairly common skeptical objections to the belief in some form of per. sonal survival after death-objections we have not yet considered in detail. Now that we have considered the separate categories of evidence and objections, we are in a position to address these three most fundamental responses of the skeptic. T first objection asserts that personal survival after death is impossible either becau we cannot even imagine what a disembodied spirit would be like, or because t very idea of such survival is conceptually incoherent. The second objection is that1 even if some form of personal survival were possible, we certainly do not yet have: any experimental evidence (and hence no scientific knowledge) of anyone's surviv­ ing death. The third objection is related to the second and consists in asserting tha the ever-present possibility of fraud or hoax in the evidence offered here for per­ sonal survival can only be excluded by insisting on the kind of robust confirmation required in experimental science-and we have nothing like that at present. A three of these objections are fairly common; but, as we shall now see, all rest equall on crucial misconceptions. THE LOGICAL IMPOSSIBILITY OF PERSONAL SURVIVAL

Skeptics who assert the impossibility of personal survival usually do so on the grounds that the very idea of a human beings personality existing independently of his or her body is just inconceivable or incoherent. In their view, it makes no sense even to talk about personal survival after death either because we cannot imagine what a human personality is if it is not at least partially identifiable with a human body, or else because the very idea of surviving one's death is conceptually incoherent. Let us consider the first disjunct here: that our very concept of a person is firmly tied to our understanding of bodily existence and activities that we canno even imagine what a person is like if it does not possess such characteristics. Just think of it. A disembodied person would need to perceive events clairvoyantly in some way, without any sense organs such as eyes and ears. A disembodied person would need to act upon other things and other persons in some way without using limbs and without the usual feelings of stress and strain that come from the slan, the joints, and the muscles. And a disembodied person would need to communicate with others telepathically without using vocal organs and emitting audible sounds. All this, as C. D. Broad has noted, is conceivable as long as we keep it in the abstract; but

ROBERT ALMEDER

197

when we try to think 'what it would be like" in concrete detail, we do not seem to have any clear or definite ideas at all.49 In urging this objection, however, the skeptic makes a crucial mistake. The mis­ take consists in thinking that, just because we cannot imagine what a disembodied spirit must be like, there cannot be any. Indeed, an adequate reply to the skeptic is that our inability to imagine fully any particular state of affairs should not be taken as evidence for its nonexistence. We may not be able to imagine an infinite series of numbers, or what it would be like to walk on the moon; still, there are infinite series of numbers, and some people have walked on the moon. In short, the skeptic makes the mistake of inferring the nonexistence of spirits simply because we cannot imagine them as some sort of physical objects. The skeptic might just as well object to belief in the existence of God because we cannot imagine what God looks like. If one believes in the existence of disembodied persons, then one believes in beings who are by defi­ nition not understandable in purely physical terms. Obviously, our belief or disbelief in such beings should be a function of whether we have sufficient evidence for think­ ing that some such beings must exist, and not whether we can imagine them as we would a physical object. What about the second part of the first objections: that the very idea of a per­ son's surviving biological death is incoherent? This argument was offered at one time by Anthony Flew, so among others, and seems to have been inspired by the belief that our whole concept of a person is so rooted in the physical that it makes no sense to suggest anybody could survive biological death. There would be nothing to survive. Flew points to numerous instances of ordinary discourse wherein the logic of the usage seems to require that human personality does not survive biological death. We often say, for example, after a shipwreck or a tragedy of some sort, "There were no survivors" or "There was only one survivor." And what does this mean except that, by definition, one does not survive biological death. The ordinary concept nf a death" just means no survival after biological death. Hence it is simply incoherent to suggest that anybody could possibly survive death. And how does one answer this sort of argument? The short answer is to say that it is dogmatic. For skepticism of this ilk, it is simply a conceptual truth that human personality-whatever this may be-does not survive physical death. Apart from the question of whether there are such conceptual truths and, if there are, whether they can be derived from the logic of ordinary usage, this particular argument carries with it the unfortunate implication that no matter what happens in the future, no matter what facts ultimately come to light, it is simply not possible that we shall ever get empirical evidence for personal survival. How is such an argument any different from a dogmatic refusal to regard anything as evidence for the thesis? Besides, even on its own terms, this argument is not very persuasive. After all, why can we not mean-when we say, "Nobody survived the accident" -nothing more than that 1

49 C. D. Broad, Lectures on Psychical Research (New York: Humanities Press, 1962), p. 409. For a similar argument, see Anthony Flew's "Can a Man Witness His Own Funeral?" Hibbert Journal 54 (1956); and William James, "Human Immortality: Two Supposed Objections to the Doctrine," in Gardner Murphy and Robert Ballou, eds., William James on Psychical Research (New York: Viking Press, 1960), pp. 279££. so Flew, "Can a Man Witness?" More recently these same arguments occur in Flew's Gifford Lectures published as The Logic of Mortality (Oxford, England: Blackwell, 1987).

DEATH IS NOT THE END

everybody suffered biological death? And if so, this only raises the questio n of whether people ever suffer biological death and survive it in some way. It does not settle it. Which raises the further question as to what human personality consists in, and what evidence there may be for the view that human personality is not simply reducible to the physical in such a way as to make the suggestion of surviving biologi­ cal death incoherent. ... THE SCIENTIFIC IMPROBABILITY OF PERSONAL SURVIVAL

As we saw above, the second common skeptical objection to belief in personal sur­ vival consists in arguing that even if personal survival is logically and factually possi­ ble, still we have no scientific knowledge of anybody's ever surviving biological death, because we have no experimental evidence that will hold up under serious sci­ entific scrutiny. This sort of objection feeds on the belief that all the evidence offered for personal survival (whether it be from reincarnation studies, apparitions of the dead, ostensible possessions, OBEs, or mediumship) is not publicly repeatable in experimental contexts under controlled conditions. We cannot, so the objection goes, generate at will compelling case studies. We cannot, for example, scientifically control disembodied spirits so as to make them appear under empirically desirable condi­ tions. Because the evidence for personal survival lacks this characteristic, the evidence is not, the skeptic asserts, repeatable under the experimental method. For this often­ cited reason, some scientists tend to consider the case studies offered in the preceding chapters as anecdotal" rather than as solid evidence. And some skeptics are down­ right insistent that, unless a belief is established by the experimental methods of the natural sciences, the belief cannot be an item of human knowledge. In replying to this objection, we may reflect that although much of the evidence for personal survival is not repeatable and accessible in the usual way that, for exam­ ple, the evidence for the law of gravity is public and repeatable, it is a mistake to think that all knowledge requires experimental evidence that is public and repeatable in the way just suggested. Such repeatability is necessary only when, in the interest of pre­ diction and control, we require causal explanations, or statements of the causes of the nomic phenomena in question. But such causal explanations are not necessary to establish that something or other occurs, rather than why it occurs. We might, for example, establish that dinosaurs existed sometime in the past without having to estab­ lish the reasons why dinosaurs happened to appear. While there is a kind of repeatabil­ ity that is necessary for reliability in establishing mere existence or occurrence, it is quite a different kind of repeatability from the experimental repeatability necessary for causal explanations of nomic phenomena. The latter, but not the former, typically require our being able to show at will the conformity of controlled experiment to causal hypothesis, thereby producing at will the data that confirm the hypothesis. However, there is a good deal of legitimate scientific knowledge that does not require the experimentally repeatable kind of evidence. Once again, for example, the evidence for the past existence of dinosaurs is not experimentally repeatable or reproducible at will. The facts that confirm the hypothesis cannot be produced at will and so repeated in the way suggested. What makes the dinosaur hypothesis" scientifically acceptable is its simplicity, or the fit between the existing data and the hypothesis; also, we know what sensory experiences would refute the hypothesis. The only plausible explanation for the data requires believing in the past existence of dinosaurs. It is not a necessary condition for empirical knowledge, then, that the evidence be experimentally repeatable at will in the way dictated by laboratory science to pro­ vide causal explanations for observed nomic regularities. This type of evidence is neeII

II

ALMEDER

of a certain sort, but not necessary for C'tr,r;1'�'',·.::.u."u essary for causal ov,,.i-:,-,-,c,1-, able explanations to the effect that s�:::-::'.c��-:!�;:.>; or other has occurred. basic has already been well and discussed Stephen Braude in the first chapter of There is an ,,,..,.,.,,..,,.,,,....,,r,,,,·� sense in which the evidence his book The Limits of for belief in the past existence of dinosaurs, say, is repeatable and needs to be repeated, but it is not the same sense in which an experiment is said to be re1JecHed and repeatable lab science. So much seems fairly obvious. Also, I know what my father said to me just before he died.The evidence for my knowledge claim-his spoken words-is not experimentally repeatable or publicly accessible. And even if there had been 5,000 people in the room with me when my father spoke his dying words, the evidence would still not be experimentally repeat­ able in the sense specified by the skeptic. But surely, I (and the 5,000 who may have been with me in the room) know what my father said on that day. His diction was impeccable and his voice loud and clear. In other words, even if all the evidence for personal survival were not experimentally repeatable in the way suggested, it would by no means follow that the belief is not an item of human public knowledge. Do unique historical events need to be repeated in that way in order for us to be justified in believing that they occurred? Or, ceteris paribus, do we accept eyewitness testi­ mony of a sufficiently large number of honorable and generally reliable people? It is distinctly possible that the methods of the natural sciences, including the requirement of experimental repeatability, make sense only when we seek causal explanations of subject matter understood to be physical and nomic in its behavior. definition, however, minds or human personalities will not be physical in any usual sense. Thus, not only is the requirement of experimental repeatability not nec­ essary for human or scientific knowledge; it also sometimes seems to argue against the very existence of minds by requiring that they be physical and nomic in the usual sense. Why would anyone assume that the same scientific method, especially it comes to experimental repeatability, is appropriate for understanding a subject mat­ ter so different in fundamental ways? Coherence of the subject matter this is very much like asking the theist for scientifically demonstrable knowledge of Hw exis­ tence of God after she or he has noted that God is a physical object conformmg to nomic regularities. The third common skeptical objection to belief in personal survival seems to be the most persistent, and this is the assertion that the evidence is persuasive only if the ever-present possibility of fraud can be clearly excluded. This possibility can be excluded, it is argued, only when the thesis is robustly verified in the way specified for experimental theses in the natural sciences. Because we do not yet have that sort of verification for personal survival, the burden of proof is still on the proponent to show that the evidence offered is free from hoax and fraud. This sort of objection is based on the acceptable principle that extraordinary claims require extraordinary evidence, and extraordinary evidence needs to be fraud­ proof-especially in an area of inquiry where extensive fraud and trickery has been richly documented. Given this objection, however, even the best cases for survival cannot be accepted as good evidence, because in each case we cannot exclude the real possibility of fraud in the way that the experimental method excludes such fraud.... 0

51 Stephen Braude, The Limits of Influence: Psychokmesis and the Philosophy of Science (New York: Routledge and Kegan Paul, 1986), pp. 57ff; and also, Stephen Braude, ESP and Psychokinesis: A Philosophical Examination fhitlaciehJhia: Temple University Press, 1979), pp. 41ff.

DUALISM REJECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED

Perhaps the strongest reply to this pointed objection is that we really do not n eed the experimental method to exclude the possibility of fraud. The same effect can be achieved simply by pointing to the best cases and the fact that the number of cases is not fixed or historically isolated-that such cases are always occurring in different places, and what makes the best cases persuasive (and unlikely to be instances of fraud} is that many logically identical cases occur regularly although not predictably.... Thus the fact that there are many past and current ideal cases of the reincarna­ tion type, in many different lands, offered by many different researchers from differ­ ing parts of the world and with strong reasons to avoid fraud or hoax, seems to serve the same purpose as repeatability in experimental science: it excludes any real likeli­ hood of fraud or hoax. Add to this the fact that such cases continue to appear fre­ quently and widely (as we would expect if the hypothesis were true), and we have reason for thinking that we are dealing with a robustly confirmed hypothesis .... So, our reply to the third skeptical objection is, first, that we do not need the experimental method to exclude the real possibility of fraud in the best cases; we only need the continual widespread appearance of cases that have the same logical charac­ teristics as the ideal cases. When enough such cases continue to occur and are exam­ ined by many different researchers who are incapable of finding any fraud, the proba­ bility of fraud becomes remote just because such cases are repeating themselves in widely differing contexts and in the hands of different researchers. Second, if this reply is not enough, then there is also-for all the reason mentioned above-a very strong case to be made for the claim that not only is belief in reincarnation and personal sur­ vival an experimentally viable hypothesis; it is a strongly confirmed one, as well.

How well do you think Almeder has made his case? What would be the skep­ tic's likely reply? Is there really no connection between our inability to imagine a state of affairs at all and the likelihood that the state of affairs does not exist? Does the fact that the critics Almeder cites do not have a convincing naturalistic expla­ nation for all the paranormal phenomena mean that such an explanation is unavailable? Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted from Robert Almeder, Death and Personal Survival: The Evidence for Life After Death (Lanham, Maryland: Littlefield Adams, 1992) t pp. 8-12, 26, 100-106, 129-130, 136-138, 143-150, 158, 205-206, 217-219, 255-258, 260-265, 267-269 and Raymond Moody, The Light Beyond (New York: Bantam Books, 1988t pp. 169-174.

PETER GEACH DUALISM REJECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED

FROM ALMEDER TO GEACH. Frequently the disputants on the question of post­ death survival seem to side with one of two possible positions. Either one is a Cartesian dualist who claims that the human is a combination of a material body and an immaterial mind or soul that can survive the death of the body, or one is an anti-dualist materialist who claims that the human is a unity whose "mind" is

PETER GEACH

201

so linked with the body that it cannot survive the death of the body. Either one lines up with Ducasse and Almeder or one lines up with Lamont. The debate, however, is more complex than just these two sides. Our present author, Peter Geach, illustrates that complexity. He sides with Lamont in rejecting dualism, but he also sides with Ducasse and Almeder in rejecting annihilation. Geach claims that the only rationally warranted position regarding personal postdeath survival involves bodily resurrection. The case made by Geach comes from his essay "Immortality" that appeared in 1969. BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Peter Thomas Geach was born in 1916 in Britain. He stud­ ied at Balliol College, Oxford and pursued advanced work in philosophy at Cambridge from 1945 to 1951. He taught at the University of Birmingham before becoming Professor of Logic at the University of Leeds. He has held distin­ guished visiting lectureships at Cambridge University, the University of Uppsala and the University of Notre Dame. His writing includes Mental Acts (1957), Reference and Generality (1962, third revised edition appearing in 1980), Three Philosophers (1961, with G. E. M. Anscombe), God and the Soul (1961) in which the essay used in this section originally appeared, Logic Matters (1972), Reason and Argument (1976); Providence and Evil (1977); The Virtues (1977); and Truth, Love and Immortality: An Introdu ction to McTaggart's Philosophy (1979). Geach's wife, Gertrude Elizabeth Margaret Anscombe, is also a well-known philosopher and the co-author of Three Philosophers. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. If one is going to claim that humans survive death, then it is important to ask what postdeath human existence would have to be like in order for one to say, for example, that Peter Geach survived death. Geach examines several different ways of construing postdeath human e"dstence. First, a number of people posit what is frequently called an "astral body,'· that is, an ordinarily invisible, subtly physical body that is united with, but can survive the death of, the obviously visible, grossly physical body. Second, some people prefer the Platonic notion of an immaterial thing-a mind or soul-that is con­ nected with the material body and is capable of surviving the death of the mater­ ial body. Third, there are those who, like Almeder, affirm reincarnation. Geach rejects all three of these views as fraught with unresolvable problems. Instead, he presents a fourth way of viewing postdeath human existence: the belief in a bod­ ily resurrection which is found in the Hebraic and Christian traditions. Geach argues that if there is postdeath survival, then it must resemble resurrection of the body. Let us see how convincingly he makes his case. Geach begins with a distinction between belief in postdeath survival and end­ less survival (that is, immortality). His concern is with survival and the character of postdeath human existence. Everybody knows that men die, and though most of us have read the advertisement "Millions now living will never die," it is commonly believed that every man born will some day die; yet historically many men have believed that there is a life after death,

DUALISM REJECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED

and indeed that this after-life will never end. That is: there has been a common belief both in survival of bodily death and in ,w,,m,,vn,, Now a philosopher might interest himself specially in immortality, as opposed to survival; conceding survival for the sake of argument, he might raise and examine conceptual difficulties about endless sur. vival. But the question of immortality cannot even arise unless men do survive bodily death; and, as we shall see, there are formidable difficulties even about survival. It i these difficulties I shall be discussing, not the special ones about endless survival.

He proceeds now to attack three different views of the character of post­ death human existence, beginning with belief in what Flew refers to in the next reading as the "astral body." Geach points out that belief in the existence of this subtle, invisible body encounters very serious evidential problems. There are various views as to the character of the after-life. One view is that man has a subtle, ordinarily invisible, body which survives the death of the ordinary gross body. This view has a long history, and seems to be quite popular in England at the moment. So far as I can see, the view is open to no philosophical objection, but like­ wise wholly devoid of philosophical interest; the mind-body problem must after all be just the same for an ethereal body as for a gross one. There could clearly be no philosophical reasons for belief in such subtle bodies, but only empirical ones; such reasons are in fact alleged, and we are urged to study the evidence. Philosophy can at this point say something: about what sort of evidence would be required. The existence of subtle bodies is a matter within the purview of physical science; evidence for it should satisfy such criteria of existence as physicists use, and should refer not only to what people say they have seen, heard, and felt, but also to effects produced by subtle bodies on physicists' apparatus. The believer in subtle bod­ ies" must, I think, accept the physicist's criteria of existence; there would surely be a conceptual muddle in speaking of bodies" but saying they might be incapable of affecting any physical apparatus. For what distinguishes real physical objects from hal­ lucinations, even collective hallucinations, is that physical objects act on one another, and do so in just the same way whether they are being observed or not; this is the point, I think, at which a phenomenalist account of physical objects breaks down. If, therefore, 11 subtle bodies" produce no physical effects, they are not bodies at all. How is it, then, that subtle bodies" have never forced themselves upon the attention of physicists, as X-rays did, by spontaneous interference with physical appa­ ratus? There are supposed to be a lot of subtle bodies" around, and physicists have a lot of delicate apparatus; yet physicists not engaged in psychical research are never bothered by the interference of subtle bodies." In these circumstances I think it wholly irrational to believe in subtle bodies." Moreover, when I who am no physicist am invited to study the evidence for subtle bodies," I find that very fact suspicious. The discoverers of X-rays and electrons did not appeal to the lay public, but to physi­ cists, to study the evidence; and so long as physicists (at least in general) refuse to take subtle bodies" seriously, a study of evidence for them by a layman like myself would be a waste of time. 11

11

II

II

II

11

11

11

Geach next turns his attention to Platonic dualism. His initial objection seems to come down to this: the terms we use to describe our private mental states (terms such as seeing, hearing, feeling, thinking, choosing, etc.) are so connected with our bodily encounter with the physical world for their meaning that ascrib-

PETER GEACH

203

ing these private mental states, such as sensations and feelings, to a disembodied spirit does not make any sense. When philosophers talk of life after death, what they mostly have in mind is a doctrine that may be called Platonic-it is found in its essentials in the Phaedo. It may be briefly stated thus: "Each man's make-up includes a wholly immaterial thing, his mind and soul. It is the mind that sees and hears and feels and thinks and chooses-in a word, is conscious. The mind is the person; the body is extrinsic to the person, like a suit of clothes. Though body and mind affect one another, the mind's existence is quite inde­ pendent of the body's; and there is thus no reason why the mind should not go on being conscious indefinitely after the death of the body, and even if it never again has with any body that sort of connection which it now has." This Platonic doctrine has a strong appeal, and there are plausible arguments in its favor. It appears a clearly intelligible supposition that I should go on after death having the same sorts of experience as I now have, even if I then have no body at all. For although these experiences are connected with processes in the body-sight, for exam­ ple, with processes in the eyes, optic nerves, and brain-nevertheless there is no neces­ sity of thought about the connection-it is easy to conceive of someone who has no eyes having the experience called sight. He would be having the same experience as I who have eyes do, and I know what sort of experience that is because I have the experience. Let us now examine these arguments. When a word can be used to stand for a private experience, like the words "seeing" or "pain," it is certainly tempting to sup­ pose that giving these words a meaning is itself a private experience-indeed that they get their meaning just from the experiences they stand for. But this is really non­ sense: if a sentence I hear or utter contains the word "pain," do I help myself to grasp its sense by giving myself a pain? Might not this be, on the contrary, rather distract­ ing? As Wittgenstein said, to think you get the concept of pain by having a pain is like thinking you get the concept of a minus quantity by running up an overdrait. Our concepts of seeing, hearing, pain, anger, etc., apply in the first instance to human beings; we willingly extend them (say) to cats, dogs, and horses, but we righlly feel uncomfortable about extending them to very alien creatures and speaking of �1 slug's hearing or an angry ant. Do we know at all what it would be to apply such concepts to an immaterial being? I think not. One may indeed be tempted to evade difficulties by saying: "An immaterial spirit is angry or in pain if it feels the same way as I do when I am angry or in pain." But, as Wittgenstein remarked, this is just like saying: "Of course I know what it is for the time on the Sun to be five o'clock: it's five o'clock on the Sun at the very moment when it's five o'clock here!"-which plainly gets us no forrader. If there is a difficulty in passing from "I am in pain" or "Smith is in pain" to "an immaterial spirit is in pain," there is equally a difficulty in passing from "Smith feels the same way as I do" to "an immaterial spirit feels the same way as I do." In fact, the question is, whether a private experience does suffice, as is here sup­ posed, to give meaning to a psychological verb like "to see." I am not trying to throw doubt on there being private experiences; of course men have thoughts they do not utter and pains they do not show; of course I may see something without any be­ haviour to show I see it; not do I mean to emasculate these propositions with neo­ behaviourist dialects. But it is not a question of whether seeing is (sometimes) a private experience, but whether one can attach meaning to the verb "to see" by a private uncheckable performance; and this is what I maintain one cannot do to any word at all.

DUALISM RE,JECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED

One way to show that a word's being given a meaning cannot be a priva uncheckable performance is the following: We can take a man's word for it that a li guistic expression has given him some private experience-e.g., has revived a pai memory, evoked a visual image, or given him a thrill in the pit of the stomach. B ut cannot take his word for it that he attached a sense to the expression, even if accept his bona fides; for later events may convince us that in fact he attached no se to the expression. Attaching sense to an expression is thus not to be identified any private experience that accompanies the expression; and I have argued this, by attacking the idea of private experiences, but by contrasting the attaching of se to an expression with some typical private experiences that may be connected the expression. We give words a sense-whether they are psychological words like "seeing" a "pain," or other words-by getting into a way of using them; and though a man invent for himself a way of using a word, it must be a way that other people could f low-otherwise we are back to the idea of conferring meaning by a private unche able performance. Well, how do we eventually use such words as "see," "hear," "feel when we have got into the way of using them? We do not exercise these concep only so as to pick our cases of seeing and the rest in our separate worlds of sen experience; on the contrary, these concepts are used in association with a host other concepts relating, e.g., to the physical characteristics of what is seen and t behaviour of those who do see. In saying this I am not putting forward a theory, b just reminding you of very familiar features in the everyday use of the verb "to and related expressions; our ordinary talk about seeing would cease to be intelligi if there were cut out of it such expressions as "I can't see, it's too far off," "I caught eye," "Don't look round," etc. Do not let the bogy of behaviourism scare you observing these features; I am not asking you to believe that "to seen is itself a wo for a kind of behaviour. But the concept of seeing can be maintained only because has threads of connexion with these other non-psychological concepts; break enoug threads, and the concept of seeing collapses.

If it does not make sense to ascribe sensations and feelings to a disembodie spirit (that is, to the immaterial Platonic soul that purportedly survives the dea of the body), and if a lifetime of such sensations and feelings are an essential fe ture of what makes Peter Geach an individual person, then a disembodied min whose thought and choices are unaccompanied by Peter Geach' s sensations an feelings can hardly be regarded as Peter Geach. If so, could one legitimately clai that any such disembodied spirit was actually Peter Geach in the condition o postdeath survival? If we conclude that the ascription of sensations and feelings to a disembodied spiri does not make sense, it does not obviously follow, as you might think, that we m deny the possibility of disembodied spirits altogether. Aquinas, for example, was co vinced that there are disembodied spirits but ones that cannot see or hear or feel pai or fear or anger; he allowed them no mental operations except those of thought and will. Damned spirits would suffer from frustration of their evil will, but not from aches and pains or foul odors or the like. It would take me too far to discuss whether his rea­ sons for thinking this were good; I want to show what follows from this view. In our human life thinking and choosing are intricately bonnd up with a play of sensations and mental images and emotions; if after a lifetime of thinking and choosing in this

PETER GEACH

205

human way there is left only a disembodied mind whose thought is wholly nonsensu­ ous and whose rational choices are unaccompanied by any human feelings-can we still say there remains the same person? Surely not: such a soul is not the person who died but a mere remnant of him. And this is just what Aquinas says (in his commentary on I Corinthians 15): anima mea non est ego, my soul is not I; and if only souls are saved, I am not saved, nor is any man. If some time after Peter Geach' s death there is again a man identifiable as Peter Geach, then Peter Geach again, or still, lives: otherwise not. Though a surviving mental remnant of a person, preserving some sort of physi­ cal continuity with the man you knew, would not be Peter Geach, this does not show that such a measure of survival is not possible; but its possibility does raise serious difficulties, even if such dehumanized thinking and willing are really conceivable at all. For whose thinking would this be? Could we tell whether one or many disembodied spirits thought the thoughts in question? We touch here on the old problem: what constitutes there being two disembodied minds (at the same time, that is)? Well, what constitutes there being two pennies? It may happen that one penny is bent and cor­ roded while another is in mint condition; but such differences cannot be what make the two pennies to be two-the two pennies could not have these varied fortunes if they were not already distinct. In the same way, differences of memories or of aims could not constitute the difference between two disembodied minds, but could only supervene upon a difference already existing. What does constitute the difference between two disembodied human minds? If we could find no ground of differentia­ tion, then not only would that which survived be a mere remnant of a person-there would not even be a surviving individuality. Could we say that souls are different because in the first instance they were souls of different bodies, and then remain different on that account when they are no longer embodied? I do not think this solution would do at all if differentiation by ref­ erence to different bodies were merely retrospective. It might be otherwise 1 f we held, with Aquinas, that the relation to a body was not merely retrospective-that each dis­ embodied human soul permanently retained a capacity for reunion to such a body as would reconstitute a man identifiable with the man who died. This might ,;dtisfacto­ rily account for the individuation of disembodied human souls; they would differ by being fitted for reunion to different bodies; but it would entail that the possibility of disembodied human souls stood or fell with the possibility of a dead man's living again as a man. Some Scholastics held that just as two pennies or two cats differ by being differ­ ent bits of matter, so human souls differ by containing different "spiritual matter." Aquinas regarded this ideas as self-contradictory; it is at any rate much too obscure to count as establishing a possibility of distinct disembodied souls. Now this recourse to "spiritual matter" might well strike us merely as the filling of a conceptual lacuna with a nonsensical piece of jargon. But it is not only Scholastic philosophers who assimilate mental processes to physical ones, only thinking of mental processes as tak­ ing place in an immaterial medium; and many people think it easy to conceive of dis­ tinct disembodied souls because they are illegitimately ascribing to souls a sort of dif­ ferentiation-say, by existing side by side-that can be significantly ascribed only to bodies. The same goes for people who talk about souls as being "fused" or "merged" in a Great Soul; they are imagining some such change in the world of souls as occurs to a drop of water falling into a pool or to a small lump of wax that is rubbed into a big one. Now if only people talked about "spiritual matter," instead of just thinking in terms of it unawares, their muddle could be more easily detected and treated.

DUALISM REJECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED

To sum up what I have said so far: The possibility of life after death for Pe Geach appears to stand or fall with the possibility of there being once again a in identifiable as Peter Geach. The existence of a disembodied soul would not be a s vival of the person Peter Geach; and even in such a truncated form, individual ex tence seems to require at least a persistent possibility of the soul's again entering in the make-up of a man who is identifiably Peter Geach.

The third view of postdeath survival that Geach attacks is reincarnation. Simp put, Geach claims that the evidence is insufficient for identifying a living person a in fact, a deceased person. Furthermore, Geach is highly skeptical of the case for su vival made on the basis of mediumship. Geach' s essay predates Almeder' s discu sion. Is Almeder' s case strong enough to withstand Geach' s objections? This suggests a form of belief in survival that seems to have become quite popular late in the West-at any rate as a half-belief-namely, the belief in reincarnatio Could it in fact have a clear sense to say that a baby born in Oxford this year is Hitl living again? How could it be shown that the Oxford baby was Hitler? Presumably by mem ries and similarities of character. I maintain that no amount of such evidence wou make it reasonable to identify the baby as Hitler. Similarities of character are of the selves obviously insufficient. As regards memories: If on growing up the Oxford ba reveals knowledge of what we should ordinarily say only Hitler can have kno does this establish a presumption that the child is Hitler? Not at all. In normal circu stances we know when to say "only he can have known that"; when queer thin start happening, we have no right to stick to our ordinary assumptions as to what ca be known. And suppose that for some time the child "is" Hitler by our criteria, an later on "is" Goering? Or might not several children simultaneously satisfy the criter for "being" Hitler? These are not merely captious theoretical objections. Spirit-mediums, we a told, will in trance convincingly enact the part of various people: sometimes of fie· tious characters, like Martians, or Red Indians ignorant of Red Indian languages, the departed 'spirits" of Johnny Walker and John Jamieson; there are even stories o mediums giving convincing "messages" from people who were alive and normally conscious at the time of the ' message." Now a mediurn giving messages from the dead is not said to be the dead man, but rather to be controlled by his spirit. What then can show whether the Oxford child is" Hitler or is merely ' controlled" Hitler's spirit? For all these reasons the appearance that there might be good eviden for reincarnation dissolves on a closer view. Nor do I see, for that matter, how the mental phenomena of mediumship could ever make it reasonable to believe that a human soul survived and communicated< For someone to carry on in a dramatic way quite out of his normal character is a com• mon hysterical symptom; so if a medium does this in a trance, it is no evidence of anything except an abnormal condition of the medium's own mind. As for the medium's telling us things that only the dead can have known," I repeat that in these queer cases we have no right to stick to our ordinary assumptions about what can be known. Moreover, as I said, there are cases, as well-authenticated as any, in which the medium convincingly enacted the part of X and told things that "Only X could have known" when X was in fact alive and normally conscious, so that his soul was certainly not trying to communicate by way of the medium! Even if we accept all 1

1

11

11

1

PETER GEACH

207

the queer stories of spirit-messages, the result is only to open up a vast field of queer possibilities-not in the least to force us to say that mediums were possessed by such­ and-such souls. This was argued by Bradley long ago in his essay "The Evidences of Spiritualism," and he has never been answered.

Geach now builds his case for bodily resurrection as the only reasonably warranted way of construing the character of postdeath survival. For Geach, bod­ ily resurrection alone holds the possibility of personal survival. How could a living man be rightly identifiable with a man who previously died? Let us first consider our normal criteria of personal identity. When we say an old man is the same person as the baby born seventy years before, we believe that the old man has material continuity with the baby. Of course this is not a criterion in the sense of being what we judge identity by; for the old man will not have been watched for sev­ enty years continuously, even by rota! But something we regarded as disproving the material continuity (e.g., absence of a birthmark, different fingerprints) would dis­ prove personal identity. Further, we believe that material continuity establishes a one-one relation: one baby grows up into one old man, and one old man has grown out of one baby. (Otherwise there would have to be at some stage a drastic change, a fusion or fission, which we should regard as destroying personal identity.) Moreover, the baby-body never coexists with the aged body, but develops into it. Now, it seems to me that we cannot rightly identify a man living "again" with a man who died until material conditions of identity are fulfilled. There must be some one-one relation of material continuity between the old body and the new. I am not saying that the new body need be even in part materially identical with the old; this, unlike material continuity, is not required for personal identity, for the old man need not have kept even a grain of matter from the baby of seventy years ago. We must here notice an important fallacy. I was indicating just now thdt I favor Aquinas's doctrine that two coexisting souls differ by being related to two different bodies and that two coexistent human bodies, like two pennies or two cats, differ by being different bits of matter. Well, if it is difference of matter that makes tw, 1 bodies different, it may seem to follow that a body can maintain its identity only if at least some identifiable matter remains in it all the time; otherwise it is no more the same body than the wine in a cask that is continuously emptied and refilled is the same wine. But just this is the fallacy: it does not follow, if difference in a certain respect at a certain time suffices to show non-identity, that sameness in that respect over a period of time is necessary to identity. Thus, Sir John Cutler's famous pair of stockings were the same pair all the time, although they started as silk and by much mending ended as worsted; people have found it hard to see this, because if at a given time there is a silk pair and also a worsted pair then there are two pairs. Again, it is clear that the same man may be in Birmingham at noon and in Oxford at 7 p.m. even though a man in Birmingham and a man in Oxford at a given time must be two different men. Once formulated, the fallacy is obvious, but it might be deceptive if not formulated. "Why worry even about material continuity? Would not mental continuity be both necessary and sufficient?" Necessary, but not sufficient. Imagine a new "Tichborne" trial. The claimant knows all the things he ought to know, and talks convincingly to the long­ lost heir's friends. But medical evidence about scars and old fractures and so on indicates that he cannot be the man; moreover, the long-lost heir's corpse is decisively identified at an exhumation. Such a case would bewilder us, particularly if the claimant's bona fides

DUALISM REJECTED BUT SURVIVAL AFFIRMED

were manifest. (He might, for example, voluntarily take a lie-detecting test.) But We should certainly not allow the evidence of mental connections with the long-lost heir to settle the matter in the claimant's favor: the claimant cannot be the long-lost heir, whose body we know lies buried in Australia, and if he honestly thinks he is then we must try to cure him of a delusion. "But if I went on being conscious, why should I worry which body I have?" To use the repeated "I" prejudges the issue; a fairer way of putting the point would be: there is going to be a consciousness that includes ostensible memories of my life, wh should I worry about which body this consciousness goes with? When we put it th way, it is quite easy to imagine circumstances in which one would worry-parti larly if the ostensible memories of my life were to be produced by processes that c produce entirely spurious memories. If, however, memory is not enough for personal identity; if a man's living ag does involve some bodily as well as mental continuity with the man who lived fo merly; then we might fairly call his new bodily life a resurrection. So the upshot our whole argument is that unless a man comes to life again by resurrection, he d not live again after death. At best some mental remnant of him would survive death and I should hold that the possibility even of such survival involves at least a perma nent capacity for renewed human life; if reincarnation is excluded, this means: capacity for resurrection. It may be hard to believe in the resurrection of the body; b Aquinas argued in his commentary on I Corinthians 15, which I have already cite that it is much harder to believe in an immortal but permanently disembodie human soul; for that would mean believing that a soul, whose very identity depend on the capacity for reunion with one human body rather than another, will continu to exist forever with this capacity unrealized. Speaking of the resurrection, St. Paul used the simile of a seed that is planted an grows into an ear of corn, to show the relation between the corpse and the body tha rises again from the dead. This simile fits in well enough with our discussion. In this life the bodily aspect of personal identity requires a one-one relationship and material conti nuity; one baby body grows into one old man's body by a continuous process. Now ilarly there is a one-one relationship between the buried seed and the ear that grows out of it; one seed grows into one ear, one ear comes from one seed; and the ear of corn is. materially continuous with the seed but need not have any material identity with it. There is of course no philosophical reason to expect that from a human corpse there will arise at some future date a new human body, continuous in some way with the corpse; and in some particular cases there appear strong empirical objections. But apart from the possibility of resurrection, it seems to me a mere illusion to have any hope for life after death. I am of the mind of Judas Maccabeus: if there is no resurrec� tion, it is superfluous and vain to pray for the dead. The traditional faith of Christianity, inherited from Judaism, is that at the end o this age Messiah will come and men will rise from their graves to die no more. That faith is not going to be shaken by inquiries about bodies burned to ashes or eaten by beasts; those who might well suffer just such a death in martyrdom were those who were most confident of a glorious reward in the resurrection. One who shares that hope will hardly wish to take out an occultistic or philosophical insurance policy, to guarantee some sort of survival as an annuity, in case God's promise of resurrection should fail.

How convincing is Geach' s case? If you agree with him, what sense is to be made of the evidence relating to paranormal human experiences presented by Almeder?

ANTONY FLEW

209

NOTE ON SOURCES. The material jn this section is from Peter Geach, "Immortality," God and the Soul (London: Kegan Paul, 1969).

ANTONY FLEW DEATH IS THE END

FROM GEACH TO FLEW. In response to the Socratic question-"Is death going to sleep or is it going on a journey?" -Corliss Lamont argues for "sleep" whereas Ducasse and Almeder favor "journey." In their cases for or against postdeath sur­ vival the mind-body problem (which we examined in a previous chapter) appears as a key issue. Corliss Lamont appeals to biological, physiological, and genetic data to support his belief in a monistic psychology which, in turn, seems to support his belief in the finality of death. Ducasse and Almeder appeal to a different set of data, which can be referred to as paranormal human experiences, to support their belief in a dualistic psychology which, in turn, seems to bolster their belief in post­ death survival. Peter Geach, however, affirms survival not on the basis of dualism but on the grounds of a belief in resurrection. Antony Flew lines up on the side of Lamont and makes his case against postdeath survival by attacking Geach's resur­ rection theory as susceptible to the 'Replica Objection/' and the dualism of Ducasse and Almeder as seriously flawed because it relies on the basically unintel­ ligible notion of a disembodied mind. 1

BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Antony Garrard Newton Flew was born in 1923 in Britain. He studied at St. John's College, Oxford and taught at several universities includ­ ing Oxford, Aberdeen, Keele, Calgary, Reading, and York (Canada). From 1986 to 1990 he served as part-time Distinguished Research Fellow in the Social Philosophy and Policy Center of Bowling Green State University, Ohio. He has published a number of major works including A New Approach to Psychical Research (1953); Hume's Philosophy of Belief (1961); God and Philosophy (1966); Evolutionary Ethics (1967); An Introduction to Western Philosophy (1971); Crime or Disease? (1973); Thinking About Thinking (1975); The Presumption of Atheism (1976) from which the reading is this section is taken; Sociology, Equality and Education (1976); A Rational Animal (1978); The Politics of Procrustes (1981); Darwinian Evolution (1984); Hume, Philosopher of Moral Science (1986); The Logic of Mortality (1987); and Equality in Liberty and Justice (1989). THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Flew begins his case against belief in post­ death survival by noting the universality of death as an enormous obstacle to such belief and by clarifying what he means by"survival." 1. The enormous initial obstacle [The] huge obstacle lying across the path of any doctrine of personal survival or per­ sonal immortality is the familiar fact that-with the possible exceptions of the prophet Elijah and Mary the mother of Jesus bar Joseph-all men die and are in more

DEATH IS THE END

or less short order buried, cremated, or otherwise disposed of. This universal fact death is what leads us normally to distinguish after a shipwreck or an air crash, excI sively and exhaustively, between the Dead and the Survivors, with no third catego of Both or Neither. This is the fact which gave the proposition"All men are mortal" its hallowed status as the first premise of the stock traditional example of a valid syllo..: gism; which proceeds from this and the further premise that "Socrates is (or was) man)," to the true if unexciting conclusion that"Socrates is (or was) mortal." 2. Survival and immortality

Confronted by such an obstacle how is any such doctrine to get started? Before tryin to suggest an answer I wish to make a sharp, simplifying move. I propose from no on to speak only of survival, without qualification, rather than of personal surviv and personal immortality. I shall thus be taking it for granted, first, that what we a interested in is our personal post-mortem futures, if any. "Survival" through our ch dren and our children's children after we ourselves are irrecoverably dead, imm tality" through the memories of others thanks to our great works, or even our imm sion in some universal world-soul-whatever that might mean-may be as much or much more than, most of us will in fact be getting. And it may be lamentably se centered, albeit humanly altogether understandable, that we should be concerne about more than these thin substitutes. But, for better or for worse, what we are di cussing now is the possibility of our post-mortem survival as persons identifiable those we are here and now. I shall also be taking it for granted, second, that survival is the necessary thoug of course not the sufficient condition of immortality. We can and shall concentrate o survival because this is pre-eminently a case where it is the first step which counts. Immortality is just more of the same-survival for ever. 11

Flew proceeds to delineate three ways in which people have tried to recon cile the universal fact that all humans are mortal, that we all die, with the claim that some or all of us will survive that death. 3. Three ways for survival

We shall, therefore, have in mind always and only personal survival; and we shall be concentrating on survival rather than on immortality inasmuch as the former is the nec­ essary but not the sufficient first step to the latter. So, now, back to the question of ho granted the undeniable fact that we shall all die, anyone can possibly maintain th some or all of us will nevertheless survive. I distinguish three sorts of way in whic attempts can be, and have been, made to overcome this enormous initial obstacle. (i) The first and most familiar I call the Platonic or Platonic-Cartesian way. Th consists in two moves, not one. The first move is to maintain that what is ordinari thought of as a person in fact consists of two radically disparate elements: the one, t body, earthy, corporeal, and perishable; the other, the soul, incorporeal, invisibl intangible, and perhaps imperishable. The second move in the Platonic o Platonic-Cartesian way consists in the contention that it is the second of these two ele� ments which is the real, essential person. It is obvious that if this way will go, then what I call the enormous initial obstacle is really no obstacle at all: the death of the body is not necessarily the death of the soul, which is the true person; and such an essentially incorporeal entity cannot in principle be touched by the earthy corruptions of the graveyard or the inferno of the crematorium. The case where this soul is stipu·

ANTONY FLEW

211

lated to be not incorporeal but corporeal I classify as a special case of the second way, the way of the astral body. (ii) This second suggestion, like the first, consists in two moves, not one. The first move is to claim that inside and, so to speak, shadowing what is ordinarily thought of as the person is another being of the same form. And the second move is, as before, to maintain that this shadow being is the real person. The crucial difference between the Platonic-Cartesian way and the way of the astral body is that, whereas in the former the soul is supposed to be essentially incorporeal, in the latter the astral body is equally essentially in its own way corporeal-albeit, of course, necessarily constituted of a different and somehow more shadowy and ethereal sort of stuff than familiar, workaday matter. Strictly speaking, it could not make sense to ask of a Platonic-Cartesian soul any such everyday and down-to-earth questions as "Where is it?", "How big is it?" "How broad and long is it?." Of the astral body, on the other hand, at least some such questions must be sensibly askable even if not in practice answerable, or what would be the point of talking of an astral body and not simply of a Platonic-Cartesian soul? Once this crucial distinguishing point is grasped, the best method of increasing one's sympathetic understanding of the way of the astral body is to think of those stock cinematic representations-as long ago in the movie version of Noel Coward's Blithe Spirit-in which a shadow person, visible only sometimes and only to some of the characters, detaches itself from a person shown as dead and thereafter continues to participate in the developing action, at one time discernibly and at another time not. This second way is not, I think, nowadays given the attention which it deserves. Part of the reason for this is that people familiar with the material of psychical research have been persuaded to adopt a different interpretation of those apparitions of the liv­ ing, the dying, and the dead which have to others seemed to provide the main prop for an astral body view. But partly, I suspect, the way of the astral body is snnply ruled out of court as unacceptably crude or intolerably materialist; and this hasty dismissal is made all the easier by the assumption-which I shall soon be challenging-that there are no serious theoretical objections to the Platonic-Cartesian way. (iii) The third of the three sorts of way which I want to distinguish and label finds its traditional home in religion rather than in psychical research. This is the one which I call the reconstitutionist way. The nature of this third way cannot be better shown than by quoting an epitaph composed for himself by Benjamin Franklin, Founding Father and Signer of the American Declaration of Independence. This epi­ taph has been erected not on but near his grave in Christ Church cemetery, Philadelphia, by the Poor Richard Society of that his city: "The body of B. Franklin, Printer, Like the Cover of an old Book, Its Contents torn out, And stript of its Lettering and Gilding, Lies here, Food for Worms. But the work shall not be lost; for it will, as he believ'd, appear once more in a new and more elegant Edition Corrected and improved By the Author."

Flew now launches his attack against all three of these attempts to reconcile the fact of death with the claim of survival. If he is able to show that each attempt is fatally flawed and if there are no other visible attempts stepping forward to take their place, then one could claim that he has dealt a serious blow to rat­ ionally warranted belief in postdeath survival. Flew begins with the reconstitu­ tionist way and raises what he calls the {/Replica Objection." Does this objection constitute a telling blow to Geach' s case for survival?

4.

of the rcconstitutionist way

decisive, here may be christened and Objection. Consider a short but most revealing passage from in the Koran. As usual it is Allah !--''--���"« • ''Thus shall be rewarded: because disbelieved our revelations and said, 'When we are turned to bones and dust shall we be raised to life?' Do they not see that Allah, who has created has power to create their like? Their fate is the heavens and the beyond all doubt. Yet the wrongdoers persist in unbelief." Certainly Allah the omnipotent must have to create their like." But in Allah talk in these precise terms of what He might indeed choose to the Prophet was speaking truer than he himself appreciated. For thus to produce even the most indistinguishably similar object after the first one has been totally destroyed and disappeared is to produce not the same object again, but a replica. To punish or to reward a replica, reconstituted on Judgment Day, for the sins or virtues of the old Antony Flew dead and cremated in 1984 is as inept and as unfair as it would be to reward or to punish one identical twin for what was in fact done by the other. Again and similarly, the Creator might very well choose to issue a Second Edition­ "Corrected and improved by the Author"-of Benjamin Franklin. But that Second Edition, however welcome, would by the same token not be the original Signer. LCHU'--C.UL

"-

attack on the Platonic-Cartesian dualism of people Flew next offers a like Ducasse. He cites Ducasse' s ,.,,.,,.,._,.,,,,,.,,.,,:,-,,.,.1- for survival based on _,,.,.,,,-.,,_,,.,.,..,,.,-,,r, communication with deceased persons via mediums. Flew tries to show that when cite paranormal human expelike Ducasse (and one could of posrc1e,n11 survival, are that a person is a perishable substance a and an substance a mind or and that the have dualists like Ducasse .U.LJLlL'-'-'--'

is an is not the case of Ducasse and other dualists for postctea belief about the nature of _,,.,. r,r. 0

0 .,..

0

5. Difficulties of the Platonic way The first thing with which we must try to come to terms here is that the assumptions of the Platonic-Cartesian way, which in some contexts we find it so easy to make, are nevertheless both extraordinary and extraordinarily questionable. (i) To appreciate how easy it is in some contexts to make these Platonic-Cartesian assumptions, consider a paper by the late Professor C. J. Ducasse, "What would consti­ tute conclusive evidence of survival after death?." It was published in the Journal of the Society for Phychical Researc h for 1962. Ducasse supposes that our friend John Doe has been on board an aircraft which crashed in the ocean, and no survivors have been found. Our phone rings "and (a) a voice we recognize as John Doe's is heard and a con­ versation with it held which convinces us that the c-n,oc>Ln::,r is really John Doe.. . or (b) the voice heard is not John Doe's but that of some other person seemingly relaying his

ANTONY FLEW

213

words to us and ours to him; and that the conversation so held does convince us that the person with whom we are conversing through that intermediary is John Doe" (p. 401). Ducasse continues: "Obviously, the two imagined situations (a) and (b) are, in all essentials, analogues of cases where a person is conversing with the purported surviv­ ing spirit of a deceased friend who either, in case (a), 'possesses' for the time being parts at least of the body of a medium ... or else who, in case (b), employs the medium only as intermediary ..." (pp. 401-402). Now certainly this constitutes as clear and vivid a description as could be desired of the model in terms of which mediums and their sitters usually think of the proceedings of the seance room.Yet it is neither obvious nor true that "the two imag­ ined situations ... are, in all essentials, analogues" of the seance situation.The crucial difference lies in the fact that in the case of the imaginary plane crash we know only "that no survivors have been found," whereas in the seance case we presumably know, beyond any possibility of doubt, that our friend has indeed died, and that his remains have been duly buried, cremated, or in some other way consumed. Now Ducasse, in his own way, appreciated all this perfectly well. The reason why he did not see it as representing any difficulty at all for "the survival hypothesis" is that here he, like almost everyone else when considering what is in psychical research called "the survival evidence," took for granted a Platonic-Cartesian view of man. These Platonic-Cartesian assumptions are made explicit a little later, when Ducasse continues: "Thus, because the John Doe case and the case of conversation through a medium are complete analogues, the particular kind of content of the con­ versation that would be adequate to prove or make positively probable that John Doe had survived the crash would likewise be adequate to prove or make positively prob­ able that the mind of our deceased friend has survived the death of his body" (p.402). This possibly surviving mind of Ducasse's is-as he himself, again in his own fashion, emphasizes-for our purposes nothing else but the Platonic-Cartesian sou L for it is an incorporeal entity which inhabits the body; and it is the real, essential person. Ducasse continues: "When the question of survival is formulated thus in terms not of 'spirits' but of minds then the allegation that the survival explanation makt0 S gratu­ itously ... four assumptions ... is seen to be erroneous.For (a) that there are minds is not an assumption but a known fact; (b) that minds are capable of remembering is likewise not an assumption but known; (c) that minds are capable of 'possessing' liv­ ing human bodies is also a known fact, for 'possession' is but the name of the normal relation of a mind to its living body. Paramount 'possession' would be possession in the very same sense, but only temporary, and of a living body by a mind other than its own-that other mind either being one which had been that of a body now dead; or being a mind temporarily wandering from its own living body. And (d) that tele­ pathic communication between minds is possible is also a known fact" (p. 403: italics and inverted commas original). (ii) Having shown by reference to Ducasse how easy and natural it is to make Platonic-Cartesian assumptions in the context of what is usually described as the sur­ vival evidence, the next thing is to challenge both these assumptions. What I shall now be doing is to develop, in a philosopher's way, a suggestion made many years ago by a leading American psychologist and psychical researcher, Gardner Murphy. Writing on "Difficulties confronting the survival hypothesis" in the Journal of the American Society for Psychical Research for 1945 Murphy spoke of the "fact that bodies are the vehicles of personality, and that most people have no conception of personal­ ity except in such terms ...". He challenged "the reader to try for a few minutes to

DEATH IS THE END

imagine what his personal existence would be like if he were deprived of ever-v device for making contact with his environment, except through the hypothetical us� of continuous telepathy to and from other invisible minds" (p. 71). I think that Murphy understated his case. For, surely, 'personality" is a term which has to be defined in terms of persons. My personality is some sort of function of my characteristics and my dispositions; and it could make no more sense to talk of my personality surviving my dissolution-of these characteristics existing without a me for them to be the characteristics of-than it would to talk of the grin of Carroll's Cheshire Cat outlasting the face of which it was one possible configuration. Nor is it just "most people," as Murphy modestly puts it it is all of us whose conceptions personality are grounded in the corporeal. For, as I have just said, personality is essentially some sort of function of persons; and persons are-surely equally essen­ tially-corporeal. Consider, for instance, how you would teach the meaning of any person word to a child. This is done, and I think could only be done, by some sort of direct or indi. rect pointing at members of that very special class of living physical objects to whic we one and all belong. Or again, and slightly more subtly, consider some of th things which we easily and regularly say about people, and think how few, if any, these things could be intelligibly said about incorporeal entities. We meet people, w shake hands with them, e.at with them, see them, hear them; they get up, go to be sit down, smile, laugh, cry. All these activities, and many, many more, could only predicated intelligibly of corporeal creatures. Now look again at what Ducasse called the "known facts," and what I still wan to call his Platonic-Cartesian assumptions. I agree, of course, that there are minds provided that by this we mean only that such statements as that he has a first-r mind, or that the child is developing a mind of his own, are often true. But th statements are, in the interpretation in which we know that they are often true, statt ments about the capacities and dispositions of flesh and blood people. They must n be misconstrued to imply that the people in question already possess, or are in t process of acquiring, important incorporeal components; much less that these-. any-people actually are incorporeal beings It is also perfectly true and much to the point to insist that all normal people a capable of a certain amount of remembering. But to say that minds are the possesso of these capacities is either an oddly artificial and, it appears, highly misleading wa of stating a fact about people, or else a speculative suggestion about a possible expl nation of that same fact in terms of a hypothetical and, presumably, corporeal entity (iii) Suppose we were to grant that ESP is a reality; there is still absolutely experimental reason to describe it as communication between minds or souls rath than as communication between people. Indeed, I believe that something eve stronger and much more interesting might be said-something at which Murphy wa perhaps hinting when he spoke a shade disrespectfully of "the hypothetical use continuous telepathy to and from other invisible minds." For could such bodile beings, necessarily lacking all conventional sensory equipment, properly be said communicate with one another by ESP, or even singly to possess any ESP capacit And, if they could, could they be said to know that they were thus communicating, that they did possess such a capacity? These questions arise-although I cannot recall having heard them put before because the term "ESP" is, whether implicitly or explicitly, defined negatively by re erence to the absence or neglect of all ordinary and ultimately perceptual methods 1

215

ANTONY FLEW

acquiring and communicating information; and because it is only by reference at some stage to the conventional sources that we become able to identify authentic ESP experiences or performances as being truly such; and thus to distinguish these both from acquisitions of information through normal channels and from such autonomous features of our own lives as our spontaneous and not significantly veridical imaginings. We never should forget, what too often is forgotten, that ESP" is not the name of some directly identifiable means of information transfer. Indeed, despite the close resemblance between the words telepathy" and "telephony," any performance depending on telephony or any other such known and normal means is for that very reason at once disqualified as a case of telepathy; and the same applies, with appropriate alterations, as regards clairvoyance. Nor can authentic ESP experi­ ences be picked out as such simply by reference to the strong conviction of the sub­ ject that this is the real thing. It is, or should be, notorious that subjective conviction is not a sufficient condition of either normal or paranormal knowledge: I may with complete confidence and absolute sincerity claim either to know normally or to have exercised my supposed ESP capacity, and yet in fact be totally mistaken. We must, therefore, distinguish: between (a) in fact possessing or exercising some ESP capacity, whether or not you believe or know that you do or are; (b) believing that you possess or are exercising an ESP capacity, whether or not you in fact do or are; and (c) gen­ uinely knowing-as opposed to believing with however little warrant or however mistakenly-that you do possess or perhaps actually are exercising such a capacity. Suppose now that in the light of these reminders we try to apply ESP concepts to these putative incorporeal subjects of experiences. Suppose further that it is a fact that there actually is some close correspondence between the mental contents of two such hypothetical bodiless beings, although such a fact would not surely, be known by any normal means by anyone-whether bodied or bodiless. Now how could either of these bodiless beings have, how indeed could there even be, any rcdson for saying that this close correspondence must point to some information transfer from one to the other? How could either of these bodiless beings have -indeed how could there even be-any reason for holding that some of its mental contents mu·.;t have been intruded by, or otherwise correspond with, some of those of another s1milarly bodiless being; and some particular one, at that? How could either have, indeed how could there be, any good reason for picking out some of its mental contents as-so to speak-messages received, for taking these but not those as the expressions of an exercise not of imagination but of ESP? Fundamentally similar difficulties arise when we attempt to apply ESP concepts to the different cases of information transfer between an ordinary person and a supposed bodiless being, and between material things and such a being (telepathy from the living to a spirit that is, and clairvoyance by a spirit). The upshot appears to be that the concepts of ESP are essentially parasiti­ cal upon everyday and this-worldly notions; that where there could not be the nor­ mal, there could not be ESP as the exception to that rule. It is too often and too easily assumed that ESP capacities could be, or even must be, the attributes of something altogether immaterial and incorporeal; partly for no better reason than that they do indeed seem to be non-physical in the entirely differ­ ent sense of being outside the range of today's physical theories. Yet the truth appears to be that the very concepts of ESP are just as much involved with the human body as are those of other human capacities. It was this point which Wittgenstein was making, with regard to our normal and known attributes and capacities rather than anything putative or paranormal, when he said gnomically: The human body is the best pie11

11

11

5

DEATH IS THE END

ture of the human soul" (L. Wittgenstein, Philosophical Investigations, trans. G. E. M. Anscombe. Oxford: Blackwell, 1953, p. 178.) (iv) We have no business, therefore, simply to take a Platonic-Cartesian view of man for granted; and to proceed at once to the question of whether the so-called survival evidence is in fact sufficient to establish that we, in our putative essential natures as incorporeal souls, do survive death and the dissolution of our bodies. Before we can possibly become entitled to begin to construe that material as evidence for this conclusion a great deal of work will have to be done to show: (a) that there can be a coherent notion of an incorporeal personal being; and (b) that a being of t sort could significantly and truly be said to be the same person as he was when was a creature of flesh and blood. My own conviction is that no amount of work can turn these two tricks. It· surely significant that Plato himself-an imaginative writer of genius as well as th Founding Father of philosophy-when he came at the end of his Republic to describe in the Myth of Er the life of supposedly incorporeal souls, was quite unable to say anything about them which did not presuppose that they must be, after all, in som fashion corporeal. So, against all his wishes and intentions, Plato there lapsed fro his own eponymous positions into what was in effect an astral body view. (v) But, suppose we take Plato's own failure in the Myth of Er-as, surely, h would have done had it been pointed out to him-as showing only that our vocab lary and our imagination are deplorably limited by our present, but tempora enmeshment in the body. And suppose we concede-as surely we must-that person words of our present vocabulary do not refer to incorporeal souls, but to ere tures of all too solid flesh. Can we not develop a new and coherent concept of an incorporeal being to whom at least some of the characteristics presently ascribed tQ people could also significantly be attributed? I do not think that we can. The basic dif­ ficulties are, first, to provide a principle of individuation by which one such being could, at least in theory, be distinguished from another such being; and, second, provide a principle of identity to permit us to say that one such being at a later time is the same as the being at an earlier time. This is difficult ground, though we can get much help by considering the unsrn.• cessful labors of Descartes and his successors. Since they mistook it that people ar incorporeal subjects of experience, our problem appeared to them not as one of deve oping a coherent new notion, but as that of giving an account of our present notion a person. But this does not make their efforts any less relevant to us. The first thi which emerges is that such an incorporeal personal being will have to be conceived consisting of a series of conscious experiences-along, no doubt, with some dispo tions, inclinations, and capacities. In the light of what has been argued already in previous subsection (5 (iii)), we have to add that unless we can solve the theoreti problem of attributing ESP and other putative paranormal capacities to such a bein these dispositions and so on will have to refer exclusively to actual or possible me bers of the same series of experiences. We now have a choice between two optio either, with Descartes, we attribute these experiences to an incorporeal spiritual sub­ stance-the I in Descartes' claim "I am a thinking substance"; or else, with Hume, we say that we can make nothing of the idea of such a substance and then go on to say that such an incorporeal being must simply consist in a series of experiences. Neither alterative shows promise. Take the second first. Whatever difficulties there may be about the idea of a substance characterized as incorporeal, it should be

ANTONY FLEW

217

easy to see why some substance is required. The word '' substance,., is being used here in its main-not, alas, its only-philosophical sense. In this sense a substance is that which can significantly be said to exist separately and in its own right so to speak. Any experience requires a substance to the experience of in exactly the same way that a grin requires a face to be the grin of. Since it makes no sense to talk of a pain or a joy or any other sort of awareness without an owner, Hume's suggestion in the Treatise (I (iv) 6) that a person might simply and solely consist in a collection of such "loose and separate" experiences must be rated as, strictly, nonsense. Hume himself never seems to have realised that and why this suggestion cannot do. But he did soon see, and confessed in the Appendix, that there is no available string, no uniting principle, to bind any such collection together and to distinguish it from any other. The obvious candidate might seem to be memory, as Locke has sug­ gested earlier in his Essay (II (xxvii)). For, surely, we are inclined to think, the person himself must always be able-if only he would tell us, and would tell us true-to say whether it was in fact he or another who had the thought or did the deed. But this will not work Expressed in modern terms, there is no possibility of giving an account of the self-identity and individuation of incorporeal collections of experiences in terms of their memory capacities. Certainly if I truly remember, and do not merely seem to remember, doing the deed, then necessarily I must be the same person as did that deed: true memory thus presupposes true personal identity. But what I remember is that I am the same person as did the deed. That I do so remember is not, and cannot be, itself what it is for me to be the same person as did it. So what about the Cartesian alternative? Can we accept that an incorporeal per­ son would be the incorporeal substance which enjoyed or suffered certain experi­ ences, and was endowed with certain capacities? The principle of individuation would then be a matter of being, or belonging to, one such substance rath.:r than to another; and the principle of self-identity would be a matter of being, or belonging to, the same such substance. But now, before we discuss the qualifications of this candidate, can w,· be told who (or what) he (or it) is? For when we were dealing with regular or conventional (corporeal) persons, there was no difficulty in saying-indeed, in showing-what was the substance to which we were attributing the experiences, the dispositions, etc.: they were the experiences, the dispositions, or whatever, of a flesh and blood person. But what positive characterization can we give to these postulated incorporeal sub­ stances? Can we say anything to differentiate such an incorporeal substance from an imaginary, an unreal, a non-existent substance?: "Beyond the wholly empty assur­ ance that it is a metaphysical principle which guarantees continuing identity through time, or the argument that since we know that identity persists some such principle must hold in default of others, no content seems available for the doctrine. Its irrele­ vance . .. is due to its being merely an alleged identity-guaranteeing condition of which no independent characterization is forthcoming" (T. Penelhum, Survival and Disembodied Existence. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul, 1970, p. 76).

The third attempt to reconcile the fact of death with the claim of survival is the hypothesis of an astral body. While Flew finds this way to be preferable to the other two, nevertheless he also rejects it on the grounds that it is neither sup­ ported by evidence nor needed as an explanatory hypothesis.

DEATH IS THE END

6. Difficulties in the way of the astral body The great, and in my view insuperable, difficulties of the Platonic way, the assumptions of which have so often been taken for granted or even asserted as known facts, should now lead us to look with a new interest and respect at the way of the astral body. In the context of this more sympathetic approach, it begins to emerge that many of those who have been thought of as-and who probably thought themselves­ Platonic-Cartesians have really been believers in astral bodies. There is, for instance some reason to think that the Latin Father Tertullian, who certainly held the soul t� be corporeal, was also inclined to think of it as of human shape; and what is this but an astral body? See Chapter IX of his de Anima, in which he cites the visions of the good sister who saw "a soul in bodily shape . . . in form resembling that of a human being in every respect." Tertullian then goes on to argue that such an object must have a color, which could be no other than an "ethereal transparent one." Since we come to examine this notion of an astral body so soon after deploying the objection to the candidate notion of incorporeal spiritual substance, it will be easy to see what the problem for the protagonist is going to be. It is, obviously, to find some positive characterization for an astral body: such that an astral body really would be a sort of body in a way in which an imaginary body, or a non existent body, or an incorporeal body are not sorts of body; and at the same time such that the hypothesis that we have, or are, astral bodies is not shown to be false by an · presently available facts. Confronted by this problem, the danger for the protagoni of an astral body view is that in his concern to avoid immediate falsification by presently known facts he may so qualify the nature of the body which he wants to hypothesize that it becomes in effect not a body, albeit elusive, but instead an incor­ poreal Platonic-Cartesian soul: "A fine brash hypothesis may thus be killed by inches1 the death by a thousand qualifications." In principle these dangers could, I think, be escaped fairly easily. We should need only to postulate the detectability of astral bodies by an instrument of a kind not yet invented. But such an utterly arbitrary postulation would invite the comment made by. Bertrand Russell in another connection: "The method of 'postulating' what we want has many advantages; they are the same as the advantages of theft over honest toil" (B. Russell, Introduction to Mathematical Philosophy. London: Allen and Unwin, 1919, p. 21), Such a drastic postulation would be warranted only if we thought-or think-that the survival evidence cannot be interpreted in terms of various ESP ongoings among ordi­ nary corporeal people, and if we also believe-as I have been arguing that we should that the Platonic-Cartesian way will not go. It would also be much encouraged if evi­ dence for levitating, apporting, and generally rip-roaring physical mediumship were better than it is.

7. Tentative conclusions on the substantive question Certainly I cannot myself recommend the reckless postulation which would be required in order to proceed along the way of the astral body. For I remain persuaded by the sort of considerations deployed so long ago by Professor E. R. Dodds in his "Why I do not believe in survival," in the Proceedings of the Society for Psychical Research for 1934. The crux of this landmark paper, which ought to be reprinted in some more accessible and more widely circulating form, is that the so-called survival evidence can be adequately, and therefore better, interpreted in terms of more or less elaborate and unconscious normal and paranormal transactions among the living-without

ANTONY

some sort of astral rather formidable difficulties indicated the Section 6. For these difficulties, unlike those of the SUl:JPf most things that occur to men. For fow .-ire the gooJs of human life, and n1,1ny Ml' the llvils, ,rnd tl11• good b lo bl' alllibuted to God alcinl' God'-. indubit,1bl(• ddl'.it ,rnd our mt•vitc1blc chs,1skr, ou r rch. gion W1)Lild h,Wl' risl'l1 tht'rl•by and would have .ittssarily be a slate of affair, which is manifestly incompatible with the non-cxistt•ncc of God. It might be lakl'11 just as a surprising n.itural fact. The atheist, in his tl'�urrcction body, and able to remcmbcr his life on earlh, might say thc1t the universc has turned out to be more complex, .ind perhaps more to be approved of, than he had reali.wd. But the mere fact of survival, with ,1 new body in a new cnvironnwnt, would not demonstratl! tu him that thl're is a Cod. It is fully rnmpalible wilh the notion of survival thal lhe hie to conw be, so far as the tlwistic problem is conccrn('d, essenti.:illy a contimwtion nl the present life, and religiously no less ambiguous. And in this evenl, survival after bodily death would not in the least constitute ii final verification of theistic faith. J shall not spend time in trying to dr.iw ii picture of a resurrection C)l1ste11n · which wc>tdd merely prolong the religious ambiguity of our present life. The 1mpor­ t,111t lllll'sli(ln, for our purpo�c, is not wheth�•r om• can ctmccivc of ,1fler-lifc experi-

ANTONY FLEW AND JOHN HICK

285

ences which would not verify theism (and in point of fact one can fairly easily con­ ceive them), but whether one can conceive of after-life experiences which would serve to verify theism. I think that we can. In trying to do so I shall not appeal to the traditional doc­ trine, which figures especially in Catholic and mystical theology, of the Beatific Vision of God. The difficulty presented by this doctrine is not so much that of deciding whether there are grounds for believing it, as of deciding what it means. I shall not, however, elaborate this difficulty, but pass directly to the investigation of a different and, as it seems to me, more intelligible possibility. This is the possibility not of a direct vision of God, whatever that might mean, but of a situation which points unam­ biguously to the existence of a loving God. This would be a situation which, so far as its religious significance is concerned, contrasts in a certain important respect with our present situation. Our present situati,on is one which in some ways seems to con­ firm and in other ways to contradict the truth of theism. Some events around us sug­ gest the presence of an unseen benevolent intelligence and others suggest that no such intelligence is at work. Our situation is religiously ambiguous. But in order for us to be aware of this fact we must already have some idea, however vague, of what it would be for our situation to be not ambiguous, but on the contrary wholly eviden­ tial of God. I therefore want to try to make clearer this presupposed concept of a reli­ giously unambiguous situation. There are, I suggest, two possible developments of our experience such that, if they occurred in conjunction with one another (whether in this life or in another life to come), they would assure us beyond rational doubt of the reality of God, as con­ ceived in the Christian faith. These are, first, an experience of the fulfillment of God's purpose for ourselves, as this has been disclosed in the Christian revelation; in con­ junction, second, with an experience of communication with God as he h::1s revealed himself in the person of Christ. The divine purpose for human life, as this is depicted in the New Testament documents, is the bringing of the human person, in society with his fellow5, to enjoy a certain valuable quality of personal life, the content of which is given in the charac­ ter of Christ-which quality of life (i.e., life in relationship with God, described in the Fourth Gospel as eternal life) is said to be the proper destiny of human nature and the source of man's final self-fulfillment and happiness. The verification situation with regard to such a fulfillment is asymmetrical. On the one hand, so long as the divine purpose remains unfulfilled, we cannot know that it never will be fulfilled in the future; hence no final falsification is possible of the claim that this fulfillment will occur-unless, of course, the prediction contains a specific time clause which, in Christian teaching, it does not. But on the other hand, if and when the divine pur­ pose is fulfilled in our own experience, we must be able to recognize and rejoice in that fulfillment. For the fulfillment would not be for us the promised fulfillment with­ out our own conscious participation in it. It is important to note that one can say this much without being cognizant in advance of the concrete form which such fulfillment will take. The before-and-after situation is analogous to that of a small child looking forward to adult life and then, having grown to adulthood, looking back upon childhood. The child possesses and can use correctly in various contexts the concept of "being grown-up," although he does not know, concretely, what it is like to be grown-up. But when he reaches adult­ hood he is nevertheless able to know that he has reached it; he is able to recognize the experience of living a grown-up life even though he did not know in advance just

FALSIFICATION AND VERIFICATION

what to expect. For his understanding of adult maturity grows as he himself matu Something similar may be supposed to happen in the case of the fulfillment of divine purpose for human life. That fulfillment may be as far removed from our sent condition as is mature adulthood from the mind of a little child; nevertheless possess already a comparatively vague notion of this final fulfillment, and a; move towards it our concept will itself become more adequate; and if and when finally reach that fulfillment, the problem of recognizing it will have disappeared the process. The other feature that must, I suggest, be present in a state of affairs that wou verify theism, is that the fulfillment of God's purpose be apprehended as to the ful ment of God's purpose and not simply as a natural state of affairs. To this end it be accompanied by an experience of communication with God as he has made hi self known to men in Christ. The specifically Christian clause, "as he has made himself known to men Christ," is essential, for it provides a solution to the problem of recognition in awareness of God. Several writers have pointed out the logical difficulty involved any claim to have encountered God.9 How could one know that it was God who one had encountered? God is described in Christian theology in terms of vari absolute qualities, such as omnipotence, omnipresence, perfect goodness, infin love, etc., which cannot as such be observed by us, as can their finite analogues, Ii ited power, local presence, finite goodness, and human love. One can recognize t a being whom one '' encounters" has a given finite degree of power, but how does recognize that he has unlimited power? How does one observe that an encounte being is omnipresent? How does one perceive that his goodness and love, which o can perhaps see to exceed any human goodness and love, are actually infinite? Su qualities cannot be given in human experience. One might claim, then, to ha encountered a Being whom one presumes, or trusts, or hopes to be God; but one c not claim to have encountered a Being whom one recognized to be the infinite almighty, eternal Creator. This difficulty is met in Christianity by the doctrine of the Incarnation although this was not among the considerations which led to the formulation oft doctrine. The idea of incarnation provides answers to the two related questi "How do we know that God has certain absolute qualities which, by their ve nature, transcend human experience?" and "How can there be an eschatological ve fication of theism which is based upon a recognition of the presence of God in Kingdom?" In Christianity God is known as "the God and Father of our Lord Jesus Christ."1 God is the Being about whom Jesus taught; the Being in relation to whom Jesus live and into a relationship with whom he brought his disciples; the Being whose aga toward men was seen on earth in the life of Jesus. In short, God is the transcendent Creator who has revealed himself in Christ. Now Jesus' teaching about the Father is part of that self-disclosure, and it is from this teaching (together with that of the prophets who preceded him) that the Christian knowledge of God's transcendent being is derived. Only God himself knows his own infinite nature; and our human belief about that nature is based upon his self-revelation to men in Christ. As Karl 9 For example, H. W. Hepburn, Christianity and Paradox, 1958, pp. 56 f. lO II Cor. 11:31.

HICK

Barth expresses it, "Jesus Christ is the of God." Our beliefs about God's scope infinite being are not capable of observational verification, human experience, but of indirect verification the removal of C1111�h,n·,t-u rational doubt cor1cerrnng Christ. An ex;p:21·1:2r,'"0 of the of the of the Father would confirm that "'" t-hr,-,,,H-u and therewith, Son in the "� rectly, the validity of Jesus' u:.u.L>LJLH)c, concerning the character of God in his infinite transcendent nature. The further question as to how an eschatological e:xr;::;12r·Ir2r''"" of the Kingdom of God could be known to be such has already been answered by implication. It is God's union with man in Christ that makes possible man's recognition of the fulfillment of God's purpose for man as being indeed the fulfillment of God's purpose for him. The presence of Christ in his Kingdom marks this as being beyond doubt the _._'--'-',"'.:',�,�....',',' --.J ,,--.--.u of the God and Father of the Lord Jesus Christ. It is true that even the experience of the realization of the promised Kingdom of with Christ reigning as Lord of the New Aeon, would not constitute a logical certification of his claims nor, accordingly, of the reality of God. But this will not seem remarkable to any philosopher in the 2::-:--'c,-;:,':,��.r_:�,J. tradition, who knows that it is only a confusion to demand that a factual proposition be an analytic truth. A set of expecta­ tions based upon faith in the historic Jesus as the incarnation of God, and in his teach­ ing as being divinely authoritative, could be so fully confirmed in post-mortem experi­ ence as to leave no grounds for rational doubt as to the validity of that faith. 0

,",,:..,�.'�"· ✓ ---,·�H

to Hick has such as "God exists" and "God is he believes he has -,,.oc•-.-.n,-nr1 adedone so? What would Flew be

and Alasdair

Hick's comments are from Theology Today 17



I

r1



I

THE QUESTION POSED

ach of us makes many moral judgments every day. We might declare an act of terrorism to be evil, a tax bill before Congress to be unjust, a parent's discipline of a child to be abusive, and so forth. Seldom, however, do we pause to inquire into the principles and presuppositions that are operative in those moral judgments. Such an inquiry cannot be avoided by those who pursue the examined life. Not to know our principles and presuppositions is to be naive. To get to know them is to achieve sophistication. When we seek such knowledge we are engaging in the branch of philosophy called "ethics." The term ethics is often used to refer to codes of ethics or to relatively well­ defined ways of behaving. In the philosophical contexts that follow, we will use ethics to mean the careful study of right and wrong human action. Ethical theory and ethics will, in this context, be synonyms. (Some philosophers use the expres­ sion moral theory for what we are calling ethical theory or ethics. They do this to distinguish the study of right and wrong human action from an articulated code of ethics.) Ethical theory is usually divided into at least three parts. A. Normative ethics tells us how we should make our ethical decisions; how we ought to live our lives. It answers the questions: What should I do? What is the good life? What should I strive for? What should I strive to become? B. Metaethics deals with the meanings of what some philosophers might call the family of ethical terms. Metaethics then deals with words such as good, bad, evn right wrong, justice, fairness, duty, obligation, ought, should, morat immora( etc.

289

AN INTRODUCTION TO MODERN PHILOSOPHY

Sometimes philosophers say that metaethics is the study of the logic of the terms; that is, how they interrelate. For example, consider the following in problem. Suppose I am walking on a country road and I see a sharp nail in road. I might very well think that I ought to get it out of the road so that a does not get a flat tire. But am I obligated to remove that nail? Do I violate so one's right if I do not remove it? Am I being immoral if I do not remove the from the road? Metaethics would focus on what the words ought, right an immoral mean and how they are related to each other. C. Moral psychology answers the question, "What makes people act the wa they do?" Having a theory of human motivation is important if one believes t a moral theory should work to change people's behavior. A moral theory based on a complete misunderstanding of people is very unlikely to work because it is unlikely that any person would want to use it. For example, a moral theory which assumed that people rarely sought or needed pleasure in any form and had a principle which demanded total abstinence from all pleasure would not be an inviting moral theory. Notice that one cannot restrict oneself to normative ethics alone. That is, one cannot answer the question, "What is the good life?" unless one has some idea of what the word good means when it is applied to a life. And it would certainly be odd for someone with no sense of what people were like to make an effort to tell them how to live their lives. Recently, ethics has come to emphasize the problems faced by the profes­ sions. Physicians must deal with questions concerning the termination of life, confidentiality, and truth telling. Sometimes their duties as physicians conflkt with what they feel is morally appropriate. For example, some doctors feel that helping patients die is sometimes the right thing to do but also believe that they are professionally bound never to do such a thing. Lawyers are often caught ind bind between their professional obligation to help their clients and what they know to be true or feel to be fair in a moral sense. A salesperson may want to tell the truth and say, "That suit looks terrible on you" but that salesperson has oblig­ ations to the company and the other employees as well as to her family (to bring home a decent salary). Obligations to stockholders, which are both legal and moral, can conflict with what company owners feel is the moral thing to do with respect to the public. Journalists often feel a conflict between their obligation to inform the public and a particular person's right to privacy. Thus, an ethical the­ ory that could not deal adequately with questions of applied and professional ethics would not be as acceptable as one that could. It is important to remember that some basic value choices are already made for us by legal and political systems. Our criminal justice system makes it difficult to convict a criminal because it is assumed that it is morally better for a guilty per­ son to go free than for an innocent person to be convicted. Our political and eco­ nomic system differs from some others by placing relatively greater value on indi­ vidualism. Totally free enterprise is restrained in regard to child labor and unsafe working conditions, both of which are felt to be morally unacceptable.

ON WHAT PRINCIPLE DO I JUDGE THINGS RIGHT OR WRONG?

291

This chapter will stress normative ethics, but we wiH offer three examples of metaethics (A. J. Ayer, C. L. Stevenson, and R. M. Hare). Given our daily moral judgments and our commitment to the examined life, we must ask such questions as "Upon what principle do we discriminate between right and wrong?" One way for us to launch into this inquiry would be to compile a list of acts or ways of acting that we would judge to be wrong. Then we could ask, "What do these acts or ways of acting have in common by virtue of which we judge them to be wrong?" Is the common ingredient the fact that they are contrary to the will of God? the fact that they are contrary to social custom or convention? the fact that they are contrary to nature, "unnatural"? the fact that they militate against human happiness? Whatever that common ingredient is, let us call it "X." We could then say, "An act is wrong if it is "X" or an ''X." In due course, when we would be able to spell out what "X" stands for, we would have formulated the principle that is operative in our moral judgments. We use such a principle when we authorize moral judgments on conduct, on character, on institutions, on laws, on customs. We say, of a given act, that it is right or wrong; of a type of character, that it is the right type or wrong type; of an institution-for example, private property-that it is right or wrong; of a law, say, capital punishment, that it is right or wrong; of a custom, that it is right or wrong. Our present problem is not which particular act or character or institution or law or custom is right or wrong. Our problem is the more general one: On what principle do we judge these things right or wrong? The authors whose writings are sampled in this chapter present a rich variety of responses to that question. From the eighteenth century we have two moral philosophers who take our questions seriously and provide two very different answers. William Paley argues that right means "according to the will of Cud." Immanuel Kant claims that right means "according to reason," or "what reason requires." From the nineteenth century we also have two very different philosophical viewpoints. John Stuart Mill, a lucid interpreter of Jeremy Bentham's eighteenth­ century utilitarianism, contends that right means "maximizing the happiness of humankind," or "producing the greatest amount of happiness possible under the circumstances." In contrast to Paley, Kant, and Milt Friedrich Nietzsche adopts a remarkably different posture in responding to the question we are examining (On what principle do I judge things right or wrong?). That question assumes that the answer to be given is an answer that is appropriate for all human beings. The "I" in the question is not made culturally specific. The "I" stands for each and every person. Accordingly, when Paley, Kant, and Mill provide us with their answers, they are articulating principles that they believe are appropriate for all human beings. Paley, for example, does not say that he is describing what is right for eighteenth-century Britons only. Nor does Kant say that he is defining right for eighteen-century Prussians only. And Mill does not propose to be formulating an ethic that is appropriate only for nineteenth-century Londoners. All of these philoso­ phers assume they are articulating a universal moral norm that is applicable to all persons. Nietzsche, however, from the posture of a cultural historian, perceives the vast diversity in moral beliefs and practices throughout the ages and

THE WILL OF GOD

embraces a relativistic position according to which there is no single universa moral viewpoint common to humankind. Instead there are various moralitie that serve the interests of specific groups. Accordingly, Nietzsche would reject th: proposals of Paley, Kant, and Mill as being human, all too human/' as bei fashioned to promote a specific cultural group's interests. The morality that Nietzsche himself finds most attractive is the one that declares that right means productive of or giving expression to the superman." From the twentieth century we have included the metaethics of A. J. Ayer (including a critique of his view by Brand Blanshard), as well as two refinemen of Ayer's position: one by C. L. Stevenson, the other by R. M. Hare. Ayer demonstrates affinities with Nietzsche by rejecting the very idea of ere. ating an ethical theory. This clearly sets him apart from Paley, Kant, and Bentham. Blanshard sees through to the ethical subjectivism inherent in Ayer's position and argues that ethical subjectivism is not a position worth holding. What is ethical subjectivism? It can take a number of forms. The easiest way to explain it is to see it as metaethics. Consider the judgment made by stating Learning how to do CPR is good." According to ethical subjectivism, "Learing how to do CPR is good" does not refer to, nor is it about, CPR. Rather, it is really a statement about the feelings, emotions, and attitudes of the person who made the statement. (In Ayer's view, it is not even a statement-it is the emotion or feeling or attitude.) The judgment might grow out of one's culture, but at bottom, it is only about feelings, emotions or attitudes. Subjectivism does not imply that ethi­ cal judgments vary from person to person (that is a different sense of subjec­ tivism"); but that ethical jud gments are subjective because they grow out of feel­ ings and emotions that may derive from a cultural or biological commonality. Indeed, according to Stevenson, ethical judgments are both subjective and objec­ tive because it is possible, Stevenson claims, to find out what the feelings,, emo­ tions, and attitudes of people are. R. M. Hare continues this balancing of the sub­ jective and objective aspects of moral judgments. We conclude with a return to normative ethics. Bernard Gert sees morality as a set of rather easily deduced rules, and Dorothy Emmet is a contemporary pro­ ponent of virtue theory, a view which had its first systematic expression in the thought of Aristotle. 11

11

11

II

WILLIAM PALEY THE WILL OF GOD

One important question we can direct at any human act is this: "Was it right or wrong?" That is, did the agent do as he ought to have done, or as he ought not to have done? Implicit in any answer to this question is a moral principle, a crite­ rion in terms of which we distinguish between right and wrong. As long as humans entertain a lively belief in the existence of God and ascribe to Him an interest in human affairs, many are likely to base their moral judgments upon

WILLIAM PALEY

293

what they consider to be His will. They are going to say that right m_eans "accord­ ing to the will of God," and wrong means "contrary to the will of God." William Paley, a popular moralist in the eighteenth century, was a man of precisely this turn of mind. If one is going to claim that God's will determines what is good, then one must be prepared to answer at least three crucial questions. First, what grounds do you have for belief in the existence of God? Second, how do you come to know the will of this God in whose existence you believe? Third, what precisely is that will? Responses to the first question were explored by a number of philoso­ phers in Chapter 5. Siding with those who found the teleological or design argu­ ment convincing, Paley offered a classic exposition of this proof in which he cited a multitude of apparently designed objects in nature that pointed beyond them­ selves to their origin in divine purpose. The second and third questions are addressed by Paley in this chapter. Paley worked out his position concerning the knowledge of God's will in the context of a struggle with deism. The issue at stake was whether God's will was manifested in scripture and/or nature. The deists, impressed by the achievements and development of modern science as it exposed the orderly behavior of natural phenomena, looked to nature as the "sourcebook" for knowledge of the will of God. For them, God created the universe, set it in motion, and then withdrew from it to allow it to function on its own as a complex clockwork, undisturbed by the kind of divine intervention described by the authors of scripture. Clearly such a view called into question the legitimacy of the biblical revelation and the whole religious establishment founded upon it. Paley and other eighteenth-century apologists for the Christian faith took on the deist challenge and argued, among other things, that God's will is made known in two books: the Book of Nature and the Book of Scripture. BIOGRAPHICAL NOTE. William Paley was born in England in 1743 and died in 1805 at the age of sixty-two. His father was headmaster of the school of Giggleswick in Yorkshire. His early education was obtained under the paternal eye. At the age of fifteen, young Paley went to Cambridge University. That his father had great expectations :rpay be gathered from a remark he made to a friend: "My son is now gone to college. He'll turn out a great man. Very great, indeed. I am certain of it. He has by far the clearest head I ever met in my life." Paley spent four years at Cambridge, obtaining his B.A. in 1762. The following anecdote suggests that he was a normal young man during these years: I spent the first two years of my undergraduate life happily, but unprofitably. I was constantly in society, where we were not immoral, but idle and rather expensive. At the commencement of my third year, however, after having left the usual party at a rather late hour in the evening, I was awakened at five in the morning by one of my companions, who stood at my bedside. He said: "Paley, I have been thinking what a fool you are. I could achieve nothing worth while, even were I to try, and anyway I can afford the idle life I lead. You could achieve anything, if you were to try, and you cannot afford to waste your time. I have had no sleep during the whole night on

the ecclesiastical world. In rose After graduating, IJ of Moral and Political Philosophy, from which the .,., . ,.,,"'�·"' his he following selections have been taken. The book was an immediate success, and fifteen editions. ,--,,...,.,..,... r,,..., as a textbook at was the clarity and cogency of his book that one of his It may be said to be the only work on moral by every class of readers." Other important his for Contentment appeared in which he warned against revolutionary doctrines. In established him as one of the premier his Evidences of Christianity defenders of the church and state. His last major Natural Theology, pubof the existence and nature of God sought to derive lished in Paley died in 1805. from a scrutiny of nature. After a lengthy 1'1'"1"""''00

11

formulation of the fundamental THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. is that which agrees with the will of and clear: of morality is stated this -�· ..,�~~•-··he sets wrong is that which does not. first a definition of virtue, consistent his himself to elaborate it. He to examine the meaning of moral obligabasic propositions; he moves on, These matters he tion and the distinction between prudence and "how are we to if right means according to the will of turns to the r rev­ tell what is and is not the will of God? His answer here is two-fold: elation and the light of nature." sense in which God's will may be gathered -nc,ri But what of the light of nature; what, that is, from Scripture is then about the morality of acts where we do not have God's express declaration? Here Paley meets a real ""'...,,-..,...,,,_,.,,� and knowing, as he that many occasions arise with respect to which --.:,.,,".,....1-,,.,,.,,_, is silent, he could not treat this matter lightly. To he assumed that human happiness is God's solve his concern. Realizing, as he says, this assumption is the foundation of the whole sys­ tem," he sets himself to explain the reasons upon which it rests." The v� -n"�­ tion in question occupies the remainder of the passages. begins with a characterization of ethics and of the meaning of right. 111•

00 1 '" '"

11

0

�···� ...... �

11

1

C"-'"" "'

1

11

11

0

101

[Ethics is] that science which teaches men their and the reasons of it. The use of ""''"''-'.-"«· upon this, that without it, the rules of life by which men are such a oftentimes mislead them, a defect either the rule or

is a of persons actions. Of persons; as when we say, such one has a to this estate; a"right" to reverence from their children.... is"right" as the Of actions; as such with death; his behaviour on that occasion was"right.'' ... DVln>-'conf"c the reasons that and at the same time, .............u·,r,r,o us with definitions of motivate us to do our moral obligation, prudence, and Virtue is the doing good to mankind, in obedience to the will of God, and for the sake of everlasting happiness.... The four cardinal virtues are prudence, fortitude, temperance, and justice. But the division of virtue, to which we are now-a-days most accustomed, is into duties; towards God ...towards other men ...towards ourselves.... More of these distinctions have been proposed, which it is not worth while to set down.... am I obliged to keep my word? ... A man is said to be obliged, when he is urged by a violent motive resulting from the command of another. First, the motive must be violent.If a person, who has done me some service ...ask me upon some occasion for my vote, may possibly give it him, from a motive of gratitude or expectation; but should hardly say that was obliged to give it him, because the inducement does not rise high enough.Whereas, if a father or a master, or any great benefactor, or one on whom my fortune depends, require my vote, give it him of course; and my answer to all who ask me why voted so and so, is, that my father or my master obliged me.... Secondly, it must result from the command of another. Offer a man a gratuity for doing anything ... he is not obliged by your offer to do it; nor would he say he is; though he may be induced, persuaded, prevailed upon, tempted.If a magistrate or the man's immediate superior command it, he considers himself as obliged to comply.... Let it be remembered that to be obliged is to be urged by a violent motive, result­ ing from the command of another. And then let it be asked, "Why am I obliged to keep my word?" and the answer will be, because am urged to do so by a violent motive" (namely, the expectation of being after this life rewarded, if I do, or punished for it, if do not) resulting from the command of another" (namely, of God). This solution goes to the bottom the subject, as no farther question can reasonably be asked. Therefore, private happiness is our motive, and the will of God our rule. 11

11

THE WILL OF GOD

There is always understood to be a difference between an act of prudence and act of duty. Thus, if I distrusted a man who owed me a sum of money, I should rec it an act of prudence to get another person bound with him; but I should hardly c an act of duty. On the other hand, it would be thought a very unusual and a I kind of language to say that, as I had made such a promise, it was prudent to perfo it; or that as my friend, when he went abroad, placed a box of jewels in my hands would be prudent in me to preserve it for him till he returned. Now, in what, you will ask, does the difference consist? ... The difference, a the only difference, is this, that, in the one case, we consider what we shall gain lose in the present world; in the other case, we consider also what we shall gain lose in the world to come. [Prudence has regard to the former; duty, to the latte Those who would establish a system of morality, independent of a future state, m look out for some different idea of moral obligation. To us there are two great questions: Will there be, after this life, any distribution of rewards and punishments at all? If there be, what actions will be rewarded and what actions will be punished? The first question comprises the credibility of the Christian religion, together with the presumptive proofs of a future retribution from the light of nature. The sec­ ond question composes the province of morality. Both questions are too much for o work.The affirmative therefore of the first, although we confess that it is the founda­ tion upon which the whole fabric rests, must in this treatise be taken for granted.

According to Paley, then, we ought to act in accordance with the will of God because our personal happiness in the life beyond death is at stake. Clearly God has the power to exercise sanctions (rewards and punishments) that will induce us to follow his will. The next question that arises is the precise content of God's will. As the will of God is our rule, to inquire what is our duty, or what we are obliged to do, in any instance, is, in effect, to inquire what is the will of God in that instance? which consequently becomes the whole business of morality. Now, there are two methods of corning at the will of God on any point: I.By his express declarations, when they are to be had, and which must be sought for in Scripture. II. By what we can discover of his designs and dispositions from his works, or, as we usually call it, the light of nature. And here we may observe the absurdity of separating natural and revealed reli­ gion from each other. The object of both is the same-to discover the will of God­ and, provided we do but discover it, it matters nothing by what means. An ambassador judging by what he knows of his sovereign's disposition, and arguing from what he has observed of his conduct, or is acquainted with his designs, may take his measures in many cases with safety; and would have him act on most occasions that arise; but if we have his commission and instructions in his pocket, it would be strange not to look into them. He will naturally conduct himself by both rules: when his instructions are clear and positive, there is an end of all farther delib­ eration (unless indeed he suspects their authenticity): where his instructions are silent or dubious, he will endeavor to supply or explain them, by what he has been able to collect from other quarters of his master's general inclination or intentions....

Humankind can know the will of God through his word recorded in the scriptures and through his works performed in nature. The scriptures provide general rules concerning piety, justice, benevolence, and purity, which are occa-

WILLIAM PALEY

297

sionally illustrated. For those matters on which the scriptures are silent we can take advantage of the light of nature: We can derive some very important insight concerning God's will for his creation by scrutinizing the nature of that creation. Paley proceeds to tell us what the light of nature reveals. The method of coming at the will of God concerning any action, by the light of nature, is to inquire into the tendency of the action to promote or diminish the gen­ eral happiness. This rule proceeds upon the presumption that God Almighty wills and wishes the happiness of his creatures, and consequently, that those actions which promote that will and wish, must be agreeable to him; and the contrary. As this presumption is the foundation of our whole system, it becomes necessary to explain the reasons upon which it rests. When God created the human species, either he wished their happiness or he wished their misery or he was indifferent and unconcerned about both. If he wished our misery, he might have made sure of his purpose, by forming our senses to be as many sores and pains to us as they are now instruments of gratifi­ cation and enjoyment.... He might have made, for example, everything we tasted bitter; everything we saw loathsome; everything we touched a sting; every smell a stench; and every sound a discord. If he had been indifferent about our happiness or misery, we must impute to our good fortune ...both the capacity of our senses to receive pleasure, and the supply of external objects fitted to excite it. But either of these, and still more both of them, being too much to be attributed to accident, nothing remains but the first supposition, that God, when he created the human species, wished their happiness; and made for them the provision which he has made, with that view, and for that purpose. The same argument may be proposed in different terms, thus: ... The world abounds with contrivances; and all the contrivances which we are acquainted with are directed to beneficial purposes. Evil no doubt exists; but is never, that we can per­ ceive, the object of contrivance. Teeth are contrived to eat, not to ache; their aching now and then is incidental to the contrivance, perhaps inseparable from it; or even, if you will, let it be called a defect in the contrivance; but it is not the object of it. This is a distinction which well deserves to be attended to. In describing implements of hus­ bandry, you would hardly say of a sickle, that it is made to cut the reaper's fingers, though from the construction of the instrument, and the manner of using it, this mis­ chief often happens.But if you had occasion to describe instruments of torture or exe­ cution, this engine, you would say, is to extend the sinews; this to dislocate the joints; this to break the bones; this to scorch the soles of the feet. Here pain and misery are the very objects of the contrivance. Now nothing of this sort is to be found in the works of nature. We never discover a train of contrivance to bring about an evil pur­ pose. No anatomist ever discovered a system of organization calculated to produce pain and disease; or, in explaining the parts of the human body, ever said, "this is to irritate; this is to inflame; this duct is to convey the gravel to the kidneys; this gland to secrete the humour which forms gout; if by the chance he come at a part of which he knows not the use, the most he can say is that it is useless; no one ever suspects that it is put there to incommode, to annoy, or torment.Since then God hath called forth his consummate wisdom to contrive and provide for our happiness, and the world appears to have been constituted with this design at first, so long as this constitution is upholden by him, we must in reason suppose the same design to continue....

THE WILL OF GOD

We conclude, therefore, that God wills and wishes the happiness of his crea­ tures. And this conclusion being once established, we are at liberty to go on with the rule bu�lt upon it, n�mely, that the _met�od �f c�ming at the will of God concerning any action, by the light of nature, 1s to mqmre mto the tendency of what action to promote or diminish the general happiness. Stated briefly, what Paley says comes to this: "Right means according to God's will. An act is right if it is according to the will of God. This is the principle of morality. God's will is to be found in the Scriptures, or discovered by the light of nature. The light of nature tells us that God intends above all to produce and promote human happiness. Where, therefore, the Scriptures are silent, we deter­ mine the rightness of an act by the fact that it produces more happiness than any other act possible at the time," This is both clear and confused. It raises more questions than it settles. For example, does Paley mean that an act is right because it agrees with God's will, or that it agrees with God's will because it is right? These two are not the same. Also, what is the relation between a person's will and God's will? Does Paley believe that God's will causes and governs all things? If so, could a human act ever be contrary to God's will? If it could not1 then it would follow that no act is ever wrong. Does Paley want that? Then, of course, there is the problem connected with detecting God's will in the Scriptures. Why the Scriptures? Why not in Plato's dialogues? Or in the Mohammedan Koran? In which parts of the Scriptures? In these parts which enjoin an eye for an eye? Or, in those parts which enjoin the golden rule? If in both, what about clashes? If in one, how choose which? Passing to the second half of his argument, has he proved, at all conclusively, that God's will is directed to creating and promoting human happiness? This hypothesis may account for some of the facts. But it does not account for all of them. (See Hume and Schopenhauer on the misery of the human estate.) Going a step further, and admitting his argument, are we justified in arguing that an act is right if it pro­ duces more happiness than any other act possible under the circumstances? Is this not to formulate a moral principle that swings clear of the first part of Paley's argument and could stand on its own feet without any aid from Scripture? If so, what about cases where the "appeal to Scripture" and "the appeal to happiness" appear to clash? Finally is it or is it not the case that we are more sure of what is right and wrong than we are of God's very existence? If so, would it not be wiser to begin with what we are more sure of, than to begin with what we are less sure of? These, and other problems that suggest themselves, were engaging the atten­ tion of Immanuel Kant during the years in which Paley was writing his Principles of Moral and Political Philosophy, published in 1785. Kant had published his Critique of Pure Reason in 1781, and was meanwhile engaged on a second Critique, directed this time not at the problem of knowledge but at the problem of morality. To a consideration of Kant's views, let us turn our attention. NOTE ON SOURCES. The materials in this section are quoted from William Paley, The Principles of Moral and Political Philosophy. That work is divided into six books. The materials in this section are from Books I and II. Each book is divided into

IMMANUEL KANT

299

brief chapters. The titles of the chapters in Books I and H will indicate the points at which material has been used for this section.

2

IMMANUEL KANT

THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE

FROM PALEY TO KANT. At the same time Paley, in England, was engaged in argu­ ing that morality has its roots in theology, Immanuel Kant, in Prussia, was engaged in showing that such is not the case. For Kant, theology can be a motive for ethics, but it cannot provide the fundamental principle that discriminates right from wrong. Kant lived in the Age of Reason, the age of Hume and Rousseau and Voltaire and the revolutions in America and France. He was a firm believer in the rational­ ity of humankind. He sought to develop the notion of a rational morality; that is, a morality that resembles rational knowledge by being valid for all persons at all times and in all cases. Just as he could speak of rational science, so he would speak of rational morality. Just as, by rational science he would mean knowledge valid and binding for all rational minds, so by rational morality he would mean morality valid and binding for all rational minds. To the first kind of rationality he devoted his Critique of Pure Reason; to the second, his Critique of Practical Reason. BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Kant was born in 1724 in Konigsberg, East Prussia, :md died there in 1804 at the age of seventy-nine. He studied at the University of Konigsberg where he eventually became a Privatdozent, teaching a wide variety of subjects including physics, mathematics, physical geography and philosophy. In 1770 he was appointed to the chair of logic and metaphysics. His personal life was quite uneventful. He scarcely travelled 40 miles beyond his native town of Konigsberg, but compensated for this lack of exposure to the world through wide reading. On one occasion he did gain some political notoriety when in 1794, after the publication of his Religion Within the Limits of Reason Alone, the Prussian king charged him with misrepresenting and depreciating orthodox Christianity. Under threat of penalties, Kant promised to refrain from further public state­ ments on religion, a vow he kept until the death of the king. Kant's own religious views included beliefs in the immortality of the soul and in the existence of God. In matters of religious experience he concentrated on moral piety rather than prayer, public worship, and mystical communion with the divine. Kant did not publish his magnum opus, the Critique of Pure Reason, until 1781, when he was fifty­ seven years old. Then he entered two decades of unusually productive activity, publishing among other works, Prolegomena to any Future Metaphysics (1783), Fundamental Principles of the Metaphysics of Morals (1785), Critique of Practical Reason (1788), Critique of Judgment (1790), Metaphysics of Morals (1797). His lifelong regard for Newtonian physics and Rousseauistic piety is often summed up in his acknowledged, profound reverence for "the starry heavens above and the moral

THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE

law within." (For additional biographical information on Kant, refer to Chapt 10, Section 2.) THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Kant's handling of the problem of moral pri ple follows from his conception of what morality is. Without a firm grip on this, is likely to miss the point of his analysis. For that reason, it is necessary to emp size his starting point. He begins by assuming that morality, whatever it may be detail, is something universally binding on all rational minds, comparable, in t respect, to science. Thus, if it is true that two and two make four, then it is bind· on all rational creatures to accept this proposition. If this is a truth, it is true everyone, not merely true for those who care to believe it. If it is true, it is true n essarily and always. It is true, in and of itself, without any reference to why i true, without any reference to who does nor does not believe it, without any re ence to consequences that follow from its being true or from its being believed. It to use a favorite phrase of Kant's, true categorically, without any strings or qualifi� cations. To repeat, it is not true because God commands it, nor because it is accord.;; ing to nature, nor because it pays in the long run to believe it nor because all most people agree to it, nor for any other reason. It is simply true because it is tru Moreover, it is true of all cases of two's and two's. There are no possible exceptio It is not something that holds for one period of time and not for another, for o pair of two's and not for another, for one stage of civilization and not for anothe In this universality, necessity, objectivity, Kant finds the differential mark of ratio­ nal knowledge. He has his own word for it. It is, he says, true a priori. This notion of a priori he carries over into the field of morality. If there is such a thing as rational science, it is a priori. If there is such a thing as rational morality, it is a priori. Moreover, just as in the case of a priori knowledge he did not under­ take to prove that there is such a thing, but assumed its existence as a fact, so in the case of morality he does not undertake to show that there is such a thing, but assumes its existence as a fact. His argument is after this manner: If you admit that there is any rational knowledge, then you must admit that it is a priori in character, and if you admit that there is any rational morality, you must admit that it is a priori in character. If you admit that there is any rational knowledge, you must recognize that it is binding on all rational beings; so, by analogy, if you admit that there is any rational morality, you must recognize that it is binding on all rational beings. He is content to accept both rational knowledge and rational morality as facts to be recognized, not as hypotheses to be proved. Once the notion of a rational morality is admitted, Kant is in a position to for­ mulate his problem. It is this: What must be its principle? It will be noticed that he is not seeking to justify morality, any more than one would seek to justify arith­ metic; not seeking to explain why right is right and wrong is wrong, any more than one would seek to explain why true is true, or false is false. He is merely say­ ing: The facts of morality are categorical facts, not dependent for their moral qual­ ity upon anything beyond themselves. Such being the case, we ask again, what principle must run through all the cases of morality, and be absent from all the cases of immorality?

IMMANUEL KANT

301

His answer is simple: an act is moral if and only if the principle that it embodies is capable of universalization without self-contradiction. This notion once stated, Kant proceeds to illustrate his meaning by some examples. His next step is to approach this same notion of categorical rightness from two other angles, namely duty and good will. When these matters have been settled, he turns to consider the problem of human free will. As a moralist, his fundamental problem is, "What ought I to do?" But it as would appear from the "scientific" view of the world, everything happens "of necessity," what sense is there to claiming that some things "ought" or "ought not" to be done? Here Kant is at once clarifying and baffling. Clarifying because he has the insight and tenacity to hold on to the "ought" as being every bit as much reality as the "is," baffling because he concludes by admitting his inability to solve the paradox involved in their joint acceptance. His treatment of this question would require too much space to be summarized here. From freedom he passes on to God and immortal­ ity. It will be necessary to state a few of his claims in the form of a condensed summary. His own language is too involved to permit direct quotation. Wherever possible, however, his own words will be introduced. Morality, the rightness and wrongness of actions, is categorical (not depen­ dent upon anything) and a priori (valid for all persons and all times and all cases). In this it resembles rational knowledge. To quote: "The morality of an action is quite a peculiar thing. When we are considering the goodness of an action, we are concerned with what constitutes the goodness in and of itself." If morality is of this categorical and a priori nature, then we can rule out several misleading attempts to formulate its principle. For example, the morality of an act is said, by some, to reside in the "feeling" that one has about the act. But thif::, could not be for two reasons: (1) If morality is a matter of someone's feelings, then it is not categorical: that is, an act would depend, for its morality, upon the fact ( exter­ nal to the act itself) that it was or was not felt about in some way or other by 3ome person or other. (2) If morality is a matter of feeling, then it is not anything univer­ sally binding and valid for all persons; that is, the same act could be both right and wrong provided merely that two persons had opposite feelings about it. But this is to rob morality of its categorical nature, to give as the defining characteristic of morality a quality in virtue of which it would fail to be categorical and a priori. Much the same line of reasoning is adduced by Kant against those who seek to locate the rightness of an act in its agreement with God's will. He says: There are those who argue that we must first have God and then morality-a very convenient principle. But ethics and theology are neither of them a principle of the other. We are not discussing, here, the fact that theology is a motive for ethics­ which it is-but we are asking whether the principle of ethical discrimination is theo­ logical-and it cannot be that. Were it so, then before a nation could have any conception of duties it would first have to know God. Nations which had no right conception of God would have no duties, and this is not the case. Nations had a right idea of their duties, e.g., were aware that lies were detestable, without having the proper notion of God. Duties must therefore be derived from some other source.

and because is so us if we do not, we act under orders mighty that He can force us to, or fear and fright, not appreciating the ,,...,.,,,-.,.,,-,1-" of our actions and we cannot constitute a vis obligandi. Threats do should do as God has commanded. a (moral) obligation; they extort. Such conduct does not make the not better. Moral laws can be right without any commander, promulgator, obligator. do we know the divine will? None of us feels it in his heart. We cannot know the moral law from any revelation, for if we did so, then those who had no revelation would be wholly ignorant of it. We imagine God as possessing the most holy and most perfect will. But what then is the most perfect will? The moral law shows us what it is. We say the will accords with the moral law and is, therefore, holiest and most perfect. Thus we recognize the perfection of the divine will from the moral law. God wills all that is morally good and proper and His will is, therefore, holy and perfect. But what is it that is morally good? Ethics supplies the answer to this question.

These strictures may be summarized. To locate the rightness of an act in its agreement with God's will is to deny its categorical i.e., to make it for its rightness, upon something other than or outside of itself. It to render morality an impossibility for all who do not know what God's will or who have a wrong notion of that will, or (it may deny His existence. There is, Kant would say, such a thing as morality apart from God's existence or our of the same. Finally, the view fails to take into account that when we goodness prior to and say, "God is good," we are of God. to the He is good because His or His action ,..,�.. ,._... �;"�:'�! There remains for consideration what Kant calls the -nrr,n-»�n-;-,,-, view of moralis that an act is because of the The pragmatic view of but because of the results that do or do not its consequences; not in follow from it. Kant does not need to concern himself with the to To locate the nature of the results. He has two of an act in the nature of its consequences is to morality. It is to make its morality upon To find the morality of an act in its consequences is to priori nature, because we can never know the consequences of an act until after the act is done, and even then never know them completely. This would reduce morality to a matter of probability; make it, as Kant says, a posteriori, instead of a priori. At this point, we can get closer to Kant's own words. A-..n__:

0

"'rl

Having examined what the principle of morality is not, we must now examine what it is. What is the one principle of morality, the criterion by which to judge and in which lies the distinction between moral goodness and all other goodness? What is the principle upon which we establish morality, and through which we are able to discriminate between what is moral and what immoral? In this connection we must first notice that there are two points to be consid­ ered: the principle upon which we discriminate, and the mainspring or motive of per­ formance. We must distinguish between the rod and the mainspring. The measuring rod is the principle of discriminating; the mainspring is the motive of the

IMMANUEL KANT

303

performance of our obligation. If we ask, "What is morally good and what is not?" it is the principle or discrimination that is in question; but if we ask, "What is it that leads me to be moral?" it is the motive that is in question. We must guard against confusing the principle of morality with the motive to morality. The first is the norm. The sec­ ond is the incentive. The essence of morality is that our actions are motivated by a general rule. If we make it the foundation of our conduct that our actions shall be consistent with a uni­ versal rule, valid at all times and for every-one, then our actions exemplify the princi­ ple of morality. In all moral judgments the idea which we frame is this: What is the character of the action taken by itself? If the principle of the action can, without self-contradiction, be universalized, it is moral; if it cannot be so universalized without contradicting itself, it is immoral. That action is immoral whose principle cancels and destroys itself when it is made a universal rule.

From this general statement of the nature of rightness Kant turns to some concrete illustrations. He considers the case of lying and suicide. These, being instances of wrongness, illustrate his notion of rightness only indirectly. May I, when in distress, make a promise with the intention not to keep it? Considerations of prudence aside, would such an act be moral? The shortest way to answer this question is to ask, "Would I be content that the principle (getting out of difficulties by making false promises) should hold good as a universal law, for myself and all others?" If I ask, "Can the principle of making deceitful promises to get out of difficulties be universalized?" I realize that it cannot. For with such a law there would be no promises at all. With such a principle made universal, it would be in vain to (dlege my intentions in regard to future actions. As soon as it were made a universal law, the principle would necessarily destroy itself, necessarily defeat its own end. A man finds himself forced to borrow money. He knows that he will nut be able to repay it, but he sees also that nothing will be lent to him unless he promises to repay it. Would it be right to promise? The principle of his action would be: When in need, borrow and promise to repay knowing that I cannot do so. Could this principle become a universal law? I see at once that it could not. As a universal law, it would contradict itself. For if this principle were a universal law, such promises would become impossible. For no one would consider such promises as binding, and all would ridicule them as vain pretenses. A man reduced to despair by a series of misfortunes feels wearied of life. Would it be right to take his own life? Could the principle of his action become a universal law of nature? The principle would be: To shorten life when its longer duration is likely to bring more evil than satisfaction. Could this principle become a universal law of nature? Clearly not. A system of nature in which it was a law to destroy life by means of the very feeling whose special office it is to impel to the improvement of life would contradict itself, and therefore could not exist as a system of nature. Hence that principle could not possibly exist as a universal law of nature. Hence it would be wholly inconsistent with the supreme principle of all duty. If we attend to ourselves on occasion of any transgression of duty, we shall find that we do not will that the principle of our action should become a universal law. On the contrary, we will that the opposite should remain a universal law, only we

THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE

assume the liberty of making an exception in our own favor-just for this time only, it may be. This cannot be justified to our own impartial judgment, and it provides that we do recognize the validity of the moral principle I have formulated, even while we allow ourselves a few exceptions which we think important and forced upon us.

Thus far Kant has been developing the notion of a rational morality as something categorical and a priori. He has used this conception of morality to eliminate certain other theories that are incompatible with it, that is, the theories that morality is a matter of feeling or emotion, that morality is a matter of obeying the will of God, and that morality is a matter of achieving certain consequences. He has disentangled what he takes to be the underlying principle of morality so con­ ceived and advanced a few illustrations of his thesis. He returns again and again throughout his ethical writings to these basic claims. One example of such a reworking is contained in his distinction between hypothetical and categorical imperatives. The statement of this is given below. But a word first on Kant's use of these terms. The term imperative, used as a noun, means "a command." Kant inclines to use it in this sense. We shall come closer to his real meaning if we construe it by the word ought. We do, as a matter of every­ day usage, employ the term ought in precisely the sense Kant would appear to have in mind. We say, for example, "If you wish to be there on time, you ought to leave early." Here the force of the ought is hypothetical; that is, it depends on whether you do or do not wish to get there on time. But there are occasions, Kant would claim, when we do not so use the term; when, for instance, we are point­ ing out what we take to be a duty. Thus, "you ought to be honest," "you ought to respect the rights of others." Here, we might feel, the ought is not dependent upon any if. It is not a hypothetical ought. It is, Kant would say, a categorical ought. The same idea could also be expressed in the distinction between a hypo­ thetical obligation and a categorical obligation. Kant says: All imperatives command either hypothetically or categorically. The former represent the practical necessity of a possible action as means to something else that is willed or might be willed. The latter would be that which represented an action as obligatory of itself without reference to some other end. If an action is good only as a means to something else, then the imperative which commands it is hypothetical only; but if it is conceived to be good in itself, that is, without reference to any further end, the imperative which commands it is categorical. The hypothetical imperative only says that the action is good for some purpose, actual or possible. The categorical imperative declares an action to be binding in itself, without reference to any purpose or end beyond itself. All sciences have a practical part, consisting of problems connected with ends or purposes possible for us, and of imperatives directing how these may be attained. Here there is no question whether the end is good or rational, but only what one must do in order to attain it. The precepts for the physician to make his patient healthy and for a prisoner to insure his victim's death are of equal value in this respect, namely that each serves to effect its purpose.

There is one imperative which commands certain conduct immediately, without having as its condition any other purpose to be attained by it. This imperative is cate-

IMMANUEL KANT

305

gorical. It concerns not the matter of the action, not its intended result, but its form and principle. This imperative may be called the imperative of morality. There is but one categorical imperative, namely, Act only on that principle which thou canst will should become a universal law." This imperative of duty may be expressed, by analogy with natural laws, as fol­ lows: 11 Act as if the principle of any action were to become by thy will a universal law of nature." If there is a supreme practical principle or categorical imperative it must be one which constitutes an objective principle, and can therefore serve as a universal practi­ cal law. From this, as a supreme practical law, all laws of the will must be capable of being deduced. Accordingly the categorical imperative may be stated in the third way: "So act as to treat humanity, whether in thine own person or in the person of another, as an end withal, never as a means only." If all the imperatives of duty can be deduced from this one imperative, from it as their principle, then, although it should remain undecided whether what is called duty is not merely a vain notion, yet at least we shall be able to show what we under­ stand by it; be able, that is, to show what the notion means. To act out of respect for this principle constitutes duty. To this every other motive must give place, because it is the condition of a will being good in itself, good absolutely, good without qualification; and the worth of such a will is above everything. The direct opposite of acting on the principle of morality is acting on the princi­ ple of private happiness. This would ruin morality altogether, were not the voice of reason so clear, so irrepressible, so distinctly audible even to the commonest men. That action should be based on the principle of private happiness can only be main­ tained by such as are bold enough to shut their ears against that heavenly voice in order to support a theory that costs no trouble. Two things fill the mind with ever new and increasing admiration and awe, the oftener and more steadily we reflect on them: the starry heavens above and the moral law within. I have not to search for them and conjecture them as though they were veiled in darkness or in a region transcending my horizon. I see them before me and connect them directly with the consciousness of my existence. Duty! Thou sublime and mighty name! Thou seekest not to move the will by threatening nor by charming. Thou merely holdest forth a law which finds entrance into the mind, a law before which all inclinations and desires are dumb. What origin is worthy of thee? Where is to be found the root of thy noble descent? I do not, therefore, need any far-reaching penetration to discern what I have to do in order that my will may be morally good. Inexperienced in the course of the world, incapable of being prepared for all its contingencies, I need only ask, "Can I will that the principle of my action should become a universal law?" If not, then it must be rejected. 11

A second reworking of his fundamental insight, that rational morality is cate­ gorical and a priori, is contained in his remarks on the intrinsic goodness of a good will. This thought requires a few words of explanation. Kant has spoken thus far of the morality of acts and wherein it resides. He has, also, restated the same notion in terms of ought and ought not. But, he is quite aware, there is no such thing as an act apart from someone who does the act. We may analyze and define the morality of an act, but we must end by addressing our remarks, not to

THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE

acts, but to persons who act. There can be right acts only insofar as persons act rightly; hence the need to restate the matter in terms of will or intention. Every moralist, no matter what his principle of morality, is brought around at last to this point; hence Kant's genuine concern over a good will; i.e., a will inspired and controlled by the principle he has defined. Nothing can be called good, without qualifications, except a good will. We now pro­ ceed to examine what exactly constitutes that will, simply good in itself, on which moral goodness depends. Intelligence, wit, judgment, courage, resolution, perseverance, and so on, are no doubt good and desirable in many respects. But these gifts of nature may also be bad and mischievous if the will which is to make use of them is not good. It is the same with gifts of fortune. Power, riches, honor, even health and happi­ ness, inspire pride and often presumption if there is not a good will to check their influence. A good will is good, not because of what it performs or accomplishes, not because of its usefulness or fruitfulness, but is simply good in itself. Even if it should happen that, owing to a special disfavor of fortune or the niggardly provision of a stepmotherly nature, a good will should wholly lack power to achieve its purpose, should by its greatest efforts achieve nothing, yet, like a jewel it would shine by its own light as a thing which has its whole value in itself. We have, then, to develop the notion of a will good in itself and without refer­ ence to anything further. This notion already exists in the sound natural understand­ ing, and requires rather to be clarified than taught or proved. In order to define more closely the notion of a good will, we will consider the wider notion of duty which includes the notion of a good will. To have moral worth an act must be done from a sense of duty alone. We must distinguish between acts which accord with what duty requires, and acts done because duty requires. The latter alone have moral worth. We must distinguish between doing what duty requires, and doing because duty requires. Only the latter possesses moral worth. If I do a thing because it is commanded, or because it brings advantage, my action is not moral. But if I do a thing because it is absolutely right in itself, my dispo­ sition is a moral one. We ought to do a thing, not because God wills it, but because it is righteous and good in itself. Thus, it is a matter of duty that a dealer should not overcharge an inexperienced customer. Refraining from so doing for any other motive than that duty requires it has no moral worth. It is one's duty to maintain life and happiness. Doing so for any other reason than that duty requires it has no moral worth. It is one's duty to be gen­ erous, kind, honest, and so on. Being so for any reason except that duty requires it has no moral worth. An action done from a sense of duty must wholly exclude the influence of inclination. An action, to be wholly moral, must exclude wholly the influ­ ence of inclination. Take for instance a man who pays his debts. He may be swayed by the fear of being punished if he defaults, or he may pay because it is right that he should. In the first case his conduct is legally right, but it is only in the latter case that it is morally right. It is a very beautiful thing to do good to men out of love for them or to be just from love of order. But this is not the true moral principle suitable to our position among rational beings as men. To pretend it were would be to set ourselves, with fan-

ciful

to do, of our own " 1"'"'" 1111•p think we need no command to do. An action done from a sense of derives its moral not from pose which is be attained by it, but from the The moral worth of action does not lie the results e;,qcJf - --'.r_t .__:r1� D'T�, 'r'. c.1·1,,"l , ' which it embodies. What sort of principle, or moral law, can that be, the conception of which must determine the will, without regard to C'XT,J,c:('_tr.: ,,.,'-'- consequences, in order that the will may be called good absolutely and without qualifications? is this: "So act that the principle of your action might become a universal law." Canst though will that the principle of thy action should become a universal law? If not, then it must be rejected. 0

0 �

Kant has now declared himself on one fundamental problem in moral phi­ losophy. Another problem remains. It grows out of his remarks on the nature and importance of a good will. A good will may be ,,LJ,-,-.--.L"7 after Kant, as a will to do what ought to be done. Here the crucial term is ought. And it is crucial because it implies that the will in question is a free will. There would be no point to the remark that a man ought to do so-and-so if, as a matter of fact, he cannot; has no free will. Furthermore, we hold a man responsible for his action, but only if his action expresses his free will in the matter. The moralist in all of us is up short by any denial of man's free will. Such a denial deprive much of our everyday ethical language of meaning. Without freedom of the will, no moral law and no moral responsibility are possible. A man commits a theft. the physical law of this deed is a necessary result of the causes preceding it in time; it was impossible that it could not have hapHow then can the moral judgment make any dlttf!Ye',1'.:'.P�, and suppose it could have been omitted? The moral judgment says it ought to have been omitted. How to can this be? How can a man be called at the same moment and with the same act in which he is subject to an inevitable necessity? Actions which are not and do not involve one's personality, do not rise to obligations. Thus no man can be placed under an obligation to give up swallowing for the very reason that it would not be within his powers. Obligation, therefore, pre­ supposes the use of freedom.

and No free no morality. That is the ,,n,,n�,r freedom of will you you annihilate morality. This is not to say that "discourage" people, so that they will "give up trying to what is right"; but rather that you make the term morality a meaningless term. Kant years thinking out a theory of which would legitimate the notion of free will. In this sense his Critique of Pure Reason was thought out with an eye to Critique of Practical Reason that followed it. In the next sentence, we are back in the ideas of the first Critique: If we take things in time as things-in-themselves, as is commonly done, then it is impossible to reconcile the necessity of the causal relation with freedom. are con­ tradictory. From the former, it follows that every event, even action, is a necessary result of what existed in time preceding. So, since time past is no longer in my power, it

THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE

would follow that every action I perform is the necessary result of causes which are not in my power. That is, it would follow that at the moment in which I act, I am never free Obligation expresses a sort of necessity which occurs nowhere else in natur� except in man. It is impossible that anything in nature ought to be other than in fact it is. In truth, obligation, if one has before one's eyes only the succession in nature, has simply and solely no meaning. We can as little ask what ought to happen in nature as what attributes a circle ought to have. If existence in time, that is, existence as phenomena, were the only kind we could ascribe to things-in-themselves, freedom would have to be rejected as a vain and impossible suggestion. Consequently, if we would save freedom, no other way remains but to consider that the existence of a thing in time and therefore according to the law of physical necessity, is appearance only. Freedom we must attribute to the thing as a reality, as a thing-in-itself. This is inevitable, if we would retain both these contradictory concep­ tions of necessity and freedom. However, when we try to explain their combination in one and the same action, great difficulties present themselves. Now, in order to remove the apparent contradiction between freedom and mechanism in one and the same action, we must recall what was said in the Critique of Pure Reason, or what follows from what was said there. It was said there that the necessity of nature-which cannot coexist with the freedom of the will-pertains only to things as phenomena. The category of causation, it was argued, extends to phenomena or appearances only. The possibility of freedom was thus left open, although its reality was not thereby proved.

Kant's words are important. He says, "The possibility of freedom was thus left open." That is all the help he claims from his theory of knowledge. It is suffi­ cient, however. As his discourse shows, he proposes to use the undeniable ought. That we ought to do some things and ought not to do others is a point upon which all moralists would agree. They might differ as to what we ought or ought not to do. The essential point is that they would all use the notions of" ought­ ness" and "ought-notness." Returning to the argument, the only point is to change this "may be free," which Kant's theory of knowledge permits, into an ''is free," which his moral practice demands. The only point is to change this "may be free" into "is free." That is, to show, in an actual case, that certain actions do imply freedom. Now, it is a duty to realize the moral law in our acts. Therefore it must be possible. ("I ought" implies "I can.") Therefore every rational being must assume whatever is implied by this possibility. Freedom of the will, independence of causal necessity, is implied by this possibility. The assumption is as necessary as the moral law, in connection with which it is valid. Freedom and duty reciprocally imply each other. It is the moral law, of which we become directly conscious, that leads directly to the conception of freedom. It is morality that first discovers to us the notion of freedom. The moral law-"I ought"which itself does not require any proof, proves the actuality of freedom in those who recognize it as binding on themselves. A man judges he can do, or refrain from doing, a certain act because he is conscious that he ought to. No one would ever have been so rash as to introduce freedom into science had not the moral law forced it upon us. Morality requires us only to be able to think freedom without self-contradiction, not to understand it. It is enough that our notion of the act as free puts no obstacle in

m,,�n�� of way of necessary. Our notion is t--.,oon,-.,,.m stands in from that in which stands mechanism of nature. From the of view of my of Pure Reason this the doctrine of nature and necessity and the doctrine of mr,,.,.,,i,h, and freedom may each be true in its own sphere. How freedom of the will is possible, how we are to conceive it theoretically and positively, how man is member of two how man's moral actions always appear necessitated while they are nonetheless free-all this is not discover­ able. Only that there is such a freedom is postulated the moral law. How freedom is possible no human intelligence will ever fully fathom. That freedom is uu,,,")HJ>L. on the other hand, no sophistry will ever wrest from the conviction of even the com­ monest man. It will be said that the solution here proposed to the problem of freedom involves great difficulty. But is any other solution easier and more intelligible?

and Thus far Kant presentation of what is A transition from moral philosophy to theology in moral comes about connection with his account of two other of morality. One of these postulates we have free will. But there are is perhaps as well to let Kant -'L"I--'-"'--'-"-

The immortality of the soul is also a postulate of the moral law. a postulate I mean a theoretical proposition, not demonstrable as such, but which is an inseparable result of an unconditional, a priori, practical (i.e., moral) law. The connection is this. The moral law commands the accordance of the will with it. This must be possible, since it is commanded. But perfect accord�mce of the with the moral law is a perfection of which no rational being of the sensible world is capable at any moment of his existence. Since, ��"�=,_,_.," it is com­ manded, it can only be realized in an infinite progression toward that perfect dccor­ dance. Now, this endless progress is only 1-,'Voc:au�c on the supposition of an endless duration of the existence and personality of the same rational being. This is called the immortality of the soul. The highest good for man, the perfect accord of his will with the moral law, is only possible on the supposition of the immortality of the soul. Consequently, this immortality, being inseparably connected with the moral law, is a postulate of pure practical reason. For a rational but finite being, the only thing possible is an endless progress from the lower to higher degrees of perfection. ... And thus he may hope, not indeed here nor at any imaginable point of his future existence, but only the endlessness of his duration, to be perfectly adequate in his will. in an This principle of the moral destination of our nature, namely, that it is endless progress that we can attain perfect accordance with the moral law, is of the greatest use, not merely for supplementing the impotence of speculative reason, but also with respect to religion.

down does he infer free will

but he also infers the exis-

THE CATEGORICAL IMPERATIVE

tence of God, not as a proot but as a postulate that reason allows him to make. His argument continues: The existence of God is also a postulate of the moral law. We proceed to exhibit this connection in a convincing manner. Happiness is the condition of a rational being in the world with whom every. thing goes according to his wish and will. It rests, thus, on the harmony of physical nature with his ends and purposes. But the rational being in the world is not the cause of the world and of physical nature. There is, therefore, not the least ground in the moral law for any necessary connection between morality (i.e., virtue) and pro­ portionate happiness. To repeat: In a being that belongs to the world as part of it, is therefore depen­ dent on it,. and for that reason cannot by his will be a cause of nature nor by his power make it completely harmonize, as far as his happiness is concerned, with his practical (i.e., moral) principles, in such a being there is not the least ground for any connection between morality and proportionate happiness. Therefore, the summum bonum, the union of virtue and happiness, is possible in the world only on the supposition of a Supreme Being having a causality correspond­ ing to moral character. Accordingly, the existence of a cause of nature, distinct from nature itself, and containing the principle of this connection, this exact harmony of happiness with morality, is postulated. Now, a being that is capable of acting on the conception of laws is an intelli­ gence, and the causality of such a being according to this conception of laws, is his will. Therefore, the supreme cause of nature, which must be presupposed as a condi­ tion of the summum bonum (the union of virtue and happiness) is a being who is the cause of nature by intelligence and will, that is, its author; that is, God. Now, in as much as it is a duty for us to promote the summum bonum, it is not merely allowable but a duty to presuppose the possibility of this summum bonum. And so, as this is possible only on condition of the existence of God, it is morally necessary1 it is a matter of duty, to assume the existence of God. The postulates of immortality, freedom, and the existence of God, all proceed from the principle of morality which is itself not a postulate but a law, an impera­ tive....These postulates are not theoretical dogmas, but suppositions practically nec­ essary, i.e., required in the interest of practice. While they do not extend our specula­ tive knowledge, they do give it a right to conceptions the possibility of which it could not otherwise venture to affirm ... . Thus respect for the moral law leads, through these postulates, to conceptions which speculation might indeed present as problems but could never solve.

By way of conclusion it might be well to repeat the main turns of Kant's argument. He begins by assuming that a rational morality is the only morality. He shows that this means categorical and a priori. This enables him to eliminate three misleading conceptions-that it is a matter of feelings, that it is a matter of conse­ quences, that it is a matter of agreeing with God's will, since on these counts it would be neither categorical nor a priori. He returns again to the conception of rational morality as categorical and a priori, and formulates its principle. This cen­ tral thesis he then works over in terms of the notion of ought or duty, and in terms of the good will. These considerations raise the problem of free will. He sharpens

JOHN STUART MILL

311

the point of this problem. He then reaches back to his theory of knowledge for justification of the claim that free will "may be so." He returns, finally, to the con­ ception of morality as necessitating free will as a postulate. There his moral phi­ losophy proper stops, and his theology begins. Kant's moral philosophy, we think, contains some of the soundest and most clarifying analyses to be found anywhere in the history of human thought. Norn ON SOURCES. The materials in this section are quoted, abridged, or para­ phrased from Immanuel Kant, Lectures on Ethics, translated by Louis Infield (New York: Century, 1930); Fundamental Principles of the Metaphysics of Morals, translated by Thomas K. Abbott (Indianapolis: Bobbs-Merrill Co., 1949); and Critique of Practical Reason, translated by Lewis White Beck (Chicago: University of Chicago Press, 1949).

3

JOHN STUART MILL

THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS

FROM KANT TO MILL. Our subject is still the principle of morality. In 1785, Paley published his Principles of Moral and Political Philosophy in which he attempted to ground morality in theology, to distinguish between right and wrong by refer­ ence to God's will. In that same year, Kant published Fundamental Principles of the Metaphysics of Morals, the first in a cluster of works in which he argued that moral­ ity is categorical and a priori, that it is not grounded in anything, but "stands on its own feet." In Kant we have a complete antithesis to the position represented by Paley. Four years later, in 1789, Jeremy Bentham (1748-1832), the "father of utilitarianism," published his foundational work on utilitarian theory, Introducil, m to the Principles of Morals and Legislation. He criticized the positions represented by Paley and Kant, and argued that the rightness of an act must not be divorced from its consequences, from its tendency to augment or diminish human happi­ ness. In his view, right means maximizing the happiness of humankind. One of his disciples was James Mill (1773-1836) whose son, John Stuart Mill (1806-1873), became a renowned interpreter, defender, and reviser of Bentham's utilitarian­ ism. A brief exposure to Bentham's thought can provide a valuable introduction to Mill's discussion. Bentham's major interest was the reformation of society's laws and institu­ tions so that the wretched conditions of the masses created by the Industrial Revolution and so clearly evident in Bentham's England would be ameliorated. With that goal in mind, he developed his moral philosophy. His starting point was an affirmation of psychological hedonism, which claims that all human beings are so constituted that they in fact always seek to attain pleasure and avoid pain. From this alleged fact about human nature, Bentham derived two major insights. First, the pursuit of pleasure and the avoidance of pain can be regarded as the standard of right and wrong. Accordingly, Bentham formulated

THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS

the principle of utility as the foundational standard of his moral perspective. ''Bv the principle of utility/' he wrote, "is meant that principle which approves or di;. approves of every action whatsoever, according to the tendency which it appears to have to augment or diminish the happiness of the party whose interest is in questio� ... " Second, pleasures an� pa�ns ca:1 be used a� the stimuli to nudge and entice people to generate a society m which the happiness of humankind is being pursued. Both of these insights required, for their application, the capacity to ass the quantity of pleasure and/or pain a given action is likely to generate. In order to evaluate acts as right or wrong, one must be able to calculate the amount of net pleasure or net pain those acts are likely to produce. In addition, in order to deploy pleasure-producing acts and pain-producing acts as effective sanctions for the building of a more truly happy society, one must be able to calculate and pre� diet the amount of net pleasure or pain those acts are likely to generate. To accomplish such calculations, Bentham devised his hedonistic calculus. Step-by., step this calculus seeks to reduce diverse pleasures and pains to comparable quantities so that various acts can be legitimately compared and rational deci� sions made. Here is how Bentham described it: Pleasures then, and the avoidance of pains, are the ends which the legislator has in view: it behooves him therefore to understand their value. Pleasures and pains are the instruments he has to work with: it behooves him therefore to understand their force, which is again, in other words, their value. To a person considered by himself the value of a pleasure or pain considered by itsel!t will be greater or less, according to the four following circumstances. 1. 2. 3. 4.

Its intensity. Its duration. Its certainty or uncertainty. Its propinquity or remoteness.

These are the circumstances which are to be considered in estimating a pleasure or a pain considered each of them by itself. But when the value of any pleasure or pain is considered for the purpose of estimating the tendency of any act by which it is produced, there are two other circumstances to be taken into account; these are, 5. Its fecundity, or the chance it has of being followed by sensations of the same kind; that is, pleasures, if it be a pleasure; pains, if it be a pain. 6. Its purity, or the chance it has of not being followed by sensations of the opposite kind: that is, pains, if it be a pleasure: pleasures, if it be a pain. These two last, however, are in strictness scarcely to be deemed properties of the pleasures or the pain itself; they are not therefore, in strictness to be taken into the account of the value of that pleasure or that pain. They are in strictness to be deemed properties only of the act, or other event by which such pleasure or pain has been produced; and accordingly are only to be taken into the account of the tendency of such act or such event. To a number of persons, with reference to each of whom the value of a pleasure or a pain is considered, it will be greater or less according to seven circumstances: to wit, the six preceding ones ... and one other: to wit:

JOHN STUART MILL

313

7. Its extent; that is, the number of persons to whom it extends; or (in other words) who are affected by it. To take an exact account then of the general tendency of any act, by which the interests of a community are affected, proceed as follows. Begin with any one person of those whose interests seem most immediately to be affected by it; and take an account, 1. Of the value of each distinguishable pleasure which appears to be produced by it in the first instance. 2. Of the value of each pain which appears to be produced by it in the first instance. 3. Of the value of each pleasure which appears to be produced by it after the first. This constitutes the fecundity of the first pleasure and the impurity of the first pain. 4. Of the value of each pain which appears to be produced by it after the first. This constitutes the fecundity of the first pain, and the impurity of the first pleasure. 5. Sum up all the values of all the pleasures on the one side, and those of all the pains on the other. The balance, if it be on the side of pleasure, will give the good ten­ dency of the act upon the whole, with respect to the interests of the individual per­ son; if on the side of pain, the bad tendency of it upon the whole. 6. Take an account of the number of persons whose interests appear to be concerned; and repeat the above process with respect to each. Sum up the numbers expressive of the degrees of good tendency, which the act has, with respect to each individual, in regard to whom the tendency of it is good upon the whole; do this again with respect to each individual, in regard to whom the tendency of it is bad upon the whole. Take the balance; which, if on the side of pleasure will give the general good tendency of the act, with respect to the total number of community individual con­ cerned; if on the side of pain the general evil tendency, with respect to the same community.

By this calculus Bentham believed he was rescuing morality from fickle senti­ ments and personal preferences, and grounding it in rational considerations. Serious questions, however, were raised about his enterprise. Is the calculus al all practical? Is there sufficient time to apply the calculus to the pressing moral prob­ lems of daily life? Can one predict the consequences of any act with precision? Are not some pleasures intrinsically more desirable than others? Furthermore, does not the appeal to happiness rather than an appeal to the will of God make utilitar­ ianism a godless doctrine? Moreover, is it really acceptable to base the rightness of an action on the consequences to the exclusion of the agent's motive? Questions such as these led Mill to interpret, defend, and modify Bentham's position. BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. John Stuart Mill grew up in the group that included Jeremy Bentham, James Mill (father of J. S.), T. R. Malthus, David Ricardo, George Grote, and others. These men were interested primarily in political, economic, and social reform. They were the driving force behind the first Reform Bill, the early Factory Acts, and so on. They were known, in their own day, as the Utilitarians and as the Philosophical Radicals. "Utilitarian" refers to the fact that they asked of any law, custom, or institution, "What is its utility? Of what use is it?" If no answer were forthcoming, beyond some vague statement about its prestige or its long standing, they proposed to scrap it. "Philosophical Radical" refers to the fact that they aimed

THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS

to go to the roots of things, the word root being English for the Latin word radix. The root to which these men proposed to go was human happiness. That, for them, was the"root question" to be addressed to any law, custom, or instituti For the most part they did not spend time seeking to justify this principle. T task J. S. Mill undertook to do. They applied the principle that right means"pro­ ducing human happiness/' or"being maximally productive of human happiness.� He undertook to clarify and defend the principle in his book Utilitarianism. M of his other writings are related to his Utilitarianism. Thus, in his essay" Liberty," written a few years before his Utilitarianism, but based on the princip subsequently given in the later book, he argued that the greatest happiness of greatest number is more likely to be achieved by allowing as much freedom thought and action as possible. In his treatise"Considerations on Representati Government/' he argued that government by elected representatives would of a better guarantee of human happiness than government by monarchs or arist crats. In his monograph The Subjection of Women he argued that the purpose of re resentative government was, in part, frustrated by refusing votes to women. T range and sincerity of his writings have given him great influence in the past hu dred years. (For other biographical notes, see Chapter 5, Section 4 and Chapter Section 5.) THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Mill's exposition and defense of the appeal t happiness as the basis of morality moves through five turns. He first states th problem: What is the basis or principle of morality? He then explores two"fal leads," and shows grounds for rejecting them. He then states his own position some length. He then asks the question: Is this belief open to any kind of proof disproof? and answers as best he can. He turns then to a review of objections a misunderstandings that he knows will be brought against his claim. These seeks to answer. With this accomplished, he is in a position to say,"I have pos an age-long problem. I have criticized two widely held theories. I have advanc my own answer. I have shown what sort of proof it is amenable to. I have stat and removed as many objections as I can think of. My case rests." His Utilitarianism begins as follows: There are few circumstances more significant of the backward states of speculatio than the little progress which has been made in the controversy respecting the crite rion of right and wrong. From the dawn of philosophy the question concerning the foundation of moral ity has been accounted the main problem in speculative thought has occupied th most gifted intellects, and divided them into sects and schools carrying on a vigorou warfare against one another. After more than two thousand years the same di scussions continue. Philosophers are still ranged under the same contending banners. Neither thinkers nor mankind at large seem nearer to agreement than when the youthful Socrates lis­ tened to the old Protagoras.

The problem is now before us: What is the foundation of morality? He pro­ poses to examine two familiar answers. The first of these is the observation that

JOHN STUART MILL

315

this is a matter of personal opinion. Thus one reads the remarks, "There's nothing right or wrong, but thinking makes it so." "Right you are, if you think you are." That is, an act is right if you, or the community, or all mankind, think it is; right and wrong are mere matters of opinion, are merely subjective. There are many different ways of stating this notion. Of all moralists who hold this view Mill says: They all, in one phrase or another, place the test of right and wrong in a feeling of approval or disapproval ... they find certain feelings of approval and disapproval in themselves ... a great part of all the ethical reasoning in books and in the world is of this sort.

His criticism of this appeal to moral feeling to settle the matter is short and pointed: All experience shows that "moral feelings" are eminently artificial and the product of culture; that the most senseless and pernicious "feelings" can be raised to the utmost intensity by inculcation, as hemlock and thistles could be reared to luxuriant growth by sowing them instead of wheat. Things which have been really believed by all mankind have been proved to be false, as that the sun rises and sets. Can immunity from similar error be claimed for the "moral feelings"? I do not found the morality of actions upon anybody's opinion or feeling of them. I found it upon facts.

"What facts?" we ask. Let us first glance at another doctrine: the appeal to nature. A thing is right, it will be said, if it is according to nature, if it is natural; wrong, if it is contrary to nature, if it is unnatural. We will inquire into the truth of the doctrines which make nature a test of and wrong, good and evil, or which in any mode or degree attach merit or approval to following, imitating, or obeying nature. A reference to that supposed standard is the predominant ingredient in the vein of thought and feeling which was open,:d by Rousseau, and which has infiltrated itself most widely into the modern mind. That any mode of thinking, feeling, or acting is according to nature" is usually accepted as a strong argument for its goodness. If it can be said, with any plausibility, that nature enjoins" anything, the propriety of obeying the injunction is considered to be made out. And, conversely, the imputation of being contrary to nature" is thought to bar the thing so designated from being tolerated or excused. It is thought that nature affords some criterion of what we ought to do. 11

11

11

Mill's handling of the appeal to nature is a good example of condensed refu­ tation. He first points out that the term nature, or the phrase according to nature, is ambiguous. He states that the two senses in which it might be used. He then shows that, given the first sense, the appeal to nature is meaningless; and, given the second sense, it is irrational and immoral. The word nature has two principal meanings: it either denotes the entire system of things, with the aggregate of all their properties, or it denotes things as they would be, apart from human intervention. Such being the two principal senses of the word nature, in which of these is it taken when the word and its derivatives are used to convey ideas of commendation, approval, and even moral obligation?

THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS

In the first of these senses, the doctrine that man ought to follow nature is unmeaning, since man has no power to do anything else than follow nature; all his actions are done through, and in obedience to, some one or many of nature's physical or mental laws. In the other sense of the term, the doctrine that man ought to follow nature , or in other words, ought to make the spontaneous course of things the model of his vol­ untary actions, is equally irrational and immoral. Irrational, because all human action whatever, consists in altering, and all useful action, in improving the spontaneous course of nature. Immoral, because the course of natural phenomena being replete with everything which when committe d by human beings is most worthy of abhorrence, any one who endeavored in his actions to imitate the natural course of things would be universally seen and acknowledged to be the wickedest of men. The doctrine that the existing order of things is the natural order, and that, being natural, all innovation upon it is criminal, is vicious. Conformity to nature has no con­ nection whatever with right and wrong. The idea can never be fitly introduced into ethical discussions at all. That a thing is unnatural is no argument for it being blamable.

At this point we may give Mill's own position. We have now two alternatives with which to compare it. He says: All action is for the sake of some end, and rules of action must take their whole char­ acter and color from the end to which they are subservient. The creed which accepts the greatest happiness principle as the foundation of morals holds that actions are right in proportion as they tend to promote happiness, wrong as they tend to produce the reverse of happiness. By happiness is intended pleasure, and the absence of pain; by unhappiness, pain, and the privation of plea­ sure. This theory I propose to expound and defend. The standard is not the agent's own greatest happiness, but the greatest amount of happiness altogether. As between his own happiness and that of others, utilitarian­ ism requires him to be as strictly impartial as a disinterested and benevolent spectator. The test of morality is not the greatest happiness of the agent himself. Utilitar­ ianism does not dream of defining morality to be the self-interest of the agent. The greatest happiness principle is the greatest happiness of mankind and of all sentient creatures. He who does anything for any other purpose than to increase the amount of happiness in the world is no more deserving of admiration than the ascetic mounted on his pillar. He may be an inspiring proof of what men can do, but assuredly not an example of what they should do. Pleasure and freedom from pain are the only things desirable as ends, and all desirable things are desirable either for the pleasure inherent in them or as means to the promotion of pleasure and the prevention of pain.

Mill has stated that morality is a matter of consequences. An act is right or wrong, according to its consequences, not because it agrees with someone's opin­ ion, or with universal opinion, or with nature, or (by implication) with God's will. He pauses a moment to elaborate this point: By "calculating the consequences" is meant, generally, calculating the consequences of classes of actions. There are, as we shall note, exceptions to this, but over all we

JOHN STUART MILL

317

must look at actions as though multiplied, and in large masses. Take murder for example. There are many persons, to kill whom would be to remove men who are a cause of no good to any human being, who are a cause of cruel physical and moral suffering to several, and whose whole influence tends to increase the mass of unhap­ piness and vice. Were such a man to be murdered, the balance of traceable conse­ quences would be greatly in favor of the act. But, the counter consideration, still on the principle of utility, is that unless persons were punished for killing, and taught not to kill, nobody's life would be safe. We say,"generally," not "universally." For the admission of exceptions to rules is a necessity equally felt in all systems of morality. To take an obvious instance: The rule against homicide, the rule against deceiving, the rule against taking advantage of superior strength, are suspended against enemies in the field and partially against malefactors in private life. In each case, the rule is suspended as far as is required by the peculiar nature of the case. That the moralities arising from special circumstances of the action may be so important as to over-rule those arising from the class of acts to which it belongs, is a liability common to all ethical systems. The existence of exceptions to moral rules is no stumbling block peculiar to the principle of utility. The essential is that the exception should itself be a general rule; so that, being definite, and not left to the partial judgment of the individual, it might not shake the stability of the wider rule in the cases to which the reason of the excep­ tion does not extend. This is an ample foundation for"the construction of a scheme of morality." With respect to the means of inducing people to conform in their actions to the scheme so formed, the utilitarian system depends, like all other schemes of morality, on the external motives supplied by law and opinion and the internal motives pro­ duced by education or reason.

The greatest happiness principle is now before us. Is the principle c_;pen to any kind of proof? Mill's answer amounts to a denial. The rationale of this denial is as follows: Of what sort of proof is this principle of the greatest happiness susceptible? It is evident that it cannot be proof in the ordinary and popular meaning of the term. Questions of ultimate ends are not amenable to direct proof. Whatever can be proved to be good must be shown to be a means to something admitted to be good without proof. The medical art is proved to be good by its conducing to health. But how is it possible to prove that health is good? The art of music is good, for the reason among others, that it produces pleasures. But what proof is it possible to give that pleasure is good? No comprehensive formula, including all things good in themselves and not as means to things good in themselves, is a subject of what is commonly meant by proof. It may be accepted or rejected, but not proved in the usual sense of that term. There is a larger meaning of the word proof in which this question of ultimate principles is as amenable to proof as any other of the disputed questions of philoso­ phy. The subject is within the cognizance of the rational faculty. Its acceptance or rejection does not depend on blind impulse or arbitrary choice.

The problem has been stated. False solutions have been exposed. His own solution has been given. The meaning of proof in these matters has been made

THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS

clear. He turns to objections that may be raised. A study of these objections a replies will clarify and fix the doctrine in one's mind. It may not be superfluous to notice a few of the common misapprehensions of u tarian ethics, even those which are so obvious and gross that it might appear impo ble for any person of candor and intelligence to fall into them.

The first objection is that such a moral philosophy is a godless doctrine: Utilitarianism is a godless doctrine. The appeal to happiness, instead of the appeal the will of God, is a godless, i.e., irreligious, principle of morality.

Mill's answer is to carry the war into the enemy's camp: The question [whether the appeal to happiness is a godless doctrine] depends u what idea we have formed of the moral character of the Deity. If it be a true b that God desires above all things the happiness of His creatures, and that this was purpose in their creation, then utilitarianism is not only not a godless doctrine, more profoundly religious than any other. Although the existence of God as a wise and just lawgiver is not a neces part of the feelings of morality, it may still be maintained that those feelings His existence eminently desirable. No doubt they do, and that is the great re why we find that good men and women cling to the belief and are pained by being questioned. If the objection [that utilitarianism is a godless doctrine] means the utilitariani does not recognize the revealed will of God as the supreme law of morals, I ans An utilitarian who believes in the perfect goodness and wisdom of God, necessa believes that whatever God has thought fit to reveal on the subject of morals m fulfill the requirements of utilitarianism in a supreme degree.

A second objection: To suppose that life has no higher end than pleasure, no better and nobler object o desire and pursuit is utterly mean and groveling; a doctrine worthy only of swine.

Mill's answer: This supposes that human beings are capable of no pleasure except those of which swine are capable. If this supposition were true, the charge could not be denied; but it would then be no charge, for if the sources of pleasure were precisely the same f human beings and for swine, then the rule of life which is good enough for the on would be good enough for the other. The comparison is felt to be degrading precisely because a beast's pleasures d not satisfy a human being's conception of happiness. Human beings have faculti more elevated than the animal appetites, and do not regard anything as happine which does not include their gratification.

A third objection: That utilitarianism [the appeal to the pleasure-pain consequences of action] renders men cold and unsympathizing; that it chills their moral feelings toward individuals; that it makes them regard only the consequences of actions, not taking into account the personal qualities from which those actions emanate.

JOHN STUART MILL

319

Mill's answer: If this means that utilitarians do not allow their judgment concerning the rightness or wrongness of an act to be influenced by their opinion of the quality of the person who does it, then it is a complaint not against utilitarianism but against having any standard of morality at all. For certainly no known ethical standard decides an action to be good or bad because it is done by a good or bad man; still less because it is done by an amiable, brave, or benevolent man, or the contrary. These considerations are relevant, not to the estimation of actions, but of persons; and there is nothing in utili­ tarianism inconsistent with the fact that there are other things which interest us in persons besides the rightness or wrongness of their actions. The stoic moralists, indeed were fond of saying that he who has virtue has everything. But no claim of this description is made for the virtuous man by the utili­ tarian moralist. There are other desirable possessions and qualities besides virtue. A right action does not necessarily indicate a virtuous character. Actions that are blam­ able often proceed from qualities entitled to praise. When this is so in any particular case, it modifies one's moral estimation of the agent, but not of the act.

A fourth objection is that the morality of an action depends upon the motive, not upon the consequences. Mill answers: As to motive, the utilitarian position is this: Motive has nothing to do with the moral­ ity of the action, though much with the worth of the agent. He who saves a fellow creature from drowning does what is morally right, whether his motive be duty or the hope of being paid for his trouble.

A fifth objection: A stock argument against utilitarianism consists in saying that an utilitarian 1\ ill be apt to make his own particular case an exception to moral rules, and when under temptation, will see an utility in the breach of a rule, greater than he will see in its observance.

Mill's answer: But is utilitarianism the only creed which is able to furnish us with excuses for evil doing and means of cheating our own conscience? They are afforded in abundance by all doctrines which recognize as a fact in morals the existence of conflicting consid­ erations; which all doctrines do that have been believed by sane persons. It is not the fault of any creed, but of the complicated nature of human affairs, that rules of conduct cannot be so framed as to require no exceptions, and that hardly any kind of action can safely be laid down as either always obligatory or always con­ demnable. There is no ethical creed which does not temper its laws by giving a certain lati­ tude, under the moral responsibility of the agent, for accommodation to peculiarities of circumstances. At the opening thus made, self-deception and dishonest casuistry get in. There exists no moral system under which cases of conflicting obligation do not arise. These are the real difficulties, the knotty points, both in a theory of ethics and in the conscientious guidance of personal conduct. But is any one less qualified to deal with cases of conflicting obligations by reason of the fact that he possesses an ultimate standard to which such cases can be referred?

0

THE MAXIMIZATION OF HAPPINESS

A sixth objection: Utilitarianism is only an appeal to expedience, and an appeal to expedience is not high morally as an appeal to principle.

Mill's answer: The objection rests on a loose use of the term expedience. Generally, the expedient mea that which is expedient for the particular interests of the agent himself; as when a tni ister of state sacrifices the interests of his country to keep himself in place. The ex ent in this sense is a branch of the hurtful; and to claim that utilitarianism is an ap to the expedient, in this sense, is simply to misunderstand or misrepresent its meani Utilitarianism does recognize in human beings the power of sacrificing their 0 greatest good for the good of others. I must repeat again, what critics seldom have justice to acknowledge, that the happiness which forms the standard of what is ri in conduct, is not the agent's own happiness but the happiness of all concerned. Utilitarianism does, however, refuse to admit that sacrifice of one's own good itself a good. A sacrifice which does not increase the sum of happiness is wasted. only sacrifice which utilitarianism applauds is that which is made in the interests the happiness either of mankind or of individuals within the limits imposed by interests of mankind.

A seventh objection: Happiness cannot be the rational purpose of life, because it is unattainable.

Mill's answer: This objection, were it well founded, would go to the root of the matter; for if no hap� piness is to be had at all by human beings, the attainment of it cannot be the end morality. However, the assertion that it is impossible that human life be happy is an exaggeration. If by happiness be meant a continuity of highly pleasurable excitement, it is evi, dent that this is impossible. A state of exalted pleasure lasts only for a few momenb, or in some cases for somewhat longer periods. If this kind of intense rapture be meant by happiness, then happiness is unattainable. But this is not what philosophers have meant by happiness when they taught that happiness was the end of life. The happiness which they meant was not a life of rapture, but moments of such in an existence made up of few transitory pains, many and various pleasures, with a decided predominance of the active over the passive, and having as the foundation not to expect more from life than it is capable of bestowing. A life thus composed, to those who have been fortunate enough to obtain it, has always appeared worthy of the name of happiness. And such an existence is even now the lot of many.

An eighth objection: We cannot calculate all the consequences of any action and thus cannot estimate the degree in which it promotes human happiness.

Mill's answer: Is there any department of human affairs in which we can do all that is desirable? Because we cannot foresee everything, is there no such thing as foresight? Can no

JOHN STUART MILL

321

estimate be formed of consequences, which would be any guide for our conduct, unless we can calculate all consequences? Because we cannot predict every effect which may follow from a person's death, are we to say that we cannot know that murder would be destructive to human happiness? Whether morality is or is not a question of consequences, it cannot be denied that prudence is a question of conse­ quences, and if there is such a thing as prudence, it is because the consequences of actions can be calculated.

A ninth objection: There is not time, previous to action, for calculating and weighing the effects of any line of conduct on the general happiness.

Mill's answer: This is exactly as if any one were to say that it is impossible to guide our conduct by Christianity, because there is not time, on every occasion on which everything has to be done, to read through the Old and New Testaments. The answer to the objection is that there has been ample time, namely, the whole past duration of the human species. During all that time mankind have been learning by experience the tendencies of action; on which experience all the pru­ dence, as well as all the morality, of life is dependent. Nobody argues that the art of navigation is not founded on astronomy, because sailors cannot wait to calculate the nautical almanac. Being rational creatures, they go to sea with it ready calculated, and all rational creatures go out upon the sea of life with their minds made up on the common questions of right and wrong. There is no difficulty in proving any ethical standard whatever to work ill, if we suppose universal idiocy to be conjoined with it, but on any hypothesis short of that, mankind must by this time have acquired positive beliefs as to the effecls of some actions on their happiness. To inform a traveler respecting the place of his ultimate destination is not to forbid the use of landmarks and direction posts on the way.

A tenth objection: If happiness is made the ultimate standard by which other things are judged to be good or bad, then we are not in a position to distinguish among kinds of happiness with respect to their goodness or badness.

Mill's answer: It is quite compatible with the principle of utility to recognize the fact that some kinds of pleasure are more desirable and more valuable than others. It would be absurd that while, in estimating all other things, quality is considered as well as quantity, the esti­ mation of pleasures should be supposed to depend on quantity alone. Of two pleasures, if there be one to which all or almost all who have experience of both give a decided preference, irrespective of any feeling of moral obligation to prefer it, that is the more desirable pleasure. Now it is an unquestionable fact that those who are equally acquainted with, and equally capable of appreciating the enjoying, both, do give a most marked pref­ erence to the manner of existence which employs their higher faculties. It is better to be a human being dissatisfied than a pig satisfied; better to be Socrates dissatisfied than a fool satisfied. And if the fool, or the pig, is of a different opinion, it is because

l22

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY they know only their side of the question. The other party to the comparison knows both sides. Few human creatures would consent to be changed into any of the lower anj. mals for a promise of the fullest allowance of an animal's pleasures. No intelligent human being would consent to be a fool, no instructed person would consent to be an ignoramus, no person of feeling and conscience would consent to be selfish and base, even though they should be persuaded that the fool, the dunce or the rascal is better satisfied with his lot than they are with theirs. From this verdict of the only competent judges, I apprehend there can be no appeal. On the question which of two pleasures is the best worth having, which of two modes of existence is the most grateful to the feelings, the judgment of those who are qualified by knowledge of both must be admitted as final. ... There is no other tribunal to be referred to.

Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted, abridged, or para­ phrased from John Stuart Mill's, "Nature" and from Chapters 1, 2, and 4 of his Utilitarianism (London: Longmans, Green, & Co., 1901); and Jeremy Bentham, Principles of Morals and Legislation (Darien, CT: Hafner Publishing Co., 1970).

ZJ

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

FROM MILL TO NIETZSCHE. We have examined three attempts to formulate !he principle of morality, to state what makes a right act right. Paley found the right­ ness of an act to depend upon its agreement with the will of God. Kant denied that the rightness of an act depended upon anything, asserting that an act if right, is so categorically, without reference to anything outside of itself. Mill found the rightness of an act to depend upon its consequences, those conse­ quences being the amount of happiness that it brought about. Each of these moralists assumed that he was articulating a moral norm that possessed univer­ sality, that was applicable to all persons regardless of time and place. Our fourth moralist, Friedrich Nietzsche, challenges that assumption. For him, there are many moralities, and the chief task confronting the moral philosopher is not to generate one universal morality with its basic principle that specifies what makes a right act right but rather to construct a history of the development of these var­ ious moralities and to identify, if possible, the types or kinds of morality that have appeared in the course of human history. As a cultural historian in the last half of the nineteenth century, Nietzsche wrote at a time when anthropology was being established as a separate disci­ pline. Cultural diversity was receiving careful study. Nietzsche became aware of the kinds of considerations that lead people to adopt a relativistic position in ethics. Ethical relativism claims that there are no universal cross-cultural moral norms; rather, there are only the moral norms that a particular society establishes and those norms vary greatly from society to society. To support their claims, eth-

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

323

ical relativists cite a number of factors. First, they note the great diversity in moral beliefs and practices, assuming that if there were universal moral norms, then people would surely be aware of them and a strong measure of moral uniformity would appear throughout human cultures. Since relativists discern no such uni­ formity, they conclude that cross-cultural universal moral norms do not exist. Second, they note that our moral beliefs and practices are acquired through enculturation, and that our society derived them from its past ancestors who fashion them as useful devices to aid in the struggle for survival and pleasure. Things that promoted survival and pleasure came to be called good or right, and things that detracted from survival and occasioned pain came to be called evil or wrong. Because ancestral environmental struggles varied from society to society, the resulting moral beliefs and practices also differed from culture to culture. Third, relativists often label as ethnocentric (being inordinately proud of one's culture to the disparagement of other cultures) the claims of those who believe they have identified a universal moral norm that is applicable to all people regardless of time and place. Finally, a number of methodological issues are often urged by relativists in support of their doctrine, such as the difficulty in generat­ ing universally accepted meanings for such terms as good as well as the difficulty in devising a strategy for justifying moral claims that would be acceptable to all cultures. Nietzsche would regard the efforts of Paley, Kant, and Mill to articulate a universal moral norm as human, all too human/' fatally flawed efforts to philos­ ophize as if one were not a culturally conditioned creature whose ideas invariably bear the mark of a specific society's enculturation. Nietzsche declares the relativ­ ity of all moralities and, at the same time, celebrates the values of the "self-tran­ scending person/' the ovennan/' the" superman." 11

11

BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. Friedrich Nietzsche was born in Germany in 1844 drtd died in 1900 at the age of fifty-six. He was born into a puritanicat religious family and was intended by his parents to enter the church. To this end he was educated pri­ vately and at a denominational school. While at the university in Bonn he broke completely with his family in doctrinal matters. He moved on to the university at Leipzig. There he met Wagner, the German composer, and became a fervent Wagnerite. He discovered Schopenhauer's writings in a second-hand bookshop and became a convinced Schopenhauerian. He met Erwin Rhode, the historian of Greek culture, and became engrossed in the problems and perspectives of the cultural history of mankind. He did military service for a year in a war with Austria, returning to the University of Leipzig to complete his studies. The fol­ lowing year he was appointed to the chair of classical philology in the university at Bale, received his Ph.D., and began work on his important book The Birth of Tragedy. The next year, 1870, he was called once more into military service in the Franco-Prussian War, which had just begun. He was head of an ambulance corps, but did only three weeks' service. Diphtheria ended his military career. He returned to the university at Bale and resumed lectures. For eight years he remained at this work. During this period he was arriving at conclusions that

24

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

formed the basis of his future writings. He published The Birth of Tragedy. It met with a chilly reception. His prestige began to decline. His next book, Thoughts Out of Season, continued four essays in which he criticized Strauss, Schopenhauer German historians, and others. Two years later for reasons of poor he alth h� retired on a small pension from the university. It should never be forgotten that Nietzsche was, first and last, a cultural his� torian; that is, he was interested in, and drew his inspiration from, the study of the cultures achieved by various peoples, ancient and modern. He wrote a series of books that develop really one theme. His investigations into humankind's cul­ tural history, understanding by the term culture such things as art, religion, sci­ ence, morality, government, and so on, impressed him with the enormous diver­ sity that has been obtained in these things at different times and places. But that was not all. He was equally impressed with the fact that cultural values are local and transitory affairs. He expressed this in the notion of the relativity of cultural values. By this he meant that cultural values are relative to time and place, rela­ tive to the needs peculiar to the peoples among whom they flourish. In other words, there is nothing eternal or absolute or immutable about them, and this, he felt, holds for values of all descriptions: religious, artistic, social, moral, scientific, and so on. On the rebound from his earlier orthodox training, he dismissed them with a great flourish of his pen in his book Human, All Too Human. That was his "great discovery." Values, one and all, are"human, all too human." The rest of his work may be described as a series of studies in the natural history of human val­ ues. Human, All Too Human, was followed by Dawn of Day, and it in turn by Joyful Wisdom. Clearly, a new note was being struck. What idea was Nietzsche working out in these books? It was something hke this: The cultural history of humankind shows that aristocratic qualities flourish in the early stages of a culture and disappear gradually as that culture becomes old. In Homer's time, the Greeks were "heroes"; by the time of Pericles and the Spartan war, they had become mere "sophists" and "philosophers" and ''scien­ tists." In early Roman history there were great kings who founded a race that conquered the ancient world, but centuries later, in the days of imperial decline, this nation of "strong1 silent men" had become helpless victims of their own weakening civilization and the new races of barbarians as yet "untouched" by such things. These newcomers swept over Europe, and another page in cultural history was begun, but with the same result. By the nineteenth century these "Germanic" peoples who had made over the civilization of ancient Rome had become democratic, even socialistic; they cultivated "science,""art,""morality" or (in some instances) decadent forms of"immortality," wealth, ease, the"emancipa­ tion of women," optimism, pessimism, philosophy, and so on. There is no quarreling with Nietzsche's likes and dislikes in these matters. The sight of Achilles sulking in his tent was simply something he admired more than the sight of Karl Marx sulking in the library of the British Museum. A Greek athlete or a Roman warrior was simply not in the same degenerate class with J. S. Mill pleading for representative government and the political enfranchisement of women, or Schopenhauer brooding over the misery and folly of human affairs.

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

325

Hence, the titles of his books. To "see through" modern degeneration was "the dawn of day," to realize that "real virtues" belong in the context of fresh and vig­ orous young cultures was the first step in "joyful wisdom." Nietzsche was carried away on the wings of this sort of thing. Lonely, poor, sickly, unpopular, a bachelor malgre lui, he nevertheless lived on in the private world of "transvalued values," heaping scorn on "art" and "science" and "morality" and "religion" and "emanci­ pation" and "democracy" and "socialism" and "humanitarianism." He poured his soul into the mold of one beautiful book, Thus Spake Zarathustra. This was the fine flower of his genius. Through the mouth of Zarathustra, the prophet of his doc­ trine, he preached and exhorted and satirized in pages of marvelous beauty and suggestiveness. But the nineteenth century passed Zarathustra by. Only a handful took the trouble to read him, and even these few were puzzled and disturbed. For their enlightenment, Nietzsche wrote two more books, Beyond Good and Evil and The Genealogy of Morals. They were intended as commentaries on Zarathustra. The substance of their argument is given in the passages that follow. The balance of Nietzsche's writings carry further the ideas presented already. The Zarathustra group was followed by The Twilight of the Idols, Antichrist, The Will to Power (unfin­ ished), and his own autobiography bearing the significant title Ecce Homo. In 1889, at the age of forty-five, Nietzsche lost the use of his mind. For the next eleven years he was caught in the toils of a steadily increasing insanity. In 1900 he died hopelessly insane. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. The following passages, chosen principally from Nietzsche's Beyond Good and Evil and The Genealogy of Morals, exhibit the fol­ lowing turns of thought. He begins by repudiating the whole notion of Lrying to formulate any principle of morality, in the sense that moralists have traditionally sought to do this. He insists that there is no such thing as morality having one fundamental principle running through it; that, on the contrary, there have been and are many moralities; and that any attempt to think philosophically about morality must begin by recognizing its diversity and the fact of its having had a history like any other phase of human culture. He propounds then a tentative natural history or genealogy of morals. From this he undertakes to draw some far-reaching conclusions. These he calls collectively his immoralism, or transvalua­ tion of values. One fundamental distinction, arising out of his account of the nat­ ural history of morals and forming the foundation of his immoralism, is that between master morality and slave morality. The characteristics of each he then describes at some length. The doctrine is now substantially complete. However, to illustrate it more concretely, he applies it in a critical way to two phenomena of modern morality, namely, the emancipation of woman and the close connection between modern morality and Christianity. He closes with a few reflections on his own significance. The opening passages are fundamental. In these Nietzsche draws the search­ ing distinction between accepting morality and trying to formulate its principle, and making moralities the subject of descriptive investigation. It is the historian of humanity's manifold cultures and cultural values who speaks:

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

Hitherto all moralists, with a pedantic and ridiculous seriousness, have wanted give a "basis" to morality, and each has believed that he has given this "basis" morality. Morality itself, however, has been regarded as something"given." That which moralists have called '' giving a basis to morality/' has proved me a learned form of good faith in prevailing morality, a new means of expressing vailing morality, consequently just a phenomenon within one definite morality, a of denial that it is lawful for this particular morality to be called in question. In case has the attempt to "provide a basis for morality" ever involved a testing, anal ing, doubting, and vivisecting of the prevailing moral faith. The philosophical workers, after the pattern of Kant and Hegel, have to fix systematize some existing body of valuations, that is to say, creations of value w have become prevalent and are for a time called "the truth." It is for these thinke make conspicuous, conceivable, intelligible, manageable what has happened been esteemed hitherto. Apart from the value of such assertions as there is a categorical imperative in we can always ask: "What does such an assertion indicate about him who makes it. Because moralists have known the moral facts imperfectly, in an arbitrary ome, perhaps the morality of their environment, their position, their church, t Zeitgeist, their climate; because they have been badly instructed with regar nations, eras, and past ages, and were by no means eager to know about these ters; precisely because of this fact, they did not even come in sight of the real pro lems of morality, problems which disclose themselves only to a comparison of man kinds of morality. There are systems of morals which are meant to justify their author in the eyes of other people; systems which are meant to tranquilize him and make him self-satis­ fied; systems which are meant to enable him to crucify and humble himself. By means of one system of morals, he wishes to take revenge; by means of another, to conceal himself; by means of another, to glorify himself and gain superiority and dis­ tinction. In short, systems of morals are only sign languages of the emotions. What is still necessary is the collection of material, the comprehensive survey and classification of sentiments of worth, distinctions of 11vorth, which live, grow1 propagate1 and perish; and the attempt1 perhaps1 to give a clear idea of the recurring and more common forms of these living crystallizations. This is necessary as prepara­ tion for a theory of types of morality.

So much as a start. The primary problem is not to formulate the principle of morality, but to recognize the existence and study the natural history of many moralities. An acquaintance with these matters, Nietzsche feels, will reveal the fact that genuine moralities arise from the presence in any group of an aristocratic or ruling-class element. He offers a hypothetical reconstruction of the natural his­ tory or genealogy of morals. Every elevation of the type "man" has hitherto been the work of an aristocratic soci­ ety1 and so it will always be; a society believing in a long gradation of rank and differ­ ences of worth among human beings, and requiring slavery in some form or other. Without the pathos of distance1 such as grows out of the difference of classes1 out of the constant outlooking and downlooking of the ruling class on subordinates and instruments1 out of the constant practice of obeying and commanding, out of keeping down and keeping at a distance, without these1 that other more mysterious pathos could never have arisen: the longing for the continued self-surmounting of man.

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

327

To be sure, one must cherish no humanitarian illusions about the origin of aris­ tocratic societies. The truth is hard. Every higher civilization has originated in bar­ barism. Men, barbarians in every respect, men of prey, still in possession of unbroken strength of will and desire for power, threw themselves upon weaker, more moral, more peaceful races, upon old mellow civilizations in which the final vital force was flickering out in brilliant fireworks of wit and depravity. In the beginnings, the noble caste was always the barbarian caste. The essential thing in a good and healthy aristocracy is that it should regard itself not as a function of the king or the people but as the significance and highest justification thereof; that it should accept with a clear conscience the sacrifice of a legion of individuals, who, for its sake, must be suppressed and reduced to imperfect men, to slaves and instruments. Its fundamental belief must be that society is not allowed to exist for its own sake, but only as a foundation and scaffolding by which a select class may be able to elevate themselves to their higher duties; like those climb­ ing, sun-seeking plants in Java which encircle a tree till, high above it but supported by it, they can unfold their tops in the open light and exhibit their happiness. Consider an aristocratic commonwealth, e.g., an ancient Greek city state, as a voluntary or involuntary contrivance for rearing human beings. There men are beside one another, thrown on their own resources, who want to make their species prevail, chiefly because they must prevail or be in danger of extermination. The favor, the abundance, the protection, are lacking under which variations are fostered. The species needs itself as species; as something which by its hardness, its uniformity, its simplicity of structure, can prevail in the struggle against neighbors or rebellious vas­ sals. Experience teaches it what are the qualities to which it owes its continued exis­ tence in spite of gods and men. These qualities it calls virtues, and these virtues alone it develops to maturity. These virtues it develops with severity. Every aristocratic morality is i1ttolerant in the education of its youth, in the control of its women, in the customs which con­ trol marriage, in the relations between old and young, in the penal laws (which have an eye only for the degenerating). It counts intolerance itself among the virtm:s. Thus is established a type, with few but very marked features. The constant struggle with unfavorable conditions is the cause of the type becoming stable and hard. Finally, however, a happy state of security results, and the enormous tension is relaxed. Perhaps there are no more enemies among neighboring peoples; perhaps the means of life and enjoyment are present in abundance. With one stroke the bond and constraint of the old discipline snaps. It is no longer regarded as a necessary condition of existence and survival. If it would continue, it can do so only as an archaizing "taste." Variations appear suddenly in the greatest exuberance and splendor. The individual dares to be individual and detach himself. At this turning point of history there manifest themselves a magnificent mani­ fold growth and an extraordinary decay, owing to the savagely opposed and seem­ ingly exploded egoisms which strive for "light and sun" and can no longer assign any limit or restraint to themselves by the hitherto existing morality. It was this morality itself which piled up the enormous strength, which bent the bow in so threatening a manner, but it is now out of date, or getting out of date. The dangerous and disquieting point has now been reached. The greater, more manifold, more comprehensive life now corning into existence is lived beyond the old morality. The individual" stands out and is obliged to have recourse to his own law 11

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

giving, his own arts and artifices for self-preservation, self-elevation, self-deliveranc Nothing but new ''whys"; nothing but new "hows." No longer any common form:� lae; misunderstanding and disregarded in league together, decay, deterioration, loftv desire, frightfully entangled; the genius of the race overflowing from all the cornu. copias of good and bad; new charms and mysteries peculiar to the still inexhausted ' still unwearied, corruption. Danger, the mother of morality, is present once more. This time the danger point has shifted into the individual, the neighbor, the friend; into the street, into their own child, into all the most personal and secret recesses of their desires and volitions. After the fabric of a society seems established and secure against external dan½ gers, it is the fear of our neighbor which creates new perspectives of moral evaluation. It is by the loftiest and strongest instincts, when they break out and carry the individual above and beyond the average, above and beyond the low level of the herd conscience, that the self-reliance of the community is destroyed: Its belief in itself breaks. Consequently these instincts will be most branded and most defamed. Strong and dangerous instincts, e.g., the love of enterprise, foolhardiness, revengefulness, astuteness, rapacity, love of power, which, up till then had to be hon­ ored and fostered and cultivated because required in the common dangers against common enemies, are now felt to be themselves dangerous, are gradually branded as immoral and given over to calumny. The opposite instincts and inclinations now attain to moral honor. The herd instinct gradually draws it conclusions. How much danger to the community or its equality is contained in an opinion, a condition, an emotion, a character, a disposition? That is now the moral perspective. Here again fear is the mother of morals. The lofty, independent spirit, the will to stand alone, are felt to be dangers. Everything that elevates the individual above the herd, and is a source of fear to the neighbor, is henceforth called evil. The tolerant, unassuming, self-adapting, self­ equalizing disposition, the middle-of-the-road desires, attain to moral distinction and honor. Under peaceful circumstances there is always less opportunity and less need for training the feelings to severity and rigor. Now every form of severity, even severity in justice, begins to disturb the conscience. A lofty and rigorous nobleness and self­ responsibility becomes now almost an offense. The man of an age of dissolution, of an age which mixes the races with one another; who has the inheritance of a diversified descent in his body, contrary instincts and standards of value which struggle among themselves and are seldom at peace; such a man, of late culture and broken lights, will, as a rule, be a weak man. His fundamental desire is that the war which is in him should come to an end. Happiness appears to him in the character of a soothing medicine and mode of thought; it is above all things the happiness of repose, of undisturbedness, of repeti­ tion, of final unity. All systems of morals which address themselves to "happiness" are only sugges­ tions for behavior adapted to the degree of danger from themselves in which the individuals live. They are thus recipes for their passions, their good and bad propen­ sities, insofar as the individuals would like to play the master. They are all so many small and great expediences, permeated with the musty odor of old family medicines and old wives' wisdom; all grotesque and absurd because they are generalizations where generalization is not justified.

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

329

The rank-and-file man assumes an air of being the only kind of man that is allowable. He glorifies, as the peculiarly human virtues, his qualities, such as public spirit, kindness, deference, industry, temperance, modesty, indulgence, sympathy (by virtue of which he is gentle, endurable, and useful to the herd). In cases where it is believed that a leader cannot be dispensed with, attempt after attempt is made to replace rulers by summing together clever herd-minded men. All representative constitutions, for example, are of this origin. There arises what I call the moral hypocrisy of the ruling class. They know no other way to protect themselves from bad conscience than to play the role of execu­ tors of older and higher orders. (Those "older and higher orders" may be predeces­ sors, the constitution, justice, the law, or God himself.) Or they even justify them­ selves by maxims drawn from the current opinions of the herd, as, for example, "the first servants of their people," or "instruments of public weal." The end is quickly approaching; everything decays and produces decay; noth­ ing will endure until the day after tomorrow; nothing, that is, except one species of man, the incurably mediocre. The mediocre alone have a prospect of continuing, of propagating themselves. They will be the men of the future, the sole survivors. "Be like them! Be mediocre!" is now the only morality which has still a significance or obtains a hearing. But it is difficult to preach this morality of mediocrity. It can never avow what it is and what it desires. It has to talk of "moderation" and "dignity," and "duty," and "brotherly love." It will have difficulty in concealing its irony! But this herding-animal morality is only one kind of morality, beside which, before which, and after which, many other moralities, above all, higher moralities, are or should be possible. Against such a possibility, this herd morality defends itself with all its strength. It says obstinately and inexorably: "I am morality, and nothing else is morality."

The first corollary that follows from Nietzsche's conception of the genealogy of morals is what he calls his immoralism, or his proposed transvaluation of values. Thus: What will the moralists who appear at this time have to preach? What shall be the message of these sharp on-lookers, these unhurried ones? What is essential and invaluable in every system of morals, is that it is a long constraint. A species originates, a type becomes established and strong in the long struggle with essentially unfavorable conditions. On the other hand, species which receive abundant nourishment, a surplus of protection and care, tend to develop variations, become fertile in prodigies and monstrosities. The essential thing, to repeat, is that there should be a long obedience in the same direction. Thereby results something which makes life worth living; for instance, virtue, art, music, dancing, reason, spirituality; whatever, in short, is trans­ figuring, refined, or divine. One may look at every system or morals in this light. It teaches us to hate the lax, the too-great freedom. It implants the need for limited horizons, for limited duties, for narrow perspectives. "Thou must obey some one, and for a long time; oth­ erwise thou wilt come to grief, and lose all respect for thyself." The tension of the soul in misfortune, its shuddering in view of rack and ruin, its inventiveness and heroism in enduring and exploiting misfortune, its depth, mystery, greatness; have these not been bestowed through the discipline of great suffering?

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

Up to now man has been in the worst hands, has been ruled by the misfits, th physiologically botched, the cunning and revengeful, the so-called saints-slanderer' of the world, traducers of humanity. The morality of decadence, the will to nothin; ness, passes as morality par excellence. Proof of this: Altruism is considered an absolute value, while egoism meets with hostility everywhere. He who disagrees with me on this point I regard as infected. For a physiologist, such an opposition of altruism and egoism would leave no room for doubt. If the smallest organ in the body neglects its self-preservation, its: recuperative powers, its"egoism," the whole organism will degenerate. The physiolo-, gist insists that such decayed parts be cut out. He pities them not at all. But the priest wants precisely the degeneration of mankind; hence he strives to preserve the decayed elements in humanity. This is the price of his rule. This is the "harm that good men do." When one is no longer serious after self-preservation and the increase of bodily energy, when anemia is made an ideal and contempt of the body is construed as"sal­ vation of the soul," what can all this be, if not a recipe for decadence? Loss of ballast· resistance to natural instincts,"selflessness," these have hitherto been called morality.' You want, if possible, to do away with suffering. There is not a more foolish "if possible." We would rather have it increased and made worse. Well-being, as you understand it, is certainly not a goal. The discipline of great suffering is the only disci­ pline that has produced all the elevations of humanity hitherto. To consider distress as something to be destroyed is sheer idiocy. Generally, it is actually harmful in its consequences, a fatal stupidity, almost as mad as the desire to abolish bad weather out of pity for the poor. In the great economy of the universe the terrors of reality, e.g., the passions, the desires, the will to power, are incalculably more essential than that petty happiness, so-called goodness. It is only among decadents that pity is called a virtue. They are too ready to for­ get modesty, reverence, and that delicacy of feeling which knows how to keep at a distance. They forget that this sentimental emotion stinks of the mob; that pity is only one step removed from bad manners; that pitying hands may be thrust with destruc­ tive results into a great destiny, into a wounded isolation.. . . The overcoming of pity I reckon among the noble virtues. There is nowadays a sickly irritability and sensitiveness to pain, a repulsive complaining, an effeminizing, which, with the aid of religious and philosophical nonsense, seeks to deck itself out as something superior. There is_ a regular cult of suffering. The unmanliness of what such groups of visionaries call sympathy is, I believe, the first thing that strikes the eye. One must resolutely taboo this latest form of bad taste. There is a point of diseased mellowness and effeminacy in the history of society, at which society itself takes the part of him who injures it, the part of the criminal. To punish now appears to be somehow "unfair." Is it not sufficient, it is asked, if the criminal be rendered harmless? Why should we still punish? Punishment is bar­ barous! And so on. With these questions, the herd morality, the morality of fear, draws its ultimate conclusion. On no point is the ordinary mind of Europe more unwilling to be corrected, than on this matter. People rave nowadays, even under the guise of "science," about corning social conditions in which the "exploiting character" of human relations is to be absent. Particularly is this true of socialistic shallowpates and howling anarchistic dogs. Their words sound to me as if they were promising a mode of life which should

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

331

refrain from all organic functions. "Exploitation" is not the mark of a depraved or primitive society; it belongs to the nature of living, as a primary organic function; it is a consequence of the will to power which is precisely the will to life. You may note that I do not care to see rudeness undervalued. It is by far the most humane form of contradiction, and amid modern effeminacy, it is one of our first virtues. To be able to be an enemy, to be an enemy, presupposes a strong nature. Strong natures need resistance, accordingly they seek it. The pathos of aggression belongs to strength as much as feelings of revenge and rancor belong to weakness. The strength of the aggressor is determined by the opposition he needs; every increase of strength betrays itself by a search for a more formidable opponent. To refrain from mutual injury, from violence, from exploitation, to put one's will on a par with others' may result in a kind of good conduct among individuals; but only when the necessary conditions are given, namely, an equality of the individuals in force and worth, and their correlation within one organization. To take this principle more generally, however, to use it as the fundamental principle of society, would immediately reveal what it actually amounts to, namely, a principle of dissolution and decay. Here one must think profoundly and resist all sen­ timentality; life itself is essentially appropriation, injury, exploitation, conquest, sup­ pression, severity, obtrusion, incorporation. Even the organization within which the members treat each other as equal, must, itself, do that toward other organizations which its members refrain from doing to each other; if, that is, it be a living, growing, and not a dying organization. It will endeavor to grow, to gain ground, to attract to itself, to acquire ascendancy; not owing to any morality or immorality, but simply because it lives, and because life is precisely will to power. Fortunately, the world is not built merely on those instincts in which !he good­ natured herd-animal would find his paltry happiness. To demand that everyone become a good man," a gregarious animal, a blue-eyed benevolent "beautiful soul," or (as Herbert Spencer wished) an altruist, would mean robbing existence of tts great­ est character, emasculating mankind. And this has been attempted. It is just this that men call morality. The good" man is the most harmful kind of man. He secures his existence at the cost of truth. He cannot create. He crucifies the man who writeth new values on new tables. He crucifies the whole future of humanity. Whatever harm the slanderers of the world may do, the harm which good men do is the most calamitous of all harm. Let me say again what I have already said a hundred times. In all our principal moral judgments, that which is sure of itself, that which glorifies itself with praise and blame, that which calls itself good, is the instinct of the herding human animal: the instinct which is coming more and more to the front, corning more and more to domi­ nate other instincts. Morality at present is herding-animal morality. All questions of politics, of the social order, of education, have been falsified from top to bottom, because the most harmful men have been taken for great men, and because people were taught to despise the fundamentals of life. II

II

Nietzsche's characteristic doctrines have their basis in these conceptions of the genealogy of morals and the transvaluation of values. His distinction between man and superman, between master morality and slave morality, his reiterated criticisms of the softer, more humanitarian virtues and customs, follow reason-

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

ably enough. Perhaps the most famous of all Nietzsche's teachings is his disti tion between master morality and slave morality. Its point is this: Moral systems must be compelled to bow before the gradations of rank Their sumption must be driven home, until they thoroughly understand that it is imm to say what "what is right and proper for one is right and proper for another." In a tour through the many finer and coarser moralities which have hitherto P vailed, or still prevail, on the earth, I have found certain traits recurring regula together, until finally two primary types revealed themselves to me: there are m morality and slave morality. Moral valuations have originated, either in a ruling class pleasantly conscious being different from the ruled, or in a ruled class, among slaves and dependents of sorts. In the master morality, when it is the rulers who determine the notion of "go ness," it is the exalted, proud type of character which is regarded as the distingu ing feature, as that which determines the order of rank The noble man separa from himself the persons in whom these characteristics are absent; them he despise They say: "Thus shall it be." They determine the whither and the why mankind. They grasp at the future with a creative hand. Whatever is and w becomes for them a means, an instrument, a hammer. Their knowing is creatin Their creating is law-giving.Their will to truth is will to power. In master morality the antithesis is between "noble" and "despicable." The co ardly, the timid, the no-accounts, the narrowly utilitarian, the distrustful, the s abasing, the doglike who submit to abuse, the mendicant flatterers, and above all t liars, are despised. A man who says, "I like that, I take it for my own, I mean to guard it and protect it"; a man who can carry out a resolution, keep hold of a woman, punish and over. throw insolence; a man who has his indignation and his sword; a man whom the weak, the suffering, even the animals, willingly submit to and naturally belong to; such a man is a master by nature. The noble type of man regards himself as the determiner of values; he does not require to be approved of; he passes the judgment; "What is injurious to me is injuri­ ous in itself"; he knows that it is he himself only who confers honor on things; he is a creator of values. He honors whatever he recognizes in himself; such morality is self­ glorification. In the foreground there is the feeling of plenitude, of power which seeks to overflow, the consciousness of a wealth which would fain give and bestow. The noble man honors in himself the powerful one, him who has power over himself, who knows how to speak and how to keep silent, who takes pleasure in sub­ jecting himself to severity and hardness and has reverence for all that is severe and hard. "Wotan placed a hard heart in my breast," says an old Scandinavian saga: it is thus rightly expressed from the soul of a proud Viking. The noble man is furthest removed from the morality which sees the essence of the moral in sympathy, or in "acting for the good of others." Faith in oneself, pride in oneself, a radical irony and enmity toward "self-lessness," belong as definitely to mas­ ter morality as do scorn and precaution in the presence of sympathy and the "warm heart." A man of this sort is carved from a single block which is hard, sweet, fragrant. He enjoys only what is good for him. His desire ceases when the limits of what is good for him are overstepped. .. . Whatever does not kill him makes him stronger. He gathers

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

333

his material from all he sees, hears, and experiences. He is a selective principle: he rejects much.... He reacts slowly to all kinds of stimuli, with that slowness which long caution and pride have bred in him .... He is always in his own company, whether mingling with men or books or nature....He honors the thing he chooses. There is an instinct for rank, which, more than anything else, is the sign of a high rank. The refinement, the goodness, the loftiness of a soul are put to a real test when something of the highest rank passes by but is not yet protected with the awe of authority; something that goes its way like a living touchstone, undistinguished, undiscovered, tentative, perhaps veiled and disguised. The noble and powerful know how to honor; it is their art, their domain for invention. The profound reverence for age and tradition, the belief and prejudice in favor of ancestors and against newcomers, is typical of master morality. If, contrari­ wise, men of "modern ideas" believe in progress" and the future," and are increas­ ingly lacking in respect for the past, the ignoble origin of these ideas" is thereby betrayed. He whose task is to investigate souls will avail himself of many varieties of this very art to determine the ultimate value of a soul, the innate order of rank to which it belongs.He will test it by its instinct for reverence.The vulgarity of many a soul spurs up like dirty water when any holy vessel, any jewel from closed shrines, any book bearing the marks of great destiny, is brought before it. Contrariwise, there is an involuntary silence, a hesitation, a cessation, by which is indicated that a soul frees the nearness of what is worthy of respect. In the so-called cultured classes today, the dealers in modern ideas," nothing is perhaps so repulsive as their lack of shame, their lack of reverence, the easy insolence of hand and eye with which they touch, finger, and examine everything.It is possible that more tact for reverence exists among the lower classes and peasants than among the newspaper-reading demimonde of intellect" and ' culture." Much has been achieved when the sentiment of reverence has been finally instilled into the masses, when they realize that they are not allowed to touch every­ thing, that there are some experiences before which they must take off their shoes and restrain their hand. The master morality is especially foreign and irritating to present-day taste. It is disliked and distrusted for the sternness of its principle that one has duties only to one's equals; that one may act toward persons of a lower rank,. toward all that is for­ eign, just as one pleases; that its values are "beyond good and evil." It is typical of the master morality to be able and obliged to exercise prolonged gratitude and prolonged revenge, but only within the circle of one's equals; artfulness in retaliation; a need for enemies as outlets for emotions of envy, quarrelsomeness, arrogance. This, of course, is not "modern morality," and is therefore difficult to real­ ize, to discover. 11

11

11

11

11

1

In contrast to the master morality stands the slave morality: It is otherwise with the second type of morality; what I have named slave morality.If the abused, the oppressed, the suffering, the unemancipated, the weary, the uncer­ tain-of-themselves, should moralize, what will be the common element in their moral evaluations? The slave has an unfavorable eye for the virtues of the powerful.He has a skep­ ticism and distrust of everything which they honor. He would fain persuade himself that their happiness is not genuine.

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

On the other hand, those qualities which serve to alleviate the existence o f suf. ferers are brought into prominence and flooded with light. It is here that sympath the kind of helping hand, the warm heart, patience, diligence, humility, friendlinefs' attain to honor. For here these are the most useful equalities, almost the only me an� of supporting the burden of existence. Slave morality is essentially the morality of utility. It is oriented aroun d the idea of the "useful." Here is the seat of the origin of the famous antithesis of "good" and ''evil," which I hav: distin�uis� �d from the antithesis of "�ood" and "bad." According to the slave morality, the evil man rouses fear. Accordmg to master morality, the "good" man rouses fear, and seeks to rouse it, while the "bad" man is regarded as the despicable being. According to slave morality, the good man must be the "safe" man: he must be good-natured, easily hoodwinked, perhaps a little stupid. Wherever slave morality gains the ascendency, language shows a tendency to approximate the significations of the words good and stupid. A last fundamental difference: the desire for freedom, the enthusiasm for "lib­ erty" the instinct of being "happy1' belong as inherently to slave morality as artifice in reverence and enthusiasm in devotion belong to master morality. Hence, we can understand, love as a passion, romantic love, with its ardors and endurances and binding ties, is a phenomenon of master morality. 1

1

Nietzsche never wearied of criticizing those phases of modern morality that smacked of "degeneration" and "slaves." Among the topics singled out for casti­ gation was the nineteenth-century enthusiasm for the emancipation of women. Says Nietzsche: To be mistaken in the fundamental problem of "man and woman1' is the typical sign of a shallow mind. To deny here the profoundest antagonism, the need for hostile tension; to dream here of "equal rights," equal training, equal claims and obligations; to prove oneself shallow at this dangerous spot, may be regarded as suspicious, nay more, as betrayed. Such an one may probably prove "too short" for all the fundamen­ tal issues of life, unable to descend into any of the depths. In no previous age have women been treated with so much respect by men as at present. This belongs to the tendency and fundamental taste of democracy. Is it any wonder that abuse should be made of this respect? Women want more; they learn to make claims; they become rivals for rights. In a word, they lose their modesty. And, let me add, they also lose their taste. They unlearn their fear of men. But the woman who "unlearns" her fear of men sacrifices her most womanly instincts. That woman should venture forward when man has ceased to inspire fear, is reasonable enough, and intelligible enough. But what is more difficult to grasp is that precisely thereby woman deteriorates. That is happening these days: let us not deceive ourselves about it. Wherever the industrial spirit has triumphed over the military and aristocratic spirit, woman strives for the economic and legal independence of a clerk. "Woman as clerk" is inscribed on the portal of that modern society which is in course of for­ mation. While she thus appropriates new rights, aspires to be master, and inscribes the "progress" of woman on her flags and banners, the very opposite realizes itself with terrible obviousness-woman retrogrades.

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

335

There is stupidity in this movement, an almost masculine stupidity, of which a well-bred sensible woman might be heartily ashamed. To lose the ground on which she can most surely achieve victory; to neglect her proper weapons; to let herself go before man where formerly she kept herself in control in artful humility; to neutralize man's faith in a fundamentally different ideal in woman, something eternally femi­ nine; to emphatically and loquaciously dissuade man from the idea that woman must be preserved, protected, and indulged like some delicate, strangely wild and often pleasant domestic animal; what does all this betoken, if not a disintegration of wom­ anly instincts? There are, to be sure, enough of idiotic friends and corrupters of woman among the learned asses of the male sex, who advise woman to defeminize herself in this manner, and to imitate all the stupidities from which all man suffers, who would like to lower woman to general culture," indeed, even to newspaper reading and med­ dling with politics. In their efforts to rise to the ideal woman, to the higher woman, they have really wished to lower the general level of women, and there are no more certain means to this end than university education, trousers, and the rights of voting like cattle. Fundamentally, the emancipated" and the emancipators" (for example, that typical old maid, Henrik Ibsen) are anarchists, misbegotten souls whose most deep-rooted instinct is revenge. Almost everywhere her nerves are being ruined, and she is daily being made more hysterical and more incapable of fulfilling her first and last function, namely, the rearing of robust children. These "friends of woman" wish to "cultivate" her, to make the weaker sex strong by "culture," as if history did not teach that the "cultivat­ ing" of mankind and the weakening of mankind have always kept pace with one another. That which inspires respect in woman, and often also fear, is her real natme 1 her genuine, carnivora-like cunning and flexibility, her tiger claws beneath the glove, her naivete in egoism, her untrainableness, her innate wildness, her incomprehensible­ ness, the extent and deviation of her virtues. That which, in spite of fear, excites one's sympathy for the dangerous and beau­ tiful in woman, is that she seems more afflicted, more vulnerable, more needful of love and more condemned to disillusion, than any other creature. Fear and sympa­ thy-it is with these feelings that man hitherto stood in the presence of woman, always with one foot in tragedy which rends while it delights. And all that is now to be at an end? The disenchantment of women is in progress? The tediousness of woman is slowly evolving? II

II

II

Another object of Nietzsche's criticism was what he describes as "Christian morality." He never tires of railing at it. From among pages and pages, the follow­ ing passages may be taken as representative: All the things men have valued heretofore are not even realities. They are mere fan­ tasies; more strictly speaking, they are lies. All the concepts, "God," "soul," "virtue," "sin," "Beyond," "truth," eternal life," are lies arising from the evil instincts of dis­ eased and harmful natures. I am the first immoralist. Basically, there are two denials included in this term. First, I deny the type of man who formerly passed as the highest, the "good" man, the "benevolent" man, the "charitable" man. Second, I deny that kind of morality which 11

336

THE RELATIVITY OF MORALITY

has become recognized and dominant, namely Christian morality. ... The second of these denials is the more decisive. No one befo�e. me has felt Christian mor�lit_Y beneat� him. To do that one must _ have height, far v1s1on, depth. Up to now, Chnshan morality has been the Circe of aU thinkers; they stood at her service. What man before me has descended into the caves from which the poisonous fumes of this ideal burst forth? Who before me ever dared to suspect they were caves? What philosopher before me was a real moralist and not a superior swindler, an idealist? Have you understood me? What defines me is the fact that I unmaske Christian morality.For this reason I needed a word which would contain the idea of universal challenge: immoralist. Blindness in the face of Christian morality is th essential crime.It is the great uncleanliness. Christian morality is the most pernicious form of the will to falsehood, the de of life. It is not error as error which infuriates me here. It is not the age-long lack "good will," of discipline, of decency, of spiritual courage, which betrays itself in t triumph of Christian morality. It is the ghastly fact that what was unnatural receiv the highest honors as morality, and remained suspended over man as the law oft categorical imperative. This is the great blundering. To teach contempt of the pri life instincts; to set up a "soul," a spirit, in order to overthrow the body; to teach to find impurity in sex; to look for the principle of evil in the need for expansion see a "higher moral value" in"self-lessness," in"objectivity," in "neighbor love"; th things are the will to nothingness, the denial of life the great nay-saying. The Jews performed the miracle of the inversion of valuations, by means which life on earth obtained a new and dangerous charm for a couple of thousa years. Their prophets fused the expressions rich, godless, wicked, violent, sensual, in one expression, and for the first time coined the word world as a term of reproa .. h. this inversion of values (which included the use of poor as synonymous with sairit a friend) the significance of the Jewish people is to be found. It is with them that sla morality begins. From the beginning, Christian morality was essentially the surfeit of life which distinguished itself under the belief in "another" and "better" life. The hatred of the world, the condemnation of emotion, the fear of beauty, the distrust of sensuality, all these have always appeared to me as the most dangerous forms of the "will to per• ish," symptoms of the deepest weariness, exhaustion, anemia. The teachers and preachers and leaders of mankind, including the theologians, have been decadents. Hence their inversion of values into a hostility to life; hence "morality." Here is a definition of morality: the idiosyncrasy of decadents actuated a desire to avenge themselves successfully upon life. I attach great value to this d nition. Have you understood me? The unmasking of Christian morality is a uniqu event. It breaks the history of mankind in two. Man lives either before or after tha Everything which was until then called the truth, is now recognized as the most harmful, spiteful, and concealed falsehood. The sacred pretext, the "improvement of man," is recognized as a ruse to drain life of its blood. This morality is vampirism. He who unmasks Christian morality unmasks the worthlessness of the values in which men believe. He sees in them only the most fatal kind of abortions; fatal, because they fascinate. The notion of "God)! was invented as the counternotion to life. The notion of a "Beyond" was invented to depreciate the only world that exists.

''immortal soul11 was invented to The notion of the 11 man11 has sin was invented to mislead our instincts. Finally, the notion of a come to mean everything that is weak, ilL misshapen, everything which should be obliterated. The law of selection is thwarted. And all this was believed in as morality! Ecrasez we who regard Christian morality and democratic We who hold a different politics to be a degenerating form of organization, where have we to fix our hopes? In new moralists and a new morality. There is no other alternative. In minds strong enough and original enough to initiate a transvaluation of values, to invert "eternal valuations/' lies our only hope. In forerunners, in men of the future, who shall fix the constraints and fasten the knots which will compel millenniums to take new paths; make preparations for vast hazardous enterprises and collective attempts in rearing and educating; put an end to the frightful rule of folly and chance which has hitherto gone by the name of history; in such do we fix our hopes. For these purposes a new type of moralist and ruler will some time be needed, at the very idea of which everything that has existed might look pale and dwarfed. The image of such leaders hovers before our eyes. But their image fills our hearts with anxiety and gloom. How are they to be born? How are they to be bred? How nurtured to that elevation and power which will feel the present needs as their tasks? Of them is demanded a transvaluation of values. In them is needed a new conscience of steel, a new heart of brass, to bear the weight of such responsibility. There is always the danger that they may be lacking or miscarry and degenerate. These are our real anxieties and glooms. These are the heavy thoughts and storms which sweep across our skies. There are few pains so grievous as to have seen an exceptional man miss his way and deteriorate. But he who has the rare eye to see the danger of mankind it·�,.::lf miss­ ing its way and deteriorating; he who has recognized the element of wild chance in human affairs; he who has detected the fate that is hidden under the idiotic unwari­ ness and blind confidence of"modern ideas, and still more of Christian and democratic politics; suffers from an anguish beyond comparison. The universal degeneracy of mankind to the level of the ideals of socialistic fools and humanitarian shallowpates, the dwarfing of man to an absolutely gregarious ani­ mal, the brutalizing of man into pygmy with equal "rights11 and "claims"-this is undoubtedly possible. He who has foreseen this possibility knows another loathing unknown to the rest of mankind. 11

11

From these themes, Nietzsche turns to the question of his own significance for the modern mind. Nietzsche on the genealogy of morals is interesting. Nietzsche on the distinction between master morality and slave morality is sug­ gestive. Nietzsche on woman and Christianity is challenging. But Nietzsche on himself in unique: Idealism is alien to me. Where you see ideal things I see human things; alas, all too human. He who would be a creator in good and evil must first be a destroyer, and break values into pieces. I am the most terrible man that has ever existed. But I shall be the most beneficent. I know the joy of annihilation. am the first immoralist. I am thus the essential destroyer.

not a am a the recollection of si)1T1etl11n.� a crisis, a clash of consciences, a decisive condemnation of all that before me had been hallowed. But my truth is terrible, for hitherto lies have been am the voice of truth. "The transvaluation of all values" is my formula for mankind's act of self-recognition. contradict as no one has contradicted before. For when engages in a struggle with falsehoods of ages, we must shocks, earthquakisc: rearrangements of hills and valleys, such as never yet have been dreamt of. All mighty forms of the old social structure I blow into space, for they rest on ·-~��,,v'-'"" Politics on a grand scale will date from me. life task is to prepare humanity for a moment of supreme se1t-consc1,n11 i,nP•c:c a great noontide, a transvaluation of all values, an emancipation from all moral val­ ues, a yea-saying, a confidence in all that has formerly been forbidden, despised, and damned: when it will gaze both backwards and forwards, emerge from the of accident and priesthood, and, for the first time, pose the question of the wherefore of humanity as a whole. But with all this there is nothing in me to suggest the founder of a "religion. Religions are the business of the mob. After corning in contact with a religious man, I have always to wash my hands. I want no "believers." I never address myself to the masses. do not wish to be a saint: I would rather be a clown. Perhaps I am a clown.

led him to relativize all moralities. For him Nietzsche's cultural must be understood in terms of its time and There is no such thing as morality having one fundamental principle running through it. There This assess­ are many moralities with their own distinctive values and ..,'",..'"' nn"iATC�ucn• did not lead Nietzsche to say that one ment of was no more preferable than any other. Nietzsche leaves no room for doubt morality of his For IH)r'7c,,no the -will the that he was to life which all humans share involves the ne,::essm to ···�-·�··· with its Christian altruism and will to power to do so. The self-sacrifice violated the fundamental will to life. As such, that morality was a noto life, and with that no-saying came the celebration of equality among humans, suspicion of the person who excels, and a commitment to mediocrity, which means the erosion of civilization. Nietzsche prefers the morality of what he the self-transcending person, the overman, the super­ calls the ubermensch man): a new egoism, which affirms the basic aggressiveness of the will to life and celebrates the pursuit of individual excellence even at the expense of others. Such a morality would constitute a transvaluation of the prevailing ··" a ment of the current altruistic no-saying to life with the superman's aggressive yes-saying to life. The superman discerns the current deterioration of from the mediocrity of the herd, legislates for himself what is right stands and wrong, and thereby sets himself beyond the prevailing good and evil. For that which is right is that which is of, and c�;e:rJ:r_·e.s�J!'1P of, the ubemzensch. 110"

.._H,✓ HJA•



••u••

339

FRIEDRICH NIETZSCHE

Clearly Nietzsche presents a challenge to the Paleys, Kants, and Mills of the world. That challenge can be described in terms of the contest between objec­ tivism and subjectivism in ethics. The objectivist claims that moral values and norms are"objective" in the sense that they exist independently of the individual so that certain things are good or evil and certain acts are right or wrong for all persons. The subjectivist claims that moral values and judgments are all ulti­ mately expressions of individual emotions and personal tastes. Although the ethi­ cal relativist might say that moral values and norms exist independently of the individual by virtue of the fact that they exist in the corporate beliefs and customs of a society and that moral values and norms are"objective" in this sense, never­ theless the relativist usually admits that those values and norms are rooted in or legitimized by individual tastes and emotions. Accordingly, ethical relativism generally implies a commitment to subjectivism. Paley, Kant, and Mill are on the side of the objectivists; Nietzsche is on the side of subjectivists. An example might help to clarify the difference in the two positions. Suppose that you said, 'Martin Luther King was a good man." From the objec­ tivist's perspective, you would be making a claim that Dr. King possessed a cer­ tain quality or characteristic such that it would be true to say that he was good." From the subjectivist' s point of view, you would not be making a factually signifi­ cant claim about Dr. King at all. Instead, you would be merely expressing a posi­ tive emotion that you had toward Dr. King. In the objectivist's world, moral judg­ ments can be assessed as true or false. In the subjectivist' s world, moral judgments are expressions of emotion, which seem to be neither true nor false. What kind of response could a Paley, Kant or Mill offer to Nietzsche's taunt that their views are human, all too human"? that morality boils down to individ­ ual emotional preferences? It is precisely the issue of objectivism versus subjec­ tivism in ethics that is the focus of the debate between our next two authors from the twentieth century, A. J. Ayer and Brand Blanshard. 1

11

11

Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted, abridged, or paraphrased from many different books, essays, and chapters. The basic argument of the section is derived principally from Friedrich Nietzsche, Beyond Good and Evil, translated by Helen Zimmermann (London: T. N. Fouli's 1914), particularly Chapters 1, 5, and 9; and 'The Genealogy of Morals," The Birth of Tragedy and the Genealogy of Morals, translated by Francis Golfing (Garden City, NY: Doubleday, 1956), Essays 1 and 2. Passages were also taken from Friedrich Nietzsche, Thus Spoke Zarathustra" in The Portable Nietzsche, edited by W. Kaufmann (New York: The Viking Press, 1954); The Dawning of Day: Thoughts on the Prejudices of Morality, translated by R. J. Hollingdale (New York: Cambridge University Press, 1982); Joyful Wisdom, trans­ lated by Thomas Common (New York: F. Ungar Publishing Co., 1960); Will to Power, translated by Walter Kaufmann and R. T. Hollingdale, edited by Walter Kaufmann (New York: Random House, 1967); and Ecce Homo: How One Becomes What One Is, translated by R. J. Hollingdale (New York: Penguin Books, 1979). 1

11

EMOTIVISM AFFIRMED

5

A.J. AYER

EMOTIVISM AFFIRMED

FROM NIETZSCHE TO AYER. You begin by being able and willing to authorize moral judgments; e.g., stealing is wrong, truth-telling is right, and so on. You then face a question: What fact, common to all your cases of wrong-doing, is the reason for calling them cases of wrong-doing? Or, what fact, common to all your cases of right-doing, is the reason for calling them cases of right-doing? Although Nietzsche disallows such questions, much traditional ethical the­ ory centers in those questions. If you get an answer, you are in a position to say, An act is wrong if and only if .... or right if and only if...." and supply what is needed to finish the statement.The completed sentence formulates the principle that is operative in your moral judgments.Much traditional ethical theory centers on the attempt to formulate the principle of moral judgment. It will be recalled that Paley, Kant, and Mill each tried to formulate the prin­ ciple of morality. Paley did so with reference to the will of God; Kant, with refer� ence to the categorical imperative; and Mill, with reference to happiness. Other alternatives would be possible. Let all of them be set down side by side. Then let the question be asked, To what logical type do these statements belong?" This is Professor Ayer's question. His answer empties moral judgments of their tradi­ tional content by construing them to be fundamentally expressions of emotion. 11

11

11

11

BIOGRAPHICAL Norn. A. J. Ayer was born in London, in 1910. He attended Eton, one of England's best-known public schools, where he excelled in academics and lettered in soccer and rugby. He attended Oxford University, receiving hi:, Bachelor of Arts in 1932. That year h2 spent several months in Vienna attending meetings of the so-called Vienna Circle-a group of distinguished scholars, including such persons as Hans Hahn, Otto Neurath, Philipp Frank, Herbert Feigl, Moritz Schlick, and Rudolf Carnap, who attempted to propagate the scien­ tific outlook in all fields of human knowledge. When Ayer returned to Oxford to pursue graduate studies, he brought with him the logical positivism of the Vienna Circle and blended it with insights from his contemporaries-Bertrand Russell and Ludwig Wittgenstein-and earlier empiricists such as George Berkeley and David Hume.The product of this synthesis was his book Language, Truth and Logic published in 1936, which became one of the most influential philosophical books of the twentieth century. In it Ayer attacks relentlessly the traditional philosophy as it was practiced in Oxford and elsewhere. During the Second World War, Ayer served in several military capacities. Upon his discharge from the army in 1945, he was appointed Dean of Wadham College, Oxford. In 1946, he became Grote Professor of the Philosophy of Mind and Logic at London University, and in 1959 he was named to the distinguished chair of Wykeham Professor of Logic at Oxford University.He died in 1989. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Ayer's question for Paley, Kant, Mill, and other traditional moral philosophers is, To what logical type do moral principles and 11

A. J. AYER

341

moral judgments belong?" In his hands this question presupposes that there are two possible answers: A statement is either empirical or tautological. He is dear that when you formulate the principle of morality, the resulting proposition is neither empirical nor tautological. His conclusion is that it is not a proposition at all, but a pseudoproposition; that is to say, it looks like a proposition because it is formulated in words and "read" like a sentence expressing a proposition, but it is nevertheless not a proposition because to be a proposition it would have to be either empirical or tautological, and it is neither. If it is not a proposition, then what is it? To say that it is a pseudoproposition is merely to say that it is not a proposition but looks as though it were. The ques­ tion remains, "What is it?" Professor Ayer' s point could be expressed by saying that it is a symbol, something used to express what is in the mind; and by distin­ guishing between two kinds of symbols-cognitive and emotive. A cognitive symbol is one that is used to express what you know or could know; an emotive symbol is one that is used to express what you feel or could feel. His claim would then be that when the principle of morality is expressed in words it is an emotive, not a cognitive symbol. In using it you express what you feel or could feel, not what you know or could know. This is the emotive theory about moral concepts and the judgments in which they occur. Our business is to give an account of "judgments of value" which is both satisfactory in itself and consistent with our general empiricist principles. We shall set ourselves to show that in so far as statements of values are significant they are ordinary "scien­ tific" statements; and that in so far as they are not scientific, they are not in the literal sense significant, but are simply expressions of emotion which can be neither true nor false. In maintaining this view, we may confine ourselves for the present to the cise of ethical statements. What is said about them will be found to apply, mutatis mutandis, to the case of aesthetic statements also. The ordinary system of ethics, as elaborated in the works of ethical philosophies, contains, first of all, propositions which express definitions of ethical terms, or judg­ ments about the legitimacy or possibility of certain definitions. Secondly, there are propositions describing the phenomena of moral experience, and their causes. Thirdly there are exhortations to moral virtue. And, lastly, there are actual ethical judgments. Only the first of our four classes, namely that which comprises the propositions relating to the definitions of ethical terms, can be said to constitute ethical philoso­ phy. The propositions which describe the phenomena of moral experience, and their causes, must be assigned to the science of psychology, or sociology. The exhortations to moral virtue are not propositions at alt but ejaculations or commands which are designed to provoke the reader to action of a certain sort. Accordingly, they do not belong to any branch of philosophy or science. As for ethical judgments, inasmuch as they are neither definitions nor comments upon definitions, nor quotations, we may say that they do not belong to ethical philosophy. A strictly philosophical treatise on ethics should therefore make no ethical pronouncements. But it should, by giving an analysis of ethical terms, show what is the category to which all such pronounce­ ments belong. And this is what we are now about to do. A question which is often discussed by ethical philosophers is whether it is pos­ sible to find definitions which would reduce all ethical terms to one or two funda-

342

EMOTIVISM AFFIFlMED

mental tenns. But this question, th?ugh it undeniably belongs to ethic�l philo sophy , is not relevant to our present enqmry. We are not now concerned to discover Whi� h term, within the sphere of ethical terms, is to be taken as fundamental: whether f r example, good" can be defined in terms of right" or "right" in terms of good:" � both in terms of "value.// What we are interested in is the possibility of reducing thr whole sphere of ethical terms to non-ethical terms. We are enquiring whether state� ments of ethical value can be translated into statements of empirical fact. That they can be so translated is the contention of those ethical philosophers who are commonly called subjectivists, and of those who are known as utilitarians. For the utilitarian defines the rightness of actions, and the goodness of ends, in terms of the pleasure, or happiness, or satisfaction, to which they give rise; the subjectivist, in terms of the feelings of approval which a certain person, or group of people, has towards them. Each of these types of definition makes moral judgments into a sub-class of psv� chological or sociological judgments; and for this reason they are very attractive to �s. For, if either was correct, it would follow that ethical assertions were not generically different from the factual assertions which are ordinarily contrasted with them. Nevertheless we shall not adopt either a subjectivist or a utilitarian analy sis ethical terms. We reject the subjectivist view that to call an action right, or a thin good, is to say that it is generally approved ot because it is not self-contradictory assert that some actions which are generally approved of are not right, or that so things which are generally approved of are not good. And we reject the alterna subjectivist view that a man who asserts that a certain action is right or that a cert thing is good, is saying that he himself approves of it, on the ground that a man w confessed that he sometimes approved of what was bad or wrong would not be c tradicting himself. And a similar argument is fatal to utilitarianism. We cannot ag that to call an action right is to say that all of the actions possible in the circumstanc it would cause, or be likely to cause, the greatest happiness, or the greatest balanu::< pleasure over pain, or the greatest balance satisfied over unsatisfied desire, becau we find that it is not self-contradictory to say that it is sometimes v,rrong to perfo the action which would actually or probably cause the greatest happiness, 01. greatest balance of pleasure over pain, or of satisfied over unsatisfied desire. 1\ since it is not self-contradictory to say that some pleasant things are not good, or that. some bad things are desired, it cannot be the case that the sentence x is good" is: equivalent to xis pleasant/' or to xis desired." And to every other variant of utili ianism with which I am acquainted the same objection can be made. Therefore validity of ethical judgments is not determined by the felicific tendencies of actio any more than by the nature of people's feelings; it must be regarded as absolute" "intrinsic/' and not empirically calculable. We are not denying that it is possible to invent a language in which all ethica symbols are definable in non-ethical terms; what we are denying is that the suggeste reduction of ethical to non-ethical statements is consistent with the conventions our actual language. That is, we reject utilitarianism and subjectivisim, not as propo als to replace our existing ethical notions by new ones, but as analyses of our existing ethical notions. Our contention is simply that in our language, sentences which con­ tain normative ethical symbols are not equivalent to sentences which express psycho­ logical propositions, or indeed empirical propositions of any kind. It is only normative ethical symbols, and not descriptive ethical symbols, that are indefinable in factual terms. There is a danger of confusing these two, because they are commonly constituted by signs of the same sensible form. Thus x is wrong" may 11

II

11

II

II

II

II

II

A.

AYER

is with norma­ does not, we maintain, express an c:-:7:;::-::·::,.::.��, n, ....,-,_Do:s1t1c·r, concerned; so that whenever ethical are tive ethics that we are at used in the course of this argument without -�,•.:�•::-::::..· �,:�-� they are to be interpreted as symbols of the normative type. admitting that normative ethical ,-,rn,,-,or->1-c are not reducible to c;rrq:.,l.rlC,'ll con­ cepts, we seem to be leaving the way clear for the view that statements of value are not controlled by observation, as ordinary empirical propositions are, but by a mysterious "intellectual intuition." This would make statements of value unverifiable. For it is notorious that what seems intuitively certain to one person may seem doubt­ ful, or even false, to another. So that unless it is possible to provide some criterion which one may decide between conflicting intuitions, a mere appeal to intuition is worthless as a test of a proposition's validity. But in the case of moral judgments, no such criterion can be given. Some moralists claim to settle the matter by saying that they "know" that their own moral judgments are correct. But such an assertion is of purely psychological interest, and has not the slightest tendency to prove the validity of any moral judgment. For dissentient moralists may equally well "know" that their ethical views are correct. And, as far as subjective certainty goes, there will be nothing to choose between them. When such differences of opinion arise in connection with an ordinary empirical proposition, one may attempt to resolve them by referring to, or actually carrying out, some relevant empirical test. But with regard to ethical state­ ments, there is, on the "intuitionist" theory, no relevant c·:-:7;;::-::·::'.::.��, test. Therefore on this theory ethical statements are held to be unverifiable. They are, of cour·:;c, also held to be genuine synthetic propositions. Considering the use which we have made of the ..-. .... ,,-..,,,-,---,in that a synthetic proposition is significant only if it is empirically verifiable, it is clear that the ;;ccep­ tance of an "absolutist" theory of ethics would undermine the whole of our main argument. And as we have already rejected the "naturalistic" theories which are com­ monly supposed to provide the alternative to "absolutism" in ethics, we seem to have reached a difficult position. We shall meet the difficulty by showing that the cor­ rect treatment of ethical statements is afforded a third theory, which is wholly compatible with our radical empiricism. by admitting that the fundamental ethical concepts are unanalysable, We inasmuch as there is no criterion by which one can test the validity of the judgments in which they occur. So far we are in agreement with the atJ:3011uw3ts, But, unlike the absowe are able to give an explanation of this fact about ethical concepts. We say that the reason why they are unanalysable is that they are mere pseudo-concepts. The presence of an ethical symbol in a proposition adds nothing to its factual content. Thus if say to someone, "You acted wrongly in stealing that money," am not stating any­ thing more than if had simply said, "You stole that money." In adding that this action is wrong am not making any further statement about it. am simply evincing my moral disapproval of it. is as if had said, "You stole that money," in a ,..,�-��,��, tone of horror, or written it with the addition of some special exclamation mark. The tone, or the exclamation mark, adds nothing to the literal meaning of the sentence. It merely serves to show that the ex1:JrE'.SS1on of it is attended by certain feelings in the'-'!---''-'-'-''•'--'•

EMOTIVISM AFFIRMED

If now I generalize my previous statement and say, "Stealing money is wrong," produce a sentence which has no factual meaning-that is, expresses no proposi which can be either true or false. It is as if I had written "Stealing money!!"-w the shape and thickness of the exclamation marks shows, by a suitable convenij that a special sort of moral disapproval is the feeling which is being expressed. I clear that there is nothing said here which can be true or false. Another man may agree with me about the wrongness of stealing, in the sense that he may quarrel me on account of my moral sentiments. But he cannot strictly speaking, contra me. For in saying that a certain type of action is right or wrong, I am not making factual statement, not even a statement about my own state of mind. I am me expressing certain moral sentiments. And the man who is ostensibly contradicting is merely expressing his moral sentiments. So that there is plainly no sense in as which of us is in the right. For neither of us is asserting a genuine proposition. What we have just been saying about the symbol "Wrong" applies to all nor tive ethical symbols. Sometimes they occur in sentences which record ordina empirical facts besides expressing ethical feeling about those facts: sometimes th occur in sentences which simply express ethical feeling about a certain type of actio or situation, without making any statement of fact. But in every case in which 0 would commonly be said to be making an ethical judgment, the function of the rele:. vant ethical word is purely "emotive." It is used to express feeling about certain objects, but not to make any assertion about them. It is worth mentioning that ethical terms do not serve only to express feelin They are calculated to arouse feeling, and so to stimulate action. Indeed some of them are used in such a way as to give the sentences in which they occur the effect of com­ mands. Thus the sentence "It is your duty to tell the truth" may be regarded both as the expression of a certain sort of ethical feeling about truthfulness and as the expres­ sion of the command "Tell the truth." The sentence "You ought to tell the truth" also involves the command "Tell the truth," but here the tone of the command is less emphatic. In the sentence "It is good to tell the truth" the command has become little more than a suggestion. And thus the "meaning" of the word "good," in its ethical usage, is differentiated from that of the word "duty" or the word "ought." In fact we may define the meaning of the various ethical words in terms both of the different feelings they are ordinarily taken to express, and also the different responses which they are calculated to provoke. We can now see why it is impossible to find a criterion for determining the validity of ethical judgments. It is not because they have an "absolute" validity which is mysteriously independent of ordinary sense experience, but because they have no objective validity whatsoever. If a sentence makes no statement at all, there is obvi­ ously no sense in asking whether what it says is true or false. And we have seen that sentences which simply express moral judgments do not say anything. They are pure expressions of feeling and as such do not come under the category of truth and false­ hood. They are unverifiable for the same reason as a cry of pain or a word of com­ mand is unverifiable-because they do not express genuine propositions. Thus, although our theory of ethics might fairly be said to be radically subjec­ tivist it differs in a very important respect from the orthodox subjectivist theory. For the orthodox subjectivist does not deny, as we do, that the sentences of a moralizer express genuine propositions. All he denies is that they express propositions of a unique non-empirical character. His own view is that they express propositions about the speaker's feelings. If this were so, ethical judgments clearly would be capable of

345

A. J. AYER

being true or false. They would be true if the speaker had the relevant feelings, and false if he had not. And this is a matter which is, in principle, empirically verifiable. Furthermore, they could be significantly contradicted. For if I say ' Tolerance is a virtue," and someone answers, "You don't approve of it," he would, on the ordinary subjectivist theory, be contradicting me. On our theory, he would not be contradict­ ing me, because, in saying that tolerance was a virtue, I should not be making any statement about my own feelings or about anything else. I should simply be evincing my feelings, which is not at all the same thing as saying that I have them. The distinction between the expression of feeling and the assertion of feeling is complicated by the fact that the assertion that one has a certain feeling often accompa­ nies the expression of that feeling, and is then, indeed, a factor in the expression of that feeling. Thus I may simultaneously express boredom and say that I am bored, and in that case my utterance of the words, "I am bored," is one of the circumstances which make it true to say that I am expressing or evincing boredom. But I can express boredom without actually saying that I am bored. I can express it by my tone and ges­ tures, while making a statement about something wholly unconnected with it, or by an ejaculation, or without uttering any words at all. So that even if the assertion that one has a certain feeling always involves the expression of that feeling, the expression of a feeling assuredly does not always involve the assertion that one has it. And this is the important point to grasp in considering the distinction between our theory and the ordinary subjectivist theory. For whereas the subjectivist holds that ethical statements actually assert the existence of certain feelings, we hold that ethical statements are expressions and excitants of feeling which do not necessarily involve any assertions. We have already remarked that the main objection to the ordinary subjectivist theory is that the validity of ethical judgments is not determined by the nature of their author's feelings. And this is an objection which our theory escapes. For it does not imply that the existence of any feelings is a necessary and sufficient condttion of the validity of an ethical judgment. It implies, on the contrary, that ethical judgments have no validity. There is, however, a celebrated argument against subjectivist theories which our theory does not escape. It has been pointed out by Moore that if ethical statements were simply statements about the speaker's feelings, it would be impossible to argue about questions of value. To take a typical example: if a man said that thrift was a virtue, and another replied that it was a vice, they would not, on this theory, be dis­ puting with one another. One would be saying that he approved of thrift, and the other that he didn't; and there is no reason why both these statements should be true. Now Moore held it to be obvious that we do dispute about questions of value, and accordingly concluded that the particular form of subjectivism which he was dis­ cussing was false. It is plain that the conclusion that it is impossible to dispute about questions of value follows from our theory also. For as we hold that such sentences as "Thrift is a virtue" and "Thrift is a vice" do not express propositions at all, we clearly cannot hold that they express incompatible propositions. We must therefore admit that if Moore's argument refutes the ordinary subjectivist theory, it also refutes ours. But in fact we deny that it does refute even the ordinary subjectivist theory. For we hold that one really never does dispute about questions of value. This may seem, at first sight, to be a very paradoxical assertion. For we certainly do engage in disputes which are ordinarily regarded as disputes about questions of value. But, in all such cases, we find, if we consider the mater closely, that the dispute 1

EMOTIVISM AFFIRMED

is not really about a question of value, but about a question of fact. When someone disagrees with us about the moral value of a certain action or type of action, we do admittedly resort to argument in order to win him over to our way of thinking. But we do not attempt to show by our arguments that he has the "wrong" ethical feeli ngs towards a situation whose nature he has correctly apprehended. What we attempt to show is that he is mistaken about the facts of the case. We argue that he has miscon. ceived the agent's motive: or that he has misjudged the effects of the action, or its probable effects in view of the agent's knowledge; or that he has failed to take into account the special circumstances in which the agent was placed. Or else we employ more general arguments about the effects which actions of a certain type tend to pro­ duce, or the qualities which are usually manifested in their performance. We do this in the hope that we have only to get our opponent to agree with us about the nature of the empirical facts for him to adopt the same moral attitude towards them as we do. And as the people with whom we argue have generally received the same moral education as ourselves, and live in the same social order, our expectation is usually justified. But if our opponent happens to have undergone a different process of moral "conditioning" from ourselves, so that, even when he acknowledges all the facts, he still disagrees with us about the moral value of the actions under discussion, then we abandon the attempt to convince him by argument. We say that it is impossible to argue with him because he has a distorted or underdeveloped moral sense; which signifies merely that he employs a different set of values from our own. We feel that our own system of values is superior, and therefore speak in such derogatory terms of his. But we cannot bring forward any arguments to show that our system is superior. For our judgment that it is so is itself a judgment of value, and accordingly outside the scope of argument. It is because argument fails us when we come to deal with pure questions of value, as distinct from questions of fact, that we finally resort to mere abuse. In short, we find that argument is possible on moral questions only if some sys­ tem of values is presupposed. If our opponent concurs with us in expressing moral disapproval of all actions of a given type t, then we may get him to condemn a partic­ ular action A, by bringing forward arguments to show that A is of type t. For the ques­ tion whether A does nor does not belong to that type is a plain question of fact. Given that a man has certain moral principles, we argue that he must, in order to be consis­ tent, react morally to certain things in a certain way. What we do not and cannot argue about is the validity of these moral principles. We merely praise or condemn them in the light of our own feelings. If anyone doubts the accuracy of this account of moral disputes, let him try to construct even an imaginary argument on a question of value which does not reduce itself to an argument about a question of logic or about an empirical matter of fact I am confident that he will not succeed in producing a single example. And if that is the case, he must allow that its involving the impossibility of purely ethical argu­ ments is not, as Moore thought, a ground of objection to our theory, but rather a point in favor of it. Having upheld our theory against the only criticism which appeared to threaten it, we may now use it to define the nature of all ethical enquiries. We find that ethical philosophy consists simply in saying that ethical concepts are pseudo-concepts and therefore unanalyzable. The further task of describing the different feelings that the different ethical terms are used to express, and the different reactions that they cus­ tomarily provoke, is a task for the psychologist. There cannot be such a thing as ethi-

A.

cal science, by ethical science one means morals. For we have seen that as ethical there can be no way of whether any such is All that one may ,�,_,,,"'"u connection is, What are the moral habits of given person or and what causes them to have rw,c;ric,olu those habits and within the scope the e:>

what will not be on the

r,;,,-r,r,

even clearer. of various colors, etc. Nowhere on list seems clear that, from a list of the facts (which is cal characteristics of the not follow beautiful. distincG. E. Moore wanted to the fact-value rl1r•hn,t -n,-,,, tion). He thought it ir-i1 ;>'.J'3�;101 .� to derive values from facts alone. Moore also -nr,-. ,ort-100 -n thought that values were objective in the sense of of external things. Thus, Moore was not a ._,..._,,t,,1:.._r:c"t, �t To use Blanshard's rabbit as an e,x�=n7:7.r, • •1�0 Hume would have considered the 1-.r,nn°r -u of the observer, while Moore (a foreconsidered the "badness" to be a ��-���-•-,, of runner of Blanshard in this the rabbit in the trap. For Moore, values-as nr1nnert:1e�,--WE�re r.h,or•f-n O but not like other properties. Remember that Moore could not allow values to be like other for if they were like other -nr,-.-n,c:irt-,oc then values would be would just be facts. deducible from facts. this would not do. Moore claimed that value terms such as 1-.-.-.,---.-.---,or+·1oc That the five traditional sense uu.a11lIH�s--reu sourness, smoothness, the smell of rotten eggs. moral ~~n�~--��i.q a non-natural sense. To -.-.r,n-n,or+, alone that from in the and that to derive a non-natural prop­ erty, one needed a non-natural -.---,,..,,,-,--, the Moore called the mistaken .__._ .. to derive values from facts alone the natu­ is that all r,,..,,.,---,,c,,..+, c are natural. If ralistic fallacy. The naturalistic then any definition of a value term will use natural all properties are properties and values could be derived from facts alone. Some 1 n-i-· 0r,r-,r,::,-1-o-rc of Moore characterize the naturalistic fallacy as the fallacious claim that a value term in terms of facts. Since the way to derive a value from can be defined facts alone is to ::::��--:.!��-�� in a factual definition of a value term, these two inter­ pretations of Moore probably come to just about the same For Moore, it was as much a to derive a value from a set of facts from "American Bull is to derive alone as it was a Bull is an American Indian." Indians are vanishing" and To return for a moment to Blanshard's e:��1rrrD.tc it does not follow from "the and "the rabbit suffered great " that "rabbits should rabbit was in the not be ,_����-�,-, unless one adds a ��,........ a non-natural fact such as "Rabbits should suffer." Strictly Moore would it way. �ii,,ui•-r,

1

1

n T1rh our organs rlnrorcolu Neither us that are but motion. For if anything else but divers motions; for motion produceth these sensible qualities (colors, sounds) were in the object which causeth them, they could not be severed from them as by mirrors and echoes they are. The cause of perception consisteth in this: When the uttermost part of the organ is pressed, it no sooner yields but the next part within it is pressed also. In this man­ ner the pressure or motion is propagated through all the parts of the organ to the innermost. Also, the pressure of the uttermost part proceedeth from the pressure of some more remote body, and so continually till we come to the object. Sense there­ fore is some internal motion in the sentient organism, generated by some internal motion of the parts of the object, and propagated through all the media to the inner­ most part of the organ. I shall endeavor to make plain these points: that the object wherein color is inherent is not the object seen; that there is nothing without us, really, which we call image or color; that color is but the apparition unto us of the motion, agitation, or change which the object worketh in the brain or some internal substance of the head; that as in vision, so also in the other senses, the subject of their inherence is not the object but the sentient creature. As a color is not inherent in the object, but an effect thereof upon us, caused by motion in the object, so neither is sound in the thing we hear, but in ourselves. The clapper hath no sound in it, but action, and maketh motion in the internal parts of the bell; so the bell hath motion, and not sound, that imparteth motion to the air; and the the ear and nerve unto the air hath motion, but no sound, which it imparteth brain; and the brain hath motion, but no sound. From hence it followeth that whatsoever qualities our senses make us think the there be in the world, they be not there, but are seeming and .::; a·•1·��1,'0•i' l :,c� things that really are in the world without us are those motions ings are caused. And this is the great deception of sense. out.

s,:t�n::-ti:r:,�

1p1p

a say the red color of a how can we so much motion of r.c,-,,,t-,,,ic,c in the observer's is? As it appears out there in space, located where the doth the sensation appear as ,--,,-,.-,,..,,.-,'"'"" situated without the His answer is:

Hobbes is

ct-n,r.r,or1

doth the sensation appear as something situated without the organ? It is true: There is in the whole organ, by reason of its own internal natural action some reaction against the motion which is propagated from the object to the innermost part of the organ. In the organ there is an endeavor opposite to the endeavor which pro­ ceedeth from the object. That endeavor inwards is the last action in the act of sense. Then from the reaction, an idea hath its being, which by reason that the endeavor is now outward, doth always appear as something situated without the organ. But though all sense be made reaction, as have said, it is not necessary that everything that reacteth should have sense. know there have been philosophers, and those learned men, who have maintained that all bodies are endued with sense. Nor do I see how they can be refuted if the nature of sense be placed in reaction

THE CLAIMS OF MATERIALISM

The argument turns from the subjectivity of sensations to the question of desires. These too must be admitted to be merely so much matter in motion. As that which is really within us, in sensation, is only motion caused by the action of external objects, so that which is really within us in appetite or desire is nothing but motion. But the appearance of that motion we call either pleasure or pain. When appetites and aversions arise alternately concerning the same thing, so that sometimes we have an appetite to it and sometimes an aversion from it, then the whole sum of desires and aversions is what we call deliberation. In deliberation, the last appetite or aversion, immediately adhering to the act or the omission thereof, is what we call will.

If this be the whole story of human preferences and desires, Hobbes is in a position to make short shrift of any lofty moral idealism. This he proceeds to do: Moral philosophy is nothing else but the science of what is good and evil in the conversation and society of mankind. Good and evil are names that signify our appetites and aversions; which in different tempers, customs, and doctrines of men, are different, and divers men differ not only in their judgment, on the sense of what is pleasant and unpleasant to the taste, smelt hearing, touch, and sight but also what is comfortable or disagreeable to reason in the actions of common life. Nay the same man, in divers times differeth from himself and at one time praiseth, that is, calleth good what at another time he dispraiseth, that is, calleth evil. Every man calleth that which pleaseth him, good; and that which displeaseth him, evil. Since every man differeth from another in constitution, they differ also from one another concerning the common distinction of good and evil. Nor is there any such thing as absolute goodness considered without relation. Whatsoever is the object of any man's appetite or desire, that it is which he for his part calleth good; and the object of his hate and aversion, evil. For these words good and evil are ever used with relation to the person that useth them, there being nothing simply and absolutely so, nor any rule of good and evil to be taken from the nature of objects themselves; but from the man, where there is no commonwealth.

To the commitments thus far, Hobbes adds one more: a categorical denial of human free will: I conceive that nothing taketh beginning from itself, but from the action of some other immediate agent without itself. Therefore, when a man hath an appetite or will to something, to which before he had no appetite or will, the cause of his will is not the will itself but something else not in his own disposing. Neither is the freedom of willing or not willing greater in man than in other liv­ ing creatures. For where there is appetite, the entire cause thereof hath preceded, and, consequently, the appetite could not choose but follow; that is, hath of necessity fol­ lowed. Therefore such a liberty as is free from necessity is not to be found in the will. If by freedom we understand the power, not of willing but of doing what we wilt then certainly that freedom is to be allowed to both men and animals. The ordinary definition of a free agent is that he is one that when all things are present which are needful to produce an effect, can nevertheless not produce it. This implies a contradiction that is nonsense, being as much as to say the cause of anything may be sufficient and yet the effect shall not follow. There is no such thing as an

THOMAS HOBBES

545

"agent," which when all things requisite to action are present, can nevertheless forbear to produce it. Or, which is all one, there is no such thing as freedom from necessity.

The essentials of Hobbes's materialism are now before us. The position evokes criticism. With unerring instinct Hobbes places his finger upon the one point which, more than any other perhaps, will be disputed: the denial of human free will. The following passages show Hobbes attempting to defend his deter­ minism against anticipated objections: To deny necessity is to destroy the power and foreknowledge of God Almighty. For whatsoever God hath purposed to bring to pass by man, or foreseeth shall come to pass, a man might frustrate and make not come to pass if he hath freedom from necessity. Then would God foreknow such things as never shall be, and decree such things as shall never come to pass. Liberty and necessity are consistent: as in the water, that hath not only liberty but a necessity to descend by the channel. So likewise in the actions men voluntarily do; which because they proceed from their will are termed voluntary. And yet, because every act of man's will and every desire and inclination proceedeth from some cause, and that from some other cause, in a continual chain, it proceedeth from necessity. To him that could see the connection of those causes, the necessity of all men's voluntary actions would appear manifest. The necessity of an action doth not make the laws that prohibit it unjust. Whatsoever necessary cause precede an action, yet if the action be forbidden, he that doth it willingly may justly be punished. For instance, suppose the law on pain of death prohibit stealing. Suppose there be a man who by the strength of temptation is necessitated to steal, and is thereupon put to death. Doth not this punishment deter others from theft? Is it not a cause that others steal not? Doth it not frame and rnake their wills to justice? To make the law is thereupon to make a cause of justice, and so to necessitate justice. The intention of the law is not to grieve the delinquent for that which is past and not to be undone; but to make him and others just who might uth­ erwise not be so. It respecteth not the evil act past, but the good to come. But you will say, how is it just to kill one man to amend another, if what were done were neces­ sary? To this I answer: men are justly killed, not because their actions are not necessi­ tated, but because their actions are noxious. We destroy, without being unjust, all that is noxious, both beasts and men. Repentance is nothing but a glad returning into the right way, after the grief of being out of the way. Even though the cause that made a man go astray were neces­ sary, there is no reason why he should not grieve. So likewise, even though the cause that made a man return into the right way were necessary, there remaineth still the cause of joy. So that I say the necessity of actions taketh away neither of those parts of repentance, neither grief for the error nor joy for the returning. As for praise and dispraise, they depend not at all on the necessity of the action praised or dispraised. For what is it to praise, but to say a thing is good? Good for me, good for someone else, or good for the commonwealth. What is it to say an act is good, but to say it is as I wish it, or as another wish it, or according to the law of the commonwealth? Can no action please me, or another, or the commonwealth, that should happen of necessity? Doth not praise and dispraise, reward and punishment, make and conform the will to good and evil by example?

THE CLAIMS OF IDEALISM

Materialism is always with us. It is as old as the record of Western philoso­ phy, having received an elaborate presentation in the fifth century B.C. in the writing-of which we now possess only as a few suggestive fragments-of the Greek materialist Democritus, and several centuries later, in the writings of the Roman materialist Lucretius. Our task is to grasp the meaning of materialism and its implications. To recapitulate: It is the belief that reality is moving particles of matter. Its adherents have usually felt committed to certain further claims, as, for example, all events are rigidly predictable; all organisms are only mechanisms; all knowledge, originating in sensations, is knowledge of appearances only, since sensations are entirely subjective; human conduct is strictly determined by antecedent and concomitant events; human motives are essentially egocentric; and the achievement of happiness, in the sense of the satisfaction of desire, is the only finally good thing. These assorted doctrines are not, of course, as logically interdependent as the materialist would have us believe. But they are tempera­ mentally interdependent. They give expression to a mood or a temperament or a frame of mind which is sufficiently widespread to demand a courteous hearing. NOTE ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted, abridged, or para­ phrased from Thomas Hobbes, The Elements of Philosophy, Human Nature, Of Liberty and Necessity, and Leviathan. From The English Works of Thomas Hobbes, Sir William Molesworth, ed. (London: J. Bohn, 1839).

2

GEORGE BERKELEY

THE CLAIMS OF IDEALISM

FROM HOBBES TO BERKELEY. It was to be expected that Hobbes's tough-minded materialism would provoke protest and criticism. Throughout the seventeenth and eighteenth centuries, it is not too much to say that materialism was the "specter" that haunted Western metaphysics. Some resorted to the simple expedi­ ent of ignoring such views. Some reviled the personal characters of those who held them. Some attacked the premises and disputed the validity of the conclu­ sions that comprised the materialist's position. Among these, in the eighteenth century, was George Berkeley, the founder of modern idealism and one of the shrewdest metaphysicians of modern times. BIOGRAPHICAL NOTE. George Berkeley was born in Ireland in 1685 and died in 1753 at the age of sixty-eight. He was educated at the Trinity College, Dublin, where while yet an undergraduate, he conceived the necessity of "refuting atheists and materialists." At the age of twenty-five he published A Treatise Concerning the Principles of Human Knowledge, and three years later his Three Dialogues Between Hylas and Philonous. These two small volumes, by one of the youngest and brightest philosophical mind of his generation, contain the statement and defense of his case against materialism and his case for idealism. For a while he was laughed at, as

GEORGE BERKELEY

547

readers of Boswell's Johnson will remember. But the scattered ranks of those who had been troubled by the fashionable materialism launched by Hobbes and others in the preceding century soon closed in his support. Shortly after publication, Berkeley visited England and was received into the circle of Addison, Pope, and Steele. He traveled on the European continent in various capacities, and on his return was appointed lecturer in divinity and Greek in Trinity College, Dublin. He received a D.D. and was made an ecclesiastical dean. He was promised aid to found a college in Bermuda for training clergymen for the colonies and missionar­ ies for the Indians. He was made, finally, Bishop of Cloyne. He died at Oxford, beloved and respected, if not clearly understood, by all who knew him. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Berkeley desires to establish the proposition that reality is spiritual, that a person's mind provides him or her with a better example of the constituent "stuff" of things than is provided by a lump of matter. This is his idealism. The first step is a critique of materialism. This Berkeley pro­ ceeds to construct. He starts from premises the materialists themselves admit (any others would be irrelevant) and seeks to show that their conclusions either (1) are incompatible with these premises, or (2) do not follow from these premises. He then approaches materialism from another angle, seeking this time to explain how materialists have come to hold their "misguided" conclusions. Methodologically this procedure is usable. A Communist might apply it to capitalism as the first step in a general statement of the case for communism. A free trader might apply it to protectionism as the first step in a general statement of the case for free trade. A liberal might apply it to conservatism as the first step in a general statement of the case for liberalism. The same remarks are applicable to capitalists, protecticn1ists, and conservatives. The case against materialism stated, Berkeley moves on to the case for ideal­ ism. He formulates a few premises that anyone, he thinks, will admit. From these he seeks to deduce his idealism. He turns then to consider possible objections that might be urged against it before they are made. The case against materialism stated, the case for idealism stated, the possible objections anticipated, he doses in on what, after all, he considers to be the most important part of the whole business, namely, an elucidation of the implications of his metaphysical idealism, an enumeration of the propositions that are also true if his idealism is true. The total argument begins as follows: It is plain that the notion of what is called matter or corporeal substance involves a contradiction,* so much so that I should not think it necessary to spend time expos­ ing its absurdity. But belief in the existence of matter seems to have taken so deep a root in the minds of philosophers, and draws after it so many ill consequences, that I choose rather to be thought prolix and tedious than to omit anything that might con­ duce to the discovery and extirpation of that prejudice. * The contradiction" would seem to be in saying that all knowledge is from sense-data, and at the same time admitting that matter is not a sense-datum. How then do we know it? II

THE CLAIMS OF IDEALISM

The following distinction between primary and secondary qualities and the claim that primary qualities are alone real, whereas secondary qualities are merely subjective, were familiar notions in Berkeley's day. Some there are who make a distinction between primary and secondary qualities. By primary qualities they mean extension, figure, motion, rest, solidity, and number. By secondary qualities they mean sensible qualities, as colors, sounds, tastes, and so forth. Our ideas of secondary qualities they acknowledge not to be the resemblances of anything existing without the mind or unperceived. But they will have our ideas of the primary qualities to be patterns or images of things which exist without the mind in an unthinking substance which they call matter. By matter, therefore, we are to understand an inert, senseless substance in which extension, figure, and motion do actually exist. Colors, sounds, heat, cold, and such like secondary qualities, they tell us, are sensations existing in the mind alone, depending on and occasioned by the different size, texture and motion of the minute particles of matter. This they take for an undoubted truth, which they can demonstrate beyond all exception.

By materialism, then, Berkeley proposes to mean the belief in an inert, senseless substance possessing primary qualities in its own right but not possessing secondary qualities in the same intimate fashion. His first criticism of this belief is as follows: But can anyone conceive the extension and motion of a body without any of its secondary qualities? It is not in my power to frame an idea of a body extended and moving but I must withal give it some color or other secondary quality which is acknowledged to exist only in the mind. In short, primary qualities abstracted from secondary qualities are inconceivable. Where therefore the secondary qualities are, b.i wit, in the mind and nowhere else, there must the primary qualities be also.

His second criticism is this: Great and small, swift and slow, degrees of extension and motion, are allowed tu exist only in the mind, being entirely relative, and changing as the frame or position of the sense organs varies. The extension therefore that exists independently of the mind is neither great nor small; the action, neither swift nor slow. That is, they are nothing at all.

His third criticism is this: Number is entirely a creature of the mind. Even though the other primary quali­ ties be allowed to exist without, it will be evident that the same thing bears a different denomination of number as the mind views it with different respects. Thus the same extension is one, or three, or thirty-six, according as the mind considers it with refer­ ence to a yard, a foot, or an inch. Number is so visibly relative and dependent on men's understanding that it is strange anyone should give it an absolute existence without the mind.

His fourth criticism is this: One argument whereby modern philosophers would prove that secondary qual­ ities do not exist in matter but in our minds may be turned likewise against primary qualities. Thus, it is said that heat and cold are affections only of the mind and not at

GEORGE BERKELEY

549

all qualities of real things; for the same body which appears cold to one hand seems warm to another. Thus, too, it is proved that sweetness is not really in the sapid thing; because, the thing remaining unaltered, the sweetness is changed to bitterness, as in the case of a fever or otherwise vitiated palate. Now, why may we not as well argue that figure and extension are not real quali­ ties existing in matter? To the same eye at different stations, or to eyes of a different texture at the same station, they appear various. By parity of reasoning, therefore, they cannot be ideas of anything settled and determinate without the mind. In short, those arguments which are thought to prove that secondary qualities (colors, tastes, etc.) exist only in the mind, may with equal force be brought to prove the same thing of primary qualities (extension, figure, motion, etc.).

His fifth criticism is this: Suppose it were possible that material substances possessing only primary quali­ ties do exist independent of the mind. Yet how is it possible for us to know this? Either we know it by our senses or by our reason. As for our senses, by them we have knowledge only of our sensations: but they do not inform us that things exist inde­ pendent of the mind or unperceived by the mind, like to those which are perceived. This the materialists themselves acknowledge; nay, insist. It remains, therefore, that, if we have any knowledge at all of material sub­ stances, it must be by our reason inferring their existence from what is immediately perceived by sense. But I do not see what reason can induce us to believe in the exis­ tence of bodies independent of the mind, from what we perceive, since the very patrons of matter themselves do not pretend there is any necessary connection betwixt them and our ideas.

His sixth criticism is this: It may be thought easier to explain the production of our sensations by support­ ing external bodies, rather than otherwise; and so it might be at least probabk that there are such things as bodies that excite ideas in our minds. But neither can this be said. For, though we give the materialists their "external bodies," they by their own confession are no nearer knowing how our ideas are produced, since they own them­ selves unable to comprehend in what manner body can act upon spirit (or mind) or how it could imprint any idea in the mind. Hence it is evident that the production of ideas or sensations in our minds can be no reason why we should suppose matter or corporeal substances; since their pro­ duction is acknowledged to remain equally inexplicable with or without this particu­ lar supposition. If therefore it were possible for bodies to exist without the mind, yet to hold that they do so must needs be a very precarious opinion. In short, if there were external bodies, it is impossible we should come to know it; and if there were not, we might have the very same reasons to think there were that we have now. Which consideration were enough to make any reasonable person suspect the strength of whatever arguments he may think himself to have, for the existence of external bodies independent of the mind.

His conclusion is this: It is on this, therefore, that I insist, to wit, that the absolute existence of unthink­ ing things are words without a meaning, or which include a contradiction. That is

THE CLAIMS OF IDEALISM

what I repeat and inculcate, and earnestly recommend to the attentive thoug hts of the reader.

He turns now to an exploration of the reasons that may have led men ''to suppose the existence of material substance": It is worth while to reflect on the motives which induced men to suppose the existence of material substance; so that having observed the gradual ceasing and expi­ ration of those motives, we may withdraw the assent that was grounded on them. First it was thought that the sensible qualities did really exist without the mind. And for this reason it seemed needful to suppose that some unthinking substratum or substance wherein they did exist, since they could not be conceived to exist by them­ selves. Then, in time, men being convinced that secondary qualities had no existence without the mind, they stripped this substratum or material substance of those quali­ ties, leaving only the primary ones, which they still conceive to exist without the mind and consequently to stand in need of a material support. But now, it having been shown that none even of these can possibly exist other­ wise than in a spirit or mind which perceives them, it follows that we have no longer any reason to suppose the being of matter," nay, that it is utterly impossible that there should be any such thing so long as that word is taken to mean an unthinking substratum or substance for qualities wherein they exist without mind. It is an extra­ ordinary instance of the force of prejudice that the mind of man retains so great a fondness, against all the evidence of reason, for a stupid, thoughtless Somewhat as a support of the qualities we perceive. 11

Thus Berkeley on materialism. One is moved to ponder its effect upon Thomas Hobbes. A smile perhaps, a sharpening of his controversial quill as he prepared to do battle with this newcomer. For Berkeley, having"dethroned" mat­ ter, sets about to "enthrone" spirit. His first step is to secure one or two proposi­ tions that "any rational man" would admit. It is evident to anyone who takes a survey of the objects of human knowledge, that they are either ideas imprinted on the senses; or such as are perceived by attend­ ing to the passions and operations of the mind; or lastly, ideas formed by help of memory and imagination-compounding, dividing, or merely representing those originally perceived in the aforesaid ways. As several such ideas are observed to accompany each other, they come to be marked by one name, and so reputed as one thing. Thus a certain color, taste, smell, figure, and consistence having been observed to go together, are accounted one dis­ tinct thing, signified by the name apple. Other collections of ideas constitute a stone, a tree, a book, and the like. Besides the ideas or objects of knowledge, there is something which knows or perceives them, and exercises divers operations as willing, imagining, remembering, about them. This perceiving active being I call 11mind, spirit, sou( or myself. The existence of an idea consists in its being perceived. Its esse is percipi. The table I write on I say exists1 that is, I see and feel it; and if I were out of my study, I should say it existed"; meaning that if I was in my study, I might perceive it, or that some other spirit actually does perceive it. There v11as an odor, that is, it was smelt; there was a sound, that is, it was heard; there was a color or figure, that is, it was per11 1 1

11

';

11

11

11

11

11

11

BERKELEY

can understand these and ceived touch. Their esse is should have any existence out of the minds Nor is it which perceive them. All our ideas and sensations inactive. There is ,��_,_,...,,� � of power or agency included in them. One idea or sensation cannot or alter another. The very being of an idea implies passiveness and inertness in it; insomuch that it is impossible for an idea to do anything, or be the cause of anything. We perceive continual succession of ideas. Some are excited anew, others are changed or totally disappear. There is therefore some cause of these ideas, whereand which produces and changes them. upon they '-'V"''"'--'H---

to argue from them: It is clear, from what hath been said, that this cause cannot itself be any idea or sensation since all such are passive and inert. It must therefore be a substance. But it has been shown that here is no corporeal or material substance. It remains therefore that the cause of our ideas and sensations is an incorporeal active substance, or spirit. find can excite some of my ideas in my mind at pleasure, and vary and shift the scene as oft as think fit. This making and unmaking of ideas doth very properly denominate the mind active. Thus much is certain and grounded on experience. But when we talk, as do materialists, of unthinking substances producing ideas, we only amuse ourselves with words. But whatever power I have over some of my ideas, I find that others have not a like dependence on my will. When, for example, I open my eyes in broad daylight, it is not in my power to choose whether shall see or no, nor to determine what I shall see. It is likewise as to hearing and the other senses. The ideas imprinted on them are not creatures of my will. There is, therefore, some other will or mind or that produces them. These ideas which cannot control, these ideas of sense, are more strong, more lively, more distinct than those which can control. They have, likewise, a steadiness, order, and coherence which belong not to those that are the effects of my will. They speak themselves the products of a mind more pmverful and wise than human needs. Some truths there are so near and obvious to the human mind that a man need only open his eyes to see them. Such take this important one to be, namely, that all the choir of heaven and furniture of the earth, in a word, all those bodies which com­ pose the mighty frame of the world, have not any subsistence, without a mind; that their being is to be perceived or known; that, consequently, so long as they are not actually perceived by me, or do not exist in my mind or the mind of any other created spirit, they must either have no existence at all or else subsist in the mind of some Eternal Spirit. For it is unintelligible to attribute to any single part of them an exis­ tence independent of (perception by a) Spirit.

tion. Are there any on this ,.,"·

these ��ii�--i���, l:5erl.,,D,h�T had drawn the wrong philosophical conclusions. pursues this line of attack. Laudan tries to Our next show how Kuhn may have been misled the history of science. AA«.u.i,.A'L'-L

c



,n+ITT

hSC'r,v,••T,

��·��•�i,,

Laudan was born in BIOGRAPHICAL NOTE. received his Ph.D. in philosophy from Princeton where he was of at the of philosophy at the area of Relativism

THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES.

If Kuhn is then are wrong. But Kuhn has made some JLJU.LI.UL•u._._,, pa.r;:,1cug_rr1s can exist at three levels:

errors.

KUHN ON THE UNITS OF SCIENTIFIC CHANGE

It is notorious that the key Kuhnian concept of a paradigm is multiply Among its most central meanings are the following three: First and t-nrornr.ci- a para­ digm offers a conceptual framework for classifying and explaining natural objects. That is, it specifies in a generic way the sorts of entities which are thought to populate a certain domain of experience and it sketches out how those entities generally inter­ act. In short, every paradigm will make certain claims about what populates the world. Such ontological claims mark that paradigm off from others, since each para­ to postulate entities and modes of interaction which differentiate it digm is from other ,.,, .. ,_u�_,,.,,uu, Second, a paradigm will specify the appropriate methods, techniques, and tools of for studying the objects in the relevant domain of LUH'-''F,""'-'""'-'•

u.�,�,-,,n

KUHN HAS MISREAD SCIENCE AND ITS HISTORY

application. Just as different paradigms have different ontologies, so they involve substantially different methodologies. (Consider, for instance, the very diffe rent methods of research and theory evaluation associated with behaviorism and cogni­ tive psychology respectively.) These methodological commitments are persistent ones, and they characterize the paradigm throughout its history. Finally, the propo­ nents of different paradigms will, according to Kuhn, espouse different sets of cogni­ tive goals or ideals. Although the partisans of two paradigms may (and usually do) share some aims in common, Kuhn insists that the goals are not fully overlapping between followers of rival paradigms. Indeed, to accept a paradigm is, for Kuhn, to subscribe to a complex of cognitive values which the proponents of no other para­ digm accept fully. Paradigm change, on this account, clearly represents a break of great magnitude. To trade in one paradigm for another is to involve oneself in changes at each of the three levels defined ... above. We give up one ontology for another, one methodol­ ogy for another, and one set of cognitive goals for another. Moreover, according to Kuhn, this change is simultaneous rather than sequential. It is worth observing in pass­ ing that, for all Kuhn's vitriol about the impoverishment of older models of scientific rationality, there are several quite striking similarities between the classical version of the hierarchical model and Kuhn's alternative to it.Both lay central stress on the justi­ ficatory interactions between claims at the factual, methodological, and axiological levels. Both emphasize the centrality of values and standards as providing criteria of choice between rival views lower in the hierarchy. Where Kuhn breaks, and breaks radically, with the tradition is in his insistence that rationality must be relativized to choices within a paradigm rather than choices between paradigms. Whereas the older account of the hierarchical model had generally supposed that core axiological and methodological commitments would typically be common property across the sci­ ences of an epoch, Kuhn asserts that there are methodological and axiological dis­ crepancies between any two paradigms. Indeed (as we shall see below), one of the core failings of Kuhn's position is that it so fully internalizes the classical b ierarchical approach that, whenever the latter breaks down (as it certainly does in grappling with interparadigmatic debate, or any other sort of disagreement involving conflict­ ing goals), Kuhn's approach has nothing more to offer concerning the possibility of rational choices.I For now, however, the immediate point to stress is that Kuhn portrays paradigm changes in ways that make them seem to be abrupt and global ruptures in the life of a scientific community.So great is this supposed transition that several of Kuhn's critics have charged that, despite Kuhn's proclaimed intentions to the contrary, his analysis inevitably turns scientific change into a nonrational or irrational process. In part, but only in part, it is Kuhn's infelicitous terminology that produces this impression. Notoriously, he speaks of the acceptance of a new paradigm as a "conversion experi­ ence,"2 conjuring up a picture of the scientific revolutionary as a born-again 1 It has been insufficiently noted just how partial Kuhn's break with positivism is, so far as cog­ nitive goals and values are concerned. As I show in detail below, most of his problems about the alleged incomparability of theories arise because Kuhn accepts without argument the positivist claim that cognitive values or standards at the top of the hierarchy are fundamentally immune to rational negotiation. 2 Kuhn, 1962.

LARRY LAUDAN

655

Christian, long on zeal and short on argument. At other times he likens paradigm change to an "irreversible Gestalt-shift."3 Less metaphorically, he claims that there is never a point at which it is "unreasonable" to hold onto an old paradigm rather than to accept a new one.4 Such language does not encourage one to imagine that para­ digm change is exactly the result of a careful and deliberate weighing-up of the respective strengths of rival contenders. But impressions based on some of Kuhn's more lurid language can probably be rectified by cleaning up some of the vocabulary of The Structure of Scientific Revolutions, a task on which Kuhn has been embarked more or less since the book first appeared.5 No changes of terminology, however, will alter the fact that some central features of Kuhn's model of science raise serious road­ blocks to a rational analysis of scientific change. The bulk of this chapter is devoted to examining some of those impedimenta. Before we turn to that examination, however, I want to stress early on that my complaint with Kuhn is not merely that he has failed to give any normatively robust or rational account of theory change, serious as that failing is. As I show below, he has failed even at the descriptive or narrative task of offering an accurate story about the manner in which large-scale changes of scientific allegiance occur. But there is yet more fundamental respect in which Kuhn's approach presents obstacles to an understanding of the dynamics of theory change. Specifically, by insisting that individual paradigms have an integral and static character-that changes take place only between, rather than within, paradigms-Kuhn has missed the single feature of science which promises to mediate and rationalize the transition from one world view or paradigm to another. Kuhn's various writings on this subject leave the reader in no doubt that he thinks the parts of a paradigm go together as an inseparable package. As he puts it in The Structure of Scientific Revolutions, "In learning a paradigm the scientist acquires theory, methods, and standards together, usunlly in an inextricable mix."6 This theme, of the inextricable and inseparable ingredienis of a paradigm, is a persistent one in Kuhn's work. One key aim of this chapter is to show how drastically we need to alter Kuhn's views about how tightly the pieces of a para­ digm's puzzle fit together before we can expect to understand how paradigmlike change occurs. Loosening up the fit.-Without too heavy an element of caricature, we can describe world-view models such as Kuhn's along the following lines: one group or faction in the scientific community accepts a particular "big picture." That requires acquiescence in a certain ontology of nature, acceptance of a specific set of rules about how to investigate nature, and adherence to a set of cognitive values about the teleol­ ogy of natural inquiry (i.e., about the goals that science seeks). On this analysis, large­ scale scientific change involves the replacement of one such world view by another, a process that entails the simultaneous repudiation of the key elements of the old pic­ ture and the adoption of corresponding (but of course different) elements of the new. In short, scientific change looks something like Figure 3.

3 Ibid. 4 Ibid., p. 159. s As Kuhn himself remarks, he has been attempting "to eliminate misunderstandings for which ° my own past rhetoric is doubtless partially responsible ' (1970 1 pp. 259-260). 6 Kuhn, 19621 p. 108; my italics.

6

KUHN HAS MISREAD SCIENCE AND ITS HISTORY

WV1 (ontology 1, methodology 1, values i)

i

WV2 (ontology 2, methodology 2, values 2)

Figure 3.

Kuhn's Picture of Theory Change

When scientific change is construed so globally, it is no small challenge to see how it could be other than a conversion experience. If different scientists not only espouse different theories but also subscribe to different standards of appraisal and ground those standards in different and conflicting systems of cognitive goals, then it is difficult indeed to imagine that scientific change could be other than a whimsical change of style or taste. There could apparently never be compelling grounds for say­ ing that one paradigm is better than another, for one has to ask: Better relative to which standards and whose goals? To make matters worse-much worse-Kuhn often suggested that each paradigm is more or less automatically guaranteed to sat­ isfy its own standards and to fail the standards of rival paradigms, thus producing a kind of self-reinforcing solipsism in science. As he once put it, "To the extent, as sig­ nificant as it is incomplete, that two scientific schools disagree about what is a prob­ lem and what a solution, they will inevitably talk through each other when debating the merits of their respective paradigms. In the partially circular arguments that regu­ larly result, each paradigm will be shown to satisfy more or less the criteria that it dic­ tates for itself and to fall short of those dictated by its opponent."7 Anyone who writes prose of this sort must think that scientific decision making is fundamentally capri­ cious. Or at least so many of us thought in the mid- and late 1960s, as philosophers began to digest Kuhn's ideas. In fact, if one looks at several discussions of Kuhn s work dating from that period, one sees this theme repeatedly. Paradigm change, it was said, could not possibly be a reasoned or rational process, Kuhn, we thought, has made science into an irrational "monster."

Next, Laudan claims that we rarely shift ontological claims, methodological rules, and cognitive goals all at once, as Kuhn implies. Too, rationality is not so paradigm-relative as Kuhn believes. Kuhn makes these mistakes because he doesn't present an accurate reflection of history and because ontological claims, methodological rules, and cognitive goals are logically separate, not all to be lumped together by Kuhn's term, paradigm. Moreover, external considerations are not always the deciding factors as paradigms shift. For example, Kuhn claimed that Lavoisier won out over Priestley because the followers of Priestley died out, but many historians have disputed Kuhn's reading of this episode. The clear implication of Kuhn's writings is that interparadigmatic debate is necessar­ ily inconclusive and thus can never be brought to rational closure. When closure does occur, it must therefore be imposed on the situation by such external factors as the demise of some of the participants or the manipulation of the levers of power and reward within the institutional structure of the scientific community. Philosophers of science, almost without exception, have found such implications troubling, for they 7 Ibid., pp. 108-109.

LARRY LAUDAN

657

directly confute what philosophers have been at pains for two millennia to establish: to wit, that scientific disputes, and more generally all disagreements about matters of fact, are in principle open to rational clarification and resolution. It is on the strength of passages such as those I have mentioned that Kuhn has been charged with rela­ tivism, subjectivism, irrationalism, and a host of other sins high on the philosopher's hit list. There is some justice in these criticisms of Kuhn's work, for (as I suggested in Chap. 1) Kuhn has failed over the past twenty years to elaborate any coherent account of consensus formation, that is, of the manner in which scientists could ever agree to support one world view rather than another.But that flaw, serious though it is, can probably be remedied, for I want to suggest that the problem of consensus for­ mation can be solved if we make two fundamental amendments in Kuhn's position. First (as argued in Chap. 3), we must replace the hierarchical view of justification with the reticulated picture, thereby making cognitive values "negotiable." Second, we must simply drop Kuhn's insistence on the integral character of world views or paradigms. More specifically, we solve the problems of consensus once we realize that the various components of a world view are individually negotiable and individually replaceable in a piecemeal fashion (that is, in such a manner that replacement of one ele­ ment need not require wholesale repudiation of all the other components), Kuhn himself grants, of course, that some components of a world view can be revised; that is what "paradigm articulation " is all about. But for Kuhn, as for such other world view theorists as Lakatos and Foucault, the central commitments of a world view, its "hard core " (to use Lakatos's marvelous phrase), are not revisable-short of rejecting the entire world view. The core ontology of a world view or paradigm, along with its methodology and axiology, comes on a take-it-or-leave-it basis. Where these levels of commitment are concerned, Kuhn (along with such critics of him as Lakatos) is an uncompromising holist. Consider, for instance, his remark: "Just because it is a transi­ tion between incommensurables, the transition between competing paradigms can­ not be made a step at a time ...like the Gestalt-switch, it must occur aU at once or not at all."S Kuhn could hardly be less ambiguous on this point. But paradigms or research programs need not be so rigidly conceived, and typi­ cally they are not so conceived by scientists; nor, if we reflect on it a moment, should they be so conceived. As I show in earlier chapters, there are complex justifactory interconnections among a scientist's ontology, his methodology, and his axiology.If a scientist's methodology fails to justify his ontology; if his methodology fails to promote his cognitive aims; if his cognitive aims prove to be utopian-in all these cases the sci­ entist will have compelling reasons for replacing one component or other of his world view with an element that does the job better. You need not modify everything else. To be more precise, the choice confronting a scientist whose world view is under strain in this manner need be nothing like as stark as the choice sketched in figure 3 (where it is a matter of sticking with what he knows best unchanged or throwing that over for something completely different), but rather a choice where the modification of one core element-while retaining the others-may bring a decided improvement.... But, once we begin to play around with the transformations permitted by the reticulational model, we see that the transition from one paradigm or world view to another can itself be a step-wise process, requiring none of the wholesale shifts in s Ibid., p. 149.

n�-��,

some such series of shifts occurred in to the natural philosophy of Newton.9 solution of the n.rr.hlo,-,, of consensus in the multiparadigm situation to be nothing more than a special or instance of unitraditional change. follows that, if we can show that the unitradi­ tional fairy tale has something going for it, then we will solve both forms of the con­ sensus-formation problem simultaneously. The core question is whether the gradual­ ist myth, which have sketched out, is better supported by the historical record than the holistic picture associated with Kuhn. 001 "

·~•H"Cro,hu the parts are together. So, thera­ pists wish to foster their patients' mental health, they should not be afraid to increase that load through a reorientation toward the meaning of one's life.

The Existential Vacuum. When persons feel that their lives are when they lack awareness of something worth when are in the midst of what Frankl calls the e.xD, ,':::,':-1,' '::· ,,o an inner on,-,r..t·,n,c:,cc "existential vacuum." The liberation of humans from certain animal instincts and cultural traditions has set them adrift and made them to the existential vacuum. This vacuum may find OVlC"\YC>cc,r.n the of power, or the of pleasure. �ALHA,,�v�A

..--. ,.

,.,,..,.,,._,..,.,.L

The existential vacuum is a widespread phenomenon of the twentieth century. This is understandable; it may be due to a twofold loss that man had to undergo since he became a truly human being. At the beginning of human history man lost some of the basic animal instincts in which an animal's behavior is embedded and by which it is secured. Such security, like Paradise, is closed to man forever; man has to make choices. In addition to this, however, man has suffered another loss in his more recent development: the traditions that had buttressed his behavior are now rapidly diminishing. No instinct tells him what he has to do, and no tradition tells him what he ought to do; soon he will not know what he wants to do. More and more he will be governed by what others want him to do, thus increasingly falling prey to con­ formism. A cross-sectional, statistical survey of the patients and the nursing staff was con­ ducted by my staff in the neurological department at the Vienna Poliklinik It revealed that 55% of the persons questioned showed a more or less marked degree of existential vacuum. In other words, more than half of them had experienced a loss of the feeling that life is meaningful. This existential vacuum manifests itself mainly in a state of boredom. Now we can understand Schopenhauer when he said that mankind was apparently doomed to vacillate eternally between the two extremes of distress and boredom. In actual fact, boredom is now causing, and certainly bringing to psychiatrists, more problems to solve than is distress. And these problems are growing increasingly crucial, for pro­ gressive automation will probably lead to an enormous increase in the leisure hours of average workers. The pity of it is that many of them will not know what to do with all their newly acquired free time. Let us think, for instance, of "Sunday neurosis," that kind of depression which afflicts people who become aware of the lack of content in their lives when the rush of the busy week is over and the void within themselves becomes manifest. Not a few cases of suicide can be traced back to this existential vacuum. Such w1cte;sp1react phe­ nomena as alcoholism and juvenile delinquency are not understandable unless we recognize the existential vacuum underlying them. This is also true of the crises pensioners and aging people.

THE WILL TO MEANING

Moreover, there are various masks and guises under which the existential vac­ uum appears. Sometimes the frustrated will to meaning is vicariously compensated for by a will to power, including the most primitive form of the will to power, the will to money. In other cases, the place of frustrated will to meaning is taken by the will to pleasure. That is why existential frustration often eventuates in sexual compensation. We can observe, in such cases, that the sexual libido becomes rampant in the existen­ tial vacuum. An analogous event occurs in neurotic cases. There are certain types of feedback mechanisms and vicious-circle formations that I will touch upon later. One can observe again and again, however, that this symptomatology has invaded an existen­ tial vacuum wherein it continues to flourish. In such patients, what we have to deal with is not a noogenic neurosis. However, we will never succeed in having the patient overcome his condition if we do not supplement the psychotherapeutic treat­ ment with logotherapy. For by filling the existential vacuum, the patient will be pre­ vented from further relapses. Therefore, logotherapy is indicated not only in noo­ genic cases, as pointed out above, but also in psychogenic cases, and in particular in what I have termed the "somatogenic (pseudo-) neuroses." Viewed in this light, a statement once made by Magda B. Arnoldl is justified: "Every therapy must in some way, no matter how restricted, also be logotherapy."

The Meaning of Life. What, then, is the meaning of life that fills the existential vacuum? In Frankl' s reply, which follows, note that Frankl suggests that the meaning of one's life fluctuates from day to day, from hour to hour. Is Frankl adopting the Sartrean perspective that we are called upon to define and redefine ourselves day by day, moment by moment? Is he suggesting, again in Sartrean fashion, that humans invent their meanings moment by moment rather than dis­ cover them? Or is Frankl simply saying that the meanings or purposes life holds for each of us must be discovered in specific settings and that there is no overall general meaning to life? What is the difference between inventing meaning and discovering it? Is this an important distinction? I doubt whether a doctor can answer this question in general terms. For the meaning of life differs from man to man, from day to day and from hour to hour. What mat­ ters, therefore, is not the meaning of life in general but rather the specific meaning of a person's life at a given moment. To put the question in general terms would be comparable to the question posed to a chess champion, "Tell me, Master, what is the best move in the world?" There simply is no such thing as the best or even a good move apart from a particular situation in a game and the particular personality of one's opponent. The same holds for human existence. One should not search for an abstract meaning of life. Everyone has his own specific vocation or mission in lifei everyone must carry out a concrete assignment that demands fulfillment. Therein he cannot be replaced, nor can his life be repeated. Thus, everyone's task is as unique as is his specific opportunity to implement it. As each situation in life represents a challenge to man and presents a problem for him to solve, the question of the meaning of life may actually be reversed. 1 Magda B. Arnold and John A. Gasson, The Human Person (New York: The Ronald Press Company, 1954), p. 618.

VIKTOR E. FRANKL

695

Ultimately, man should not ask what the meaning of life is, but rather must recognize that it is he who is asked. In a word, each man is questioned by life; and he can only answer to life by answering for his own life; to life he can only respond by being responsible. Thus, logotherapy sees in responsibleness the very essence of human existence.... Thus far we have shown that the meaning of life always changes, but that it never ceases to be.According to logotherapy, we can discover this meaning in life in three different ways: (1) by doing a deed; (2) by experiencing a value; and (3) by suf­ fering. The first, the way of achievement or accomplishment, is quite obvious. The second and third need further elaboration. The second way of finding a meaning in life is by experiencing something, such as a work of nature or culture; and also by experiencing someone, i.e., by love. Love is the only way to grasp another human being in the innermost core of his personality. No one can become fully aware of the very essence of another human being unless he loves him. By the spiritual act of love he is enabled to see the essential traits and features in the beloved person; and even more, he sees that which is poten­ tial in him, that which is not yet actualized but yet ought to be actualized. Furthermore, by his love, the loving person enables the beloved person to actualize these potentialities. By making him aware of what can be and of what he should become, he makes these potentialities come true. In logotherapy, love is not interpreted as a mere epiphenomenon of sexual drives and instincts in the sense of a so-called sublimation. Love is as primary a phenomenon as sex. Normally, sex is a mode of expression for love. Sex is justified, even sanctified, as soon as, but only as long as, it is a vehicle of love. Thus love is not understood as a mere side effect of sex but sex as a way of expressing the experience of that ultimate togetherness that is called love. A third way to find a meaning in life is by suffering. Whenever one is confronted with an inescapable, unavoidable situation, when­ ever one has to face a fate that cannot be changed, e.g., an incurable disease, such as an inoperable cancer, just then is one give a last chance to actualize the highest value, to fulfill the deepest meaning, the meaning of suffering. For what matters above all 1s the attitude we take toward suffering, the attitude in which we take our suffering upon ourselves. Let me cite a clear-cut example: Once, an elderly general practitioner consulted me because of his severe depression. He could not overcome the loss of his wife who had died two years before and whom he had loved above all else. Now how could I help him? What should I tell him? Well, I refrained from telling him anything, but instead confronted him with the question, "What would have happened, Doctor, if you had died first, and your wife would have had to survive you?" "Oh," he said, "for her this would have been terrible; how she would have suffered!" Whereupon I replied, "You see, Doctor, such a suffering has been spared her, and it is you who have spared her this suffering; but now, you have to pay for it by surviving and mourning her." He said no word but shook my hand and calmly left my office. Suffering ceases to be suffering in some way at the moment it finds a meaning, such as the meaning of a sacrifice. Of course, this was no therapy in the proper sense since, first, his despair was no disease; and second, I could not change his fate, I could not revive his wife. But in that moment I did succeed in changing his attitude toward his unalterable fate inas­ much as from that time on he could at least see a meaning in his suffering. It is one of the basic tenets of logotherapy that man's main concern is not to gain pleasure or to

THE WILL TO MEANING

avoid pain, but rather to see a meaning in his life. That is why man is even ready to suffer, on the condition, to be sure, that his suffering has a meaning. It goes without saying that suffering would not have a meaning unless it were absolutely necessary; e.g., a cancer that can be cured by surgery must not be shoul­ dered by the patient as though it were his cross. This would be masochism rather than heroism. But if a doctor can neither heal the disease nor bring relief to the patient by easing his pain, he should enlist the patient's capacity to fulfill the meaning of his suf­ fering. Traditional psychotherapy has aimed at restoring one's capacity to work and to enjoy life; logotherapy includes these, yet goes further by having the patient regain his capacity to suffer, if need be, thereby finding meaning even in suffering. In this context Edith Weisskopf-Joelson, professor of psychology at Purdue University, contends, in her article on logotherapy,2 that "our current mental-hygiene philosophy stresses the idea that people ought to be happy, that unhappiness is a symptom of maladjustment. Such a value system might be responsible for the fact that the burden of unavoidable unhappiness is increased by unhappiness about being unhappy." And in another paper, 3 she expresses the hope that logotherapy "may help counteract certain unhealthy trends in the present-day culture of the United States, where the incurable sufferer is given very little opportunity to be proud of his suffering and to consider it ennobling rather than degrading" so that "he is not only unhappy, but also ashamed of being unhappy." There are situations in which one is cut off from the opportunity to do one's work or to enjoy one's life; but what never can be ruled out is the unavoidability of suffering. In accepting this challenge to suffer bravely, life has a meaning up to the last moment, and it retains this meaning literally to the end. In other words, life's meaning is an unconditional one, for it even includes the potential meaning of suffering. Let me recall that which was perhaps the deepest experience I had in the con­ centration camp. The odds of surviving the camp were no more than one to twenty, as can easily be verified by exact statistics. It did not even seem possible, let alone probable, that the manuscript of my first book, which I had hidden in my coat when I arrived at Auschwitz, would ever be rescued. Thus, I had to undergo and to over­ come the loss of my spiritual child. And now it seemed as if nothing and no one would survive me; neither a physical nor a spiritual child of my own! So I found myself confronted with the question of whether under such circumstances my life was ultimately void of any meaning. Not yet did I notice that an answer to this question with which I was wrestling so passionately was already in store for me, and that soon thereafter this answer would be given to me. This was the case when I had to surrender my clothes and in turn inherited the worn-out rags of an inmate who had been sent to the gas chamber immediately after his arrival at the Auschwitz railway station. Instead of the many pages of my manuscript, I found in a pocket of the newly acquired coat a single page torn out of a Hebrew prayer book, which contained the main Jewish prayer, Shema Yisrael. How should I have interpreted such a "coincidence" other than as a challenge to live my thoughts instead of merely putting them on paper? 2 Edith Weisskopf-Joelson, "Some Comments on a Viennese School of Psychiatry," The Journal

of Abnormal and Social Psychology, Vol. 51, pp. 701-3 (1955).

3 Edith Weisskopf-Joelson, "Logotherapy and Existential Analysis," Acta psychotherap., Vol. 6, pp. 193-204 (1958).

VIKTOR E. FRANKL

697

A bit later, I remember, it seemed to me that I would die in the near future. In this critical situation, however, my concern was different from that of most of my comrades. Their question was, "Will we survive the camp? For, if not, all this suffer­ ing has no meaning." The question which beset me was, "Has all this suffering, this dying around us, a meaning? For, if not, then ultimately there is no meaning to sur­ vival; for a life whose meaning depends upon such a happenstance-whether one escapes or not-ultimately would not be worth living at all."

Modern Collective Neurosis: Nihilism. Frankl claims that much of modern psy­ chotherapy is informed by what he calls "pan-determinism," the view that the human is fully conditioned by hereditary and environmental factors. This view, says Frankl, breeds both fatalism (the claim that there is not much one can do to alter the predetermined course of his or her life) and also nihilism (the claim that life has no meaning). Indeed, if I accept the contention that I am a pawn of forces beyond my control, that I cannot alter the inexorable playing out of those forces, am I not induced to think of myself as merely a puff of smoke in the capricious winds of primal forces, an ephemeral thing devoid of meaning, a thing whose existence is like a tale told by an idiot-full of sound and fury but signifying noth­ ing? For Frankl, nihilism is the disease of modern humankind, and Frankl offers some strong words in response. Every age has its own collective neurosis, and every age needs its own psychotherapy to cope with it. The existential vacuum that is the mass neurosis of the present time, can be described as a private and personal form of nihilism; for nihilism can be defined as the contention that being has no meaning. As for psychotherapy, however, it will never be able to cope with this state of affairs on a mass scale if it does not keep itself free from the impact and influence of the contemporary trends of a nihilistic philosophy; otherwise it represents a symptom of the mass neurosis rather than its possible cure. Psychotherapy would not only reflect a nihilistic philosophy but abo, even though unwillingly and unwittingly, transmit to the patient what is actually a caricature rather than a true picture of man. First of all, there is a danger inherent in the teaching of man's "nothingbutness," the theory that man is nothing but the result of biological, psychological and sociolog­ ical conditions, or the product of heredity and environment. Such a view of man makes him into a robot, not a human being. This neurotic fatalism is fostered and strengthened by a psychotherapy that denies that man is free. To be sure, a human being is a finite being, and his freedom is restricted. It is not freedom from conditions, but freedom to take a stand toward the conditions. For example, I am certainly not responsible for the fact that I have gray hair; however, I am responsible for the fact that I did not go to the hairdresser to have him tint my hair-as a number of ladies might have done. So there is a certain amount of freedom left to everyone, even if only the choice of the color of one's hair. Psychoanalysis has often been blamed for its so-called pan-sexualism. I, for one, doubt whether this approach has ever been legitimate. However, there is something that seems to me to be an even more erroneous and dangerous assumption, namely, that which I call "pan-determinism." By that I mean the view of man that disregards his capacity to take a stand toward any conditions whatsoever. Man is not fully conditioned and determined; he determines himself whether to give in to conditions or stand up to

THE WILL TO MEANING

them. In other words, man is ultimately self-determining. Man does not simply exist, but always decides what his existence will be, what he will become in the next moment. By the same token, every human being has the freedom to change at an instant. Therefore, we can predict his future only within the large frame of a statistical survey referring to a whole group; the individual personality, however, remains essentially unpredictable. The basis for any predictions would be represented by biological, psy­ chological or sociological conditions. Yet one of the main features of human existence is the capacity to rise above such conditions and transcend them. In the same man­ ner, man ultimately transcends himself; a human being is self-transcending being. Let me cite the case of Dr. J_. He was the only man I ever encountered in my whole life whom I would dare to call a Mephistophelean being, a satanic figure. At that time he was generally called "the mass murderer of Steinhof," the name of the large mental hospital in Vienna. When the Nazis started their euthanasia program, he held all the strings in his hands and was so fanatic in the job assigned to him that he tried not to let one single psychotic individual escape the gas chamber. After the war, when I came back to Vienna I asked what had happened to Dr. J_. "He has been imprisoned by the Russians in one of the isolation cells of Steinhof," they told me. "On the next day, however, the door of his cell stood open and Dr. J_ was never seen again." Later I was convinced that, like others, he had by the help of his com­ rades made his way to South America. More recently, however, I was consulted by a former Austrian diplomat who had been imprisoned behind the Iron Curtain for many years, first in Siberia and then in the famous Ljubljanka prison in Moscow. While I was examining him neurologically, he suddenly asked me whether I hap­ pened to know Dr. J___ . After my affirmative reply he continued: "I made his acquaintance in Ljubljanka. There he died, at about forty, from cancer of the urinary bladder. Before he died, however, he showed himself to be the best comrade you can imagine! He gave consolation to everybody. He lived up to the highest conceivable moral standard. He was the best friend I ever met during my long years in prison!" This is the story of Dr. J_, "the mass murderer of Steinhof." How can you dare to predict the behavior of man! You may predict the movements of a machine, of an automaton; more than this, you may even try to p redict the mechanisms or "dynamisms" of the human psyche as well: but man is more than psyche.... For too long a time, for half a century in fact, psychiatry tried to interpret the human mind merely as a mechanism, and consequently the therapy of mental dis­ ease merely as a technique. I believe this dream has been dreamt out. What now begin to loom on the horizon are not the sketches of a psychologized medicine, but those of a humanized psychiatry. A doctor, however, who would still interpret his own role mainly as that of a technician, would confess that he sees in his patient nothing more than a machine, instead of seeing the human being behind the disease! A human being is not one thing among others; things determine each other, but man is ultimately self-determining. What he becomes-within the limits of endow­ ment and environment-he has made out of himself. In the concentration camps, for example, in this living laboratory and on this testing ground, we watched and wit­ nessed some of our comrades behave like swine while others behaved like saints. Man has both potentialities within himself; which one is actualized depends on deci­ sions but not on conditions. Our generation is realistic, for we have come to know man as he really is. After all, man is that being who has invented the gas chambers of Auschwitz; however, he

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION

699

is also that being who has entered those gas chambers upright, with the Lord's Prayer or the Shema Yisrael on his lips.

In reflecting upon Frankl' s argument several questions are worth noting. What if the Nazis,who ran the concentration camps where Frankl and his fellow prisoners suffered, claimed that they were simply fulfilling the meaning that life harbored for them at that time? Are all meanings equally warranted because all are disprivileged? Would not Frankl find repugnant the goal or purpose of some Nazis (namely, building a master race through racial, ethnic, and genetic cleans­ ing), a goal which invested their lives with meaning and enabled them to sur­ vive? But by what criteria would Frankl reject this Nazi sense of meaning? By what criteria would he adjudicate diverse human projects? Is not this same prob­ lem encountered by the virtue ethicists (see Chapter 6) when they challenge us to ask "What kind of a person will I become if I do this act, and is that the kind of person I wish to become?" Are we perhaps driven to affirm Bernard Gert's five moral rules as reflecting five fundamental human evils (death, pain, disability, loss of freedom, loss of pleasure) that must be recognized and avoided, if possi­ ble,for humans to survive and flourish? Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted from Viktor Frankl Man's Search for Meaning: An Introduction to Logotherapy (New York: Pocket Books, 1963),pp.103-107,117-122, 154-173,176-183,204-209,212-214.

'f

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION

THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS

FROM FRANKL TO THE BIBLICAL TRADITION. According to Frankl, life presents each person with an open and distinctive future.My future is open because there are real possible future alternatives presented to me from which I can, must, and do choose. I am free. I have tasks to perform, and/or values to be experienced, and/or inescapable sufferings to endure that are uniquely mine. The specific meaning or purpose that I am called upon to fulfill each day is uniquely mine,no one else's.Frankl declares that "the meaning of life differs from man to man,from day to day and from hour to hour. ... One should not search for an abstract meaning of life. Everyone has his own specific vocation or mission in life ..." (Man's Search for Meaning, pp.171-172). If, as Frankl says, my meaning for today is uniquely mine and yours is uniquely yours, does that mean that the general or cosmic question which embraces all of us (What is the meaning of life?) and which is frequently answered by the world's religious traditions is an inappropriate question? Not necessarily. As a logotherapist, Frankl focuses on the individual's specific, per­ sonal story, not on humankind's story in general. Yet he neither criticizes nor ignores the cosmic stories that his patients bring with them. Indeed, on occasion

THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS

he draws on a patient's cosmic story to help the patient exit the existential vac­ uum. Clearly, Frankl is not an enemy of the cosmic story. One could even argue that his view of the will to meaning being fulfilled through a task performed, a value experienced, or an inescapable suffering endured is itself a cosmic story that describes the form that human meaning takes, a form that all humans share and a form that each individual is called upon to fill with content through per­ sonal, specific choices. Furthermore, a case could be made that the cosmic stories of the great religious traditions focus on Frankl' s three categories: work, love, and suffering. Let us proceed, then/ to examine the cosmic stories offered by several representative religious traditions beginning with the biblical view, bearing in mind of course that not all cosmic stories are religious. Norn. The Bible, from which the excerpts in this section have been taken, is not just one book. It is, rather, a mini-library of more than sixty volumes. It was written over the course of more than ten centuries by scores of contribut­ ing writers. Some of these writers are known; others unknown. Indeed, one of the finest theological treatises in the collection was written by an anonymous per­ son called "Second Isaiah" by scholars because his or her treatise was simply attached to the end of the book written by Isaiah. Diverse literary forms are pre­ sent in the Bible, including poetry, parables, letters, myths, historical narratives, and regulations for secular and sacred activities. As the biblical narrative unfolds, we encounter Abraham leaving Mesopotamia, around 1750 B.C., in search of a land where he can raise his family and serve his God. He settled in the land of Canaan where his son Isaac, grand­ son Jacob (also referred to as "Israel"), and their descendants lived until a famine drove Jacob and his family to Egypt for food. In Egypt they flourished until the Egyptians forced them into servitude. Around 1290 B.C. Moses masterminded the Exodus of the children of Israel from Egypt and their journey back to Canaan. In Canaan, after a protracted struggle, they subdued their rivals for the land and established a kingdom around 1020 B.C., first ruled by Saul and then by David. The rising and falling fortunes of this kingdom are chronicled in page after page of the Bible. Infused into this political story is the theme that the children of Israel, in all their actions, are either cooperating with their God or frustrating his revealed plans for them. Indeed, it would be safe to say that the Bible, in spite of its being a multivolume work, contains a single unifying perspective of a God who acts pur­ posefully. The Bible presents us with the picture of a God who has a purpose, who is involved in events to promote that purpose, and who reveals himself to humans to invite them to participate with him in accomplishing that purpose. The goal of divine action in the Bible seems to be the creation of a "people of God," a human community that is holy, just, and righteous, a community that eventually would bring spiritual enlightenment to humankind. The story that unfolds in the Bible is, accordingly, a drama of the vacillating responses of the children of Israel to the divine summons to be a people of God. HISTORICAL

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION

701

The first passage we have selected comes from Deuteronomy, the fifth book of the Bible. It was probably written no earlier than the late seventh century B.C., but it represents a more ancient oral tradition that in all likelihood stems from Moses. This passage prescribes the prayer a faithful Israelite is to offer when bringing the firstfruits of the harvest to the priest as an expression of thankfulness to God. Homeless Aramaean" in verse 5 refers to Jacob. ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES.

11

26 2

3

4 5

WHEN YOU COME INTO THE LAND WHICH the LORD your God is giving you to occupy as your patrimony and settle in it, you shall take the firstfruits of all the produce of the soil, which you gather in from the land which the LORD your God is giving you, and put them in a basket. Then you shall go to the place which the LORD your God will choose as a dwelling for his Name and come to the priest, whoever he shall be in those days. You shall say to him, 'I declare this day to the LORD your God that I have entered the land which the LORD swore to our forefathers to give us.' The priest shall take the basket from your hand and set it down before the altar of the LORD your God. Then you shall solemnly recite before the LORD your God: 'My father was a homeless Aramaean who went down to Egypt with a small company and lived there until they became a great, powerful, and

numerous nation. But the Egyptians ill­ treated us, humiliated us and imposed cruel slavery upon us. Then we cried to the LORD the God of our fathers for help, and he listened to us and saw our humiliation, our hardship and distress; and so the LORD brought us out of Egypt with a strong hand and out­ stretched arm, with terrifying deeds, and with signs and portents. He brought us to this place and gave us this land, a land flowing with milk and honey. And now I have brought the firstfruits of the soil which thou, 0 LORD, hast given me.' You shall then set the basket before the LORD your God and bow down in worship before him. You shall all rejoice, you and the Levites and the aliens living among you, for all the good things which the LORD your God has given to you and to your family.

6 7

9

10

11

Some scholars regard this prayer to be a very ancient tradition that exposes the heart of the Israelites' faith. Notice that the prayer is historically oriented and that it celebrates the Exodus as divine liberation. Clearly, Israelite faith sets human action within the context of divine action, from which the human action derives its ultimate significance. The next passage summarizes the vacillating commitment of the Israelites to the God of their liberation from bondage in Egypt. Moses, you will recalt led the Israelites in their Exodus from Egypt. He did not, however, guide them into Canaan, their promised land." That task was left to his successor, Joshua, an able military leader who led the Israelites successfully in their attempt to establish settlements among the inhabitants of Canaan. The Israelites were unable, however, to destroy the indigenous Canaanites. They remained as a constant military threat to the Israelite newcomers, and their polytheistic religion, with its emphasis on fertility and the cycles of nature, represented a powerful alternative to the Israelite faith centered in the God of the Exodus. The following passage suggests that in times of prosperity the Israelites tended to forget the God of the Exodus with His ethical demands and 11

THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS

instead embraced the Baal of the Canaanites with his sexually sensuous religious rites. In times of adversity, however, the Israelites would return to the worship of the God of deliverance, the one who brought them out of bondage in E gypt. 6 7

8 9 10

11 12

13 14

15

JOSHUA DISMISSED THE PEOPLE, AND THE Israelites went off to occupy the country, each man to his allotted portion. As long as Joshua was alive and the elders who survived him-everyone1 that is1 who had witnessed the whole great work which the LORD had done for Israel-the people worshipped the LORD. At the age of a hundred and ten Joshua son of Nun1 the servant of the LORD1 died1 and they buried him within the border of his own property in Timnath-heres north of Mount Gaash in the hill-country of Ephraim. Of that whole generation1 all were gathered to their forefathers1 and another genera­ tion followed who did not acknowledge the LORD and did not know what he had done for Israel. Then the Israelites did what was wrong in the eyes of the LORD1 and worshipped the Baalim. They forsook the LORD1 their fathers' God who had brought them out of Egypt1 and went after other gods1 gods of the races among whom they lived; they bowed before them and provoked the LORD to anger; they forsook the LORD and worshipped the Baal and the Ashtaroth. The LORD in his anger made them the prey of bands of raiders and plunderers; he sold them to their enemies all around them1 and they could no longer make a stand. Every time they went out to battle the LORD brought disaster upon them1 as he had said when he gave them his solemn warning1 and they were in dire straits.

The LORD set judges over them1 who rescued them from the marauding bands. Yet they did not listen even to these judges1 but turned wantonly to worship other gods and bowed down before them; all too soon they aban­ doned the path of obedience to the Lmm's commands which their fore­ fathers had followed. They did not obey the LORD. Whenever the LORD set up a judge over them1 he was with that judge1 and kept them safe from their enemies so long as he lived. The LORD would relent as often as he heard them groaning under oppression and ill­ treatment. But as soon as the judge was dead, they would relapse into deeper corruption than their fore­ fathers and give their allegiance to other gods1 worshipping them and bowing down before them. They gave up none of their evil practices and their wilful ways. And the LORD was angry with Israel and said, 'This nation has broken the covenant which I laid upon their forefathers and has not obeyed me1 and now1 of all the nations which Joshua left at his death1 I will not drive out to make room for them one single man. By their means I will test Israet to see whether or not they will keep strictly to the way of the LORD as their forefathers did.' So the LORD left those nations alone and made no haste to drive them out or give them into Joshua's hands.

l6 17

18

19

20

21

22 23

This view of the Israelite struggle with Canaanite culture, with the implicit claim that fidelity to God and His purposes leads to peace and prosperity, while rejection of God and His plans leads to strife and adversity, is at the core of an enormously influential stream of thought called the Deuteronomic theology of history. Indeed, does it not seem fitting that the righteous should be happy and that the unrighteous should be miserable? Accordingly, adversity and suffering in the life of a nation (or individual) would be interpreted as evidence that the will of God was being violated. The Deuteronomic moral law of cause and effect (that is, the claim that as you sow, so shall you reap) seemed to explain quite well the adversities that befell

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION

703

people and offered the Israelites a cosmic story whose power to interpret events endured for centuries. In 586 s.c. N ebuchadrezzar, King of Babylon, destroyed Jerusalem and car­ ried the leading citizens of the nation into exile in Babylon. For years, prophets had warned of a coming doom that would be a fitting punishment for Israel's neglect of righteousness and disregard for social justice. The destruction of Jerusalem seemed to be not only that prophesied punishment for Israel's sins, but also a devastation of the nation itself, and even an incentive to abandon faith in the cosmic story that God was working with the"chosen people," the children of Israel to create a holy and just human community. One might think that the cosmic story beginning with God's summons to Abraham would be discredited beyond recovery. No doubt there was some loss of faith; but the destruction of Jerusalem and the exile in Babylon inspired a fresh outpouring of religious seri­ ousness. Great prophetic voices like those of Ezekiel and Second Isaiah helped to keep faith alive. Indeed, Second Isaiah went so far as to internationalize Israel's cosmic story. Second Isaiah discerned the purposes of God to be more inclusive than merely creating a nation of Israelites who pursued righteousness and jus­ tice. For Second Isaiah, the community of God's concern embraced all peoples. In one of the famous "Servant of God" passages, Second Isaiah envisions an international mission for the Servant. Some scholars think that the "Servant" refers to an individual, while others believe the reference is to the Israelite com­ munity. No matter who "Servant" refers to, Israel's cosmic story here takes on a global dimension. 42

2

3

4

5

Here is my servant, whom I uphold, my chosen one in whom I delight, I have bestowed my spirit upon him, and he will make justice shine on the nations. He will not call out or lift his voice high, or make himself heard in the open street. He will not break a bruised reed, or snuff out a smoldering wick; he will make justice shine on every race, never faltering, never breaking down, he will plant justice on earth, while coasts and islands wait for his teaching. Thus speaks the LORD who is God, he who created the skies and stretched them out, who fashioned the earth and all that grows in it,

who gave breath to its people, the breath of life to all who walk upon it: I, the LORD, have called you with righteous purpose and taken you by the hand; I have formed you, and appointed you to be a light to all peoples, a beacon for the nations, to open eyes that are blind, to bring captives out of prison, out of the dungeons where they lie in darkness. I am the LORD; the LORD is my name; I will not give my glory to another god, nor my praise to any idol. See how the first prophecies have cmne to pass, and now I declare new things; before they break from the bud I announce them to you.

6

7

8

9

THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS

Almost fifty years after the destruction of Jerusalem, Cyrus the Great of Persia conquered Babylon and allowed the exiled Israelites to return to Palestine to rebuild their nation. To many of the exiles it must have seemed as if the Deuteronomic moral law was being vindicated. Israel had paid heavily for her centuries of sins, but her renewed commitment to God was now being rewarded. With understandable zeat the repatriates attempted to establish a holy commu­ nity in Palestine that would remain faithful to God come what may. Scrupulously, they tried to obey the laws of Moses. According to Deuteronomic theory, this building of a holy community should have produced peace and prosperity, but it did not. Strife and adversity plagued the Israelites in their rebuilding. The Deuteronomic cosmic story w�s seriously challenged. Pious Israelites began to ask, "Why do the righteous suffer? Why do bad things happen to good people?" Those are the questions with which the Book of Job wrestled in the post-exilic period. In the Book of Job, one of humankind's poetic masterpieces, we encounter Job, a righteous, thinking man whose suffering calls into question the established Deuteronomic doctrine that whatsoever one sows that will one also reap. Job had lived a righteous life and had tasted the sweet fruits of prosperity. As the poem begins, Job is deluged by a tidal wave of adversity. Three friends come to comfort him. By his side they sit in silence for seven days. Job breaks the silence with a cry of dereliction, wishing that he had never been born. Wondering why he has been called upon to suffer when he has tried so dili­ gently to live uprightly, feeling betrayed by God and scoffed at by miscreants, Job cries out for healing words. Does he receive such healing from his friends? Hardly. An extended debate ensues, in which they affirm over and over the orthodox doctrine of divine retribution and try to convince Job that his afflic­ tions are punishments for sins. They challenge Job to search his past, to acknowl­ edge his misdeeds, and to seek forgiveness. Job, a thinking and honest man, can­ not discern anything in his past conduct that merits such affliction. Indeed, his experience stands as evidence that seems to falsify the Deuteronomic cosmic story championed by his three compatriots. But Job's quarrel is not just with those three friends. Because Job believed that God was ultimately responsible for all events, his complaint, in the final analysis, is directed against God Himself. Indeed, Job declares that if he could just find God, he would challenge Him to his face on the issue of the unjust suffering of the righteous. The poem reaches its climax and conclusion when God Himself enters the debate and asks ques­ tions that reveal how puny is the wisdom of Job that has called into question the wisdom of God. God's interrogation of Job reduces him to submission and silence. Here are but a few verses from this grand poem that calls into question the Deuteronomic story. We begin with the arrival of Job's three friends, who have come to console him on the loss of his material wealth, the death of his sons and daughters, and the savage affliction of his body with disease.

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION 11

12

13

When Job's three friends, Eliphaz of Teman, Bildad of Shuah, and Zophar of Naamah, heard of all these calamities which had overtaken him, they left their homes and arranged to come and condole with him and comfort him. But when they first saw him from a distance, they did not recognize him; and they wept aloud, rent their cloaks and tossed dust into the air over their heads. For seven days and seven nights they sat beside him on the ground, and none of them said a word to him; for they saw that his suffering was very great.

3 l-2After this Job broke silence and cursed the day of his birth: 3

11 12

Perish the day when I was born and the night which said,'A man is conceived'! ... Why was I not still-born, why did I not die when I came out of the womb? Why was I ever laid on my mother's knees

or put to suck at her breasts? Why was I not hidden like an untimely birth, like an infant that has not lived to see the light? For then I should be lying in the quiet grave, asleep in death, at rest, with kings and their ministers who built themselves palaces, with princes rich in gold who filled their houses with silver. There the wicked man chafes no more, there the tired labourer rests; the captive too finds peace there and hears no taskmaster's voice; high and low are there, even the slave, free from his master. Why should the sufferer be born to see the light? Why is life given to men who find it so bitter?

705

16

13

14

15 17 18 19 20

One of his friends replies to Job's cry with an affirmation of the Deuteronomic moral order: as one sows, so one reaps. 4

Then Eliphaz the Temanite began:

2

If one ventures to speak with you, will you lose patience? For who could hold his tongue any longer? Think how once you encouraged those who faltered, how you braced feeble arms, how a word from you upheld the stumblers and put strength into weak knees. But now that adversity comes upon you, you lose patience;

3

4 5

it touches you, and you are unmanned. Is your religion no comfort to you? Does your blameless life give you no hope? For consider, what innocent man has ever perished? Where have you seen the upright destroyed? This I know, that those who plough mischief and sow trouble reap as they have sown; they perish at the blast of God and are shrivelled by the breath of his nostrils.

6

7

8 9

Job responds, demanding that he be made aware of his misdeeds. 6

Then Job answered:

2

0 that the grounds for my resentment might be weighed,

and my misfortunes set with them on the scales! For they would outweigh the sands of the sea:

3

THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS

4

5

6

7

8

what wonder if my words are wild? The arrows of the Almighty find their mark in me, and their poison soaks into my spirit; God's onslaughts wear me away. Does the wild ass bray when he has grass or the ox low when he has fodder? Can a man eat tasteless food unseasoned with salt, or find any flavor in the juice of mallows? Food that should nourish me sticks in my throat, and my bowels rumble with an echoing sound.

that he would be pleased to crush me, to snatch me away with his hand and cut me off! For that would bring me relief, and in the face of unsparing anguish I would leap for joy. Have I the strength to wait? What end have I to expect, that I should be patient?

9

Is my strength the strength of stone, or is my flesh bronze? Oh how shall I find help within myself? The power to aid myself is put out of my reach....

12

0 that I might have my request, that God would grant what I hope for:

Tell me plainly, and I will listen in silence; show me where I have erred.

24

10

11

13

Another of his friends reiterates the Deuteronomic doctrine, in response to which Job protests that he is blameless and claims that God destroys the innocent and the wicked alike. 8

Then Bildad the Shuhite began:

2

How long will you say such things, the long-winded ramblings of an old man? Does God pervert judgment? Does the Almighty pervert justice? Your sons sinned against him, so he left them to be victims of their own iniquity. If only you will seek God betimes and plead for the favor of the Almighty, if you are innocent and upright, then indeed will he watch over you and see your just intent fulfilled. Then, though your beginnings were humble, your end will be great....

3 4

5

6

7

9

Then Job answered:

2

Indeed this I know for the truth, that no man can win his case against God. If a man chooses to argue with him, God will not answer one question in a thousand.

3

He is wise, he is powerful; what man has stubbornly resisted him and survived? ...

4

Though I am right, I get no answer, though I plead with my accuser for mercy. If I summoned him to court and he responded, I do not believe that he would listen to my pleafor he bears hard upon me for a trifle and rains blows on me without cause; he leaves me no respite to recover my breath but fills me with bitter thoughts. If the appeal is to force, see how strong he is; if to justice, who can compel him to give me a hearing? Though I am right, he condemns me out of my own mouth; though I am blameless, he twists my words. Blameless, I say; of myself I reek nothing, I hold my life cheap. But it is all one; therefore I say,

15

16

17 18

19

20

21 22

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION 'He destroys blameless and wicked alike' ... 10

I am sickened of life; I will give free rein to my griefs,

I will speak out in bitterness of soul. I will say to God, 'Do not condemn me, but tell me the ground of thy complaint against me.

707 2

Job reminds his friends that, like them, he has a lifetime of experience, and that he does understand what they are saying. Unlike them, however, he is pre­ pared to argue with God Himself about unmerited suffering. 13

2 3

4

5 6 7

8 9

10

All this I have seen with my own eyes, with my own ears I have heard it, and understood it. What you know, I also know; in nothing do I fall short of you. But for my part I would speak with the Almighty and am ready to argue with God, while you like fools are smearing truth with your falsehoods, stitching a patchwork of lies, one and all. Ah, if you would only be silent and let silence be your wisdom! Now listen to my arguments and attend while I put my case. Is it on God's behalf that you speak so wickedly, or in his defence that you allege what is false? Must you take God's part, or put his case for him? Will all be well when he examines you? Will you quibble with him as you quibble with a man? He will most surely expose you

if you take his part by falsely accusing me. Will not God's majesty strike you with dread, and terror of him overwhelm you? Your pompous talk is dust and ashes, your defenses will crumble like clay. Be silent, leave me to speak my mind, and let what may come upon me! I will put my neck in the noose and take my life in my hands. If he would slay me, I should not hesitate; I should still argue my cause to his face. This at least assures my success, that no godless man may appear before him. Listen then, listen to my words, and give a hearing to my exposition. Be sure of this: once I have stated my ca'.:ie I know that I shall be acquitted. Who is there that can argue so forcibly with me that he could reduce me straightway to silence and death?

11

12 13 14

15

16 17 18

19

Intransigently, Job's friends cling to the Deuteronomic doctrine and repeat­ edly challenge Job to repent of his sins so that God will cease to afflict him. 22

Then Eliphaz the Temanite answered:

2

Can man be any benefit to God? Can even a wise man benefit him? Is it an asset to the Almighty if you are righteous? Does he gain if your conduct is perfect? Do not think that he reproves you because you are pious,

4

that on this count he brings you to trial. No: it is because you are a very wicked man, and your depravity passes all bounds....

5

Come to terms with God and you will prosper;

21

THE STORY OF THE GOD WHO ACTS

22 23

24

25

26

that is the way to mend your fortune. Take instruction from his mouth and store his words in your heart. If you come back to the Almighty in true sincerity, if you banish wrongdoing from your home, if you treat your precious metal as dust and the gold of Ophir as stones from the river-bed, then the Almighty himself will be your precious metal; he will be your silver in double measure. Then, with sure trust in the Almighty,

you will raise your face to God; you will pray to him, and he will hear you, and you will have cause to fulfill your vows. In all your designs you will succeed, and light will shine on your path; but God brings down the pride of the haughty and keeps safe the man of modest looks. He will deliver the innocent, and you will be delivered, because your hands are clean.

27

28

29

30

Job really wants to argue with God, not with these purveyors of conven­ tional wisdom. Job's desire is realized. God addresses him from the midst of a storm. 38

2 3

4

5

6

7

8

9

10

Then the LORD answered Job out of the tempest: Who is this whose ignorant words cloud my design in darkness? Brace yourself and stand up like a man; I will ask questions, and you shall answer. Where were you when I laid the earth's foundations? Tell me, if you know and understand. Who settled its dimensions? Surely you should know. Who stretched his measuring-line over it? On what do its supporting pillars rest? Who set its corner-stone in place, when the morning stars sang together and all the sons of God shouted aloud? Who watched over the birth of the sea, when it burst in flood from the womb?when I wrapped it in a blanket of cloud and cradled it in fog, when I established its bounds,

fixing its doors and bars in place, and said, 'Thus far shall you come and no farther, and here your surging waves shall halt.' In all your life have you ever called up the dawn or shown the morning its place? ... Have you descended to the springs of the sea or walked in the unfathomable deep? Have the gates of death been revealed to you? Have you ever seen the door-keepers of the place of darkness? Have you comprehended the vast expanse of the world? Corne, tell me all this, if you know. Which is the way to the home of light and where does darkness dwell? And can you then take each to its appointed bound and escort it on its homeward path? Doubtless you know all this; for you were born already, so long is the span of your life! Have you visited the storehouse of the snow

11

12

16

17

18

19

20

21

22

THE BIBLICAL TRADITION

23

or seen the arsenal where hail is stored, which I have kept ready for the day of calamity, for war and for the hour of battle? ...

40

Then the Lorrn said to Job:

2

Is it for a man who disputes with the Almighty to be stubborn? Should he that argues with God answer back?

3

And Job answered the LORD:

4

What reply can I give thee, I who carry no weight? I put my finger to my lips. I have spoken once and now will not answer again; twice I have spoken, and I will do so no more.

5

6

Then the LORD answered Job out of the tempest:

7

Brace yourself and stand up like a man; I will ask questions, and you shall answer. Dare you deny that I am just or put me in the wrong that you may be right?

8

Have you an arm like God's arm, can you thunder with a voice like his? Deck yourself out, if you can, in pride and dignity, array yourself in pomp and splendour; unleash the fury of your wrath, look upon the proud man and humble him; look upon every proud man and bring him low, throw down the wicked where they stand; hide them in the dust together, and shroud them in an unknown grave. Then I in my turn will acknowledge that your own right hand can save you....

709 9 10 11 12

13 14

Then Job answered the LORD:

42

I know that thou canst do all things and that no purpose is beyond thee. But I have spoken of great things which I have not understood, things too wonderful for me to know. I knew of thee then only by report but now I see thee with my own eyes. Therefore I melt away; I repent in dust and ashes.

2 3

5 6

So Job's question "Why do bad things happen to good people?" rernains unanswered; his outspoken challenge to the Deuteronomic story is silenced. Does that silence suggest that the Deuteronomic view is validated? Or does the silence suggest that the suffering of the righteous person is a riddle that does not fit neatly into the story as structured by conventional wisdom? If so, does that silence sug­ gest that the Deuteronomic cosmic story needs revision? If so, in what way? There are several ways in which that cosmic story could be revised. One approach would be to claim, along with John Stuart Mill (see Chapter 5), that God is finite. In that case, God could be viewed as willing but unable to ensure that bad things will not happen to good people. God would be seen as genuinely needing human beings to promote his purposes. To be needed by God is no insignificant task for a human. Would not such a revision of the cosmic theory provide a solu­ tion to Job's puzzle, and invest human life with abiding purpose and meaning? Or would regarding God as finite remove the assurance that God's purposes would ultimately prevail, and thereby divest this cosmic story of its power to satisfy the human quest for meaning? Would affirming a finite God only make matters worse as Bradley claims in his response to Mill? (See Chapter 5, again.)

THE STORY OF TRANSCENDING SUFFERING

Another approach would be to build on Bradley's suggestion that myster1es" are to be expected in religious thinking. One might claim, for example, that God acts, through events, to promote his purposes; that God does reward right­ eousness and punish evil; and that righteous people do frequently experience unmerited suffering. But one could add the further claim that suffering is a mys­ tery that currently transcends human intelligence. Would that addendum to the cosmic story really satisfy the questions of the innocent who suffer? Still another approach would be to extend the concept of human life to include postdeath survival (the issue addressed in Chapter 4). One could then claim that unmerited suffering would in due course receive appropriate compen­ sation, if not on this side of death, then surely on the other. The notion of post­ death compensation for current privation became an increasingly appealing addi­ tion to the cosmic story during the post-exilic period when thinking about life after death gained increased attention. This approach became especially attractive to Christians in light of their belief in the resurrection of Jesus as the Christ. But what kind of postdeath situation would be, indeed could be, adequate compensa­ tion for the painful death of a little child or for the innocent victims of war? Since Job, the biblical cosmic story has been questioned, rethought, and refined. It will, no doubt, continue to be pondered and revised because it brings together three important human realities: the will to meaning; the sense of the divine; and the experience of unmerited suffering. As you reflect on the selections in this section, remember that space limita­ tions have allowed us to include only a very few passages from an extensive and diverse literary tradition. We invite you to enhance the discussion of this section by examining on your own the rich variety of that tradition. The biblical story of a God who acts to accomplish his purposes invests the lives of some people, but not alt with meaning. Other people look to other cos­ mic stories for meaning. We turn next to an ancient story that has been widely received by diverse peoples: the Buddhist story. 11

Norn ON SOURCES. The material in this section is quoted from The New English Bible with the Apocrypha (New York: Oxford University Press, 1976). Passages are from Deuteronomy 26:1-11; Judges 2:6-23; Isaiah 42:1-9; and Job 2:11-3:3; 3:11-20; 4:1-9; 6:1-13, 24; 8:1-7; 9:1-4, 15-22; 10:1-2; 13:1-19; 22:1-5, 21-30; 38:1-12, 16-23; 40:1-14; 42:1-6.

THE BUDDHIST TRADITION THE STORY Of TRANSCENDING SUIFIFERING

FROM THE BIBLICAL TO THE BUDDHIST TRADITION. In this chapter we examine the stories people tell about themselves to try to connect human events with each other so that life appears to be moving in a certain direction, toward an intelligi­ ble goal. The biblical story portrayed the patriarchs (Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob)

I :;�

l t

i

i

THE BUDDHIST TRADITION

711

and their descendants responding to the summons from God to become a holy, righteous, and just community that would eventually bring spiritual enlighten­ ment to humankind. Running through this story is the Deuteronomic theme that God rewards the righteous with peace and prosperity but punishes the wicked with strife and adversity. Apparently, this story was able to invest the lives of believers with a sense of meaning and purpose for centuries. Presumably the suf­ fering of innocent individuals could be explained as divine punishment for the sins of their ancestors. But when the children of Israel seemed to have paid fully for their past sins, through the destruction of Jerusalem and the subsequent exile in Babylon, the suffering of innocent persons became a serious challenge to the biblical story. That challenge was articulated powerfully by the Book of Job some time after the return of the exiles to Palestine in the middle of the sixth century B.C. In the twentieth century the questions asked by Job have again been raised, because of the carnage of two World Wars, the horrors of the Holocaust, the destruction of Hiroshima and Nagasaki, and the killing fields of Southeast Asia. As in Job's time, completely satisfying answers are not easy to find. At the same time Job was raising his questions in the Near East, during the sixth century, a different religious tradition in another part of the world was also seriously challenged. The place was India. The conventional wisdom under con­ sideration was enshrined in the Upanishads, part of the sacred writings of the early Indian tradition. The challenger was a young prince named Siddhartha of the Gautama family. The outcome was Buddhism. HISTORICAL NOTE. Two doctrines were articulated in the Upanishads (probably for the first time in Indian literature) that are important for our discussion: the doc­ trines of samsara and the Law of Karma. Samsara involves the belief in reincarnation. It is claimed that the soul of a human being who dies is, with one exception, reborn in another state of existence. That new state of existence (which may be in a lu!aven or a hell; as a vegetable, animal, or human; and for a long or short time) is deter­ mined by the Law of Karma, according to which good deeds result in a more favor­ able future existence while evil deeds lead to a less favorable future existence. The consequences of one's deeds are inescapable. If one has an elevated social status and wealth at the present time, it is because of good deeds in previous existences. Similarly, low social status, poverty, and affliction are indicators of evil deeds in previous existences. The doctrines of karma/samsara are blended in the following passage from the oldest and best known of the Upanishads: "those who are of pleas­ ant conduct here-the prospect is, indeed, that they will enter a pleasant womb, either the womb of a brahmin [i.e., a priest], or the womb of a ksatriya [i.e., a noble], or the womb of a vaisya [i.e., a peasant or artisan]. But those who are of stinking conduct here-the prospect is, indeed, that they will enter a stinking womb, either the womb of a dog, or the womb of a swine, or the womb of an outcast" (Chandogya Upanishad V.x.7). The one exception to the cycle of rebirths mandated for humankind involves the person who achieves moksha, that is, deliverance or release from that cycle. Moksha comes to the person 1Nho is enlightened, who has no nega­ tive karma remaining for which redress must be made in another existence.

THE STORY OF TRANSCENDING SUFFERING

Siddhartha Gautama challenged this doctrine of kanna/samsara not by reject­ ing it as false, but by discovering a strategy for overcoming it, a method for achieving release from the relentless cycle of rebirths, a technique presumably available to any person. The story of how Siddhartha actually reached Enlightenment and what he actually taught his followers is difficult, and probably impossible, to reconstruct. The story of his life as well as his teachings were handed down orally from one generation to another for many years before the oral tradition began to be com­ mitted to writing. By then, pious imagination and theological reflection had embellished and enriched the original story beyond recognition. Many different stories circulated about Gautama's life and about his previous lives as a Bodhisattva (a term applied to the Buddha prior to his achieving Enlightenment). A recovery of the historical Gautama, however, is not essential for our discussion. It is sufficient for us to summarize a few of those stories which have been told and retold by Buddhists through the centuries in order to gain some insight about what they consider to be the essence of Gautama's message-a message that invests their lives with purpose and meaning. THE ARGUMENT OF THE PASSAGES. Siddhartha was born about 560 B.C. in north­ ern India. According to tradition, his father was a ruler with considerable wealth. Although Siddhartha was surrounded by material possessions, and although he married a beautiful and devoted woman who bore him a son, he renounced these pleasures and became a homeless, wandering ascetic in search of spiritual enlightenment. Legend has it that Siddhartha's father had a premonition that his son might renounce the kingly life in order to search for an answer to the ques­ tion of human suffering. Accordingly, the father tried to shield the young prince from all sights of suffering that might awaken in him the urge to solve the prob­ lem of suffering. The gods, however, intervened during several of the young prince's excursions to a park outside the family's palace, and caused the young prince to encounter the three great bearers of human suffering: old age, disease, and death. Here is the story as told in the ]ataka. Now on a certain day the Future Buddha wished to go to the park, and told his chari­ oteer to make ready the chariot. Accordingly the man brought out a sumptuous and elegant chariot, and adorning it richly, he harnessed to it four state-horses of the Sindhava breed, as white as the petals of the white lotus, and announced to the Future Buddha that everything was ready. And the Future Buddha mounted the chariot, which was like to a palace of the gods, and proceeded towards the park. "The time for the enlightenment of prince Siddhartha draweth nigh," thought the gods; "we must show him a sign:" and they changed one of their number into a decrepit old man, broken-toothed, gray-haired, crooked and bent of body, leaning on a staff, and trembling, and showed him to the Future Buddha, but so that only he and the charioteer saw him. Then said the Future Buddha to the charioteer, in the manner related in the Mahapadana,"Friend, pray, who is this man? Even his hair is not like that of other men." And when he heard the answer, he said, "Shame on birth, since to every one that is born

THE BUDDHIST TRADITION

713

old age must come." And agitated in heart, he thereupon returned and ascended his palace. "Why has my son returned so quickly?" asked the king. "Sire, he has seen an old man," was the reply; "and because he has seen an old man,he is about to retire from the world." "Do you want to kill me, that you say such things? Quickly get ready some plays to be performed before my son. If we can but get him to enjoying pleasure, he will cease to think of retiring from the world." Then the king extended the guard to half a league in each direction. Again1 on a certain day, as the Future Buddha was going to the park, he saw a diseased man whom the gods had fashioned; and having again made inquiry, he returned, agitated in heart1 and ascended his palace. And the king made the same inquiry and gave the same orders as before; and again extending the guard1 placed them for three quarters of a league around. And again on a certain day, as the Future Buddha was going to the park1 he saw a dead man whom the gods had fashioned; and having again made inquiry1 he returned, agitated in heart, and ascended his palace. And the king made the same inquiry and gave the same orders as before; and again extending the guard1 placed them for a league around.

Finally, the gods presented to the young prince a model he could follow in seeking to understand and deal with the suffering he had come to know: a monk who had retired from the world. And again on a certain day, as the Future Buddha was going to the park, he saw a monk1 carefully and decently clad1 whom the gods had fashioned; and he asked his charioteer1 "Pray1 who is this man?" Now although there was no Buddha in the world1 and the charioteer hJ_,j no knowledge of either monks or their good qualities, yet by the power of the gods he was inspired to say1 "Sire1 this is one who has retired from the world;" and he there­ upon proceeded to sound the praises of retirement from the world. The thougl ;t of retiring from the world was a pleasing one to the Future Buddha....

Nothing could deter the young Siddhartha, the Future Buddha, from renouncing his princely life: neither the beauty of women, nor affection for his son Rahula, nor the pleasures of kingly rule. But the Future Buddha in his splendid chariot entered the city with a pomp and mag­ nificence of glory that enraptured all minds. At the same moment Kisa Gotami1 a vir­ gin of the warrior caste 1 ascended to the roof of her palace1 and beheld the beauty and majesty of the Future Buddha1 as he circumambulated the city; and in her plea­ sure and satisfaction at the sight1 she burst forth into this song of joy:"Full happy now that mother is, Full happy now that father is1 Full happy now that woman is1 Who owns this lord so glorious!" On hearing this, the Future Buddha thought, "In beholding a handsome figure the heart of a mother attains Nirvana, the heart of a father attains Nirvana1 the heart of a wife attains Nirvana. This is what she says. But wherein does Nirvana consist?"

averse to the answer came: And him,whose mind was fire of lust is extinct, that Nirvana; when the fires of hatred and infatuation are false extinct, that is Nirvana; when and all other -ncc,,cc1rYno and torments me a are extinct, that is Nirvana. She has what am looking for. behooves me this very and retire from the world in quest of Nirvana. send this lady a teacher's fee." And loosening from his neck a pearl necklace worth a hundred thousand pieces of money, he sent it to Kisa Gotami. And great was her satisfaction at this, for she "Prince Siddhartha has fallen in love with me, and has sent me a present.. ." ''It behooves me to go forth on the Great Retirement this very "said he;and he arose from his couch,and coming near the door,called out,"Who's there?" "Master, it is I, Channa," replied the courtier who had been sleeping with his head on the threshold. "I wish to go forth on the Great Retirement to-day.Saddle a horse for me." sire." And taking saddle and bridle with him, the courtier started for the stable. There, by the light of lamps fed with sweet-smelling oils, he perceived the mighty steed Kanthaka in his pleasant quarters, under a canopy of cloth beautified with a pattern of jasmine flowers. "This is the one for me to saddle to-day," he;and he saddled Kanthaka.... Now the Future Buddha,after he had sent Channa on his errand,thought to him­ self, "I will take just one look at my son;" and, rising from the couch on which he was sitting, he went to the suite of apartments occupied by the mother of Rahula, and opened the door of her chamber. Within the chamber was burning a lamp fed with sweet-smelling oil,and the mother of Rahula lay sleeping on a couch strewn deep with jasmine and other flowers, her hand resting on the head of her son. When the Future Buddha reached the threshold, he paused, and gazed at the two from where he stood. "If were to raise my wife's hand from off the child's head, and take hjm up,she would awake, and thus prevent my departure. will first become a Buddha, and then come back and see my son." So saying, he descended from the palace.... Thus the Future Buddha,casting away with indifference a universal so�.rer·eHmtv already in his grasp,-spewing it out as if were but phlegm,--departed from the in great splendor on the full-moon day of the month Asalhi, when the moon was in Libra. And when he had gone out from the city, he became desirous of looking back at it;but no sooner had the thought arisen in his mind, than the broad earth, seeming to fear lest the Great Being might neglect to perform the act of looking back, split and turned round like a potter's wheel. When the Future Buddha had stood a while fac­ ing the city and gazing upon it, and had indicated in that place the spot for the "Shrine of the Turning Back of Kanthaka," he turned Kanthaka in the direction in which he meant to go,and proceeded on his way in great honor and exceeding glory.

his hair and beard, Siddhartha set tells us that he tested the ancient India. First he tried the found too of asceticism but discovered such sects as years of severe self-mortification and self-starvation failed to lead to

THE BUDDHIST TRADITION

715

Siddhartha took nourishment and sat down under the Tree of Wisdom at Caya (also known as the Bodhi-tree or Bo-tree). There he meditated; and there he received the answer for which he had been searching. He discerned that the cause of human misery is "desire" or '' craving," and he discovered a strategy for eliminating that craving. Having gained enlightenment, he went to Varanast the ancient name for Benares. There, in the deer park outside the city, he encoun­ tered five ascetics, former friends who had disassociated themselves from him when he abandoned the way of asceticism. The Buddha, the Enlightened One, explained his newly discovered insight to these five monks in his famous ''Sermon in the Deer Park in Benares." In the Sermon, the Buddha outlines three of the most important concepts of Buddhism: the Four Noble Truths, the Noble Eightfold Path, and the Middle Way. THE FIRST SERMON1

These two extremes, 0 monks, are not to be practiced by one who has gone forth from the world. What are the two? That conjoined with the passions, low, vulgar, common, ignoble, and useless. Avoiding these two extremes the Tathagata 2 has gained the knowledge of the Middle Way, which gives sight and knowledge, and tends to calm, to insight, enlightenment, nirvana. What, 0 monks, is the Middle Way, which gives sight.... ? It is the noble Eightfold Path, namely, right views, right intention, right speech, right action, right livelihood, right effort, right mindfulness, right concentration. This, 0 monks, is the Middle Way.... (1) Now this, 0 monks, is the noble truth of pain: birth is painful, old age is painful, sickness is painful, death is painful, sorrow, lamentation, dejection 1 and despair are painful. Contact with unpleasant things is painful, not getting what one wishes is painful. In short the five khandhas of grasping are painful.3 (2) Now this, 0 monks, is the noble truth of the cause of pain: that craving which leads to rebirth, combined with pleasure and lust, finding pleasure hei e and there, namely, the craving for passion, the craving for existence, the craving for non­ existence. (3) Now this, 0 monks, is the noble truth of the cessation of pain: the cessation without a remainder of that craving, abandonment, forsaking, release, non-attach­ ment. (4) Now this, 0 monks, is the noble truth of the way that leads to the cessation of pain: this is the noble Eightfold Path, namely, right views, right intention, right speech, right action, right livelihood, right effort, right mindfulness, right concentra­ tion.... As long as in these noble truths my threefold knowledge and insight duly with its twelve divisions was not well purified, even so long, 0 monks, in the world with

1 Samyutta-nikaya v. 420; in Edward J. Thomas, The Life of Buddha as Legend and History (New York: Alfred A. Knopf, 1927), pp. 87-8. 2 "Tathagata" is a name for the Buddha. Literally it means one who has "thus come." 3 The five khandhas (groups or aggregates) are form, feeling (or sensation), perception (voli­ tional disposition), predispositions (or impressions), and consciousness.

knew. when in these noble truths my threefold its twelve divisions was well �"=•l-••�rl O monks1 the highest co1rnr:)1e1te enlightenment. Thus knew. arose that the release of my mind is no rebirth.

Buddha1 s sermon, and the Buddhist monastic order. The "'"n.... n-.-,,... gatt1�:r·cct around the Buddha to pursue his ..._,__.u,?.rf2[.'.:ah · n,n of the Buddha delivered an aversion for �errir.c;r a famous message that focuses on the need those features of human existence that burn with the passion of craving, a that attaches humans to their individual lives and to the of a,,_,."'"",.� that must be _,.,.��-�."!..!.!��_!:"• if one is to e:X:1.Jf2I.'lf2I'" the coolness of nirvana. The five ascetics were converted

II

0 rt

THE FIRE-SERMON Translated from the Maha-Vagga (i.21.1)

0

u�h:._,"'!_','c! .!'';,'�r:., t-

Then The Blessed One1 having dwelt in Uruvela as long as he wished1 proceeded on his wanderings in the direction of Caya Head, accompanied by a great congregation of priests1 thousand in number1 who had all of them aforetime been monks with matted hair.And there in Caya1 on Caya Head, The Blessed One dwelt together with the thousand priests. And there The Blessed One addressed the priests:All things1 0 priest are on fire.And what1 0 are all these which are on fire? "The eye1 0 priests1 is on fire; forms are on fire1 eye-consciousness is on impressions received the eye are on fire; and whatever sensation 1 unpleasant or indifferent1 originates in dependence on impressions r,..,,.,..,"'"'" eye1 that also is on fire. And with what are these on fire? "With the fire of passion, say l; with the fire of hatred1 with the fire of infatua­ tion; with birth, old age1 death1 sorrow, lamentation1 misery1 grie( and despair are they on fire. "The ear is on fire; sounds are on fire; ...the nose is on fire; odors are on fire; ... the tongue is on fire; tastes are on fire; ... the body is on fire; things tangible are on fire; ... the mind is on fire; ideas are on fire; ... mind-consciousness is on fire; impressions received by the mind are on fire; and whatever sensation1 pleasant, unpleasant1 or indifferent originates in dependence on impressions received by the mind1 that also is on fire. And with whatare these on fire? "With the fire of passion1 say I, with the fire of hatred1 with the fire of infatuaare tion; with birth1 old age1 death1 sorrow1 lamentation1 misery1 grie( and they on fire. 11

11

11

4 The goddess of temptation. 5 God in the role of creator.

the or the eye, for that also he conceives an aversion. Conceives an aver­ sion for the ear, conceives an aversion for sounds, .. conceives an aversion for nose, conceives an aversion for odors, ... conceives an aversion for the ceives an aversion for tastes, ... conceives an aversion for the body, conceives an aversion for the impressions received aversion for mind-consciousness, conceives the mind; and whatever sensation, PlE!asant, or indifferent, impressions received by the mind, for this also he conceives an and by the ,"""n- this aversion, he becomes divested of he becomes free, and when he is free he becomes aware that he is absence of free; and he knows that rebirth is exhausted, that he has lived the life, that he and that he is no more for this world." has done what it behooved him to Now while this exposition was being the minds of the thousand priests became free from attachment and delivered from the non...-""' c �.Ui-".L�Ll.LH.U

,,,..,....,,,

0

1 110 -

Here Endeth the Fire-Sermon

about dealing with is the At the heart of the Buddha's ...�_.,.,..�, "the Doctrine and the Path." The simplest statement of the Dharma is the Four Noble Truths cited above: all life is full of suffering; the cause of suffering is human craving, desire; cessation of suffering is attainable through the cessation of craving; the cessation of can be achieved the Noble involving a program of Eightfold in a life of cor,t.��':Ili-;lu.u When craving is er�1t1;tc·at,• '2,'1, the individual is freed from u�,... �,.. ,,..,_,, from the Nirvana. the Dharma offers both fering and a strategy for liberation. As Buddhism spread known as Mahayana Buddhism and a southern branch known as Theravada Buddhism and today in Sri Burma, and Theravada Buddhism cherished the an arhat, who, in accordance with the mandates of The Fire ideal of the Sermon, extinguishes craving, loses individual personality, and becomes absorbed in an impersonal bliss that foreshadows nirvana. Mahayana trast, cherishes the ideal of the bodhisattva, who, out of c,crrrr.JJ.�"'._,�JJl'v into the::_::_-;','-;:,��::::·:::.�· .. �� bliss of nirvana in order humans, refrains from entering to help others find the path to nirvana. Although the ideal of the Theravadans seems to be fixed on the specific individual's achievement of nirvana while the Mahayanists' ideal is more other-affirming, both traditions emphasize the devel­ �,_,,_,.,�.,. .. of certain human virtues that bring the cessation of sorrow and The strong emphasis on the elimination of human craving in both traditions seems to have committed Buddhism to the elimination of selfishness and the facilitation of benevolence. It is not cn·,-.r,,,,c,n t-�-.o,•rl will be more chaff than wheat, few chosen of the many called. Yet this not willed by God. Too this world of ours has connived at evil, too counted on the divine mercy, on God's forgiveness. Repentance was enough, men thought; nothing was forbidden. Everyone felt comfortably assured; when the day came, he would surely turn from his sins and repent. Pending that the easiest course was to surrender all along the line; divine compassion would do the rest.For a long while God gazed down on this town with eyes of c01np,as1,1on; but He grew His eternal hope was too long deferred, and now He has turned weary of His face away from us. And so, God's light withdrawn, we walk in darkness, in the thick darkness of this plague.... "My brothers," he cried, "that fatal hunt is up, and harrying our streets today. See him there, that angel of the pestilence, comely as Lucifer, shining like Evil's very self! He is hovering above your roofs with his great spear in his right hand, poised to strike, while his left hand is stretched toward one or other of your houses. Maybe at this very moment his finger is pointing to your door, the red spear crashing on its panels, and even now the plague is entering your home and settling down in your bedroom to await your return. Patient and watchful, ineluctable as the order of the scheme of things, it bides its time. No earthly power, nay, not even-mark me well­ the vaunted might of human science can avail you to avert that hand once it is stretched toward you. And winnowed like corn on the blood-stained threshing-floor of suffering, you will be cast away with the chaff.... "Yes, the hour has come for serious thought. You fondly imagined it was enough to visit God on Sundays, and thus you could make free of your You believed some brief formalities, some bendings of the knee, would recomp·nse Him well enough for your criminal indifference. But God is not mocked. These brief encounters could not sate the fierce hunger of His love. He wished see you longer and more often; that is His manner of loving and, indeed, it is the only manner of lov­ ing. And this is why, wearied of waiting for you to come to Him, He loosed on you this visitation; as He has visited all the cities that offended against Him since the dawn of history. Now you are learning your lesson, the lesson that was learned by of Sodom and Gomorrah, by Job and Pharaoh, Cain and his offspring, by the by all that hardened their hearts against Him. And like them you have been behold­ ing mankind and all creation with new eyes, since the gates of this city closed on you and on the pestilence. Now, at last, you know the hour has struck to bend your thoughts to first and last things."

Paneloux ends his sermon by that the evil of the may be transformed into ;c,v•v-....., ... if it becomes the means whereby the townsfolk are brought closer to God. Paneloux softens his claim that the the townsfolk especially after w1tnE�ssim the Paneloux now views the child. Rather than for humankind. ble of God's ........ ... ,JcJ

c,, ....... Lpositional attitudes, 621 >positional content, 620 ,positions,619 lists,623 uctionist,622 lacement, 622 th,622 Jrich,E. H.,486,487 ril,520 ias of Leontium,4 �-bush,81 ,Francisco de,611 )ry X,Pope,225 n, Susan, 668 Iles, Roger de,177 ·, George,313 lham,Arthur,176-178,179 )t,Francois,263,435 ey,Edmund,194-195 rmas,Jurgen,676 ,Hans, 340 lton, William, 263 et,513,520,524,537,672 iness,237-239,250,310. See also Hobbes,Mill, Nietzsche,Paley, Pascal r,Thomas,237,513,568 R. M.,287,291,292,366, 374-389 11ibal example,388-389 tmands,377 tmend, 377 1parison class,377,387

descriptive,378,381-383 "doog," 381 evaluative,378,381-383 motorcar example,378 Harvey,William,240,406,539, 540 Hastings,Warren,423 Hauser,Kasper,504 Havit,Mr., 626. See also Gettier example, Mr. Nogot Hawkes,Ms.,191 Haydn,Franz J.,488,507 Hedonistic calculus,312 Hedonistic paradox, 449 Hegel, G. W. F.,16,44,99,326, 514,558,574 Heidegger,Martin,100,103,106, 676 Heisenberg's Uncertainty Principle,132 Helmholtz, Hermann,659 Helvetius, Claude A.,93 HenryV,513 Hepburn,H. W.,286 Hephaestus,9 Heracleitus,683 Hercules,421 Here, 9, 11 Hermeneutics,673 Herrick, C. Judson,160,161 Hertz,Rudolf,659 Hesiod,15 Hick,John,224,274-287 Hindu,Hinduism,156 Hippias of Elis,4 Hitler,Adolf,206,448,474 Hobbema,488 Hobbes, T.,40,404-412,413,447, 466,470,538,539-546,550, 557,562,569,571 appetites/aversions,406-407, 544 body,541 cause (and effect),541-542 commonwealth,412 covenants,411-412 desire,544 determinism,541-542 egoism,406,408,412

endeavor,543 felicity (happiness),408,412 free will,544 God,541,545 good/evil,407,544 imagination,542 justice/injustice,408,410, 411-412 justified force,447 laws of nature,410,411 liberty,411 life,nasty,410,412,413 love/hate,407 materialism,40,541 motion,406, 412,541 perception, 542-543 pleasure/displeasure,407 power, 408,410,411,412 right/wrong,408,410,544 right of nature,410,411 right to revolt,412 self-interest,406,407,408,412 sensationism,542 state of nature,404,408,410, 412,413 war/peace,408,409,410,411, 412 will, 544 Hokusai, Katsushika, 519 Holbach, Baron D',92-98,100, 119 pseudonym,Mirabaud,93 Holistic,133 Holocaust,130 Homeopathy, 649 Homer,15,324,484 Homunculi, 60,80 Hospers,John,135, 480, 514-526 Hugo,Victor,499 Humanism, lOlff. Hume, David, 93,216,217,224, 240-249,250,263,264,265, 299,340,374,377,414,493, 557,558,572,582-590,591, 593,594,595,59�601,602, 612,613,618,625,631,659 causal analogy,244-248 causality,585 constant conjunction, 586

INDEX

::ustom,588-589 =lesign,243-248 2mpiricism,582 2vil,247-248,298 first cause,248-249 free will,587 habit,588 ideas,583 impressions,582 infinite regression,248-249 mind,584 miracles,241-243,248 objects,584 perceptions,584 proofs of God,224,241-249 quality,583 representational account of mind,63 self,584 skepticism,241,248,249 substance,583 uniformity in nature,241-242, 588,590 urd, G. S.,185 usserl, Edmund,676 uxley,Julian,638 uxley,Thomas H.,224,243, 259-265,266,269,271,638 agnosticism,259,262-265,266 uysmans,Joris Karl,507 ypothetical behavioral,54 imperative,304 go,520 )Sen, Henrik,335 lealism,42,546,611. See also Berkeley lentity,in the strict sense,48 lentity theory,45,46,52 lentity thesis,633 nitation game,67 nmortality,153££.,309,555,591 astral body,201-202,211, 217-219 definition of,154,155-156, 201-202,210-211 evidence assessed,195-200 illusion,167

objections to,155-167, 196-200, 209--219 paranormal evidence for apparitions, 172,179-183, 195,198,211 mediums,193--195, 198,206, 207,213 near-death experiences, 190-192 out-of body experience, 190-192, 195,198 possession,. 184-190, 198 reasons for desiring,168-169 reincarnation,156,176-179, 195,198,200,201,206,208 Replica Objection,209,211-212 resurrection,154,201,207,208, 209,284-287 soul,disembodied spirit,201, 203,204,205,206,208,209, 212 versus annihilation,153-167, 201 Impressions,582,595. See also Hume Indeterminism,111 definition of,122 Indubitandum, 28 Industrial revolution,311 Innate ideas,79 Intentionality,77,79 Inverted spectrum,62 Is,of identity,48 Is-Ought distinction, 375 Isaac,221,700,710 Jacob1 221,700,701,710 Jaggar, Alison,663-671, 672 discovery,663 emotion,663££. feminist theory,668££. ideology,665 justification,663 misogyny,665 outlaw emotions,663,667,671 positivist,664,665,667 privilege (epistemological),669 Western epistemology,663 James I,405

763

James, Henry,272 James,William,45,92, l19ff.,197, 249,259,265-274,516,684 belief in God 1 224 chance,123££. determinism definition of,122 dilemma of, 119££.,128 finite God,265,273-274 genuine option,266-267,268 indeterminism definition of,122 mind,63 passional nature,267,268,271 pluralism,273-274 pragmatism,265 quagmire of evasion,140 regret judgments,125 religious hypothesis,268,269, 270,271 sentiment of rationality,121, 122 subjectivism, 127 will to believe,265,266,267, 272,273 Jamieson,John,206 Jaspers, Karl,103 Jefferson,Thomas,475 Jesus,163,164,209,286-287,472, 475,710 Job,704-710,711,733 John XXII, Pope,225 Jonson, Ben,539 Joseph (Father of Jesus),209 Joshua,702 Joyce,James,532 Julius Caesar,242 Jung, C. G., 90,690 Justice,25�39�40�410-412, 474,475,569 Kahan,J.,185 Kamala,164-165 Kant,Immanuel,167,168,240, 263,264,291,298,299-311, 322,323,326,340,348,390, 396,401,539,561,572,582, 590-601,609,612,613,618, 631,672,681

INDEX

mel (continued) 302,592 �,594 ge,300,593,594,600 1,595 lity,595 imperative,299,304,

of understanding, : other moralities,301 lumber,594,602 306 1,591 f God,223,224,591 nsibility,595 1eculation,596 n, 307,308,591,600 305,306 310 al imperative,304 .;,309,591 s,595 306 od,305 ise,303 302ff. h,306 )0

)99 1,599 riew,302 mology,599 )Wledge,300££. ,rality,299,300 rchology,598 �nee,299 592 I

598

vium, 310 priori,602 1emselves,307,600, :.is jl 303

universalizability,301 Kanthaka,714 Kekule,August,633 Kepler,Johannes,540,574 Kierkegaard,Soren,679 King,Martin Luther,404,466-478 civil disobedience, 404,471ff. injustice,474,475 just/unjust laws,404,473,474 justice,474,475 nonviolence,477 Kipling,Rudyard,507 Kisa Gotami,714 Knox,T.M,508,509 Koyre,Alexander,646 Kuhn,Thomas,633,641-649,650, 653-662,672,673,675 anomalies, 641 arbitrary element,641 consensus,641 historiographic revolution,645 history,644 logic (context) of discovery, 642,649 logic (context) of justification, 642,649 mature science,644 normal science,641,642,647, 648 paradigm,641-649 progress,641 research tradition,643 revolution,641,647,648 scientific community,642,646 La Place, Pierre S.,542 Lacan,Jacques,676 Lagard-Quost,P. H.J.,383 Lakatos,I.,657,662 Lamarckians, 660 Lamartine,Alphonse M. L.,499 Lamont,Corliss,154-167,168, 169,201,209 immortality,155ff. definition of,155 Laudan,Larry,653-662,663,682 big picture,655 counter-examples to Kuhn, 658-661

hard core,657 mature science,658 paradigm,653,655 rationality,654,656 relativism,657 reticulated picture,657 sequential charge,654 simultaneous charge,654 subjectivism,657 Law,404,410,413-419,422, 432-434,442,446-448,449, 450,453,455,456,462 basis of force, 414-415 general will,416-418,432 protection,456,464 religion,424,429,430 social compact,415-416 civil disobedience,404,467-470, 471ff. definition of,403,404,418 divine right of kings,405 just,404,410,411-412,468,473, 474 justifiable revolution,433 karma,711. See also moral law legislated, 403-404,418,434 moral,302ff.,473,702,704, 705, 711,721,722,725,730 natural,241,473 of nature, 410,411 of three stages,573 parsimony,166-167 serves ruling class,442,446 social development, 433 unjust,404,410,411-412,418, 469,473,474 Lear,520 Lehrer,Keith,582,618,625-629 acceptance,626 Chisholm's sheep example,627 coherence,625,628 externalism,625,629 foundationalism,625,628 Gettier example,626,627 justified (completely),626 truth,626 Leibnitz, Gottfried,16,45,103, 385,560

Lenin Leone Lesch Leuci1 Levi-S Lewis, Liaiso1 Liberal Liberta Liberty I-Lincoln Locke, l Locke,J Loebne1 Loft, Ca Logical l Lo gical 1 27 Louis X\ Lucretiu, Luther,I\ Lycon,6 Lyell,Ge1

Macbeth, MaccabeL McCarthy McClean-" McClintoc McGill,Ra Mach, Ern MacIntyre, Majoritaria Malcolm,I' Malthus, T. Manichaea Marcel, Gal Markoff,JOJ Martians,5: Marx,Karl, 466,4i alienation bourgeoisi 439,44 448 capital, 43S capitalism, 435

INDEX

�enin,V. I.,448 �eonardo da Vinci,486,488,499 �esch-Nyhan disease,135 �eucippus,21 �evi-Strauss,C.,652,676 �ewis,I. M.,185 �iaison areas (of the brain),87 �iberalism,250,450,452,459 �ibertarianism,92, 119 �iberty. See Burke,Emmet, Hobbes,Mill,Rousseau �incoln,Abraham,448,475 �ocke,D.,139,143,144,145 Jocke,John,93,217,582,590,681 Joebner,Hugh,71 Joft,Captain Robert,181,182 Jogical behaviorism,44,54,56 Jogical positivism,positivists,16, 274-275,350,601,606 Jouis XVIII,572 Jucretius,158,277 oUther,Martin,475 oycon,6 "yell,George,642 v1acbeth,520 v1accabeus,Judas,208 v1cCarthy,Joseph,155 v1cClean-Rice,Nicholas,185,189 v1cClintock,Barbara,663,669 v1cGill,Ralph,475 v1ach, Ernst, 659 v1aclntyre,Alasdair, 287, 397 v1ajoritarianism,450 v1alcolm, Norman, 81,85,86 v1althus,T. R.,313 v1anichaeanism,557 v1arcel,Gabriel,100,103 v1arkoff,John,69 v1artians,52 v1arx,Karl, 100,324,404, 432-447, 466,467,470 alienation,435 bourgeoisie, 435,436,437,438, 439,440,441,442,443,446, 448 capital,439,440,443,444,445 capitalism,capitalist,404,434, 435

class war,404,434,435,436, 441,444,447,448 Communism, 434,435,443,444, 445 Communists,434,435,436,443, 444,445,447 division of labor,436,439 economic substructure,433, 434,448 exploitation,433,440,444 forces of production,433,438, 439,442,446 freedom,445 humanness,434,435 instruments of production,437, 438,440,446 laws,404,433,434,442,446, 447-448 means of production, 438,439 mode of production,437,438, 445,446 power political,443,446,447 social,444,445 private property,444,445 proletarians, 404,435,436,439, 440,441,442,443,446,447 reification,100 relations of production,433, 437,439 revolution,433,434,435,442, 446,447 social superstructure,433,434 state,434,437,446 wage-labor,443,444,445 Mary,Mother of Jesus,209 Massillon, 499 Materialism,materialist,40,42, 52,154,200,211,222,538, 539,541,545,546,547,548, 558,559 definition of,21,222 Mathematical reasoning,93 Mazzarolles,177 Meaning in life,683,684 absurd,736 acting "as if",684,736,737 discovered/invented,690,694, 695,737

765

fluctuating,694 moral law,702,704,705,711, 721,722,725,730 open futures,699 purposeful life,685,687,688, 700,710 stories,684,685 cosmic,685,699,700,703,704, 709,710 of combatting suffering, 731-737 of God who acts,699-710 of pursuing moral ideat 718-730 of transcending suffering, 710-718 will to meaning,685,686-699 storytelling,685,686,737 suffering,298,559,684,685,688, 691,695,696,700,704-710, 711,715,717,732,733,736, 737 Meletus,4,6,7,10,11,12,13 Meredith, James,477 Mersenne, 24 Meshach,474 Messiah,208 Metaethics,389 Metaphysics,537-579 critical,539 definition of,538 dualism,538 idealism,538,547-557 materialism,539,540-546 monism,539 pluralism,538 positivism,572,573-579 skepticism,539 voluntarism,539,559-571 Metempsychosis,156 Metsu,488 Metternich, Prince K.,435 Michelangelo,488,499 Mill,James,311,313 Mill,John Stuart,249-259,262, 265,266,273,291,311, 313££.,323,340,350,396, 399,404,447-466,470,572, 709

INDEX

Stuart (continued) nt from analogy for 2r minds,81-82 erests,454 1 of other moralities, -316 lesign,251-252,253 Jd,224,250,253-257, l,457,458 1 of expression,457,458, 460,461,462 1 of thought,457,458, happiness principle, 317 ss,250,253,256,316,320 tic paradox,449 God, 256 tal rights,448,450,454, 457,459 tality, 456,462,463,464, ,450,453,455,456,462 n,250,450,452,459 �50,451,454,455,456, 458,462,463,464,465 f press,457,459,466 liberty,456,464 lles,317 ,454 ;election,252-253 s ranked,318,321 :48,449,450,451,452, 459,465 � of utility,312 · the greatest Jiness principle,317 ection,456 ntract,464 ntrol,453-455,456,457, 459,462,464,465 y/antipathy,454 �,455,458 lde,459-460 of majority,404,450,

utilitarianism,250,314,449 women,250,314 Miller,J.,676 Milton,John,404 Mind. See also Berkeley,Hume, Mill representational account,63 Mind-body problem,32,156-167, 169-171,202,209,683 dependence,158-166,169-171 identity, 170-171 raw feels,46,51,156 Minos,15 Miracle,241-243,248,250 definition of,241 Mitchell,Basil,287 Model,types of,65 Modernism, 675 Mohamed,S. A, 731 Molotov,V. M.,357 Mona Lisa,375,672 Monism,monistic, 45,154,157, 158,165,166,167,209,538 Monsignori, Francesco, 486 Montaigne,581 Moody,Raymond A.,Jr.,190-192 Moore, G. E.,33,345,366,374, 375,377,389,607 Moral rules,317,351,390 Morley,Lord,250 Morning star,46 evening star,46 Moses,700,701,704,719 Mozart,W. A,488,499,507,519, 524,525 Munsterberg,Hugo,120 Murdoch,Iris,397 Murphy, Gardner,159,172,197, 213,214,219 Musaeus,15 Myers,F. W. H.,194-195 Myth of Er,216 Nansen,Dr.,267 Napoleon,573 Natural selection, 252-253,259 Natural theology,223-224,225, 226,239,240,241,243,249, 250,256,265,582

Naturalism, naturalistic,366, 377 Naturalistic fallacy,375,377 Nature,221,259 Near-death experiences, 190-192 Nebuchadnezzar,474,703 Necessary being,228 Necessitarianism,93 Nelli,Rene,177,178 Neurath, Otto,340. See also Vienna Circle Newman,John Henry,271 Newton,Isaac,93,166,256,574, 642,643,644,658,659 Newtonian physics, 299 Nietzsche,Friedrich,100,156, 322,323,324,325,340,679, 689,692 altruism,330 aristocracy,326, 327 Christian morality,325,335-337 cultural relativism, 325 egoism,330 ethical relativism,291,325 exploitation,331 genealogy of morals,325 happiness,334 herd conscience,328,331 instinct,328 morality,328 immoralist,325 master morality,332,333 mediocrity,329 nay-saying,335,339 slave morality,332,333-334 transvaluation of values,325, 329,338 ubermensch (overman, superman),331,338 will to life,331 will to power,331,339 women (also effeminacy),330, 331,334-335 yea-saying,338 Nihilism,683,684,697, 736 Nobel Prize,86,101 Nogot,Mr.,626. See also Gettier example, Mr. Havit Nomological dangler,47

]\ ]\ ]\

C C 0

0 0

0 0

01 01 Pa; Pai Pal Pal e

Paln Pam Pant Parai Paral Parac Paral ParaParar app ESP mec nea1 out-,

J

Non-natural n .... ,,,,.,.c, ....1-1,=>c Normative ethics,289,389,390 166 Occam,William Odysseus,16 Opiate theory of religion,685 125,163 15 Osborne,Harold,519,524 Other minds,problem 45,81 Ought-is dichotomy,374 Out-of-body experiences, 190-192,195,198 Pagels,Heinz,141 Paine,Thomas,422 Palamedes,16 Paley,William,18,291,309,311, 322,323,340,468 ethics definition of,291 duty,295 happiness,297 obligation,295 prudence,296 right,294-295,298 virtue,294,295 will of 294,297 Palmer, George H.,120 Paneloux,Father,732,733,734,736 Pantheism, 263,563-564 Parable of Invisible 277-278 Parable of Travellers,283-284 Paradigm,641-649,653,655 Parallelism,45 Para-mechanical,40 Paranormal phenomena,154, 175-200,209,212 apparitions,172,179-183,195, 198,211 ESP,214-215,216,218 mediums,172,193-195,198, 206,207,213 ° near-death c:xrx:rlC.'I',C.'2 u, 190-192 out-of-body experiences, 190-192,195,198

184-190,198 reincarnation,156,176-179, 195,198,200,201,206,208 173,215 Parker,De Witt,530 Parmenides,222 Parrhasius,484 Parsimony,law of,166-167 Pascal,Blaise,224,231-239,240, 249,250,265,267 happiness,237-239 human dignity,236 human misery,235-237 infinities,234-235,236 mystic experience,232,237 proofs of God,234,239 unbelievers,three kinds, 232-234 wager,238-239 Pascal,Jacqueline,232 Pasricha,Satwant,185,186,187, 189 Passos,J. Dos,532 Pattison,E. M.,185 Paul,St.,121,208,472,475 Paulsen,171 Peirce, Charles,659,660 Penelham,Terrence,217 Perception, 174-175, 542-543, 584 Pericles,2,324 Ralph B.,359 Persuasive definition,382 Pessimism,108,126,130,559 Phenomenalism,202 Phidias,2 Philosophy definition of,1,16-18 Physicalism token,56 type,56 Picasso,P.,488 Piper,Mrs.,172,194 Pistol,513 Pitt,William,422 Planck,Max,643 Plato, Platonic, Platonism, 2,14, 21,158,196,202,203,204, 210,211,212,213,214,216,

218,257,481,483,484,485, 486,490,493,495,504,528, 631,671 Pleasure,137,312,318,321,407 Pliny,563 Pluralism,273-274,538 Allan,514,518 Poe, Ponge,107 Alexander,547 Karl,86,89,92,131-134 clocks clouds,133 Positivism,positivist,571-579, 602,617,631-640,641,653, 664,665,667,673,674 Postm od ernism, ,v,-